]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
gdb/doc: Remove mention of vCont's default actions
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2505 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2506 @value{GDBN}.
2507
2508 @item show inferior-tty
2509 @kindex show inferior-tty
2510 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2511 @end table
2512
2513 @node Attach
2514 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2515 @kindex attach
2516 @cindex attach
2517
2518 @table @code
2519 @item attach @var{process-id}
2520 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2521 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2522 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2523 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2524 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2525
2526 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2527 executing the command.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2531 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2532 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2533 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2534
2535 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2536 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2537 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2538 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2539 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2540 Specify Files}.
2541
2542 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2543 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2544 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2545 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2546 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2547 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2548 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2549
2550 @table @code
2551 @kindex detach
2552 @item detach
2553 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2554 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2555 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2556 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2557 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2558 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2559 executing the command.
2560 @end table
2561
2562 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2563 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2564 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2565 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2566 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2567 Messages}).
2568
2569 @node Kill Process
2570 @section Killing the Child Process
2571
2572 @table @code
2573 @kindex kill
2574 @item kill
2575 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2576 @end table
2577
2578 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2579 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2580 is running.
2581
2582 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2583 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2584 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2585 outside the debugger.
2586
2587 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2588 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2589 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2590 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2591 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2592 breakpoint settings).
2593
2594 @node Inferiors and Programs
2595 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2596
2597 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2598 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2599 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2600 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2601 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2602 from multiple executables.
2603
2604 @cindex inferior
2605 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2606 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2607 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2608 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2609 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2610 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2611 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2612 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2613 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2614 threads running in it.
2615
2616 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2617 inferiors}}:
2618
2619 @table @code
2620 @kindex info inferiors
2621 @item info inferiors
2622 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2623
2624 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2625
2626 @enumerate
2627 @item
2628 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2629
2630 @item
2631 the target system's inferior identifier
2632
2633 @item
2634 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2635
2636 @end enumerate
2637
2638 @noindent
2639 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2640 indicates the current inferior.
2641
2642 For example,
2643 @end table
2644 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2645
2646 @smallexample
2647 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2648 Num Description Executable
2649 2 process 2307 hello
2650 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2651 @end smallexample
2652
2653 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2654
2655 @table @code
2656 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2657 @item inferior @var{infno}
2658 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2659 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2660 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2661 @end table
2662
2663 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2664 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2665 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2666 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2667 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2668 information on convenience variables.
2669
2670 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2671 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2672 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2673 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2674 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2675 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2676
2677 @table @code
2678 @kindex add-inferior
2679 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2681 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2682 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2683 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2684 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2685
2686 @kindex clone-inferior
2687 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2688 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2689 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2690 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2691 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2692
2693 @smallexample
2694 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2695 Num Description Executable
2696 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2697 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2698 Added inferior 2.
2699 1 inferiors added.
2700 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2701 Num Description Executable
2702 2 <null> helloworld
2703 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2704 @end smallexample
2705
2706 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2707
2708 @kindex remove-inferiors
2709 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2710 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2711 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2712 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2713
2714 @end table
2715
2716 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2717 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2718 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2719 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2720
2721 @table @code
2722 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2724 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2725 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2726 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2727 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2728
2729 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2730 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2731 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2732 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2733 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2734 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2735 @end table
2736
2737 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2738 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2739 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2740 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2741
2742
2743 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2744 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2745
2746 @table @code
2747 @kindex set print inferior-events
2748 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2749 @item set print inferior-events
2750 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2751 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2752 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2753 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2754 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2755 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2756
2757 @kindex show print inferior-events
2758 @item show print inferior-events
2759 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2760 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2764 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2765 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2766
2767
2768 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2769 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2770 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2771 info program-spaces}} command.
2772
2773 @table @code
2774 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2775 @item maint info program-spaces
2776 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2777 @value{GDBN}.
2778
2779 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2780
2781 @enumerate
2782 @item
2783 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2784
2785 @item
2786 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2787 the @code{file} command.
2788
2789 @end enumerate
2790
2791 @noindent
2792 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2793 indicates the current program space.
2794
2795 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2796 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2797 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2798
2799 @smallexample
2800 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2801 Id Executable
2802 * 1 hello
2803 2 goodbye
2804 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2805 @end smallexample
2806
2807 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2808 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2809 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2810 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2811 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2812
2813 @smallexample
2814 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2815 Id Executable
2816 * 1 vfork-test
2817 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2818 @end smallexample
2819
2820 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2821 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2822 @end table
2823
2824 @node Threads
2825 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2826
2827 @cindex threads of execution
2828 @cindex multiple threads
2829 @cindex switching threads
2830 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2831 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2832 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2833 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2834 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2835 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2836 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2837
2838 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2839 programs:
2840
2841 @itemize @bullet
2842 @item automatic notification of new threads
2843 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2844 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2845 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2846 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2847 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2848 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2849 messages on thread start and exit.
2850 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2851 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2852 isn't compatible with the program.
2853 @end itemize
2854
2855 @cindex focus of debugging
2856 @cindex current thread
2857 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2858 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2859 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2860 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2861 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2862
2863 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2864 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2865 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2866 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2867 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2868 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2869 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2870 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2871 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2872 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2873
2874 @smallexample
2875 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2876 @end smallexample
2877
2878 @noindent
2879 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2880 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2881 further qualifier.
2882
2883 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2884 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2885 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2886 @c program?
2887 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2888 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2889 @c threads ab initio?
2890
2891 @anchor{thread numbers}
2892 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2893 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2894 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2895 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2896 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2897 between threads of different inferiors.
2898
2899 @cindex qualified thread ID
2900 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2901 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2902 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2903 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2904 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2905 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2906 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2907 inferior.
2908
2909 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2910 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2911 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2912 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2913
2914 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2915 @cindex thread ID lists
2916 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2917 argument. A list element can be:
2918
2919 @enumerate
2920 @item
2921 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2922 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2923 @samp{1}.
2924
2925 @item
2926 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2927 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2928 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2929
2930 @item
2931 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2932 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2933 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2934 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2935 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2936
2937 @end enumerate
2938
2939 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2940 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2941 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2942 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2943 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2944 7.1}.
2945
2946
2947 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2948 @cindex global thread number
2949 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2950 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2951 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2952 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2953 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2954 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2955
2956 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2957 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2958 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2959
2960 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2961 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2962 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2963 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2964 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2965 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2966 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2967 general information on convenience variables.
2968
2969 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2970 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2971 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2972
2973 @smallexample
2974 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2975 @end smallexample
2976
2977 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2978
2979 @smallexample
2980 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2981 @end smallexample
2982
2983 @table @code
2984 @kindex info threads
2985 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2986
2987 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2988 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2989 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2990 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2991
2992 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2993
2994 @enumerate
2995 @item
2996 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2997
2998 @item
2999 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3000 option was specified
3001
3002 @item
3003 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3004
3005 @item
3006 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3007 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3008 program itself.
3009
3010 @item
3011 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3012 @end enumerate
3013
3014 @noindent
3015 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3016 indicates the current thread.
3017
3018 For example,
3019 @end table
3020 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3021
3022 @smallexample
3023 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3024 Id Target Id Frame
3025 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3026 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3027 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3028 at threadtest.c:68
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3032 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3033 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3034
3035 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3036 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3037
3038 @smallexample
3039 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3040 Id GId Target Id Frame
3041 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3042 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3043 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3044 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3045 @end smallexample
3046
3047 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3048 Solaris-specific command:
3049
3050 @table @code
3051 @item maint info sol-threads
3052 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3053 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3054 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3055 @end table
3056
3057 @table @code
3058 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3059 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3060 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3061 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3062 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3063 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3064
3065 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3066 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3067
3068 @smallexample
3069 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3070 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3071 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3072 8 printf ("hello\n");
3073 @end smallexample
3074
3075 @noindent
3076 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3077 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3078 threads.
3079
3080 @kindex thread apply
3081 @cindex apply command to several threads
3082 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3083 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3084 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3085 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3086 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3087 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3088 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3089 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3090
3091
3092 @kindex thread name
3093 @cindex name a thread
3094 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3095 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3096 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3097 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3098
3099 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3100 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3101 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3102 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3103 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3104
3105 @kindex thread find
3106 @cindex search for a thread
3107 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3108 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3109 matches the supplied regular expression.
3110
3111 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3112 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3113 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3114 is the LWP id.
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3118 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3119 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3120 Id Target Id Frame
3121 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3122 @end smallexample
3123
3124 @kindex set print thread-events
3125 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3126 @item set print thread-events
3127 @itemx set print thread-events on
3128 @itemx set print thread-events off
3129 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3130 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3131 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3132 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3133 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3134
3135 @kindex show print thread-events
3136 @item show print thread-events
3137 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3138 have started and exited.
3139 @end table
3140
3141 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3142 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3143 programs with multiple threads.
3144
3145 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3146 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3147
3148 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3149 @table @code
3150 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3151 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3152 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3153 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3154 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3155 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3156 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3157 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3158 macro.
3159
3160 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3161 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3162 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3163 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3164 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3165 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3166
3167 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3168 refers to the default system directories that are
3169 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3170 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3171 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3172
3173 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3174 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3175 was loaded in the inferior process.
3176
3177 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3178 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3179 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3180 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3181 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3182 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3183 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3184
3185 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3186 only on some platforms.
3187
3188 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3189 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3190 Display current libthread_db search path.
3191
3192 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3193 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3194 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3195 @item set debug libthread-db
3196 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3197 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3198 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3199 @end table
3200
3201 @node Forks
3202 @section Debugging Forks
3203
3204 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3205 @cindex multiple processes
3206 @cindex processes, multiple
3207 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3208 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3209 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3210 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3211 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3212 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3213 will cause it to terminate.
3214
3215 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3216 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3217 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3218 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3219 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3220 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3221 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3222 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3223 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3224 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3225
3226 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3227 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3228 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3229 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3230
3231 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3232 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3233 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3234
3235 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3236 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3237
3238 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3239 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3240
3241 @table @code
3242 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3243 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3244 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3245 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3246 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3247
3248 @table @code
3249 @item parent
3250 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3251 unimpeded. This is the default.
3252
3253 @item child
3254 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3255 unimpeded.
3256
3257 @end table
3258
3259 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3260 @item show follow-fork-mode
3261 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3262 @end table
3263
3264 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3265 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3266 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3267
3268 @table @code
3269 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3270 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3271 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3272 retain debugger control over them both.
3273
3274 @table @code
3275 @item on
3276 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3277 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3278 independently. This is the default.
3279
3280 @item off
3281 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3282 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3283 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3284 is held suspended.
3285
3286 @end table
3287
3288 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3289 @item show detach-on-fork
3290 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3291 @end table
3292
3293 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3294 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3295 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3296 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3297 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3298 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3299
3300 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3301 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3302 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3303 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3304 and Programs}.
3305
3306 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3307 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3308 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3309 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3310 the child process's @code{main}.
3311
3312 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3313 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3314
3315 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3316 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3317 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3318 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3319 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3320 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3321 command.
3322
3323 @table @code
3324 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3325 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3326
3327 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3328 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3329
3330 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3331
3332 @table @code
3333 @item new
3334 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3335 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3336 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3337 original inferior.
3338
3339 For example:
3340
3341 @smallexample
3342 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3343 (gdb) info inferior
3344 Id Description Executable
3345 * 1 <null> prog1
3346 (@value{GDBP}) run
3347 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3348 Program exited normally.
3349 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3350 Id Description Executable
3351 1 <null> prog1
3352 * 2 <null> prog2
3353 @end smallexample
3354
3355 @item same
3356 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3357 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3358 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3359 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3360 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3361
3362 For example:
3363
3364 @smallexample
3365 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3366 Id Description Executable
3367 * 1 <null> prog1
3368 (@value{GDBP}) run
3369 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3370 Program exited normally.
3371 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3372 Id Description Executable
3373 * 1 <null> prog2
3374 @end smallexample
3375
3376 @end table
3377 @end table
3378
3379 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3380 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3381
3382 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3383 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3384 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3385
3386 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3387 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3388
3389 @cindex checkpoint
3390 @cindex restart
3391 @cindex bookmark
3392 @cindex snapshot of a process
3393 @cindex rewind program state
3394
3395 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3396 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3397 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3398 later.
3399
3400 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3401 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3402 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3403 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3404 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3405
3406 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3407 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3408 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3409 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3410 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3411 start again from there.
3412
3413 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3414 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3415
3416 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3417
3418 @table @code
3419 @kindex checkpoint
3420 @item checkpoint
3421 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3422 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3423 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3424
3425 @kindex info checkpoints
3426 @item info checkpoints
3427 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3428 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3429 listed:
3430
3431 @table @code
3432 @item Checkpoint ID
3433 @item Process ID
3434 @item Code Address
3435 @item Source line, or label
3436 @end table
3437
3438 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3439 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3440 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3441 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3442 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3443 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3444 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3445
3446 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3447 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3448 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3449 the debugger.
3450
3451 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3452 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3453 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3454
3455 @end table
3456
3457 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3458 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3459 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3460 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3461 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3462 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3463 previously read data can be read again.
3464
3465 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3466 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3467 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3468 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3469 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3470 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3471
3472 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3473 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3474 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3475 different execution path this time.
3476
3477 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3478 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3479 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3480 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3481 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3482 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3483 potentially pose a problem.
3484
3485 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3486
3487 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3488 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3489 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3490 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3491 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3492 next.
3493
3494 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3495 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3496 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3497 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3498 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3499
3500 @node Stopping
3501 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3502
3503 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3504 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3505 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3506
3507 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3508 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3509 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3510 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3511 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3512 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3513 explicitly request this information at any time.
3514
3515 @table @code
3516 @kindex info program
3517 @item info program
3518 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3519 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3520 @end table
3521
3522 @menu
3523 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3524 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3525 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3526 Skipping over functions and files
3527 * Signals:: Signals
3528 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3529 @end menu
3530
3531 @node Breakpoints
3532 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3533
3534 @cindex breakpoints
3535 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3536 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3537 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3538 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3539 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3540 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3541 program.
3542
3543 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3544 the executable is run.
3545
3546 @cindex watchpoints
3547 @cindex data breakpoints
3548 @cindex memory tracing
3549 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3550 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3551 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3552 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3553 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3554 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3555 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3556 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3557 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3558 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3559 same commands.
3560
3561 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3562 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3563 Automatic Display}.
3564
3565 @cindex catchpoints
3566 @cindex breakpoint on events
3567 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3568 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3569 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3570 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3571 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3572 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3573 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3574
3575 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3576 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3577 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3578 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3579 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3580 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3581 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3582 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3583 enable it again.
3584
3585 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3586 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3587 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3588 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3589 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3590 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3591 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3592
3593 @menu
3594 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3595 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3596 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3597 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3598 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3599 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3600 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3601 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3602 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3603 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3604 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3605 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3606 @end menu
3607
3608 @node Set Breaks
3609 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3610
3611 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3612 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3613 @c
3614 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3615
3616 @kindex break
3617 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3618 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3619 @cindex latest breakpoint
3620 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3621 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3622 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3623 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3624 convenience variables.
3625
3626 @table @code
3627 @item break @var{location}
3628 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3629 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3630 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3631 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3632 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3633
3634 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3635 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3636 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3637 that situation.
3638
3639 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3640 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3641 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3642
3643 @item break
3644 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3645 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3646 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3647 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3648 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3649 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3650 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3651 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3652 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3653 inside loops.
3654
3655 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3656 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3657 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3658 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3659 existed when your program stopped.
3660
3661 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3662 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3663 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3664 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3665 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3666 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3667 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3668
3669 @kindex tbreak
3670 @item tbreak @var{args}
3671 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3672 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3673 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3674 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3675
3676 @kindex hbreak
3677 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3678 @item hbreak @var{args}
3679 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3680 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3681 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3682 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3683 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3684 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3685 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3686 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3687 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3688 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3689 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3690 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3691 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3692 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3693 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3694 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3695 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3696 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3697
3698 @kindex thbreak
3699 @item thbreak @var{args}
3700 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3701 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3702 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3703 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3704 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3705 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3706 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3707 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3708
3709 @kindex rbreak
3710 @cindex regular expression
3711 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3712 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3713 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3714 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3715 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3716 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3717 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3718 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3719 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3720
3721 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3722 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3723 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3724 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3725 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3726 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3727
3728 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3729 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3730 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3731 classes.
3732
3733 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3734 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3735 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3736
3737 @smallexample
3738 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3739 @end smallexample
3740
3741 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3742 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3743 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3744 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3745 every function in a given file:
3746
3747 @smallexample
3748 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3749 @end smallexample
3750
3751 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3752 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3753
3754 @kindex info breakpoints
3755 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3756 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3757 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3758 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3759 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3760 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3761 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3762
3763 @table @emph
3764 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3765 @item Type
3766 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3767 @item Disposition
3768 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3769 @item Enabled or Disabled
3770 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3771 that are not enabled.
3772 @item Address
3773 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3774 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3775 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3776 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3777 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3778 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3779 @item What
3780 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3781 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3782 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3783 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3784 @end table
3785
3786 @noindent
3787 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3788 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3789 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3790 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3791 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3792 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3793
3794 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3795 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3796 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3797 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3798
3799 @noindent
3800 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3801 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3802 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3803 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3804 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3805
3806 @noindent
3807 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3808 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3809 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3810 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3811 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3812 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3813
3814 @noindent
3815 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3816 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3817
3818 @end table
3819
3820 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3821 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3822 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3823 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3824
3825 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3826 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3827 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3828 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3829
3830 @itemize @bullet
3831 @item
3832 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3833
3834 @item
3835 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3836 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3837
3838 @item
3839 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3840 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3841
3842 @item
3843 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3844 several places where that function is inlined.
3845 @end itemize
3846
3847 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3848 the relevant locations.
3849
3850 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3851 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3852 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3853 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3854 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3855 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3856 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3857
3858 For example:
3859
3860 @smallexample
3861 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3862 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3863 stop only if i==1
3864 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3865 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3866 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3867 @end smallexample
3868
3869 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3870 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3871 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3872 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3873 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3874 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3875 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3876 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3877 that belong to that breakpoint.
3878
3879 @cindex pending breakpoints
3880 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3881 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3882 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3883 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3884 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3885 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3886 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3887 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3888 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3889 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3890 is not yet resolved.
3891
3892 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3893 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3894 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3895 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3896 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3897 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3898
3899 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3900 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3901 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3902 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3903
3904 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3905 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3906 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3907
3908 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3909 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3910 address specification to an address:
3911
3912 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3913 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3914 @table @code
3915 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3916 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3917 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3918
3919 @item set breakpoint pending on
3920 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3921 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3922
3923 @item set breakpoint pending off
3924 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3925 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3926 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3927
3928 @item show breakpoint pending
3929 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3930 @end table
3931
3932 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3933 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3934 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3935
3936 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3937 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3938 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3939 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3940 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3941 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3942 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3943 breakpoints.
3944
3945 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3946
3947 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3948 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3949 @table @code
3950 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3951 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3952 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3953 breakpoint must be used.
3954
3955 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3956 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3957 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3958 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3959 @end table
3960
3961 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3962 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3963 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3964 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3965 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3966 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3967 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3968 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3969 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3970
3971 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3972 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3973 @table @code
3974 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3975 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3976 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3977 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3978
3979 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3980 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3981 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3982 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3983 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3984 @end table
3985
3986 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3987 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3988 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3989
3990 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3991 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3992
3993 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3994
3995 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3996 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3997 @table @code
3998 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3999 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4000 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4001 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4002 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4003
4004 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4005 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4006 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4007 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4008 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4009 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4010 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4011 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4012 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4013 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4014 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4015 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4016 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4017
4018 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4019 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4020 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4021 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4022 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4023 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4024 @end table
4025
4026
4027 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4028 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4029 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4030 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4031 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4032 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4033 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4034 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4035
4036
4037 @node Set Watchpoints
4038 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4039
4040 @cindex setting watchpoints
4041 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4042 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4043 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4044 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4045 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4046
4047 @itemize @bullet
4048 @item
4049 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4050
4051 @item
4052 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4053 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4054 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4055
4056 @item
4057 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4058 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4059 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4060 @end itemize
4061
4062 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4063 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4064 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4065 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4066 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4067 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4068 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4069 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4070 the expression changes.
4071
4072 @cindex software watchpoints
4073 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4074 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4075 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4076 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4077 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4078 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4079 culprit.)
4080
4081 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4082 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4083 slow down the running of your program.
4084
4085 @table @code
4086 @kindex watch
4087 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4088 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4089 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4090 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4091 to watch the value of a single variable:
4092
4093 @smallexample
4094 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4095 @end smallexample
4096
4097 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4098 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4099 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4100 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4101 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4102 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4103
4104 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4105 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4106 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4107 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4108 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4109 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4110 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4111 error.
4112
4113 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4114 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4115 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4116 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4117 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4118 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4119 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4120 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4121 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4122 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4123 Examples:
4124
4125 @smallexample
4126 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4127 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4128 @end smallexample
4129
4130 @kindex rwatch
4131 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4132 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4133 by the program.
4134
4135 @kindex awatch
4136 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4137 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4138 or written into by the program.
4139
4140 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4141 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4142 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4143 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4144 @end table
4145
4146 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4147 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4148 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4149 a never-changing value:
4150
4151 @smallexample
4152 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4153 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4154 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4155 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4156 @end smallexample
4157
4158 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4159 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4160 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4161 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4162 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4163 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4164
4165 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4166 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4167 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4168 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4169 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4170 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4171 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4172 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4173
4174 @table @code
4175 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4176 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4177 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4178
4179 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4180 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4181 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4182 @end table
4183
4184 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4185 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4186 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4187
4188 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4189
4190 @smallexample
4191 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4192 @end smallexample
4193
4194 @noindent
4195 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4196
4197 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4198 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4199 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4200 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4201 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4202 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4203 will print a message like this:
4204
4205 @smallexample
4206 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4207 @end smallexample
4208
4209 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4210 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4211 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4212 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4213 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4214 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4215 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4216 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4217
4218 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4219 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4220 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4221 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4222 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4223 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4224
4225 @smallexample
4226 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4227 @end smallexample
4228
4229 @noindent
4230 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4231
4232 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4233 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4234 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4235 expression with separately allocated resources.
4236
4237 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4238 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4239 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4240
4241 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4242 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4243 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4244 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4245 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4246 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4247 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4248 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4249 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4250
4251 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4252 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4253 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4254 watched expression from every thread.
4255
4256 @quotation
4257 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4258 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4259 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4260 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4261 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4262 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4263 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4264 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4265 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4266 @end quotation
4267
4268 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4269
4270 @node Set Catchpoints
4271 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4272 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4273 @cindex exception handlers
4274 @cindex event handling
4275
4276 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4277 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4278 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4279
4280 @table @code
4281 @kindex catch
4282 @item catch @var{event}
4283 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4284
4285 @table @code
4286 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4287 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4288 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4289 @kindex catch throw
4290 @kindex catch rethrow
4291 @kindex catch catch
4292 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4293 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4294
4295 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4296 regular expression will be caught.
4297
4298 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4299 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4300 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4301 exception being thrown.
4302
4303 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4304 @value{GDBN}:
4305
4306 @itemize @bullet
4307 @item
4308 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4309 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4310 supported.
4311
4312 @item
4313 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4314 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4315 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4316 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4317 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4318 built.
4319
4320 @item
4321 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4322 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4323
4324 @item
4325 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4326 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4327 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4328 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4329
4330 @item
4331 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4332 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4333 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4334 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4335 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4336 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4337 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4338 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4339 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4340
4341 @item
4342 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4343
4344 @item
4345 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4346 @end itemize
4347
4348 @item exception
4349 @kindex catch exception
4350 @cindex Ada exception catching
4351 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4352 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4353 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4354 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4355 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4356
4357 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4358 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4359 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4360 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4361 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4362 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4363 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4364 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4365
4366 @item exception unhandled
4367 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4368 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4369
4370 @item assert
4371 @kindex catch assert
4372 A failed Ada assertion.
4373
4374 @item exec
4375 @kindex catch exec
4376 @cindex break on fork/exec
4377 A call to @code{exec}.
4378
4379 @item syscall
4380 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4381 @kindex catch syscall
4382 @cindex break on a system call.
4383 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4384 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4385 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4386 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4387 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4388 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4389 will be caught.
4390
4391 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4392 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4393 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4394 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4395
4396 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4397 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4398 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4399 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4400
4401 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4402 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4403 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4404 available choices.
4405
4406 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4407 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4408 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4409 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4410 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4411 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4412 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4413 behind the OS upgrades).
4414
4415 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4416 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4417 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4418 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4419 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4420 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4421 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4422 syscall groups available on your environment.
4423
4424 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4425 arguments to it:
4426
4427 @smallexample
4428 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4429 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4430 (@value{GDBP}) r
4431 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4432
4433 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4434 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4435 (@value{GDBP}) c
4436 Continuing.
4437
4438 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4439 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4440 (@value{GDBP})
4441 @end smallexample
4442
4443 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4444
4445 @smallexample
4446 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4447 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4448 (@value{GDBP}) r
4449 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4450
4451 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4452 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4453 (@value{GDBP}) c
4454 Continuing.
4455
4456 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4457 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4458 (@value{GDBP})
4459 @end smallexample
4460
4461 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4462 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4463 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4464
4465 @smallexample
4466 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4467 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4468 (@value{GDBP}) r
4469 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4470
4471 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4472 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4473 (@value{GDBP}) c
4474 Continuing.
4475
4476 Program exited normally.
4477 (@value{GDBP})
4478 @end smallexample
4479
4480 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4481
4482 @smallexample
4483 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4484 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4485 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4486 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4487 (@value{GDBP}) r
4488 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4489
4490 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4491 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4492
4493 (@value{GDBP}) c
4494 Continuing.
4495 @end smallexample
4496
4497 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4498 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4499 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4500 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4504 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4505 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4506 (@value{GDBP})
4507 @end smallexample
4508
4509 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4510 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4511 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4512 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4513 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4514 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4515
4516 @smallexample
4517 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4518 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4519 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4520 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4521 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4522 (@value{GDBP})
4523 @end smallexample
4524
4525 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4526
4527 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4528 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4529
4530 @smallexample
4531 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4532 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4533 @end smallexample
4534
4535 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4536
4537 @item fork
4538 @kindex catch fork
4539 A call to @code{fork}.
4540
4541 @item vfork
4542 @kindex catch vfork
4543 A call to @code{vfork}.
4544
4545 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4546 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4547 @kindex catch load
4548 @kindex catch unload
4549 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4550 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4551 matches one of the affected libraries.
4552
4553 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4554 @kindex catch signal
4555 The delivery of a signal.
4556
4557 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4558 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4559 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4560
4561 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4562 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4563 signal names.
4564
4565 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4566 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4567 will be caught.
4568
4569 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4570 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4571 catchpoint.
4572
4573 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4574 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4575 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4576 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4577 commands.
4578
4579 @end table
4580
4581 @item tcatch @var{event}
4582 @kindex tcatch
4583 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4584 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4585
4586 @end table
4587
4588 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4589
4590
4591 @node Delete Breaks
4592 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4593
4594 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4595 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4596 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4597 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4598 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4599 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4600
4601 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4602 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4603 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4604 their breakpoint numbers.
4605
4606 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4607 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4608 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4609
4610 @table @code
4611 @kindex clear
4612 @item clear
4613 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4614 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4615 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4616 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4617
4618 @item clear @var{location}
4619 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4620 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4621 most useful ones are listed below:
4622
4623 @table @code
4624 @item clear @var{function}
4625 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4626 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4627
4628 @item clear @var{linenum}
4629 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4630 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4631 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4632 @end table
4633
4634 @cindex delete breakpoints
4635 @kindex delete
4636 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4637 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4638 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4639 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4640 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4641 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4642 @end table
4643
4644 @node Disabling
4645 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4646
4647 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4648 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4649 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4650 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4651 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4652
4653 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4654 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4655 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4656 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4657 do not know which numbers to use.
4658
4659 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4660 affects all of its locations.
4661
4662 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4663 different states of enablement:
4664
4665 @itemize @bullet
4666 @item
4667 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4668 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4669 @item
4670 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4671 @item
4672 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4673 disabled.
4674 @item
4675 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4676 N times, then becomes disabled.
4677 @item
4678 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4679 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4680 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4681 @end itemize
4682
4683 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4684 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4685
4686 @table @code
4687 @kindex disable
4688 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4689 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4690 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4691 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4692 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4693 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4694 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4695
4696 @kindex enable
4697 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4698 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4699 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4700
4701 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4702 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4703 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4704
4705 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4706 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4707 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4708 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4709 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4710 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4711 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4712
4713 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4714 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4715 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4716 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4717 @end table
4718
4719 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4720 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4721 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4722 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4723 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4724 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4725 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4726 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4727 Stepping}.)
4728
4729 @node Conditions
4730 @subsection Break Conditions
4731 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4732 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4733
4734 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4735 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4736 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4737 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4738 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4739 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4740 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4741 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4742
4743 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4744 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4745 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4746 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4747 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4748
4749 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4750 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4751 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4752 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4753 one.
4754
4755 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4756 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4757 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4758 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4759 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4760 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4761 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4762 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4763 conditions for the
4764 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4765 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4766
4767 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4768 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4769 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4770 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4771 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4772 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4773
4774 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4775 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4776 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4777 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4778 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4779
4780 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4781 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4782 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4783 with the @code{condition} command.
4784
4785 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4786 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4787 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4788 catchpoint.
4789
4790 @table @code
4791 @kindex condition
4792 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4793 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4794 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4795 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4796 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4797 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4798 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4799 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4800 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4801 prints an error message:
4802
4803 @smallexample
4804 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4805 @end smallexample
4806
4807 @noindent
4808 @value{GDBN} does
4809 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4810 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4811 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4812
4813 @item condition @var{bnum}
4814 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4815 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4816 @end table
4817
4818 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4819 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4820 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4821 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4822 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4823 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4824 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4825 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4826 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4827 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4828 your program reaches it.
4829
4830 @table @code
4831 @kindex ignore
4832 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4833 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4834 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4835 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4836 takes no action.
4837
4838 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4839 a count of zero.
4840
4841 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4842 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4843 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4844 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4845
4846 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4847 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4848 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4849
4850 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4851 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4852 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4853 Variables}.
4854 @end table
4855
4856 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4857
4858
4859 @node Break Commands
4860 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4861
4862 @cindex breakpoint commands
4863 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4864 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4865 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4866 enable other breakpoints.
4867
4868 @table @code
4869 @kindex commands
4870 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4871 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4872 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4873 @itemx end
4874 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4875 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4876 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4877
4878 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4879 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4880
4881 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4882 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4883 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4884 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4885 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4886 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4887 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4888 Expressions}).
4889 @end table
4890
4891 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4892 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4893
4894 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4895 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4896 that resumes execution.
4897
4898 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4899 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4900 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4901 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4902 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4903
4904 @kindex silent
4905 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4906 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4907 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4908 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4909 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4910 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4911
4912 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4913 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4914 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4915
4916 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4917 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4918
4919 @smallexample
4920 break foo if x>0
4921 commands
4922 silent
4923 printf "x is %d\n",x
4924 cont
4925 end
4926 @end smallexample
4927
4928 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4929 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4930 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4931 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4932 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4933 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4934 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4935
4936 @smallexample
4937 break 403
4938 commands
4939 silent
4940 set x = y + 4
4941 cont
4942 end
4943 @end smallexample
4944
4945 @node Dynamic Printf
4946 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4947
4948 @cindex dynamic printf
4949 @cindex dprintf
4950 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4951 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4952 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4953 having to recompile it.
4954
4955 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4956 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4957 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4958 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4959 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4960 redirects to files and so forth.
4961
4962 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4963 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4964 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4965 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4966 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4967 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4968 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4969
4970 @table @code
4971 @kindex dprintf
4972 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4973 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4974 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4975 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4976
4977 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4978 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4979 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4980 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4981 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4982 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4983
4984 @item gdb
4985 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4986 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4987
4988 @item call
4989 @kindex dprintf-style call
4990 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4991 @code{printf}).
4992
4993 @item agent
4994 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4995 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4996 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4997 support running commands on the target.
4998
4999 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5000 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5001 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5002 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5003 command.
5004
5005 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5006 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5007 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5008 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5009 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5010 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5011
5012 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5013 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5014 you could do the following:
5015
5016 @example
5017 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5018 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5019 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5020 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5021 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5022 (gdb) info break
5023 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5024 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5025 continue
5026 (gdb)
5027 @end example
5028
5029 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5030 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5031 the variable settings.
5032
5033 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5034 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5035 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5036 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5037 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5038 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5039
5040 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5041 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5042 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5043
5044 @end table
5045
5046 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5047 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5048 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5049 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5050 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5051 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5052
5053 @node Save Breakpoints
5054 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5055
5056 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5057 breakpoints}} command.
5058
5059 @table @code
5060 @kindex save breakpoints
5061 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5062 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5063 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5064 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5065 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5066 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5067 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5068 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5069 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5070 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5071 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5072 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5073 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5074 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5075 that can no longer be recreated.
5076 @end table
5077
5078 @node Static Probe Points
5079 @subsection Static Probe Points
5080
5081 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5082 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5083 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5084 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5085 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5086
5087 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5088 ELF-compatible systems:
5089
5090 @itemize @bullet
5091
5092 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5093 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5094 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5095 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5096 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5097 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5098 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5099 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5100
5101 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5102 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5103 C@t{++} languages.
5104 @end itemize
5105
5106 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5107 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5108 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5109 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5110 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5111 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5112 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5113 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5114 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5115
5116 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5117 probes}, with optional arguments:
5118
5119 @table @code
5120 @kindex info probes
5121 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5122 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5123 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5124 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5125
5126 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5127 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5128 probes from all providers are listed.
5129
5130 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5131 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5132 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5133
5134 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5135 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5136 given, all object files are considered.
5137
5138 @item info probes all
5139 List the available static probes, from all types.
5140 @end table
5141
5142 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5143 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5144 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5145 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5146 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5147
5148 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5149 commands, with optional arguments:
5150
5151 @table @code
5152 @kindex enable probes
5153 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5154 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5155 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5156 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5157
5158 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5159 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5160 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5161
5162 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5163 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5164 given, all object files are considered.
5165
5166 @kindex disable probes
5167 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5168 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5169 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5173 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5174 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5175 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5176 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5177 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5178 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5179 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5180 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5181 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5182 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5183 at the current probe point.
5184
5185 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5186 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5187 an error message.
5188
5189
5190 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5191 @node Error in Breakpoints
5192 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5193
5194 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5195 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5196
5197 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5198 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5199 @smallexample
5200 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5201 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5202 @end smallexample
5203
5204 @noindent
5205 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5206 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5207 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5208
5209 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5210 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5211
5212 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5213 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5214 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5215
5216 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5217 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5218 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5219 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5220
5221 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5222 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5223 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5224 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5225 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5226 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5227 first in the bundle.
5228
5229 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5230 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5231 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5232 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5233 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5234 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5235 is hit.
5236
5237 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5238 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5239
5240 @smallexample
5241 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5242 @end smallexample
5243
5244 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5245 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5246 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5247 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5248 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5249 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5250 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5251 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5252
5253 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5254 adjusted breakpoints:
5255
5256 @smallexample
5257 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5258 to 0x00010410.
5259 @end smallexample
5260
5261 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5262 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5263 frequently than expected.
5264
5265 @node Continuing and Stepping
5266 @section Continuing and Stepping
5267
5268 @cindex stepping
5269 @cindex continuing
5270 @cindex resuming execution
5271 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5272 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5273 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5274 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5275 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5276 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5277 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5278 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5279 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5280 handlers}).)
5281
5282 @table @code
5283 @kindex continue
5284 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5285 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5286 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5287 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5288 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5289 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5290 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5291 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5292 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5293 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5294
5295 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5296 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5297 @code{continue} is ignored.
5298
5299 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5300 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5301 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5302 @code{continue}.
5303 @end table
5304
5305 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5306 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5307 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5308 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5309
5310 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5311 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5312 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5313 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5314 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5315 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5316
5317 @table @code
5318 @kindex step
5319 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5320 @item step
5321 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5322 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5323 abbreviated @code{s}.
5324
5325 @quotation
5326 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5327 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5328 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5329 @c distinction here.
5330 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5331 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5332 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5333 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5334 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5335 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5336 below.
5337 @end quotation
5338
5339 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5340 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5341 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5342 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5343 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5344 called within the line.
5345
5346 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5347 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5348 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5349 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5350 was any debugging information about the routine.
5351
5352 @item step @var{count}
5353 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5354 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5355 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5356
5357 @kindex next
5358 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5359 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5360 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5361 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5362 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5363 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5364 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5365 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5366
5367 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5368
5369
5370 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5371 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5372 @c
5373 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5374 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5375 @c function are executed without stopping.
5376
5377 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5378 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5379 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5380
5381 @kindex set step-mode
5382 @item set step-mode
5383 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5384 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5385 @itemx set step-mode on
5386 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5387 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5388 information rather than stepping over it.
5389
5390 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5391 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5392 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5393
5394 @item set step-mode off
5395 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5396 debug information. This is the default.
5397
5398 @item show step-mode
5399 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5400 source line debug information.
5401
5402 @kindex finish
5403 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5404 @item finish
5405 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5406 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5407 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5408
5409 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5410 ,Returning from a Function}).
5411
5412 @kindex until
5413 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5414 @cindex run until specified location
5415 @item until
5416 @itemx u
5417 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5418 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5419 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5420 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5421 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5422 than the address of the jump.
5423
5424 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5425 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5426 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5427 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5428 through the next iteration.
5429
5430 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5431 stack frame.
5432
5433 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5434 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5435 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5436 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5437 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5438
5439 @smallexample
5440 (@value{GDBP}) f
5441 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5442 206 expand_input();
5443 (@value{GDBP}) until
5444 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5445 @end smallexample
5446
5447 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5448 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5449 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5450 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5451 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5452 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5453 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5454
5455 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5456 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5457 argument.
5458
5459 @item until @var{location}
5460 @itemx u @var{location}
5461 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5462 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5463 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5464 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5465 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5466 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5467 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5468 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5469 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5470 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5471 invocations have returned.
5472
5473 @smallexample
5474 94 int factorial (int value)
5475 95 @{
5476 96 if (value > 1) @{
5477 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5478 98 @}
5479 99 return (value);
5480 100 @}
5481 @end smallexample
5482
5483
5484 @kindex advance @var{location}
5485 @item advance @var{location}
5486 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5487 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5488 @ref{Specify Location}.
5489 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5490 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5491 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5492 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5493
5494
5495 @kindex stepi
5496 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5497 @item stepi
5498 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5499 @itemx si
5500 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5501
5502 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5503 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5504 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5505 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5506
5507 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5508
5509 @need 750
5510 @kindex nexti
5511 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5512 @item nexti
5513 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5514 @itemx ni
5515 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5516 proceed until the function returns.
5517
5518 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5519
5520 @end table
5521
5522 @anchor{range stepping}
5523 @cindex range stepping
5524 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5525 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5526 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5527 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5528 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5529 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5530 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5531 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5532 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5533 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5534 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5535 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5536 if necessary:
5537
5538 @table @code
5539 @kindex set range-stepping
5540 @kindex show range-stepping
5541 @item set range-stepping
5542 @itemx show range-stepping
5543 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5544
5545 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5546 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5547 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5548 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5549 default is @code{on}.
5550
5551 @end table
5552
5553 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5554 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5555 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5556
5557 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5558 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5559 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5560 a particular file when stepping.
5561
5562 For example, consider the following C function:
5563
5564 @smallexample
5565 101 int func()
5566 102 @{
5567 103 foo(boring());
5568 104 bar(boring());
5569 105 @}
5570 @end smallexample
5571
5572 @noindent
5573 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5574 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5575 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5576 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5577
5578 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5579 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5580 is called from many places.
5581
5582 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5583 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5584 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5585 @code{foo}.
5586
5587 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5588 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5589 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5590
5591 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5592 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5593 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5594 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5595 the underlying system.
5596 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5597 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5598
5599 @table @code
5600 @kindex skip
5601 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5602 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5603 that specify what to skip.
5604 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5605
5606 @table @code
5607 @item -file @var{file}
5608 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5609 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5610
5611 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5612 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5613 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5614 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5615 over when stepping.
5616
5617 @smallexample
5618 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5619 @end smallexample
5620
5621 @item -function @var{linespec}
5622 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5623 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5624 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5625 @xref{Specify Location}.
5626
5627 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5628 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5629 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5630 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5631
5632 This form is useful for complex function names.
5633 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5634 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5635 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5636 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5637 regular expression makes this easier.
5638
5639 @smallexample
5640 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5641 @end smallexample
5642
5643 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5644 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5648 @end smallexample
5649 @end table
5650
5651 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5652 will be skipped.
5653
5654 @kindex skip function
5655 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5656 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5657 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5658 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5659
5660 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5661 will be skipped.
5662
5663 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5664 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5665
5666 @kindex skip file
5667 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5668 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5669 will be skipped over when stepping.
5670
5671 @smallexample
5672 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5673 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5674 @end smallexample
5675
5676 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5677 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5678 @end table
5679
5680 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5681 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5682
5683 @table @code
5684 @kindex info skip
5685 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5686 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5687 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5688 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5689
5690 @table @emph
5691 @item Identifier
5692 A number identifying this skip.
5693 @item Enabled or Disabled
5694 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5695 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5696 @item Glob
5697 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5698 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5699 @item File
5700 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5701 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5702 @item RE
5703 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5704 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5705 @item Function
5706 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5707 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5708 @end table
5709
5710 @kindex skip delete
5711 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5712 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5713 skips.
5714
5715 @kindex skip enable
5716 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5717 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5718 skips.
5719
5720 @kindex skip disable
5721 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5722 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5723 skips.
5724
5725 @end table
5726
5727 @node Signals
5728 @section Signals
5729 @cindex signals
5730
5731 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5732 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5733 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5734 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5735 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5736 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5737 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5738 requested an alarm).
5739
5740 @cindex fatal signals
5741 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5742 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5743 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5744 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5745 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5746 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5747
5748 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5749 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5750 signal.
5751
5752 @cindex handling signals
5753 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5754 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5755 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5756 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5757 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5758
5759 @table @code
5760 @kindex info signals
5761 @kindex info handle
5762 @item info signals
5763 @itemx info handle
5764 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5765 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5766 the defined types of signals.
5767
5768 @item info signals @var{sig}
5769 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5770
5771 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5772
5773 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5774 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5775 for details about this command.
5776
5777 @kindex handle
5778 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5779 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5780 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5781 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5782 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5783 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5784 say what change to make.
5785 @end table
5786
5787 @c @group
5788 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5789 Their full names are:
5790
5791 @table @code
5792 @item nostop
5793 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5794 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5795
5796 @item stop
5797 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5798 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5799
5800 @item print
5801 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5802
5803 @item noprint
5804 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5805 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5806
5807 @item pass
5808 @itemx noignore
5809 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5810 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5811 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5812
5813 @item nopass
5814 @itemx ignore
5815 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5816 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5817 @end table
5818 @c @end group
5819
5820 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5821 program until you
5822 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5823 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5824 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5825 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5826 program sees that signal when you continue.
5827
5828 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5829 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5830 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5831 erroneous signals.
5832
5833 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5834 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5835 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5836 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5837 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5838 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5839 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5840 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5841 Program a Signal}.
5842
5843 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5844 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5845
5846 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5847 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5848 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5849 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5850 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5851 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5852 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5853 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5854 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5855 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5856 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5857 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5858 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5859
5860 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5861
5862 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5863 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5864 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5865 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5866
5867 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5868 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5869 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5870 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5871
5872 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5873 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5874
5875 @smallexample
5876 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5877 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5878 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5879 (@value{GDBP}) c
5880 Continuing.
5881
5882 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5883 main () sigusr1.c:28
5884 28 p = 0;
5885 (@value{GDBP}) si
5886 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5887 9 @{
5888 @end smallexample
5889
5890 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5891 program to receive the signal first:
5892
5893 @smallexample
5894 (@value{GDBP}) n
5895 28 p = 0;
5896 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5897 (@value{GDBP}) si
5898 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5899 9 @{
5900 (@value{GDBP})
5901 @end smallexample
5902
5903 @cindex extra signal information
5904 @anchor{extra signal information}
5905
5906 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5907 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5908 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5909 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5910 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5911 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5912 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5913 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5914 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5915 system header.
5916
5917 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5918 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5919
5920 @smallexample
5921 @group
5922 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5923 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5924 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5925 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5926 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5927 type = struct @{
5928 int si_signo;
5929 int si_errno;
5930 int si_code;
5931 union @{
5932 int _pad[28];
5933 struct @{...@} _kill;
5934 struct @{...@} _timer;
5935 struct @{...@} _rt;
5936 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5937 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5938 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5939 @} _sifields;
5940 @}
5941 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5942 type = struct @{
5943 void *si_addr;
5944 @}
5945 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5946 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5947 @end group
5948 @end smallexample
5949
5950 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5951
5952 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5953 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5954 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5955 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5956 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5957 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5958 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5959 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5960 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5961 information is displayed.
5962
5963 The usual output of a segfault is:
5964 @smallexample
5965 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5966 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5967 68 value = *(p + len);
5968 @end smallexample
5969
5970 While a bound violation is presented as:
5971 @smallexample
5972 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5973 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5974 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5975 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5976 68 value = *(p + len);
5977 @end smallexample
5978
5979 @node Thread Stops
5980 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5981
5982 @cindex stopped threads
5983 @cindex threads, stopped
5984
5985 @cindex continuing threads
5986 @cindex threads, continuing
5987
5988 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5989 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5990 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5991 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5992 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5993 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5994 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5995 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5996 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5997
5998 @menu
5999 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6000 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6001 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6002 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6003 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6004 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6005 @end menu
6006
6007 @node All-Stop Mode
6008 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6009
6010 @cindex all-stop mode
6011
6012 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6013 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6014 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6015 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6016 underfoot.
6017
6018 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6019 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6020 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6021
6022 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6023 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6024 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6025 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6026 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6027 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6028 stops.
6029
6030 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6031 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6032 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6033 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6034
6035 @cindex automatic thread selection
6036 @cindex switching threads automatically
6037 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6038 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6039 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6040 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6041 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6042 thread.
6043
6044 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6045 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6046
6047 @table @code
6048 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6049 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6050 @cindex lock scheduler
6051 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6052 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6053 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6054 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6055 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6056 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6057 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6058 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6059 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6060 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6061 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6062 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6063 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6064 @code{on} in replay mode.
6065
6066 @item show scheduler-locking
6067 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6068 @end table
6069
6070 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6071 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6072 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6073 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6074 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6075 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6076 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6077 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6078 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6079 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6080 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6081 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6082 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6083 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6084
6085 @table @code
6086 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6087 @item set schedule-multiple
6088 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6089 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6090 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6091 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6092 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6093 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6094
6095 @item show schedule-multiple
6096 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6097 multiple processes.
6098 @end table
6099
6100 @node Non-Stop Mode
6101 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6102
6103 @cindex non-stop mode
6104
6105 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6106 @c with more details.
6107
6108 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6109 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6110 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6111 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6112 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6113 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6114
6115 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6116 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6117 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6118 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6119 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6120 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6121 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6122 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6123 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6124 independently and simultaneously.
6125
6126 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6127 or attach to your program:
6128
6129 @smallexample
6130 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6131 set pagination off
6132
6133 # Finally, turn it on!
6134 set non-stop on
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6138
6139 @table @code
6140 @kindex set non-stop
6141 @item set non-stop on
6142 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6143 @item set non-stop off
6144 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6145 @kindex show non-stop
6146 @item show non-stop
6147 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6148 @end table
6149
6150 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6151 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6152 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6153 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6154 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6155 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6156 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6157 default.
6158
6159 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6160 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6161 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6162
6163 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6164 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6165 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6166 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6167 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6168
6169 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6170 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6171 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6172 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6173 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6174
6175 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6176
6177 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6178 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6179 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6180 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6181 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6182 previously current thread.
6183
6184 @node Background Execution
6185 @subsection Background Execution
6186
6187 @cindex foreground execution
6188 @cindex background execution
6189 @cindex asynchronous execution
6190 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6191
6192 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6193 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6194 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6195 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6196 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6197 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6198
6199 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6200 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6201
6202 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6203 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6204 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6205 are:
6206
6207 @table @code
6208 @kindex run&
6209 @item run
6210 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6211
6212 @item attach
6213 @kindex attach&
6214 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6215
6216 @item step
6217 @kindex step&
6218 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6219
6220 @item stepi
6221 @kindex stepi&
6222 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6223
6224 @item next
6225 @kindex next&
6226 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6227
6228 @item nexti
6229 @kindex nexti&
6230 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6231
6232 @item continue
6233 @kindex continue&
6234 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6235
6236 @item finish
6237 @kindex finish&
6238 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6239
6240 @item until
6241 @kindex until&
6242 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6243
6244 @end table
6245
6246 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6247 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6248 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6249 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6250 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6251 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6252
6253 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6254 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6255
6256 @table @code
6257 @kindex interrupt
6258 @item interrupt
6259 @itemx interrupt -a
6260
6261 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6262 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6263 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6264 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6265 @end table
6266
6267 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6268 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6269
6270 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6271 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6272 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6273
6274 @table @code
6275 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6276 @cindex thread breakpoints
6277 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6278 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6279 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6280 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6281 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6282 specify some source line.
6283
6284 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6285 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6286 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6287 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6288 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6289
6290 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6291 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6292 program.
6293
6294 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6295 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6296 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6297
6298 @smallexample
6299 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6300 @end smallexample
6301
6302 @end table
6303
6304 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6305 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6306 thread list. For example:
6307
6308 @smallexample
6309 (@value{GDBP}) c
6310 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6311 @end smallexample
6312
6313 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6314 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6315 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6316 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6317 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6318 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6319 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6320 command.
6321
6322 @node Interrupted System Calls
6323 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6324
6325 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6326 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6327 @cindex premature return from system calls
6328 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6329 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6330 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6331 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6332 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6333 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6334 stop execution.
6335
6336 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6337 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6338 style anyways.
6339
6340 For example, do not write code like this:
6341
6342 @smallexample
6343 sleep (10);
6344 @end smallexample
6345
6346 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6347 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6348
6349 Instead, write this:
6350
6351 @smallexample
6352 int unslept = 10;
6353 while (unslept > 0)
6354 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6355 @end smallexample
6356
6357 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6358 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6359 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6360 @value{GDBN}.
6361
6362 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6363 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6364 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6365 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6366
6367 @node Observer Mode
6368 @subsection Observer Mode
6369
6370 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6371 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6372 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6373 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6374 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6375
6376 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6377 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6378 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6379 mode.
6380
6381 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6382 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6383 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6384 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6385 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6386
6387 @table @code
6388
6389 @kindex observer
6390 @item set observer on
6391 @itemx set observer off
6392 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6393 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6394 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6395 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6396
6397 @item show observer
6398 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6399
6400 @kindex may-write-registers
6401 @item set may-write-registers on
6402 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6403 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6404 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6405 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6406
6407 @item show may-write-registers
6408 Show the current permission to write registers.
6409
6410 @kindex may-write-memory
6411 @item set may-write-memory on
6412 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6413 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6414 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6415 defaults to @code{on}.
6416
6417 @item show may-write-memory
6418 Show the current permission to write memory.
6419
6420 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6421 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6422 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6423 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6424 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6425 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6426
6427 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6428 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6429
6430 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6431 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6432 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6433 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6434 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6435 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6436 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6437
6438 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6439 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6440
6441 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6442 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6443 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6444 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6445 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6446 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6447 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6448
6449 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6450 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6451
6452 @kindex may-interrupt
6453 @item set may-interrupt on
6454 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6455 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6456 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6457 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6458 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6459
6460 @item show may-interrupt
6461 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6462
6463 @end table
6464
6465 @node Reverse Execution
6466 @chapter Running programs backward
6467 @cindex reverse execution
6468 @cindex running programs backward
6469
6470 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6471 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6472 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6473 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6474
6475 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6476 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6477 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6478 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6479 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6480 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6481
6482 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6483 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6484 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6485 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6486 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6487 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6488 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6489 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6490 prior values@footnote{
6491 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6492 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6493 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6494
6495 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6496 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6497 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6498 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6499 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6500 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6501 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6502 }.
6503
6504 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6505 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6506
6507 @table @code
6508 @kindex reverse-continue
6509 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6510 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6511 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6512 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6513 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6514 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6515 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6516
6517 @kindex reverse-step
6518 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6519 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6520 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6521 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6522
6523 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6524 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6525 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6526 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6527 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6528 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6529
6530 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6531 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6532
6533 @kindex reverse-stepi
6534 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6535 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6536 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6537 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6538 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6539 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6540 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6541
6542 @kindex reverse-next
6543 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6544 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6545 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6546 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6547 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6548 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6549 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6550 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6551 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6552 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6553
6554 @kindex reverse-nexti
6555 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6556 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6557 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6558 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6559 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6560 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6561 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6562 frame) is reached.
6563
6564 @kindex reverse-finish
6565 @item reverse-finish
6566 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6567 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6568 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6569 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6570
6571 @kindex set exec-direction
6572 @item set exec-direction
6573 Set the direction of target execution.
6574 @item set exec-direction reverse
6575 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6576 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6577 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6578 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6579 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6580 @item set exec-direction forward
6581 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6582 This is the default.
6583 @end table
6584
6585
6586 @node Process Record and Replay
6587 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6588 @cindex process record and replay
6589 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6590
6591 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6592 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6593 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6594
6595 @cindex replay mode
6596 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6597 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6598 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6599 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6600 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6601 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6602 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6603 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6604 execution log.
6605
6606 @cindex record mode
6607 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6608 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6609 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6610 for future replay.
6611
6612 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6613 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6614 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6615 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6616 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6617 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6618
6619 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6620 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6621 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6622 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6623
6624 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6625 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6626
6627 @table @code
6628 @kindex target record
6629 @kindex target record-full
6630 @kindex target record-btrace
6631 @kindex record
6632 @kindex record full
6633 @kindex record btrace
6634 @kindex record btrace bts
6635 @kindex record btrace pt
6636 @kindex record bts
6637 @kindex record pt
6638 @kindex rec
6639 @kindex rec full
6640 @kindex rec btrace
6641 @kindex rec btrace bts
6642 @kindex rec btrace pt
6643 @kindex rec bts
6644 @kindex rec pt
6645 @item record @var{method}
6646 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6647 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6648 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6649 recording methods are available:
6650
6651 @table @code
6652 @item full
6653 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6654 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6655 execution.
6656
6657 @item btrace @var{format}
6658 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6659 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6660 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6661 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6662 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6663 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6664 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6665
6666 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6667 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6668 formats are available:
6669
6670 @table @code
6671 @item bts
6672 @cindex branch trace store
6673 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6674 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6675 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6676
6677 @item pt
6678 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6679 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6680 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6681 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6682
6683 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6684 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6685 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6686
6687 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6688 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6689 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6690 buffer-size with care.
6691 @end table
6692
6693 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6694 @end table
6695
6696 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6697 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6698 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6699 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6700
6701 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6702 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6703 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6704 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6705 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6706
6707 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6708 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6709 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6710 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6711 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6712 does not support these two modes.
6713
6714 @kindex record stop
6715 @kindex rec s
6716 @item record stop
6717 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6718 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6719 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6720
6721 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6722 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6723 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6724 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6725 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6726
6727 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6728 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6729 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6730 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6731 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6732
6733 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6734 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6735
6736 @kindex record goto
6737 @item record goto
6738 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6739 ways to specify the location to go to:
6740
6741 @table @code
6742 @item record goto begin
6743 @itemx record goto start
6744 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6745
6746 @item record goto end
6747 Go to the end of the execution log.
6748
6749 @item record goto @var{n}
6750 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6751 @end table
6752
6753 @kindex record save
6754 @item record save @var{filename}
6755 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6756 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6757 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6758
6759 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6760
6761 @kindex record restore
6762 @item record restore @var{filename}
6763 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6764 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6765
6766 @kindex set record full
6767 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6768 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6769 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6770 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6771
6772 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6773 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6774 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6775 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6776 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6777 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6778 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6779 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6780
6781 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6782 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6783 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6784
6785 @kindex show record full
6786 @item show record full insn-number-max
6787 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6788 recording method.
6789
6790 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6791 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6792 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6793 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6794 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6795 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6796 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6797 oldest one to be deleted.
6798
6799 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6800 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6801
6802 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6803 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6804
6805 @item set record full memory-query
6806 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6807 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6808 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6809 case.
6810
6811 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6812 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6813 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6814 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6815 results.
6816
6817 @item show record full memory-query
6818 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6819
6820 @kindex set record btrace
6821 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6822 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6823 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6824 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6825 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6826 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6827 You can use the following command for that:
6828
6829 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6830 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6831 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6832 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6833 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6834 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6835 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6836 position.
6837
6838 @kindex show record btrace
6839 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6840 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6841
6842 @kindex set record btrace bts
6843 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6844 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6845 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6846 format. Default is 64KB.
6847
6848 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6849 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6850 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6851 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6852 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6853 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6854 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6855
6856 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6857 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6858
6859 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6860 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6861
6862 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6863 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6864 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6865
6866 @kindex set record btrace pt
6867 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6868 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6869 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6870 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6871
6872 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6873 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6874 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6875 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6876 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6877 actual buffer size for each thread.
6878
6879 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6880 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6881
6882 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6883 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6884
6885 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6886 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6887 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6888
6889 @kindex info record
6890 @item info record
6891 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6892 method:
6893
6894 @table @code
6895 @item full
6896 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6897 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6898
6899 @itemize @bullet
6900 @item
6901 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6902 @item
6903 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6904 @item
6905 Highest recorded instruction number.
6906 @item
6907 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6908 @item
6909 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6910 @item
6911 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6912 @end itemize
6913
6914 @item btrace
6915 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6916
6917 @itemize @bullet
6918 @item
6919 Recording format.
6920 @item
6921 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6922 @item
6923 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6924 instructions.
6925 @item
6926 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6927 @end itemize
6928
6929 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6930 @itemize @bullet
6931 @item
6932 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6933 @end itemize
6934
6935 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6936 @itemize @bullet
6937 @item
6938 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6939 @end itemize
6940 @end table
6941
6942 @kindex record delete
6943 @kindex rec del
6944 @item record delete
6945 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6946 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6947 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6948 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6949
6950 @kindex record instruction-history
6951 @kindex rec instruction-history
6952 @item record instruction-history
6953 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6954 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6955 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6956 are printed in execution order.
6957
6958 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6959 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6960 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6961
6962 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6963 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6964 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6965 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6966 @code{/p} modifier.
6967
6968 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6969 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6970 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6971
6972 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6973 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6974
6975 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6976 disassemble:
6977
6978 @table @code
6979 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6980 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6981 @var{insn}.
6982
6983 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6984 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6985 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6986 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6987 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6988 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6989
6990 @item record instruction-history
6991 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6992
6993 @item record instruction-history -
6994 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6995
6996 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6997 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6998 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6999 number @var{end} is included.
7000 @end table
7001
7002 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7003
7004 @kindex set record
7005 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7006 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7007 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7008 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7009 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7010
7011 @kindex show record
7012 @item show record instruction-history-size
7013 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7014 instruction-history} command.
7015
7016 @kindex record function-call-history
7017 @kindex rec function-call-history
7018 @item record function-call-history
7019 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7020 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7021 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7022 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7023 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7024 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7025 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7026 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7027 given together.
7028
7029 @smallexample
7030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7031 1 void foo (void)
7032 2 @{
7033 3 @}
7034 4
7035 5 void bar (void)
7036 6 @{
7037 7 ...
7038 8 foo ();
7039 9 ...
7040 10 @}
7041 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7042 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7043 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7044 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7045 @end smallexample
7046
7047 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7048 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7049 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7050 to print:
7051
7052 @table @code
7053 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7054 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7055
7056 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7057 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7058 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7059 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7060 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7061
7062 @item record function-call-history
7063 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7064
7065 @item record function-call-history -
7066 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7067
7068 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7069 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7070 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7071 @end table
7072
7073 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7074
7075 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7076 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7077 Define how many lines to print in the
7078 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7079 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7080
7081 @item show record function-call-history-size
7082 Show how many lines to print in the
7083 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7084 @end table
7085
7086
7087 @node Stack
7088 @chapter Examining the Stack
7089
7090 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7091 stopped and how it got there.
7092
7093 @cindex call stack
7094 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7095 is generated.
7096 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7097 the arguments of the call,
7098 and the local variables of the function being called.
7099 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7100 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7101 stack}.
7102
7103 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7104 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7105
7106 @cindex selected frame
7107 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7108 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7109 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7110 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7111 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7112 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7113
7114 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7115 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7116 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7117
7118 @menu
7119 * Frames:: Stack frames
7120 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7121 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7122 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7123 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7124
7125 @end menu
7126
7127 @node Frames
7128 @section Stack Frames
7129
7130 @cindex frame, definition
7131 @cindex stack frame
7132 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7133 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7134 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7135 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7136 which the function is executing.
7137
7138 @cindex initial frame
7139 @cindex outermost frame
7140 @cindex innermost frame
7141 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7142 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7143 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7144 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7145 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7146 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7147 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7148 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7149
7150 @cindex frame pointer
7151 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7152 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7153 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7154 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7155 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7156 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7157
7158 @cindex frame number
7159 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7160 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7161 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7162 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7163 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7164
7165 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7166 @c underflow problems.
7167 @cindex frameless execution
7168 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7169 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7170 @smallexample
7171 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7172 @end smallexample
7173 generates functions without a frame.)
7174 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7175 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7176 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7177 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7178 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7179 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7180 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7181
7182 @node Backtrace
7183 @section Backtraces
7184
7185 @cindex traceback
7186 @cindex call stack traces
7187 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7188 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7189 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7190 stack.
7191
7192 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7193 @table @code
7194 @kindex backtrace
7195 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7196 @item backtrace
7197 @itemx bt
7198 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7199 frames in the stack.
7200
7201 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7202 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7203
7204 @item backtrace @var{n}
7205 @itemx bt @var{n}
7206 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7207
7208 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7209 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7210 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7211
7212 @item backtrace full
7213 @itemx bt full
7214 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7215 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7216 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7217 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7218
7219 @item backtrace no-filters
7220 @itemx bt no-filters
7221 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7222 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7223 @itemx bt no-filters full
7224 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7225 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7226 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7227 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7228 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7229 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7230 support.
7231 @end table
7232
7233 @kindex where
7234 @kindex info stack
7235 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7236 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7237
7238 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7239 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7240 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7241 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7242 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7243 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7244 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7245 multi-threaded program.
7246
7247 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7248 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7249 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7250 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7251 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7252 line number.
7253
7254 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7255 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7256
7257 @smallexample
7258 @group
7259 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7260 at builtin.c:993
7261 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7262 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7263 at macro.c:71
7264 (More stack frames follow...)
7265 @end group
7266 @end smallexample
7267
7268 @noindent
7269 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7270 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7271 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7272
7273 @noindent
7274 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7275 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7276 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7277 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7278 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7279
7280 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7281 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7282 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7283 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7284 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7285 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7286 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7287 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7288 such a backtrace might look like:
7289
7290 @smallexample
7291 @group
7292 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7293 at builtin.c:993
7294 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7295 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7296 at macro.c:71
7297 (More stack frames follow...)
7298 @end group
7299 @end smallexample
7300
7301 @noindent
7302 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7303 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7304
7305 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7306 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7307 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7308
7309 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7310 @cindex program entry point
7311 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7312 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7313 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7314 @code{main}@footnote{
7315 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7316 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7317 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7318 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7319 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7320 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7321
7322 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7323 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7324
7325 @table @code
7326 @item set backtrace past-main
7327 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7328 @kindex set backtrace
7329 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7330
7331 @item set backtrace past-main off
7332 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7333 default.
7334
7335 @item show backtrace past-main
7336 @kindex show backtrace
7337 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7338
7339 @item set backtrace past-entry
7340 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7341 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7342 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7343 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7344
7345 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7346 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7347 application. This is the default.
7348
7349 @item show backtrace past-entry
7350 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7351
7352 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7353 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7354 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7355 @cindex backtrace limit
7356 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7357 or zero means unlimited levels.
7358
7359 @item show backtrace limit
7360 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7361 @end table
7362
7363 You can control how file names are displayed.
7364
7365 @table @code
7366 @item set filename-display
7367 @itemx set filename-display relative
7368 @cindex filename-display
7369 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7370
7371 @item set filename-display basename
7372 Display only basename of a filename.
7373
7374 @item set filename-display absolute
7375 Display an absolute filename.
7376
7377 @item show filename-display
7378 Show the current way to display filenames.
7379 @end table
7380
7381 @node Selection
7382 @section Selecting a Frame
7383
7384 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7385 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7386 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7387 of the stack frame just selected.
7388
7389 @table @code
7390 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7391 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7392 @item frame @var{n}
7393 @itemx f @var{n}
7394 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7395 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7396 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7397 @code{main}.
7398
7399 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7400 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7401 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7402 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7403 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7404 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7405 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7406 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7407
7408 @kindex up
7409 @item up @var{n}
7410 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7411 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7412 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7413
7414 @kindex down
7415 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7416 @item down @var{n}
7417 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7418 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7419 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7420 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7421 @end table
7422
7423 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7424 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7425 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7426 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7427
7428 @need 1000
7429 For example:
7430
7431 @smallexample
7432 @group
7433 (@value{GDBP}) up
7434 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7435 at env.c:10
7436 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7437 @end group
7438 @end smallexample
7439
7440 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7441 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7442 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7443 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7444 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7445 for details.
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @kindex select-frame
7449 @item select-frame
7450 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7451 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7452 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7453 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7454
7455 @kindex down-silently
7456 @kindex up-silently
7457 @item up-silently @var{n}
7458 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7459 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7460 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7461 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7462 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7463 distracting.
7464 @end table
7465
7466 @node Frame Info
7467 @section Information About a Frame
7468
7469 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7470 stack frame.
7471
7472 @table @code
7473 @item frame
7474 @itemx f
7475 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7476 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7477 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7478 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7479 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7480
7481 @kindex info frame
7482 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7483 @item info frame
7484 @itemx info f
7485 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7486 including:
7487
7488 @itemize @bullet
7489 @item
7490 the address of the frame
7491 @item
7492 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7493 @item
7494 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7495 @item
7496 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7497 @item
7498 the address of the frame's arguments
7499 @item
7500 the address of the frame's local variables
7501 @item
7502 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7503 @item
7504 which registers were saved in the frame
7505 @end itemize
7506
7507 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7508 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7509 the usual conventions.
7510
7511 @item info frame @var{addr}
7512 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7513 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7514 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7515 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7516 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7517 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7518
7519 @kindex info args
7520 @item info args
7521 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7522
7523 @item info locals
7524 @kindex info locals
7525 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7526 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7527 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7528
7529 @end table
7530
7531 @node Frame Filter Management
7532 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7533 @cindex managing frame filters
7534
7535 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7536 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7537
7538 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7539 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7540
7541 @table @code
7542 @kindex info frame-filter
7543 @item info frame-filter
7544 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7545 their name, priority and enabled status.
7546
7547 @kindex disable frame-filter
7548 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7549 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7550 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7551 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7552 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7553 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7554 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7555 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7556 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7557 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7558 may be enabled again later.
7559
7560 @kindex enable frame-filter
7561 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7562 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7563 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7564 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7565 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7566 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7567 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7568 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7569 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7570
7571 Example:
7572
7573 @smallexample
7574 (gdb) info frame-filter
7575
7576 global frame-filters:
7577 Priority Enabled Name
7578 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7579 100 Yes Reverse
7580
7581 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7582 Priority Enabled Name
7583 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7584
7585 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7586 Priority Enabled Name
7587 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7588
7589 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7590 (gdb) info frame-filter
7591
7592 global frame-filters:
7593 Priority Enabled Name
7594 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7595 100 Yes Reverse
7596
7597 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7598 Priority Enabled Name
7599 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7600
7601 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7602 Priority Enabled Name
7603 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7604
7605 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7606 (gdb) info frame-filter
7607
7608 global frame-filters:
7609 Priority Enabled Name
7610 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7611 100 Yes Reverse
7612
7613 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7614 Priority Enabled Name
7615 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7616
7617 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7618 Priority Enabled Name
7619 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7620 @end smallexample
7621
7622 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7623 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7624 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7625 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7626 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7627 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7628 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7629
7630 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7631 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7632 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7633 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7634 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7635 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7636 dictionary resides.
7637
7638 Example:
7639
7640 @smallexample
7641 (gdb) info frame-filter
7642
7643 global frame-filters:
7644 Priority Enabled Name
7645 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7646 100 Yes Reverse
7647
7648 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7649 Priority Enabled Name
7650 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7651
7652 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7653 Priority Enabled Name
7654 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7655
7656 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7657 (gdb) info frame-filter
7658
7659 global frame-filters:
7660 Priority Enabled Name
7661 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7662 50 Yes Reverse
7663
7664 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7665 Priority Enabled Name
7666 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7667
7668 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7669 Priority Enabled Name
7670 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7671 @end smallexample
7672 @end table
7673
7674 @node Source
7675 @chapter Examining Source Files
7676
7677 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7678 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7679 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7680 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7681 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7682 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7683 source files by explicit command.
7684
7685 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7686 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7687 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7688
7689 @menu
7690 * List:: Printing source lines
7691 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7692 * Edit:: Editing source files
7693 * Search:: Searching source files
7694 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7695 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7696 @end menu
7697
7698 @node List
7699 @section Printing Source Lines
7700
7701 @kindex list
7702 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7703 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7704 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7705 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7706 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7707
7708 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7709
7710 @table @code
7711 @item list @var{linenum}
7712 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7713 current source file.
7714
7715 @item list @var{function}
7716 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7717 @var{function}.
7718
7719 @item list
7720 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7721 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7722 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7723 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7724 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7725
7726 @item list -
7727 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7728 @end table
7729
7730 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7731 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7732 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7733
7734 @table @code
7735 @kindex set listsize
7736 @item set listsize @var{count}
7737 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7738 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7739 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7740 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7741
7742 @kindex show listsize
7743 @item show listsize
7744 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7745 @end table
7746
7747 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7748 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7749 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7750 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7751 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7752
7753 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7754 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7755 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7756 to specify some source line.
7757
7758 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7759
7760 @table @code
7761 @item list @var{location}
7762 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7763
7764 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7765 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7766 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7767 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7768 the same source file as the first location.
7769
7770 @item list ,@var{last}
7771 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7772
7773 @item list @var{first},
7774 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7775
7776 @item list +
7777 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7778
7779 @item list -
7780 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7781
7782 @item list
7783 As described in the preceding table.
7784 @end table
7785
7786 @node Specify Location
7787 @section Specifying a Location
7788 @cindex specifying location
7789 @cindex location
7790 @cindex source location
7791
7792 @menu
7793 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7794 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7795 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7796 @end menu
7797
7798 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7799 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7800 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7801 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7802 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7803
7804 @node Linespec Locations
7805 @subsection Linespec Locations
7806 @cindex linespec locations
7807
7808 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7809 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7810 specifying a linespec:
7811
7812 @table @code
7813 @item @var{linenum}
7814 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7815
7816 @item -@var{offset}
7817 @itemx +@var{offset}
7818 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7819 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7820 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7821 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7822 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7823 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7824 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7825 linespec.
7826
7827 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7828 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7829 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7830 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7831 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7832 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7833 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7834
7835 @item @var{function}
7836 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7837 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7838
7839 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7840 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7841
7842 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7843 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7844 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7845 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7846 functions in different source files.
7847
7848 @item @var{label}
7849 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7850 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7851 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7852 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7853
7854 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7855 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7856 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7857 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7858 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7859 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7860
7861 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7862 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7863 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7864 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7865 each one of those probes.
7866 @end table
7867
7868 @node Explicit Locations
7869 @subsection Explicit Locations
7870 @cindex explicit locations
7871
7872 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7873 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7874
7875 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7876 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7877 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7878 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7879 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7880
7881 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7882 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7883 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7884 the symbol table to know.
7885
7886 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7887 following table:
7888
7889 @table @code
7890 @item -source @var{filename}
7891 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7892 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7893 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7894 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7895 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7896
7897 @item -function @var{function}
7898 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7899 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7900 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7901 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7902
7903 @item -label @var{label}
7904 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7905 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7906 selected stack frame.
7907
7908 @item -line @var{number}
7909 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7910 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7911 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7912 relative to the current line.
7913 @end table
7914
7915 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7916 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7917
7918 @node Address Locations
7919 @subsection Address Locations
7920 @cindex address locations
7921
7922 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7923 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7924
7925 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7926 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7927 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7928 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7929 source files.
7930
7931 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7932 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7933 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7934 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7935 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7936 of @var{address}:
7937
7938 @table @code
7939 @item @var{expression}
7940 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7941
7942 @item @var{funcaddr}
7943 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7944 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7945 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7946 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7947 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7948 (although the Pascal form also works).
7949
7950 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7951 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7952
7953 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7954 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7955 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7956 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7957 functions with identical names in different source files.
7958 @end table
7959
7960 @node Edit
7961 @section Editing Source Files
7962 @cindex editing source files
7963
7964 @kindex edit
7965 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7966 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7967 The editing program of your choice
7968 is invoked with the current line set to
7969 the active line in the program.
7970 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7971 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7972
7973 @table @code
7974 @item edit @var{location}
7975 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7976 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7977 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7978 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7979 command most commonly used:
7980
7981 @table @code
7982 @item edit @var{number}
7983 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7984
7985 @item edit @var{function}
7986 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7987 @end table
7988
7989 @end table
7990
7991 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7992 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7993 @footnote{
7994 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7995 following command-line syntax:
7996 @smallexample
7997 ex +@var{number} file
7998 @end smallexample
7999 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8000 the file where to start editing.}.
8001 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8002 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8003 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8004 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8005 @smallexample
8006 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8007 export EDITOR
8008 gdb @dots{}
8009 @end smallexample
8010 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8011 @smallexample
8012 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8013 gdb @dots{}
8014 @end smallexample
8015
8016 @node Search
8017 @section Searching Source Files
8018 @cindex searching source files
8019
8020 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8021 regular expression.
8022
8023 @table @code
8024 @kindex search
8025 @kindex forward-search
8026 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8027 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8028 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8029 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8030 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8031 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8032 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8033 @code{fo}.
8034
8035 @kindex reverse-search
8036 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8037 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8038 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8039 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8040 this command as @code{rev}.
8041 @end table
8042
8043 @node Source Path
8044 @section Specifying Source Directories
8045
8046 @cindex source path
8047 @cindex directories for source files
8048 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8049 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8050 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8051 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8052 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8053 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8054 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8055
8056 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8057 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8058 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8059 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8060 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8061 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8062 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8063 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8064 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8065 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8066 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8067
8068 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8069 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8070 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8071 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8072 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8073 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8074
8075 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8076 source files.
8077
8078 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8079 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8080 each line is in the file.
8081
8082 @kindex directory
8083 @kindex dir
8084 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8085 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8086 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8087
8088 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8089 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8090
8091 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8092 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8093 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8094 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8095 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8096 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8097 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8098 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8099 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8100 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8101 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8102 name to look up the sources.
8103
8104 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8105 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8106 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8107 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8108 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8109 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8110 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8111 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8112
8113 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8114 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8115 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8116 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8117 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8118 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8119 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8120
8121 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8122 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8123 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8124 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8125 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8126 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8127 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8128 command.
8129
8130 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8131 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8132 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8133 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8134 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8135 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8136 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8137
8138 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8139 @cindex default source path substitution
8140 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8141 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8142 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8143 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8144 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8145 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8146 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8147 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8148 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8149 together.
8150
8151 @table @code
8152 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8153 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8154 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8155 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8156 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8157 part of absolute file names) or
8158 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8159 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8160
8161 @kindex cdir
8162 @kindex cwd
8163 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8164 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8165 @cindex compilation directory
8166 @cindex current directory
8167 @cindex working directory
8168 @cindex directory, current
8169 @cindex directory, compilation
8170 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8171 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8172 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8173 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8174 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8175 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8176
8177 @item directory
8178 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8179
8180 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8181 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8182
8183 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8184 @kindex set directories
8185 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8186 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8187
8188 @item show directories
8189 @kindex show directories
8190 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8191
8192 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8193 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8194 @kindex set substitute-path
8195 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8196 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8197 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8198
8199 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8200 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8201
8202 @smallexample
8203 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8204 @end smallexample
8205
8206 @noindent
8207 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8208 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8209 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8210
8211 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8212 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8213 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8214 the substitution.
8215
8216 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8217
8218 @smallexample
8219 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8220 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8221 @end smallexample
8222
8223 @noindent
8224 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8225 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8226 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8227 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8228
8229
8230 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8231 @kindex unset substitute-path
8232 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8233 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8234 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8235
8236 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8237
8238 @item show substitute-path [path]
8239 @kindex show substitute-path
8240 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8241 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8242
8243 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8244 rules.
8245
8246 @end table
8247
8248 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8249 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8250 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8251
8252 @enumerate
8253 @item
8254 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8255
8256 @item
8257 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8258 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8259 directories in one command.
8260 @end enumerate
8261
8262 @node Machine Code
8263 @section Source and Machine Code
8264 @cindex source line and its code address
8265
8266 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8267 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8268 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8269 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8270 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8271 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8272 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8273 well as hex.
8274
8275 @table @code
8276 @kindex info line
8277 @item info line @var{location}
8278 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8279 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8280 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8281 @end table
8282
8283 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8284 the object code for the first line of function
8285 @code{m4_changequote}:
8286
8287 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8288 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8289 @smallexample
8290 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8291 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8292 @end smallexample
8293
8294 @noindent
8295 @cindex code address and its source line
8296 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8297 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8298 @smallexample
8299 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8300 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8301 @end smallexample
8302
8303 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8304 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8305 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8306 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8307 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8308 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8309 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8310 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8311 Variables}).
8312
8313 @table @code
8314 @kindex disassemble
8315 @cindex assembly instructions
8316 @cindex instructions, assembly
8317 @cindex machine instructions
8318 @cindex listing machine instructions
8319 @item disassemble
8320 @itemx disassemble /m
8321 @itemx disassemble /s
8322 @itemx disassemble /r
8323 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8324 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8325 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8326 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8327 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8328 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8329 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8330 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8331 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8332 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8333
8334 @table @code
8335 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8336 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8337 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8338 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8339 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8340 @end table
8341
8342 @noindent
8343 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8344 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8345
8346 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8347 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8348
8349 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8350 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8351 @end table
8352
8353 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8354 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8355
8356 @smallexample
8357 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8358 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8359 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8360 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8361 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8362 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8363 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8364 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8365 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8366 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8367 End of assembler dump.
8368 @end smallexample
8369
8370 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8371 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8372 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8373
8374 @smallexample
8375 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8376 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8377 5 @{
8378 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8379 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8380 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8381 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8382 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8383
8384 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8385 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8386 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8387
8388 7 return 0;
8389 8 @}
8390 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8391 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8392 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8393
8394 End of assembler dump.
8395 @end smallexample
8396
8397 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8398 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8399 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8400 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8401 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8402 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8403 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8404 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8405 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8406
8407 @file{foo.h}:
8408
8409 @smallexample
8410 int
8411 foo (int a)
8412 @{
8413 if (a < 0)
8414 return a * 2;
8415 if (a == 0)
8416 return 1;
8417 return a + 10;
8418 @}
8419 @end smallexample
8420
8421 @file{foo.c}:
8422
8423 @smallexample
8424 #include "foo.h"
8425 volatile int x, y;
8426 int
8427 main ()
8428 @{
8429 x = foo (y);
8430 return 0;
8431 @}
8432 @end smallexample
8433
8434 @smallexample
8435 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8436 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8437 5 @{
8438
8439 6 x = foo (y);
8440 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8441 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8442
8443 7 return 0;
8444 8 @}
8445 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8446 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8447 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8448 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8449
8450 End of assembler dump.
8451 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8452 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8453 foo.c:
8454 5 @{
8455 6 x = foo (y);
8456 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8457
8458 foo.h:
8459 4 if (a < 0)
8460 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8461 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8462
8463 6 if (a == 0)
8464 7 return 1;
8465 8 return a + 10;
8466 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8467 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8468 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8469 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8470
8471 foo.c:
8472 6 x = foo (y);
8473 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8474
8475 7 return 0;
8476 8 @}
8477 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8478 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8479
8480 foo.h:
8481 5 return a * 2;
8482 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8483 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8484 End of assembler dump.
8485 @end smallexample
8486
8487 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8488
8489 @smallexample
8490 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8491 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8492 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8493 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8494 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8495 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8496 End of assembler dump.
8497 @end smallexample
8498
8499 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8500 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8501 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8502 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8503
8504 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8505 mnemonics or other syntax.
8506
8507 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8508 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8509 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8510 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8511 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8512
8513 @table @code
8514 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8515 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8516 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8517 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8518 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8519 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8520
8521 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8522 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8523 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8524 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8525
8526 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8527 @item show disassembly-flavor
8528 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8529 @end table
8530
8531 @table @code
8532 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8533 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8534 @item set disassemble-next-line
8535 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8536 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8537 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8538 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8539 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8540 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8541 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8542 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8543 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8544 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8545 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8546 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8547 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8548 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8549 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8550 instruction.
8551 @end table
8552
8553
8554 @node Data
8555 @chapter Examining Data
8556
8557 @cindex printing data
8558 @cindex examining data
8559 @kindex print
8560 @kindex inspect
8561 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8562 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8563 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8564 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8565 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8566 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8567
8568 @table @code
8569 @item print @var{expr}
8570 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8571 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8572 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8573 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8574 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8575 Formats}.
8576
8577 @item print
8578 @itemx print /@var{f}
8579 @cindex reprint the last value
8580 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8581 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8582 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8583 @end table
8584
8585 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8586 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8587 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8588
8589 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8590 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8591 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8592 Table}.
8593
8594 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8595 @kindex explore
8596 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8597 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8598 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8599 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8600 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8601 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8602 embedded in the higher level data types.
8603
8604 @table @code
8605 @item explore @var{arg}
8606 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8607 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8608 @end table
8609
8610 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8611 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8612 C program as
8613
8614 @smallexample
8615 struct SimpleStruct
8616 @{
8617 int i;
8618 double d;
8619 @};
8620
8621 struct ComplexStruct
8622 @{
8623 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8624 int arr[10];
8625 @};
8626 @end smallexample
8627
8628 @noindent
8629 followed by variable declarations as
8630
8631 @smallexample
8632 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8633 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8634 @end smallexample
8635
8636 @noindent
8637 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8638 @code{explore} command as follows.
8639
8640 @smallexample
8641 (gdb) explore cs
8642 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8643 the following fields:
8644
8645 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8646 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8647
8648 Enter the field number of choice:
8649 @end smallexample
8650
8651 @noindent
8652 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8653 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8654 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8655 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8656 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8657 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8658 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8659 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8660
8661 @smallexample
8662 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8663 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8664 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8665 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8666
8667 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8668 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8669
8670 Press enter to return to parent value:
8671 @end smallexample
8672
8673 @noindent
8674 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8675 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8676 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8677 to explore.
8678
8679 @smallexample
8680 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8681 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8682
8683 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8684
8685 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8686
8687 Press enter to return to parent value:
8688 @end smallexample
8689
8690 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8691 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8692 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8693 level data structure).
8694
8695 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8696 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8697 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8698 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8699 same example as above, your can explore the type
8700 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8701 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8702
8703 @smallexample
8704 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8705 @end smallexample
8706
8707 @noindent
8708 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8709 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8710 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8711 example.
8712
8713 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8714 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8715 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8716 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8717 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8718
8719 @table @code
8720 @item explore value @var{expr}
8721 @cindex explore value
8722 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8723 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8724 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8725 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8726 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8727
8728 @item explore type @var{arg}
8729 @cindex explore type
8730 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8731 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8732 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8733 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8734 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8735 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8736 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8737 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8738 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8739 @end table
8740
8741 @menu
8742 * Expressions:: Expressions
8743 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8744 * Variables:: Program variables
8745 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8746 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8747 * Memory:: Examining memory
8748 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8749 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8750 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8751 * Value History:: Value history
8752 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8753 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8754 * Registers:: Registers
8755 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8756 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8757 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8758 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8759 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8760 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8761 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8762 character set than GDB does
8763 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8764 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8765 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8766 @end menu
8767
8768 @node Expressions
8769 @section Expressions
8770
8771 @cindex expressions
8772 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8773 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8774 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8775 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8776 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8777 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8778 @ref{Compilation}.
8779
8780 @cindex arrays in expressions
8781 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8782 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8783 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8784 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8785 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8786 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8787
8788 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8789 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8790 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8791 languages.
8792
8793 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8794 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8795
8796 @cindex casts, in expressions
8797 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8798 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8799 at that address in memory.
8800 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8801
8802 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8803 to programming languages:
8804
8805 @table @code
8806 @item @@
8807 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8808 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8809
8810 @item ::
8811 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8812 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8813
8814 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8815 @cindex type casting memory
8816 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8817 @cindex casts, to view memory
8818 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8819 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8820 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8821 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8822 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8823 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8824 @end table
8825
8826 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8827 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8828 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8829
8830 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8831 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8832 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8833 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8834 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8835 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8836 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8837
8838 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8839 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8840 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8841 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8842 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8843 as well.
8844
8845 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8846 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8847 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8848 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8849 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8850 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8851 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8852 choices.
8853
8854 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8855 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8856 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8857
8858 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8859 @smallexample
8860 @group
8861 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8862 [0] cancel
8863 [1] all
8864 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8865 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8866 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8867 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8868 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8869 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8870 > 2 4 6
8871 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8872 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8873 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8874 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8875 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8876 breakpoints.
8877 (@value{GDBP})
8878 @end group
8879 @end smallexample
8880
8881 @table @code
8882 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8883 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8884 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8885
8886 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8887 is ambiguous.
8888
8889 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8890 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8891 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8892 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8893 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8894 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8895 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8896 in the use of the menu.
8897
8898 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8899 when an ambiguity is detected.
8900
8901 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8902 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8903
8904 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8905 @item show multiple-symbols
8906 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8907 @end table
8908
8909 @node Variables
8910 @section Program Variables
8911
8912 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8913 in your program.
8914
8915 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8916 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8917
8918 @itemize @bullet
8919 @item
8920 global (or file-static)
8921 @end itemize
8922
8923 @noindent or
8924
8925 @itemize @bullet
8926 @item
8927 visible according to the scope rules of the
8928 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8929 @end itemize
8930
8931 @noindent This means that in the function
8932
8933 @smallexample
8934 foo (a)
8935 int a;
8936 @{
8937 bar (a);
8938 @{
8939 int b = test ();
8940 bar (b);
8941 @}
8942 @}
8943 @end smallexample
8944
8945 @noindent
8946 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8947 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8948 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8949 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8950
8951 @cindex variable name conflict
8952 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8953 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8954 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8955 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8956 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8957 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8958 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8959
8960 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8961 @ifnotinfo
8962 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8963 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8964 @end ifnotinfo
8965 @smallexample
8966 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8967 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8968 @end smallexample
8969
8970 @noindent
8971 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8972 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8973 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8974 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8975
8976 @smallexample
8977 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8978 @end smallexample
8979
8980 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8981 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8982 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8983 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8984 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8985
8986 @smallexample
8987 void
8988 foo (int a)
8989 @{
8990 if (a < 10)
8991 bar (a);
8992 else
8993 process (a); /* Stop here */
8994 @}
8995
8996 int
8997 bar (int a)
8998 @{
8999 foo (a + 5);
9000 @}
9001 @end smallexample
9002
9003 @noindent
9004 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9005 here is what you might see
9006 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9007
9008 @smallexample
9009 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9010 $1 = 10
9011 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9012 $2 = 5
9013 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9014 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9015 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9016 $3 = 5
9017 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9018 $4 = 0
9019 @end smallexample
9020
9021 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9022 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9023 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9024 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9025 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9026
9027 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9028 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9029 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9030 @code{some_global}.
9031
9032 @smallexample
9033 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9034 $1 = 23
9035 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9036 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9037 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9038 $2 = 27
9039 @end smallexample
9040
9041 @cindex wrong values
9042 @cindex variable values, wrong
9043 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9044 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9045 @quotation
9046 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9047 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9048 scope, and just before exit.
9049 @end quotation
9050 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9051 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9052 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9053 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9054 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9055 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9056 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9057 variable definitions may be gone.
9058
9059 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9060 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9061 when compiling.
9062
9063 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9064 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9065 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9066 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9067 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9068 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9069 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9070
9071 @smallexample
9072 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9073 @end smallexample
9074
9075 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9076 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9077 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9078 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9079 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9080
9081 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9082 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9083 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9084 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9085
9086 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9087 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9088 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9089 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9090 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9091
9092 @smallexample
9093 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9094 29 i++;
9095 (gdb) next
9096 30 e (i);
9097 (gdb) print i
9098 $1 = 31
9099 (gdb) print i@@entry
9100 $2 = 30
9101 @end smallexample
9102
9103 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9104 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9105 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9106 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9107 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9108 For program code
9109
9110 @smallexample
9111 char var0[] = "A";
9112 signed char var1[] = "A";
9113 @end smallexample
9114
9115 You get during debugging
9116 @smallexample
9117 (gdb) print var0
9118 $1 = "A"
9119 (gdb) print var1
9120 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9121 @end smallexample
9122
9123 @node Arrays
9124 @section Artificial Arrays
9125
9126 @cindex artificial array
9127 @cindex arrays
9128 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9129 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9130 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9131 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9132 program.
9133
9134 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9135 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9136 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9137 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9138 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9139 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9140 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9141 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9142 example. If a program says
9143
9144 @smallexample
9145 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9146 @end smallexample
9147
9148 @noindent
9149 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9150
9151 @smallexample
9152 p *array@@len
9153 @end smallexample
9154
9155 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9156 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9157 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9158 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9159 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9160
9161 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9162 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9163 The value need not be in memory:
9164 @smallexample
9165 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9166 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9167 @end smallexample
9168
9169 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9170 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9171 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9172 @smallexample
9173 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9174 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9175 @end smallexample
9176
9177 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9178 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9179 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9180 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9181 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9182 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9183 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9184 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9185 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9186 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9187
9188 @smallexample
9189 set $i = 0
9190 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9191 @key{RET}
9192 @key{RET}
9193 @dots{}
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 @node Output Formats
9197 @section Output Formats
9198
9199 @cindex formatted output
9200 @cindex output formats
9201 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9202 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9203 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9204 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9205 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9206
9207 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9208 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9209 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9210 letters supported are:
9211
9212 @table @code
9213 @item x
9214 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9215 hexadecimal.
9216
9217 @item d
9218 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9219
9220 @item u
9221 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9222
9223 @item o
9224 Print as integer in octal.
9225
9226 @item t
9227 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9228 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9229 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9230 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9231
9232 @item a
9233 @cindex unknown address, locating
9234 @cindex locate address
9235 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9236 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9237 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9238
9239 @smallexample
9240 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9241 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9242 @end smallexample
9243
9244 @noindent
9245 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9246 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9247
9248 @item c
9249 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9250 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9251 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9252 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9253
9254 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9255 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9256 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9257 data.
9258
9259 @item f
9260 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9261 using typical floating point syntax.
9262
9263 @item s
9264 @cindex printing strings
9265 @cindex printing byte arrays
9266 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9267 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9268 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9269 natural types.
9270
9271 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9272 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9273 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9274 array.
9275
9276 @item z
9277 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9278 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9279 to the size of the integer type.
9280
9281 @item r
9282 @cindex raw printing
9283 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9284 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9285 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9286 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9287 pretty-printer which might exist.
9288 @end table
9289
9290 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9291
9292 @smallexample
9293 p/x $pc
9294 @end smallexample
9295
9296 @noindent
9297 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9298 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9299
9300 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9301 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9302 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9303
9304 @node Memory
9305 @section Examining Memory
9306
9307 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9308 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9309
9310 @cindex examining memory
9311 @table @code
9312 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9313 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9314 @itemx x @var{addr}
9315 @itemx x
9316 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9317 @end table
9318
9319 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9320 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9321 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9322 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9323 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9324
9325 @table @r
9326 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9327 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9328 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9329 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9330 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9331 @c 4.1.2.
9332
9333 @item @var{f}, the display format
9334 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9335 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9336 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9337 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9338 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9339
9340 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9341 The unit size is any of
9342
9343 @table @code
9344 @item b
9345 Bytes.
9346 @item h
9347 Halfwords (two bytes).
9348 @item w
9349 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9350 @item g
9351 Giant words (eight bytes).
9352 @end table
9353
9354 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9355 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9356 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9357 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9358 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9359 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9360 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9361 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9362 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9363 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9364 be altered.
9365
9366 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9367 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9368 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9369 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9370 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9371 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9372 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9373 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9374 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9375 a value from memory).
9376 @end table
9377
9378 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9379 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9380 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9381 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9382 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9383
9384 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9385 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9386 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9387
9388 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9389 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9390 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9391 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9392 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9393
9394 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9395 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9396 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9397 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9398 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9399 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9400 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9401 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9402 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9403
9404 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9405 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9406 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9407 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9408 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9409 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9410
9411 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9412 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9413 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9414 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9415 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9416 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9417 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9418
9419 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9420 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9421
9422 @smallexample
9423 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9424 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9425 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9426 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9427 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9428 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9429 @end smallexample
9430
9431 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9432 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9433 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9434 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9435 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9436 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9437 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9438 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9439 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9440
9441 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9442 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9443 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9444
9445 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9446 @cindex addressable memory unit
9447 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9448 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9449 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9450 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9451 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9452 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9453 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9454 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9455 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9456
9457 @cindex remote memory comparison
9458 @cindex target memory comparison
9459 @cindex verify remote memory image
9460 @cindex verify target memory image
9461 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9462 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9463 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9464 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9465 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9466 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9467
9468 @table @code
9469 @kindex compare-sections
9470 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9471 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9472 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9473 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9474 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9475 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9476
9477 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9478 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9479 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9480 @end table
9481
9482 @node Auto Display
9483 @section Automatic Display
9484 @cindex automatic display
9485 @cindex display of expressions
9486
9487 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9488 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9489 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9490 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9491 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9492 The automatic display looks like this:
9493
9494 @smallexample
9495 2: foo = 38
9496 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9497 @end smallexample
9498
9499 @noindent
9500 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9501 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9502 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9503 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9504 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9505 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9506
9507 @table @code
9508 @kindex display
9509 @item display @var{expr}
9510 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9511 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9512
9513 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9514
9515 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9516 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9517 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9518 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9519 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9520
9521 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9522 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9523 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9524 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9525 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9526 @end table
9527
9528 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9529 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9530 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9531
9532 @table @code
9533 @kindex delete display
9534 @kindex undisplay
9535 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9536 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9537 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9538 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9539 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9540 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9541 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9542
9543 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9544 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9545
9546 @kindex disable display
9547 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9548 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9549 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9550 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9551 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9552 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9553 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9554 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9555
9556 @kindex enable display
9557 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9558 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9559 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9560 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9561 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9562 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9563 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9564
9565 @item display
9566 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9567 done when your program stops.
9568
9569 @kindex info display
9570 @item info display
9571 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9572 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9573 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9574 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9575 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9576 @end table
9577
9578 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9579 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9580 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9581 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9582 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9583 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9584 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9585 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9586 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9587 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9588 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9589
9590 @node Print Settings
9591 @section Print Settings
9592
9593 @cindex format options
9594 @cindex print settings
9595 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9596 and symbols are printed.
9597
9598 @noindent
9599 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9600
9601 @table @code
9602 @kindex set print
9603 @item set print address
9604 @itemx set print address on
9605 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9606 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9607 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9608 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9609 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9610 @code{set print address on}:
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 @group
9614 (@value{GDBP}) f
9615 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9616 at input.c:530
9617 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9618 @end group
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @item set print address off
9622 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9623 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9624
9625 @smallexample
9626 @group
9627 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9628 (@value{GDBP}) f
9629 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9630 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9631 @end group
9632 @end smallexample
9633
9634 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9635 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9636 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9637 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9638
9639 @kindex show print
9640 @item show print address
9641 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9642 @end table
9643
9644 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9645 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9646 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9647 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9648 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9649 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9650 it prints a symbolic address:
9651
9652 @table @code
9653 @item set print symbol-filename on
9654 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9655 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9656 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9657 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9658
9659 @item set print symbol-filename off
9660 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9661 default.
9662
9663 @item show print symbol-filename
9664 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9665 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9666 @end table
9667
9668 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9669 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9670 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9671
9672 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9673 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9674
9675 @table @code
9676 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9677 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9678 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9679 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9680 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9681 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9682 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9683 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9684
9685 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9686 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9687 symbolic address.
9688 @end table
9689
9690 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9691 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9692 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9693 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9694 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9695 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9696 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9697 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9698
9699 @smallexample
9700 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9701 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9702 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9703 @end smallexample
9704
9705 @quotation
9706 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9707 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9708 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9709 @end quotation
9710
9711 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9712 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9713
9714 @table @code
9715 @item set print symbol on
9716 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9717 one exists.
9718
9719 @item set print symbol off
9720 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9721 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9722 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9723
9724 @item show print symbol
9725 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9726 address.
9727 @end table
9728
9729 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9730
9731 @table @code
9732 @item set print array
9733 @itemx set print array on
9734 @cindex pretty print arrays
9735 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9736 but uses more space. The default is off.
9737
9738 @item set print array off
9739 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9740
9741 @item show print array
9742 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9743 arrays.
9744
9745 @cindex print array indexes
9746 @item set print array-indexes
9747 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9748 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9749 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9750 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9751
9752 @item set print array-indexes off
9753 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9754
9755 @item show print array-indexes
9756 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9757 arrays.
9758
9759 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9760 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9761 @cindex number of array elements to print
9762 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9763 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9764 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9765 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9766 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9767 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9768 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9769 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9770
9771 @item show print elements
9772 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9773 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9774
9775 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9776 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9777 @cindex printing frame argument values
9778 @cindex print all frame argument values
9779 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9780 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9781 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9782 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9783 values are:
9784
9785 @table @code
9786 @item all
9787 The values of all arguments are printed.
9788
9789 @item scalars
9790 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9791 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9792 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9793 only scalar arguments are shown:
9794
9795 @smallexample
9796 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9797 at frame-args.c:23
9798 @end smallexample
9799
9800 @item none
9801 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9802 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9803
9804 @smallexample
9805 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9806 at frame-args.c:23
9807 @end smallexample
9808 @end table
9809
9810 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9811 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9812 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9813 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9814 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9815 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9816 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9817 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9818 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9819 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9820
9821 @item show print frame-arguments
9822 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9823
9824 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9825 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9826
9827 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9828 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9829 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9830 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9831 This is the default.
9832
9833 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9834 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9835
9836 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9837 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9838 @kindex set print entry-values
9839 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9840 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9841 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9842 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9843 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9844
9845 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9846 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9847 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9848 @code{no} setting.
9849
9850 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9851 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9852 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9853 this information.
9854
9855 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9856
9857 @table @code
9858 @item no
9859 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9860 point.
9861 @smallexample
9862 #0 equal (val=5)
9863 #0 different (val=6)
9864 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9865 #0 born (val=10)
9866 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9867 @end smallexample
9868
9869 @item only
9870 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9871 values are never printed.
9872 @smallexample
9873 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9874 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9875 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9876 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9877 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9878 @end smallexample
9879
9880 @item preferred
9881 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9882 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9883 value for such parameter.
9884 @smallexample
9885 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9886 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9887 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9888 #0 born (val=10)
9889 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9890 @end smallexample
9891
9892 @item if-needed
9893 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9894 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9895 parameter.
9896 @smallexample
9897 #0 equal (val=5)
9898 #0 different (val=6)
9899 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9900 #0 born (val=10)
9901 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9902 @end smallexample
9903
9904 @item both
9905 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9906 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9907 optimizations.
9908 @smallexample
9909 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9910 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9911 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9912 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9913 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9914 @end smallexample
9915
9916 @item compact
9917 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9918 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9919 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9920 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9921 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9922 @smallexample
9923 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9924 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9925 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9926 #0 born (val=10)
9927 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9928 @end smallexample
9929
9930 @item default
9931 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9932 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9933 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9934 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9935 @smallexample
9936 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9937 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9938 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9939 #0 born (val=10)
9940 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9941 @end smallexample
9942 @end table
9943
9944 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9945 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9946
9947 @item show print entry-values
9948 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9949 entry.
9950
9951 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9952 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9953 @cindex repeated array elements
9954 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9955 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9956 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9957 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9958 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9959 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9960 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9961 is 10.
9962
9963 @item show print repeats
9964 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9965 elements.
9966
9967 @item set print null-stop
9968 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9969 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9970 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9971 contain only short strings.
9972 The default is off.
9973
9974 @item show print null-stop
9975 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9976 @sc{null} character.
9977
9978 @item set print pretty on
9979 @cindex print structures in indented form
9980 @cindex indentation in structure display
9981 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9982 per line, like this:
9983
9984 @smallexample
9985 @group
9986 $1 = @{
9987 next = 0x0,
9988 flags = @{
9989 sweet = 1,
9990 sour = 1
9991 @},
9992 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9993 @}
9994 @end group
9995 @end smallexample
9996
9997 @item set print pretty off
9998 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9999
10000 @smallexample
10001 @group
10002 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10003 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10004 @end group
10005 @end smallexample
10006
10007 @noindent
10008 This is the default format.
10009
10010 @item show print pretty
10011 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10012
10013 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10014 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10015 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10016 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10017 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10018 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10019 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10020 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10021
10022 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10023 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10024 international character sets, and is the default.
10025
10026 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10027 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10028
10029 @item set print union on
10030 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10031 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10032 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10033
10034 @item set print union off
10035 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10036 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10037 instead.
10038
10039 @item show print union
10040 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10041 structures and other unions.
10042
10043 For example, given the declarations
10044
10045 @smallexample
10046 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10047 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10048 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10049 Bug_forms;
10050
10051 struct thing @{
10052 Species it;
10053 union @{
10054 Tree_forms tree;
10055 Bug_forms bug;
10056 @} form;
10057 @};
10058
10059 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10060 @end smallexample
10061
10062 @noindent
10063 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10064
10065 @smallexample
10066 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10067 @end smallexample
10068
10069 @noindent
10070 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10071
10072 @smallexample
10073 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10074 @end smallexample
10075
10076 @noindent
10077 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10078 and in Pascal.
10079 @end table
10080
10081 @need 1000
10082 @noindent
10083 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10084
10085 @table @code
10086 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10087 @item set print demangle
10088 @itemx set print demangle on
10089 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10090 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10091 linkage. The default is on.
10092
10093 @item show print demangle
10094 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10095
10096 @item set print asm-demangle
10097 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10098 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10099 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10100 The default is off.
10101
10102 @item show print asm-demangle
10103 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10104 or demangled form.
10105
10106 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10107 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10108 @kindex set demangle-style
10109 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10110 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10111 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10112
10113 @table @code
10114 @item auto
10115 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10116 This is the default.
10117
10118 @item gnu
10119 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10120
10121 @item hp
10122 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10123
10124 @item lucid
10125 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10126
10127 @item arm
10128 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10129 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10130 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10131 require further enhancement to permit that.
10132
10133 @end table
10134 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10135
10136 @item show demangle-style
10137 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10138
10139 @item set print object
10140 @itemx set print object on
10141 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10142 @cindex display derived types
10143 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10144 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10145 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10146 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10147 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10148 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10149 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10150
10151 @item set print object off
10152 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10153 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10154
10155 @item show print object
10156 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10157
10158 @item set print static-members
10159 @itemx set print static-members on
10160 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10161 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10162
10163 @item set print static-members off
10164 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10165
10166 @item show print static-members
10167 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10168
10169 @item set print pascal_static-members
10170 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10171 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10172 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10173 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10174
10175 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10176 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10177
10178 @item show print pascal_static-members
10179 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10180
10181 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10182 @item set print vtbl
10183 @itemx set print vtbl on
10184 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10185 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10186 @cindex VTBL display
10187 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10188 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10189 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10190
10191 @item set print vtbl off
10192 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10193
10194 @item show print vtbl
10195 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10196 @end table
10197
10198 @node Pretty Printing
10199 @section Pretty Printing
10200
10201 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10202 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10203 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10204
10205 @menu
10206 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10207 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10208 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10209 @end menu
10210
10211 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10212 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10213
10214 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10215 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10216 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10217
10218 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10219 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10220 pretty-printers with their names.
10221 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10222 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10223 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10224 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10225
10226 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10227 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10228 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10229 do anything special.
10230
10231 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10232
10233 @itemize @bullet
10234 @item
10235 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10236 all inferiors.
10237
10238 @item
10239 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10240 when debugging that program.
10241 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10242
10243 @item
10244 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10245 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10246 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10247 @end itemize
10248
10249 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10250 pretty-printers are selected,
10251
10252 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10253 for new types.
10254
10255 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10256 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10257
10258 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10259
10260 @smallexample
10261 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10262 $1 = @{
10263 static npos = 4294967295,
10264 _M_dataplus = @{
10265 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10266 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10267 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10268 @},
10269 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10270 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10271 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10272 @}
10273 @}
10274 @end smallexample
10275
10276 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10277
10278 @smallexample
10279 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10280 $2 = "abcd"
10281 @end smallexample
10282
10283 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10284 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10285 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10286
10287 @table @code
10288 @kindex info pretty-printer
10289 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10290 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10291 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10292
10293 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10294 whose pretty-printers to list.
10295 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10296 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10297 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10298 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10299 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10300
10301 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10302 to list.
10303
10304 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10305 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10306 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10307 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10308
10309 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10310 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10311 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10312 @end table
10313
10314 Example:
10315
10316 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10317 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10318 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10319 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10320
10321 @smallexample
10322 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10323 library1.so:
10324 foo
10325 library2.so:
10326 bar
10327 bar1
10328 bar2
10329 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10330 library2.so:
10331 bar
10332 bar1
10333 bar2
10334 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10335 1 printer disabled
10336 2 of 3 printers enabled
10337 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10338 library1.so:
10339 foo [disabled]
10340 library2.so:
10341 bar
10342 bar1
10343 bar2
10344 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10345 1 printer disabled
10346 1 of 3 printers enabled
10347 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10348 library1.so:
10349 foo [disabled]
10350 library2.so:
10351 bar
10352 bar1 [disabled]
10353 bar2
10354 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10355 1 printer disabled
10356 0 of 3 printers enabled
10357 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10358 library1.so:
10359 foo [disabled]
10360 library2.so:
10361 bar [disabled]
10362 bar1 [disabled]
10363 bar2
10364 @end smallexample
10365
10366 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10367 as can each individual subprinter.
10368
10369 @node Value History
10370 @section Value History
10371
10372 @cindex value history
10373 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10374 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10375 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10376 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10377 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10378 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10379 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10380 symbol table.
10381
10382 @cindex @code{$}
10383 @cindex @code{$$}
10384 @cindex history number
10385 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10386 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10387 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10388 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10389 history number.
10390
10391 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10392 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10393 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10394 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10395 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10396 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10397 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10398
10399 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10400 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10401
10402 @smallexample
10403 p *$
10404 @end smallexample
10405
10406 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10407 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10408
10409 @smallexample
10410 p *$.next
10411 @end smallexample
10412
10413 @noindent
10414 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10415 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10416
10417 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10418 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10419
10420 @smallexample
10421 print x
10422 set x=5
10423 @end smallexample
10424
10425 @noindent
10426 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10427 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10428
10429 @table @code
10430 @kindex show values
10431 @item show values
10432 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10433 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10434 values} does not change the history.
10435
10436 @item show values @var{n}
10437 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10438
10439 @item show values +
10440 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10441 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10442 @end table
10443
10444 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10445 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10446
10447 @node Convenience Vars
10448 @section Convenience Variables
10449
10450 @cindex convenience variables
10451 @cindex user-defined variables
10452 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10453 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10454 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10455 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10456 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10457
10458 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10459 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10460 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10461 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10462 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10463
10464 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10465 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10466 For example:
10467
10468 @smallexample
10469 set $foo = *object_ptr
10470 @end smallexample
10471
10472 @noindent
10473 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10474 @code{object_ptr}.
10475
10476 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10477 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10478 value with another assignment at any time.
10479
10480 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10481 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10482 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10483 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10484
10485 @table @code
10486 @kindex show convenience
10487 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10488 @item show convenience
10489 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10490 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10491 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10492
10493 @kindex init-if-undefined
10494 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10495 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10496 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10497 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10498 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10499 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10500 override default values used in a command script.
10501
10502 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10503 any side-effects do not occur.
10504 @end table
10505
10506 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10507 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10508 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10509
10510 @smallexample
10511 set $i = 0
10512 print bar[$i++]->contents
10513 @end smallexample
10514
10515 @noindent
10516 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10517
10518 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10519 values likely to be useful.
10520
10521 @table @code
10522 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10523 @item $_
10524 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10525 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10526 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10527 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10528 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10529 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10530 to the type of @code{$__}.
10531
10532 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10533 @item $__
10534 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10535 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10536 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10537
10538 @item $_exitcode
10539 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10540 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10541 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10542 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10543
10544 @item $_exitsignal
10545 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10546 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10547 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10548 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10549
10550 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10551 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10552 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10553 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10554 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10555
10556 @smallexample
10557 #include <signal.h>
10558
10559 int
10560 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10561 @{
10562 raise (SIGALRM);
10563 return 0;
10564 @}
10565 @end smallexample
10566
10567 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10568 or signalled would be:
10569
10570 @smallexample
10571 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10572 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10573 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10574 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10575 >echo The program has exited\n
10576 >else
10577 >echo The program has signalled\n
10578 >end
10579 >end
10580 (@value{GDBP}) run
10581 Starting program:
10582
10583 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10584 The program no longer exists.
10585 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10586 The program has signalled
10587 @end smallexample
10588
10589 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10590 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10591 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10592 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10593
10594 @smallexample
10595 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10596 The program has exited
10597 @end smallexample
10598
10599 @item $_exception
10600 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10601 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10602
10603 @item $_probe_argc
10604 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10605 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10606
10607 @item $_sdata
10608 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10609 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10610 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10611 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10612 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10613
10614 @item $_siginfo
10615 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10616 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10617 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10618 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10619 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10620
10621 @item $_tlb
10622 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10623 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10624 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10625 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10626 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10627 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10628
10629 @item $_inferior
10630 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10631 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10632
10633 @item $_thread
10634 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10635
10636 @item $_gthread
10637 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10638
10639 @end table
10640
10641 @node Convenience Funs
10642 @section Convenience Functions
10643
10644 @cindex convenience functions
10645 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10646 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10647 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10648 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10649 @value{GDBN}.
10650
10651 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10652 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10653
10654 @table @code
10655
10656 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10657 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10658 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10659 returns zero.
10660
10661 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10662 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10663 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10664 it is @code{void}:
10665
10666 @smallexample
10667 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10668 $1 = void
10669 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10670 $2 = 1
10671 (@value{GDBP}) run
10672 Starting program: ./a.out
10673 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10674 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10675 $3 = 0
10676 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10677 $4 = 0
10678 @end smallexample
10679
10680 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10681 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10682 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10683 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10684 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10685 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10686 anymore.
10687
10688 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10689 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10690
10691 @smallexample
10692 void
10693 foo (void)
10694 @{
10695 @}
10696 @end smallexample
10697
10698 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10699
10700 @smallexample
10701 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10702 $1 = void
10703 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10704 $2 = 1
10705 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10706 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10707 $3 = void
10708 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10709 $4 = 1
10710 @end smallexample
10711
10712 @end table
10713
10714 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10715 @code{Python} support.
10716
10717 @table @code
10718
10719 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10720 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10721 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10722 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10723 Otherwise it returns zero.
10724
10725 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10726 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10727 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10728 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10729 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10730 regular expression support.
10731
10732 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10733 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10734 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10735 Otherwise it returns zero.
10736
10737 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10738 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10739 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10740
10741 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10742 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10743 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10744 Otherwise it returns zero.
10745
10746 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10747 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10748 The default is 1.
10749
10750 Example:
10751
10752 @smallexample
10753 (gdb) backtrace
10754 #0 bottom_func ()
10755 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10756 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10757 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10758 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10759 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10760 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10761 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10762 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10763 $1 = 1
10764 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10765 $1 = 1
10766 @end smallexample
10767
10768 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10769 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10770 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10771 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10772
10773 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10774 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10775 The default is 1.
10776
10777 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10778 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10779 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10780 Otherwise it returns zero.
10781
10782 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10783 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10784 The default is 1.
10785
10786 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10787 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10788 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10789 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10790
10791 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10792 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10793 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10794 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10795
10796 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10797 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10798 The default is 1.
10799
10800 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10801 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10802 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10803 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10804
10805 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10806 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10807 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10808
10809 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10810 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10811 an enumerated type:
10812
10813 @smallexample
10814 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10815 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10816 @end smallexample
10817
10818 @end table
10819
10820 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10821 convenience functions.
10822
10823 @table @code
10824 @item help function
10825 @kindex help function
10826 @cindex show all convenience functions
10827 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10828 @end table
10829
10830 @node Registers
10831 @section Registers
10832
10833 @cindex registers
10834 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10835 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10836 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10837 your machine.
10838
10839 @table @code
10840 @kindex info registers
10841 @item info registers
10842 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10843 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10844
10845 @kindex info all-registers
10846 @cindex floating point registers
10847 @item info all-registers
10848 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10849 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10850
10851 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10852 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10853 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10854 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10855 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10856 @end table
10857
10858 @anchor{standard registers}
10859 @cindex stack pointer register
10860 @cindex program counter register
10861 @cindex process status register
10862 @cindex frame pointer register
10863 @cindex standard registers
10864 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10865 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10866 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10867 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10868 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10869 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10870 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10871 you could print the program counter in hex with
10872
10873 @smallexample
10874 p/x $pc
10875 @end smallexample
10876
10877 @noindent
10878 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10879
10880 @smallexample
10881 x/i $pc
10882 @end smallexample
10883
10884 @noindent
10885 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10886 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10887 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10888 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10889 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10890 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10891 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10892
10893 @smallexample
10894 set $sp += 4
10895 @end smallexample
10896
10897 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10898 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10899 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10900 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10901 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10902 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10903 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10904
10905 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10906 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10907 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10908 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10909 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10910 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10911 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10912
10913 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10914 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10915 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10916 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10917 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10918 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10919 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10920 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10921 prints the data in both formats.
10922
10923 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10924 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10925 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10926 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10927 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10928 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10929 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10930
10931 @smallexample
10932 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10933 $1 = @{
10934 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10935 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10936 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10937 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10938 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10939 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10940 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10941 @}
10942 @end smallexample
10943
10944 @noindent
10945 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10946 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10947 value to a @code{struct} member:
10948
10949 @smallexample
10950 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10951 @end smallexample
10952
10953 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10954 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10955 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10956 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10957 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10958 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10959
10960 @cindex caller-saved registers
10961 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10962 @cindex volatile registers
10963 @cindex <not saved> values
10964 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10965 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10966 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10967 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10968 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10969 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10970 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10971 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10972 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10973 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10974 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10975 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10976 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10977 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10978 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10979 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10980 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10981 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10982 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10983 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10984 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10985 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10986 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10987
10988 @node Floating Point Hardware
10989 @section Floating Point Hardware
10990 @cindex floating point
10991
10992 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10993 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10994
10995 @table @code
10996 @kindex info float
10997 @item info float
10998 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10999 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11000 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11001 the ARM and x86 machines.
11002 @end table
11003
11004 @node Vector Unit
11005 @section Vector Unit
11006 @cindex vector unit
11007
11008 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11009 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11010
11011 @table @code
11012 @kindex info vector
11013 @item info vector
11014 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11015 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11016 @end table
11017
11018 @node OS Information
11019 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11020 @cindex OS information
11021
11022 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11023 you debug your program.
11024
11025 @cindex auxiliary vector
11026 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11027 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11028 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11029 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11030 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11031 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11032 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11033 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11034 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11035 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11036 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11037 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11038
11039 @table @code
11040 @kindex info auxv
11041 @item info auxv
11042 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11043 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11044 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11045 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11046 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11047 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11048 an unrecognized tag.
11049 @end table
11050
11051 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11052 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11053 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11054 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11055 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11056 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11057 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11058
11059 @table @code
11060 @kindex info os
11061 @item info os @var{infotype}
11062
11063 Display OS information of the requested type.
11064
11065 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11066
11067 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11068 @table @code
11069 @kindex info os cpus
11070 @item cpus
11071 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11072 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11073 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11074 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11075 kernel initialization.
11076
11077 @kindex info os files
11078 @item files
11079 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11080 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11081 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11082 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11083
11084 @kindex info os modules
11085 @item modules
11086 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11087 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11088 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11089 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11090 in memory.
11091
11092 @kindex info os msg
11093 @item msg
11094 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11095 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11096 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11097 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11098 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11099 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11100 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11101 the message queue was last changed.
11102
11103 @kindex info os processes
11104 @item processes
11105 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11106 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11107 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11108 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11109 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11110 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11111
11112 @kindex info os procgroups
11113 @item procgroups
11114 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11115 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11116 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11117 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11118 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11119 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11120 and the process group leader is listed first.
11121
11122 @kindex info os semaphores
11123 @item semaphores
11124 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11125 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11126 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11127 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11128 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11129
11130 @kindex info os shm
11131 @item shm
11132 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11133 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11134 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11135 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11136 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11137 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11138 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11139
11140 @kindex info os sockets
11141 @item sockets
11142 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11143 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11144 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11145 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11146 connection.
11147
11148 @kindex info os threads
11149 @item threads
11150 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11151 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11152 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11153 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11154 process is not listed.
11155 @end table
11156
11157 @item info os
11158 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11159 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11160 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11161 types, this command will report an error.
11162 @end table
11163
11164 @node Memory Region Attributes
11165 @section Memory Region Attributes
11166 @cindex memory region attributes
11167
11168 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11169 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11170 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11171 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11172 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11173 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11174 user can override the fetched regions.
11175
11176 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11177 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11178 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11179 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11180 all memory.
11181
11182 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11183 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11184
11185 @table @code
11186 @kindex mem
11187 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11188 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11189 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11190 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11191 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11192 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11193
11194 @item mem auto
11195 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11196 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11197
11198 @kindex delete mem
11199 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11200 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11201 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11202
11203 @kindex disable mem
11204 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11205 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11206 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11207 It may be enabled again later.
11208
11209 @kindex enable mem
11210 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11211 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11212
11213 @kindex info mem
11214 @item info mem
11215 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11216 for each region:
11217
11218 @table @emph
11219 @item Memory Region Number
11220 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11221 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11222 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11223
11224 @item Lo Address
11225 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11226
11227 @item Hi Address
11228 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11229
11230 @item Attributes
11231 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11232 @end table
11233 @end table
11234
11235
11236 @subsection Attributes
11237
11238 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11239 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11240 write accesses to a memory region.
11241
11242 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11243 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11244 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11245
11246 @table @code
11247 @item ro
11248 Memory is read only.
11249 @item wo
11250 Memory is write only.
11251 @item rw
11252 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11253 @end table
11254
11255 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11256 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11257 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11258 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11259 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11260
11261 @table @code
11262 @item 8
11263 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11264 @item 16
11265 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11266 @item 32
11267 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11268 @item 64
11269 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11270 @end table
11271
11272 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11273 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11274 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11275 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11276 @c
11277 @c @table @code
11278 @c @item hwbreak
11279 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11280 @c @item swbreak (default)
11281 @c @end table
11282
11283 @subsubsection Data Cache
11284 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11285 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11286 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11287 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11288 registers.
11289
11290 @table @code
11291 @item cache
11292 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11293 @item nocache
11294 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11295 @end table
11296
11297 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11298 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11299 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11300 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11301 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11302
11303 @table @code
11304 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11305 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11306 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11307 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11308 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11309 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11310 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11311 The default value is @code{on}.
11312 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11313 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11314 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11315 @end table
11316
11317
11318 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11319 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11320 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11321 @c
11322 @c @table @code
11323 @c @item verify
11324 @c @item noverify (default)
11325 @c @end table
11326
11327 @node Dump/Restore Files
11328 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11329 @cindex dump/restore files
11330 @cindex append data to a file
11331 @cindex dump data to a file
11332 @cindex restore data from a file
11333
11334 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11335 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11336 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11337 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11338 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11339 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11340 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11341
11342 @table @code
11343
11344 @kindex dump
11345 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11346 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11347 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11348 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11349
11350 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11351 @table @code
11352 @item binary
11353 Raw binary form.
11354 @item ihex
11355 Intel hex format.
11356 @item srec
11357 Motorola S-record format.
11358 @item tekhex
11359 Tektronix Hex format.
11360 @item verilog
11361 Verilog Hex format.
11362 @end table
11363
11364 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11365 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11366 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11367 form.
11368
11369 @kindex append
11370 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11371 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11372 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11373 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11374 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11375
11376 @kindex restore
11377 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11378 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11379 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11380 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11381 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11382
11383 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11384 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11385 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11386 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11387 from that location.
11388
11389 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11390 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11391 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11392 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11393
11394 @end table
11395
11396 @node Core File Generation
11397 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11398 @cindex dump core from inferior
11399
11400 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11401 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11402 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11403 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11404 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11405 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11406 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11407
11408 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11409 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11410 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11411
11412 @table @code
11413 @kindex gcore
11414 @kindex generate-core-file
11415 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11416 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11417 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11418 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11419 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11420 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11421
11422 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11423 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11424
11425 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11426 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11427 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11428
11429 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11430 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11431 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11432 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11433 Enable or disable the use of the file
11434 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11435 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11436 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11437 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11438
11439 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11440 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11441 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11442 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11443 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11444 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11445 about the bits that can be set in the
11446 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11447 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11448
11449 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11450 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11451 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11452 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11453 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11454 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11455 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11456 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11457 @end table
11458
11459 @node Character Sets
11460 @section Character Sets
11461 @cindex character sets
11462 @cindex charset
11463 @cindex translating between character sets
11464 @cindex host character set
11465 @cindex target character set
11466
11467 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11468 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11469 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11470 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11471 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11472 @dfn{target character set}.
11473
11474 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11475 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11476 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11477 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11478 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11479 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11480 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11481 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11482 character and string literals in expressions.
11483
11484 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11485 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11486 target-charset} command, described below.
11487
11488 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11489 support:
11490
11491 @table @code
11492 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11493 @kindex set target-charset
11494 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11495 list of supported target character sets, type
11496 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11497
11498 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11499 @kindex set host-charset
11500 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11501
11502 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11503 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11504 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11505 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11506 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11507
11508 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11509 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11510 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11511
11512 @item set charset @var{charset}
11513 @kindex set charset
11514 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11515 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11516 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11517 for both host and target.
11518
11519 @item show charset
11520 @kindex show charset
11521 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11522
11523 @item show host-charset
11524 @kindex show host-charset
11525 Show the name of the current host character set.
11526
11527 @item show target-charset
11528 @kindex show target-charset
11529 Show the name of the current target character set.
11530
11531 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11532 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11533 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11534 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11535 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11536 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11537
11538 @item show target-wide-charset
11539 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11540 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11541 @end table
11542
11543 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11544 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11545 @file{charset-test.c}:
11546
11547 @smallexample
11548 #include <stdio.h>
11549
11550 char ascii_hello[]
11551 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11552 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11553 char ibm1047_hello[]
11554 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11555 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11556
11557 main ()
11558 @{
11559 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11560 @}
11561 @end smallexample
11562
11563 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11564 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11565 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11566
11567 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11568
11569 @smallexample
11570 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11571 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11572 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11573 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11574 @dots{}
11575 (@value{GDBP})
11576 @end smallexample
11577
11578 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11579 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11580 strings:
11581
11582 @smallexample
11583 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11584 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11585 (@value{GDBP})
11586 @end smallexample
11587
11588 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11589 initial character set:
11590 @smallexample
11591 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11592 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11593 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11594 (@value{GDBP})
11595 @end smallexample
11596
11597 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11598 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11599 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11600 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11601 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11602
11603 @smallexample
11604 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11605 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11606 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11607 $2 = 72 'H'
11608 (@value{GDBP})
11609 @end smallexample
11610
11611 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11612 literals you use in expressions:
11613
11614 @smallexample
11615 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11616 $3 = 43 '+'
11617 (@value{GDBP})
11618 @end smallexample
11619
11620 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11621 character.
11622
11623 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11624 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11625 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11626
11627 @smallexample
11628 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11629 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11630 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11631 $5 = 200 '\310'
11632 (@value{GDBP})
11633 @end smallexample
11634
11635 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11636 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11637
11638 @smallexample
11639 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11640 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11641 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11642 @end smallexample
11643
11644 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11645 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11646 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11647 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11648 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11649
11650 @smallexample
11651 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11652 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11653 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11654 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11655 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11656 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11657 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11658 $7 = 72 '\110'
11659 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11660 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11661 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11662 $9 = 200 'H'
11663 (@value{GDBP})
11664 @end smallexample
11665
11666 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11667 string literals you use in expressions:
11668
11669 @smallexample
11670 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11671 $10 = 78 '+'
11672 (@value{GDBP})
11673 @end smallexample
11674
11675 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11676 character.
11677
11678 @node Caching Target Data
11679 @section Caching Data of Targets
11680 @cindex caching data of targets
11681
11682 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11683 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11684 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11685 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11686 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11687 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11688 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11689 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11690 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11691 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11692 is executing.
11693 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11694 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11695 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11696 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11697 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11698 in the code segment.
11699 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11700 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11701
11702 @table @code
11703 @kindex set remotecache
11704 @item set remotecache on
11705 @itemx set remotecache off
11706 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11707 with old scripts.
11708
11709 @kindex show remotecache
11710 @item show remotecache
11711 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11712
11713 @kindex set stack-cache
11714 @item set stack-cache on
11715 @itemx set stack-cache off
11716 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11717 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11718
11719 @kindex show stack-cache
11720 @item show stack-cache
11721 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11722
11723 @kindex set code-cache
11724 @item set code-cache on
11725 @itemx set code-cache off
11726 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11727 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11728 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11729
11730 @kindex show code-cache
11731 @item show code-cache
11732 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11733 accesses.
11734
11735 @kindex info dcache
11736 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11737 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11738 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11739 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11740 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11741 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11742
11743 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11744 printed in hex.
11745
11746 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11747 @cindex dcache size
11748 @kindex set dcache size
11749 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11750
11751 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11752 @cindex dcache line-size
11753 @kindex set dcache line-size
11754 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11755 Must be a power of 2.
11756
11757 @item show dcache size
11758 @kindex show dcache size
11759 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11760
11761 @item show dcache line-size
11762 @kindex show dcache line-size
11763 Show default size of dcache lines.
11764
11765 @end table
11766
11767 @node Searching Memory
11768 @section Search Memory
11769 @cindex searching memory
11770
11771 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11772 @code{find} command.
11773
11774 @table @code
11775 @kindex find
11776 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11777 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11778 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11779 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11780 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11781 @end table
11782
11783 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11784 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11785
11786 @table @r
11787 @item @var{s}, search query size
11788 The size of each search query value.
11789
11790 @table @code
11791 @item b
11792 bytes
11793 @item h
11794 halfwords (two bytes)
11795 @item w
11796 words (four bytes)
11797 @item g
11798 giant words (eight bytes)
11799 @end table
11800
11801 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11802 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11803 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11804
11805 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11806 value's type in the current language.
11807 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11808 pattern as a mixture of types.
11809 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11810 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11811 which is typically four bytes.
11812
11813 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11814 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11815 @end table
11816
11817 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11818 (@code{"}).
11819 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11820 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11821
11822 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11823 number of matches found.
11824
11825 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11826 @samp{$_}.
11827 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11828
11829 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11830
11831 @smallexample
11832 void
11833 hello ()
11834 @{
11835 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11836 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11837 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11838 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11839 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11840 @}
11841 @end smallexample
11842
11843 @noindent
11844 you get during debugging:
11845
11846 @smallexample
11847 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11848 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11849 1 pattern found
11850 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11851 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11852 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11853 2 patterns found
11854 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11855 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11856 1 pattern found
11857 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11858 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11859 1 pattern found
11860 (gdb) print $numfound
11861 $1 = 1
11862 (gdb) print $_
11863 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11864 @end smallexample
11865
11866 @node Value Sizes
11867 @section Value Sizes
11868
11869 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11870 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11871 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11872 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11873 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11874
11875 @table @code
11876 @kindex set max-value-size
11877 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11878 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11879 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11880 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11881 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11882
11883 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11884 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11885
11886 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11887 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11888 currently 16 bytes.
11889
11890 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11891 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11892 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11893 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11894 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11895 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11896 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11897 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11898
11899 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11900
11901 @kindex show max-value-size
11902 @item show max-value-size
11903 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11904 allocate for the contents of a value.
11905 @end table
11906
11907 @node Optimized Code
11908 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11909 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11910 @cindex debugging optimized code
11911
11912 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11913 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11914 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11915 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11916 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11917 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11918 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11919
11920 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11921 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11922 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11923 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11924
11925 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11926 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11927 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11928 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11929 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11930 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11931
11932 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11933 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11934 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11935 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11936 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11937
11938 @menu
11939 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11940 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11941 @end menu
11942
11943 @node Inline Functions
11944 @section Inline Functions
11945 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11946
11947 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11948 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11949 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11950 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11951 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11952 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11953 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11954 @code{info frame} command.
11955
11956 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11957 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11958 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11959 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11960 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11961 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11962 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11963 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11964 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11965 local variables in the caller.
11966
11967 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11968 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11969 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11970 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11971 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11972 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11973 instructions are executed.
11974
11975 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11976 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11977 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11978 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11979
11980 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11981 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11982
11983 @itemize @bullet
11984 @item
11985 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11986 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11987 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11988 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11989 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11990 or inside the inlined function instead.
11991
11992 @item
11993 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11994 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11995 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11996 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11997
11998 @end itemize
11999
12000 @node Tail Call Frames
12001 @section Tail Call Frames
12002 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12003
12004 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12005 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12006 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12007 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12008 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12009
12010 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12011 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12012 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12013 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12014 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12015 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12016 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12017
12018 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12019 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
12020 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12021 this information.
12022
12023 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12024 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12025
12026 @smallexample
12027 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12028 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12029 (gdb) info frame
12030 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12031 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12032 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12033 source language c++.
12034 Arglist at unknown address.
12035 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12036 @end smallexample
12037
12038 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12039 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12040 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12041 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12042 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12043 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12044
12045 @table @code
12046 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12047 @item set debug entry-values
12048 @kindex set debug entry-values
12049 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12050 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12051 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12052 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12053 result.
12054
12055 @item show debug entry-values
12056 @kindex show debug entry-values
12057 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12058 values at function entry and tail calls.
12059 @end table
12060
12061 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12062 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12063 reference by variable @code{x}):
12064
12065 @smallexample
12066 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12067 void (*x) (void) = c;
12068 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12069 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12070 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12071
12072 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
12073 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
12074 a () at t.c:3
12075 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12076 (gdb) bt
12077 #0 a () at t.c:3
12078 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12079 @end smallexample
12080
12081 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12082
12083 @smallexample
12084 int i;
12085 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12086 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12087 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12088 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12089 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12090 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12091 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12092 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12093
12094 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12095 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12096 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12097 (gdb) bt
12098 #0 f () at t.c:2
12099 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12100 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12101 @end smallexample
12102
12103 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12104 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12105
12106 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12107 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12108 @set ARROW @click{}
12109 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12110 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12111 @end ifset
12112 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12113 @set ARROW ->
12114 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12115 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12116 @end ifclear
12117
12118 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12119 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12120 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12121
12122 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12123 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12124 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12125 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12126 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12127 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12128
12129 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12130 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12131 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12132 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12133 omitted.
12134
12135 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12136 entry may fail:
12137
12138 @smallexample
12139 int v;
12140 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12141 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12142 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12143 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12144 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12145 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12146
12147 (gdb) bt
12148 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12149 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
12150 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12151 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12152 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12153 @end smallexample
12154
12155 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12156 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12157 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12158 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12159 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12160
12161 @node Macros
12162 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12163
12164 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12165 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12166 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12167 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12168 where it was defined.
12169
12170 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12171 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12172 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12173 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12174
12175 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12176 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12177 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12178 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12179 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12180 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12181 see @ref{List}.
12182
12183 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12184 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12185 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12186
12187 @table @code
12188
12189 @kindex macro expand
12190 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12191 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12192 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12193 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12194 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12195 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12196 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12197 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12198 it can be any string of tokens.
12199
12200 @kindex macro exp1
12201 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12202 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12203 @cindex expand macro once
12204 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12205 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12206 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12207 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12208 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12209 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12210 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12211 can be any string of tokens.
12212
12213 @kindex info macro
12214 @cindex macro definition, showing
12215 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12216 @cindex macros, from debug info
12217 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12218 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12219 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12220 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12221 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12222 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12223
12224 @kindex info macros
12225 @item info macros @var{location}
12226 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12227 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12228 command-line where those definitions were established.
12229
12230 @kindex macro define
12231 @cindex user-defined macros
12232 @cindex defining macros interactively
12233 @cindex macros, user-defined
12234 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12235 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12236 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12237 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12238 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12239 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12240 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12241 @var{arglist}.
12242
12243 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12244 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12245 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12246 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12247 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12248
12249 @kindex macro undef
12250 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12251 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12252 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12253 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12254 in the program being debugged.
12255
12256 @kindex macro list
12257 @item macro list
12258 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12259 @end table
12260
12261 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12262 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12263 show our source files:
12264
12265 @smallexample
12266 $ cat sample.c
12267 #include <stdio.h>
12268 #include "sample.h"
12269
12270 #define M 42
12271 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12272
12273 main ()
12274 @{
12275 #define N 28
12276 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12277 #undef N
12278 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12279 #define N 1729
12280 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12281 @}
12282 $ cat sample.h
12283 #define Q <
12284 $
12285 @end smallexample
12286
12287 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12288 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12289 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12290 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12291 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12292 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12293 information.
12294
12295 @smallexample
12296 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12297 $
12298 @end smallexample
12299
12300 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12301
12302 @smallexample
12303 $ gdb -nw sample
12304 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12305 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12306 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12307 (@value{GDBP})
12308 @end smallexample
12309
12310 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12311 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12312 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12313
12314 @smallexample
12315 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12316 3
12317 4 #define M 42
12318 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12319 6
12320 7 main ()
12321 8 @{
12322 9 #define N 28
12323 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12324 11 #undef N
12325 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12326 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12327 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12328 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12329 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12330 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12331 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12332 #define Q <
12333 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12334 expands to: (42 + 1)
12335 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12336 expands to: once (M + 1)
12337 (@value{GDBP})
12338 @end smallexample
12339
12340 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12341 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12342 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12343 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12344
12345 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12346 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12347
12348 @smallexample
12349 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12350 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12351 (@value{GDBP}) run
12352 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12353
12354 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12355 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12356 (@value{GDBP})
12357 @end smallexample
12358
12359 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12360
12361 @smallexample
12362 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12363 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12364 #define N 28
12365 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12366 expands to: 28 < 42
12367 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12368 $1 = 1
12369 (@value{GDBP})
12370 @end smallexample
12371
12372 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12373 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12374 thereof) in force at each point:
12375
12376 @smallexample
12377 (@value{GDBP}) next
12378 Hello, world!
12379 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12380 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12381 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12382 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12383 (@value{GDBP}) next
12384 We're so creative.
12385 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12386 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12387 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12388 #define N 1729
12389 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12390 expands to: 1729 < 42
12391 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12392 $2 = 0
12393 (@value{GDBP})
12394 @end smallexample
12395
12396 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12397 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12398 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12399 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12400
12401 @smallexample
12402 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12403 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12404 -D__STDC__=1
12405 (@value{GDBP})
12406 @end smallexample
12407
12408
12409 @node Tracepoints
12410 @chapter Tracepoints
12411 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12412 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12413
12414 @cindex tracepoints
12415 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12416 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12417 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12418 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12419 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12420 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12421 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12422
12423 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12424 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12425 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12426 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12427 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12428 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12429 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12430 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12431 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12432 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12433 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12434
12435 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12436 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12437 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12438 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12439 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12440 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12441 Packets}.
12442
12443 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12444 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12445 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12446
12447 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12448
12449 @menu
12450 * Set Tracepoints::
12451 * Analyze Collected Data::
12452 * Tracepoint Variables::
12453 * Trace Files::
12454 @end menu
12455
12456 @node Set Tracepoints
12457 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12458
12459 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12460 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12461 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12462 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12463 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12464 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12465 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12466
12467 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12468 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12469 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12470 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12471 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12472 tracepoint was hit.
12473
12474 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12475 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12476 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12477 either.
12478
12479 @cindex fast tracepoints
12480 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12481 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12482 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12483
12484 @cindex static tracepoints
12485 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12486 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12487 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12488 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12489 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12490 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12491 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12492 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12493 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12494 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12495 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12496 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12497 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12498 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12499 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12500 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12501 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12502 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12503 static tracepoint marker.
12504
12505 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12506 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12507
12508 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12509 conditions and actions.
12510
12511 @menu
12512 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12513 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12514 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12515 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12516 * Trace State Variables::
12517 * Tracepoint Actions::
12518 * Listing Tracepoints::
12519 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12520 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12521 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12522 @end menu
12523
12524 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12525 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12526
12527 @table @code
12528 @cindex set tracepoint
12529 @kindex trace
12530 @item trace @var{location}
12531 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12532 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12533 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12534 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12535 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12536 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12537 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12538 in tracing}).
12539 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12540 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12541 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12542 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12543 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12544 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12545 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12546 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12547 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12548 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12549 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12550 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12551
12552 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12553
12554 @smallexample
12555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12556
12557 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12558
12559 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12560
12561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12562
12563 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12564 @end smallexample
12565
12566 @noindent
12567 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12568
12569 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12570 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12571 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12572 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12573 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12574 information on tracepoint conditions.
12575
12576 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12577 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12578 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12579 @kindex ftrace
12580 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12581 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12582 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12583 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12584 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12585 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12586 message.
12587
12588 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12589 @code{trace}.
12590
12591 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12592 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12593 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12594 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12595 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12596 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12597 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12598 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12599
12600 @example
12601 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12602 @end example
12603
12604 @noindent
12605 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12606 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12607
12608 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12609 @cindex set static tracepoint
12610 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12611 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12612 @kindex strace
12613 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12614 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12615 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12616 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12617 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12618
12619 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12620 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12621 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12622 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12623 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12624 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12625 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12626 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12627 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12628 tracing engine:
12629
12630 @smallexample
12631 main ()
12632 @{
12633 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12634 @}
12635 @end smallexample
12636
12637 @noindent
12638 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12639 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12640
12641 @smallexample
12642 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12643 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12644 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12645 Data: "str %s"
12646 [etc...]
12647 @end smallexample
12648
12649 @noindent
12650 so you may probe the marker above with:
12651
12652 @smallexample
12653 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12654 @end smallexample
12655
12656 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12657 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12658 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12659 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12660 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12661 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12662 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12663 the @samp{Data:} field.
12664
12665 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12666 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12667 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12668
12669 @vindex $tpnum
12670 @cindex last tracepoint number
12671 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12672 @cindex tracepoint number
12673 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12674 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12675
12676 @kindex delete tracepoint
12677 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12678 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12679 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12680 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12681 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12682
12683 Examples:
12684
12685 @smallexample
12686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12687
12688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12689 @end smallexample
12690
12691 @noindent
12692 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12693 @end table
12694
12695 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12696 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12697
12698 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12699
12700 @table @code
12701 @kindex disable tracepoint
12702 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12703 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12704 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12705 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12706 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12707 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12708 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12709 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12710 next trace experiment.
12711
12712 @kindex enable tracepoint
12713 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12714 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12715 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12716 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12717 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12718 next time a trace experiment is run.
12719 @end table
12720
12721 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12722 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12723
12724 @table @code
12725 @kindex passcount
12726 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12727 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12728 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12729 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12730 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12731 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12732 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12733 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12734 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12735 user.
12736
12737 Examples:
12738
12739 @smallexample
12740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12741 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12742
12743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12744 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12751 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12752 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12753 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12754 @end smallexample
12755 @end table
12756
12757 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12758 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12759 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12760 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12761
12762 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12763 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12764 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12765 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12766 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12767 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12768 is true.
12769
12770 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12771 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12772 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12773 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12774 just as with breakpoints.
12775
12776 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12777 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12778 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12779 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12780 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12781 accesses, and so forth.
12782
12783 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12784 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12785 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12786 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12787 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12788 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12789 search through.
12790
12791 @smallexample
12792 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12793 @end smallexample
12794
12795 @node Trace State Variables
12796 @subsection Trace State Variables
12797 @cindex trace state variables
12798
12799 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12800 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12801 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12802 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12803 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12804 integers.
12805
12806 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12807 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12808 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12809 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12810
12811 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12812 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12813 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12814 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12815 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12816 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12817 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12818 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12819 variable with the same name.
12820
12821 @table @code
12822
12823 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12824 @kindex tvariable
12825 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12826 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12827 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12828 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12829 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12830 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12831 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12832 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12833 value. The default initial value is 0.
12834
12835 @item info tvariables
12836 @kindex info tvariables
12837 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12838 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12839 currently running.
12840
12841 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12842 @kindex delete tvariable
12843 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12844 are specified.
12845
12846 @end table
12847
12848 @node Tracepoint Actions
12849 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12850
12851 @table @code
12852 @kindex actions
12853 @cindex tracepoint actions
12854 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12855 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12856 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12857 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12858 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12859 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12860 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12861 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12862 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12863 @code{while-stepping}.
12864
12865 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12866 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12867 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12868
12869 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12870 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12871 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12872
12873 @smallexample
12874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12875
12876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12877
12878 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12879 @end smallexample
12880
12881 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12882 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12883 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12884 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12885 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12886 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12887 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12888 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12889
12890 @smallexample
12891 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12892 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12893 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12894 > collect bar,baz
12895 > collect $regs
12896 > while-stepping 12
12897 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12898 > end
12899 end
12900 @end smallexample
12901
12902 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12903 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12904 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12905 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12906 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12907 special arguments are supported:
12908
12909 @table @code
12910 @item $regs
12911 Collect all registers.
12912
12913 @item $args
12914 Collect all function arguments.
12915
12916 @item $locals
12917 Collect all local variables.
12918
12919 @item $_ret
12920 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12921 of a backtrace.
12922
12923 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12924 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12925 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12926 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12927 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12928 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12929
12930 @item $_probe_argc
12931 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12932 tracepoint is located.
12933 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12934
12935 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12936 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12937 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12938 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12939
12940 @item $_sdata
12941 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12942 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12943 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12944 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12945 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12946 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12947 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12948 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12949 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12950
12951 @smallexample
12952 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12953 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12954 @end smallexample
12955
12956 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12957 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12958 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12959 @value{GDBN}.
12960 @end table
12961
12962 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12963 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12964 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12965
12966 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12967 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12968 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12969 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12970 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12971 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12972 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12973 @samp{mystr}.
12974
12975 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12976 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12977
12978 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12979 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12980 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12981 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12982 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12983 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12984 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12985 action were used.
12986
12987 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12988 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12989 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12990 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12991 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12992 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12993
12994 @smallexample
12995 > while-stepping 12
12996 > collect $regs, myglobal
12997 > end
12998 >
12999 @end smallexample
13000
13001 @noindent
13002 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13003 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13004 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13005 @code{stepping}.
13006
13007 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13008 @kindex set default-collect
13009 @cindex default collection action
13010 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13011 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13012 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13013 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13014 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13015 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13016
13017 @item show default-collect
13018 @kindex show default-collect
13019 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13020 tracepoint hit.
13021
13022 @end table
13023
13024 @node Listing Tracepoints
13025 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13026
13027 @table @code
13028 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13029 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13030 @cindex information about tracepoints
13031 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13032 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13033 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13034 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13035 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13036 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13037
13038 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13039 tracing:
13040
13041 @itemize @bullet
13042 @item
13043 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13044
13045 @item
13046 the state about installed on target of each location
13047 @end itemize
13048
13049 @smallexample
13050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13051 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13052 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13053 while-stepping 20
13054 collect globfoo, $regs
13055 end
13056 collect globfoo2
13057 end
13058 pass count 1200
13059 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13060 collect $eip
13061 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13062 installed on target
13063 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13064 installed on target
13065 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13066 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13067 not installed on target
13068 (@value{GDBP})
13069 @end smallexample
13070
13071 @noindent
13072 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13073 @end table
13074
13075 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13076 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13077
13078 @table @code
13079 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13080 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13081 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13082 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13083 program.
13084
13085 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13086
13087 @table @emph
13088 @item Count
13089 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13090 stable identifier.
13091 @item ID
13092 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13093 @item Enabled or Disabled
13094 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13095 that are not enabled.
13096 @item Address
13097 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13098 @item What
13099 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13100 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13101 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13102 will be left blank.
13103 @end table
13104
13105 @noindent
13106 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13107
13108 @table @emph
13109 @item Data
13110 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13111 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13112 marker call.
13113 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13114 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13115 @end table
13116
13117 @smallexample
13118 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13119 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13120 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13121 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13122 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13123 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13124 Data: str %s
13125 (@value{GDBP})
13126 @end smallexample
13127 @end table
13128
13129 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13130 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13131
13132 @table @code
13133 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13134 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13135 @cindex collected data discarded
13136 @item tstart
13137 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13138 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13139 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13140 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13141 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13142 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13143 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13144 information, and so forth.
13145
13146 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13147 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13148 @item tstop
13149 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13150 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13151 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13152 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13153 needs to be stopped quickly.
13154
13155 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13156 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13157 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13158
13159 @kindex tstatus
13160 @cindex status of trace data collection
13161 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13162 @item tstatus
13163 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13164 collection.
13165 @end table
13166
13167 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13168
13169 @smallexample
13170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13171 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13172 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13173 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13174 > while-stepping 11
13175 > collect $regs
13176 > end
13177 > end
13178 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13179 [time passes @dots{}]
13180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13181 @end smallexample
13182
13183 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13184 @cindex disconnected tracing
13185 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13186 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13187 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13188 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13189 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13190 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13191 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13192 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13193
13194 @table @code
13195 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13196 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13197 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13198 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13199 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13200 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13201 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13202 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13203
13204 @item show disconnected-tracing
13205 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13206 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13207
13208 @end table
13209
13210 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13211 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13212 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13213 it will continue after reconnection.
13214
13215 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13216 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13217 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13218 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13219 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13220 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13221 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13222 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13223 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13224 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13225
13226 @cindex circular trace buffer
13227 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13228 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13229 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13230 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13231 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13232 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13233 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13234 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13235 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13236 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13237 the next run.
13238
13239 @table @code
13240 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13241 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13242 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13243 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13244 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13245 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13246 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13247
13248 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13249 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13250 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13251 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13252 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13253 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13254
13255 @end table
13256
13257 @table @code
13258 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13259 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13260 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13261 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13262 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13263 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13264 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13265 likes. This is also the default.
13266
13267 @item show trace-buffer-size
13268 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13269 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13270 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13271 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13272 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13273 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13274 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13275 @end table
13276
13277 @table @code
13278 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13279 @kindex set trace-user
13280
13281 @item show trace-user
13282 @kindex show trace-user
13283
13284 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13285 @kindex set trace-notes
13286 Set the trace run's notes.
13287
13288 @item show trace-notes
13289 @kindex show trace-notes
13290 Show the trace run's notes.
13291
13292 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13293 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13294 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13295 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13296 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13297
13298 @item show trace-stop-notes
13299 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13300 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13301
13302 @end table
13303
13304 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13305 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13306
13307 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13308 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13309 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13310 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13311 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13312 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13313 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13314 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13315 mentioned here.
13316
13317 @itemize @bullet
13318
13319 @item
13320 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13321 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13322 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13323 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13324 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13325 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13326 cannot be collected either.
13327
13328 @item
13329 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13330 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13331 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13332 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13333 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13334 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13335 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13336 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13337 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13338 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13339
13340 @item
13341 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13342 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13343 in a misleading way.
13344
13345 @item
13346 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13347 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13348 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13349 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13350 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13351 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13352 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13353 by @code{ptr}.
13354
13355 @item
13356 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13357 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13358 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13359 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13360 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13361 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13362 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13363 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13364 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13365 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13366 invalid address.
13367
13368 @item
13369 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13370 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13371 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13372 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13373 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13374 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13375 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13376 it to zero.
13377
13378 @end itemize
13379
13380 @node Analyze Collected Data
13381 @section Using the Collected Data
13382
13383 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13384 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13385 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13386 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13387 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13388 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13389 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13390 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13391 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13392 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13393 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13394 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13395 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13396 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13397 the buffer will fail.
13398
13399 @menu
13400 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13401 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13402 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13403 @end menu
13404
13405 @node tfind
13406 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13407
13408 @kindex tfind
13409 @cindex select trace snapshot
13410 @cindex find trace snapshot
13411 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13412 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13413 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13414 snapshot is selected.
13415
13416 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13417
13418 @table @code
13419 @item tfind start
13420 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13421 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13422
13423 @item tfind none
13424 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13425
13426 @item tfind end
13427 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13428
13429 @item tfind
13430 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13431 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13432
13433 @item tfind -
13434 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13435 retracing earlier steps.
13436
13437 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13438 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13439 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13440 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13441 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13442
13443 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13444 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13445 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13446 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13447 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13448
13449 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13450 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13451 addresses (exclusive).
13452
13453 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13454 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13455 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13456
13457 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13458 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13459 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13460 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13461 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13462 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13463 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13464 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13465 @end table
13466
13467 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13468 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13469 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13470 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13471 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13472 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13473 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13474 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13475 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13476 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13477 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13478 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13479 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13480 tracepoint as the current one.
13481
13482 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13483 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13484 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13485 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13486 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13487
13488 @smallexample
13489 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13490 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13491 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13492 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13493 > tfind
13494 > end
13495
13496 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13497 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13498 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13499 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13500 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13501 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13502 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13503 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13504 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13505 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13506 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13507 @end smallexample
13508
13509 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13510 the buffer:
13511
13512 @smallexample
13513 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13514 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13515 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13516 > tfind line
13517 > end
13518
13519 Frame 0, X = 1
13520 Frame 7, X = 2
13521 Frame 13, X = 255
13522 @end smallexample
13523
13524 @node tdump
13525 @subsection @code{tdump}
13526 @kindex tdump
13527 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13528 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13529
13530 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13531 the current trace snapshot.
13532
13533 @smallexample
13534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13535 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13536 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13537 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13538 > end
13539
13540 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13541
13542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13543 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13544 at gdb_test.c:444
13545 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13546
13547 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13548 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13549 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13550 d1 0x18 24
13551 d2 0x80 128
13552 d3 0x33 51
13553 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13554 d5 0x22 34
13555 d6 0xe0 224
13556 d7 0x380035 3670069
13557 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13558 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13559 a2 0x100 256
13560 a3 0x322000 3284992
13561 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13562 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13563 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13564 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13565 ps 0x0 0
13566 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13567 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13568 fpstatus 0x0 0
13569 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13570 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13571 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13572 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13573 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13574 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13575 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13576 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13577 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13578
13579 (@value{GDBP})
13580 @end smallexample
13581
13582 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13583 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13584 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13585 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13586
13587 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13588 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13589 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13590 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13591 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13592 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13593 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13594 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13595 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13596 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13597
13598 @node save tracepoints
13599 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13600 @kindex save tracepoints
13601 @kindex save-tracepoints
13602 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13603
13604 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13605 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13606 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13607 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13608 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13609 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13610
13611 @node Tracepoint Variables
13612 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13613 @cindex tracepoint variables
13614 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13615
13616 @table @code
13617 @vindex $trace_frame
13618 @item (int) $trace_frame
13619 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13620 snapshot is selected.
13621
13622 @vindex $tracepoint
13623 @item (int) $tracepoint
13624 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13625
13626 @vindex $trace_line
13627 @item (int) $trace_line
13628 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13629
13630 @vindex $trace_file
13631 @item (char []) $trace_file
13632 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13633
13634 @vindex $trace_func
13635 @item (char []) $trace_func
13636 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13637 @end table
13638
13639 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13640 use @code{output} instead.
13641
13642 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13643 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13644 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13645 which are managed by the target.
13646
13647 @smallexample
13648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13649
13650 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13651 > output $trace_file
13652 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13653 > tfind
13654 > end
13655 @end smallexample
13656
13657 @node Trace Files
13658 @section Using Trace Files
13659 @cindex trace files
13660
13661 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13662 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13663 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13664 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13665 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13666
13667 @table @code
13668
13669 @kindex tsave
13670 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13671 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13672 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13673 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13674 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13675 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13676 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13677 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13678 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13679 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13680 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13681 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13682 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13683 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13684 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13685
13686 @kindex target tfile
13687 @kindex tfile
13688 @kindex target ctf
13689 @kindex ctf
13690 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13691 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13692 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13693 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13694 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13695 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13696 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13697 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13698 the host.
13699
13700 @smallexample
13701 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13702 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13703 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13704 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13705 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13706 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13707 i = 0
13708 a = 0
13709 b = 1 '\001'
13710 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13711 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13712 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13713 $1 = 1
13714 @end smallexample
13715
13716 @end table
13717
13718 @node Overlays
13719 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13720 @cindex overlays
13721
13722 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13723 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13724 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13725 use overlays.
13726
13727 @menu
13728 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13729 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13730 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13731 mapped by asking the inferior.
13732 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13733 @end menu
13734
13735 @node How Overlays Work
13736 @section How Overlays Work
13737 @cindex mapped overlays
13738 @cindex unmapped overlays
13739 @cindex load address, overlay's
13740 @cindex mapped address
13741 @cindex overlay area
13742
13743 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13744 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13745 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13746 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13747 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13748
13749 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13750 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13751 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13752 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13753 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13754 largest overlay as well.
13755
13756 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13757 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13758 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13759 there.
13760
13761 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13762 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13763 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13764
13765 @smallexample
13766 @group
13767 Data Instruction Larger
13768 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13769 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13770 | | | | | |
13771 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13772 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13773 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13774 | and heap | | | | | |
13775 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13776 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13777 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13778 | | | | | |
13779 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13780 address | | | | | |
13781 | overlay | <-' | | |
13782 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13783 | | <---. | | load address
13784 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13785 | | | |
13786 +-----------+ | |
13787 +-----------+
13788 | |
13789 +-----------+
13790
13791 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13792 @end group
13793 @end smallexample
13794
13795 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13796 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13797 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13798 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13799 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13800 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13801 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13802 program and the overlay area.
13803
13804 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13805 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13806 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13807 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13808 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13809 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13810 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13811
13812 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13813 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13814 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13815
13816 @itemize @bullet
13817
13818 @item
13819 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13820 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13821 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13822 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13823
13824 @item
13825 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13826 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13827 your program's performance.
13828
13829 @item
13830 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13831 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13832 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13833 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13834 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13835 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13836 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13837
13838 @item
13839 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13840 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13841 instruction and data spaces.
13842
13843 @end itemize
13844
13845 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13846 improved in many ways:
13847
13848 @itemize @bullet
13849
13850 @item
13851 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13852 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13853 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13854 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13855 area in the usual way.
13856
13857 @item
13858 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13859 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13860
13861 @item
13862 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13863 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13864 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13865 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13866 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13867 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13868 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13869
13870 @end itemize
13871
13872
13873 @node Overlay Commands
13874 @section Overlay Commands
13875
13876 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13877 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13878 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13879 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13880 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13881 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13882
13883 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13884 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13885
13886 @table @code
13887 @item overlay off
13888 @kindex overlay
13889 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13890 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13891 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13892 overlay support is disabled.
13893
13894 @item overlay manual
13895 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13896 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13897 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13898 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13899 commands described below.
13900
13901 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13902 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13903 @cindex map an overlay
13904 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13905 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13906 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13907 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13908 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13909 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13910
13911 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13912 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13913 @cindex unmap an overlay
13914 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13915 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13916 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13917 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13918
13919 @item overlay auto
13920 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13921 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13922 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13923 Overlay Debugging}.
13924
13925 @item overlay load-target
13926 @itemx overlay load
13927 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13928 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13929 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13930 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13931 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13932 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13933
13934 @item overlay list-overlays
13935 @itemx overlay list
13936 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13937 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13938 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13939
13940 @end table
13941
13942 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13943 of the function the address falls in:
13944
13945 @smallexample
13946 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13947 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13948 @end smallexample
13949 @noindent
13950 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13951 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13952 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13953 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13954
13955 @smallexample
13956 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13957 No sections are mapped.
13958 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13959 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13960 @end smallexample
13961 @noindent
13962 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13963 name normally:
13964
13965 @smallexample
13966 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13967 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13968 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13969 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13970 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13971 @end smallexample
13972
13973 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13974 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13975 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13976 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13977 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13978
13979 @itemize @bullet
13980 @item
13981 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13982 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13983 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13984 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13985 @item
13986 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13987 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13988 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13989 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13990 breakpoints properly.
13991 @end itemize
13992
13993
13994 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13995 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13996 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13997
13998 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13999 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14000 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14001 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14002 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14003 current state of the overlays.
14004
14005 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14006 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14007
14008 @table @asis
14009
14010 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14011 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14012
14013 @smallexample
14014 struct
14015 @{
14016 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14017 unsigned long vma;
14018
14019 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14020 unsigned long size;
14021
14022 /* The overlay's load address. */
14023 unsigned long lma;
14024
14025 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14026 zero otherwise. */
14027 unsigned long mapped;
14028 @}
14029 @end smallexample
14030
14031 @item @code{_novlys}:
14032 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14033 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14034
14035 @end table
14036
14037 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14038 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14039 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14040 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14041 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14042 currently mapped.
14043
14044 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14045 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14046 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14047 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14048 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14049 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14050 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14051 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14052 are not being executed.
14053
14054 @node Overlay Sample Program
14055 @section Overlay Sample Program
14056 @cindex overlay example program
14057
14058 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14059 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14060 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14061 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14062 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14063 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14064 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14065
14066 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14067 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14068 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14069 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14070
14071 @table @file
14072 @item overlays.c
14073 The main program file.
14074 @item ovlymgr.c
14075 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14076 @item foo.c
14077 @itemx bar.c
14078 @itemx baz.c
14079 @itemx grbx.c
14080 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14081 @item d10v.ld
14082 @itemx m32r.ld
14083 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14084 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14085 @end table
14086
14087 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14088 cross-compiler like this:
14089
14090 @smallexample
14091 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14092 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14093 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14094 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14095 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14096 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14097 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14098 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14099 @end smallexample
14100
14101 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14102 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14103 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14104
14105
14106 @node Languages
14107 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14108 @cindex languages
14109
14110 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14111 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14112 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14113 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14114 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14115 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14116
14117 @cindex working language
14118 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14119 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14120 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14121 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14122 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14123 language}.
14124
14125 @menu
14126 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14127 * Show:: Displaying the language
14128 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14129 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14130 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14131 @end menu
14132
14133 @node Setting
14134 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14135
14136 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14137 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14138 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14139 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14140 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14141 are printed, etc.
14142
14143 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14144 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14145 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14146 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14147 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14148 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14149 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14150 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14151 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14152 Displaying the Language}.
14153
14154 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14155 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14156 another language. In that case, make the
14157 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14158 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14159 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14160
14161 @menu
14162 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14163 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14164 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14165 @end menu
14166
14167 @node Filenames
14168 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14169
14170 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14171 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14172
14173 @table @file
14174 @item .ada
14175 @itemx .ads
14176 @itemx .adb
14177 @itemx .a
14178 Ada source file.
14179
14180 @item .c
14181 C source file
14182
14183 @item .C
14184 @itemx .cc
14185 @itemx .cp
14186 @itemx .cpp
14187 @itemx .cxx
14188 @itemx .c++
14189 C@t{++} source file
14190
14191 @item .d
14192 D source file
14193
14194 @item .m
14195 Objective-C source file
14196
14197 @item .f
14198 @itemx .F
14199 Fortran source file
14200
14201 @item .mod
14202 Modula-2 source file
14203
14204 @item .s
14205 @itemx .S
14206 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14207 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14208 @end table
14209
14210 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14211 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14212
14213 @node Manually
14214 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14215
14216 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14217 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14218 your program.
14219
14220 @kindex set language
14221 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14222 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14223 a language, such as
14224 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14225 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14226
14227 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14228 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14229 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14230 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14231 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14232 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14233 command such as:
14234
14235 @smallexample
14236 print a = b + c
14237 @end smallexample
14238
14239 @noindent
14240 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14241 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14242 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14243 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14244
14245 @node Automatically
14246 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14247
14248 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14249 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14250 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14251 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14252 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14253 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14254 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14255 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14256 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14257
14258 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14259 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14260 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14261 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14262 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14263
14264 @node Show
14265 @section Displaying the Language
14266
14267 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14268 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14269
14270 @table @code
14271 @item show language
14272 @anchor{show language}
14273 @kindex show language
14274 Display the current working language. This is the
14275 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14276 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14277
14278 @item info frame
14279 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14280 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14281 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14282 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14283 information listed here.
14284
14285 @item info source
14286 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14287 Display the source language of this source file.
14288 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14289 information listed here.
14290 @end table
14291
14292 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14293 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14294 with a language explicitly:
14295
14296 @table @code
14297 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14298 @kindex set extension-language
14299 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14300 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14301
14302 @item info extensions
14303 @kindex info extensions
14304 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14305 @end table
14306
14307 @node Checks
14308 @section Type and Range Checking
14309
14310 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14311 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14312 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14313 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14314 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14315 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14316 errors when your program is running.
14317
14318 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14319 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14320 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14321 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14322
14323 @menu
14324 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14325 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14326 @end menu
14327
14328 @cindex type checking
14329 @cindex checks, type
14330 @node Type Checking
14331 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14332
14333 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14334 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14335 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14336 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14337
14338 @smallexample
14339 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14340
14341 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14342 $1 = 2
14343 @exdent but
14344 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14345 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14346 @end smallexample
14347
14348 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14349 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14350
14351 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14352 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14353 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14354 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14355 expressions like the second example above.
14356
14357 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14358 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14359 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14360 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14361 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14362 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14363
14364 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14365
14366 @kindex set check type
14367 @kindex show check type
14368 @table @code
14369 @item set check type on
14370 @itemx set check type off
14371 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14372 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14373 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14374
14375 @item show check type
14376 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14377 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14378 @end table
14379
14380 @cindex range checking
14381 @cindex checks, range
14382 @node Range Checking
14383 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14384
14385 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14386 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14387 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14388 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14389 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14390
14391 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14392 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14393 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14394 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14395
14396 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14397 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14398 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14399 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14400 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14401 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14402
14403 @smallexample
14404 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14405 @end smallexample
14406
14407 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14408 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14409 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14410
14411 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14412
14413 @kindex set check range
14414 @kindex show check range
14415 @table @code
14416 @item set check range auto
14417 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14418 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14419 each language.
14420
14421 @item set check range on
14422 @itemx set check range off
14423 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14424 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14425 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14426 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14427
14428 @item set check range warn
14429 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14430 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14431 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14432 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14433 systems).
14434
14435 @item show range
14436 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14437 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14438 @end table
14439
14440 @node Supported Languages
14441 @section Supported Languages
14442
14443 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14444 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14445 @c This is false ...
14446 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14447 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14448 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14449 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14450 language.
14451
14452 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14453 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14454 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14455 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14456 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14457 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14458 language reference or tutorial.
14459
14460 @menu
14461 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14462 * D:: D
14463 * Go:: Go
14464 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14465 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14466 * Fortran:: Fortran
14467 * Pascal:: Pascal
14468 * Rust:: Rust
14469 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14470 * Ada:: Ada
14471 @end menu
14472
14473 @node C
14474 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14475
14476 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14477 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14478
14479 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14480 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14481 together.
14482
14483 @cindex C@t{++}
14484 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14485 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14486 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14487 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14488 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14489 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14490 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14491
14492 @menu
14493 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14494 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14495 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14496 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14497 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14498 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14499 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14500 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14501 @end menu
14502
14503 @node C Operators
14504 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14505
14506 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14507
14508 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14509 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14510 often defined on groups of types.
14511
14512 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14513
14514 @itemize @bullet
14515
14516 @item
14517 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14518 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14519
14520 @item
14521 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14522 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14523
14524 @item
14525 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14526
14527 @item
14528 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14529
14530 @end itemize
14531
14532 @noindent
14533 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14534 in order of increasing precedence:
14535
14536 @table @code
14537 @item ,
14538 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14539 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14540 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14541
14542 @item =
14543 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14544 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14545
14546 @item @var{op}=
14547 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14548 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14549 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14550 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14551 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14552
14553 @item ?:
14554 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14555 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14556 should be of an integral type.
14557
14558 @item ||
14559 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14560
14561 @item &&
14562 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14563
14564 @item |
14565 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14566
14567 @item ^
14568 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14569
14570 @item &
14571 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14572
14573 @item ==@r{, }!=
14574 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14575 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14576
14577 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14578 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14579 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14580 and non-zero for true.
14581
14582 @item <<@r{, }>>
14583 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14584
14585 @item @@
14586 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14587
14588 @item +@r{, }-
14589 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14590 pointer types.
14591
14592 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14593 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14594 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14595 integral types.
14596
14597 @item ++@r{, }--
14598 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14599 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14600 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14601 operation takes place.
14602
14603 @item *
14604 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14605 @code{++}.
14606
14607 @item &
14608 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14609
14610 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14611 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14612 to examine the address
14613 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14614 stored.
14615
14616 @item -
14617 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14618 precedence as @code{++}.
14619
14620 @item !
14621 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14622 @code{++}.
14623
14624 @item ~
14625 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14626 @code{++}.
14627
14628
14629 @item .@r{, }->
14630 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14631 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14632 pointer based on the stored type information.
14633 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14634
14635 @item .*@r{, }->*
14636 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14637
14638 @item []
14639 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14640 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14641
14642 @item ()
14643 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14644
14645 @item ::
14646 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14647 and @code{class} types.
14648
14649 @item ::
14650 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14651 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14652 above.
14653 @end table
14654
14655 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14656 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14657 predefined meaning.
14658
14659 @node C Constants
14660 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14661
14662 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14663
14664 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14665 following ways:
14666
14667 @itemize @bullet
14668 @item
14669 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14670 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14671 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14672 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14673 @code{long} value.
14674
14675 @item
14676 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14677 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14678 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14679 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14680 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14681 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14682 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14683 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14684 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14685 constant.
14686
14687 @item
14688 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14689 integral equivalents.
14690
14691 @item
14692 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14693 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14694 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14695 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14696 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14697 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14698 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14699 @samp{\n} for newline.
14700
14701 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14702 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14703 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14704 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14705
14706 @item
14707 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14708 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14709 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14710 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14711 characters.
14712
14713 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14714 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14715 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14716
14717 @item
14718 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14719 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14720
14721 @item
14722 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14723 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14724 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14725 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14726 @end itemize
14727
14728 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14729 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14730
14731 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14732 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14733
14734 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14735 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14736 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14737 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14738 @quotation
14739 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14740 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14741 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14742 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14743 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14744 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14745 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14746 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14747 @end quotation
14748
14749 @enumerate
14750
14751 @cindex member functions
14752 @item
14753 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14754
14755 @smallexample
14756 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14757 @end smallexample
14758
14759 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14760 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14761 @item
14762 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14763 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14764 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14765 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14766 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14767
14768 @cindex call overloaded functions
14769 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14770 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14771 @item
14772 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14773 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14774 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14775 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14776 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14777 default arguments.
14778
14779 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14780 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14781 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14782 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14783 number of function arguments.
14784
14785 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14786 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14787 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14788
14789 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14790 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14791 @smallexample
14792 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14793 @end smallexample
14794
14795 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14796 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14797
14798 @cindex reference declarations
14799 @item
14800 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14801 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14802 dereferenced.
14803
14804 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14805 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14806 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14807 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14808 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14809
14810 @item
14811 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14812 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14813 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14814 necessary, for example in an expression like
14815 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14816 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14817 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14818
14819 @item
14820 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14821 specification.
14822 @end enumerate
14823
14824 @node C Defaults
14825 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14826
14827 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14828
14829 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14830 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14831 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14832 selects the working language.
14833
14834 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14835 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14836 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14837 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14838 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14839 for further details.
14840
14841 @node C Checks
14842 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14843
14844 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14845
14846 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14847 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14848 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14849 constants to pointers.
14850
14851 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14852 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14853 that is not itself an array.
14854
14855 @node Debugging C
14856 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14857
14858 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14859 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14860 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14861 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14862
14863 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14864 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14865 ,Expressions}.
14866
14867 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14868 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14869
14870 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14871
14872 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14873 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14874
14875 @table @code
14876 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14877 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14878 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14879 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14880 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14881 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14882
14883 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14884 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14885 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14886 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14887 classes.
14888 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14889
14890 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14891 @item catch throw
14892 @itemx catch rethrow
14893 @itemx catch catch
14894 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14895 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14896
14897 @cindex inheritance
14898 @item ptype @var{typename}
14899 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14900 @var{typename}.
14901 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14902
14903 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14904 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14905 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14906 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14907 multiple inheritance is in use.
14908
14909 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14910 @item demangle @var{name}
14911 Demangle @var{name}.
14912 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14913
14914 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14915 @item set print demangle
14916 @itemx show print demangle
14917 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14918 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14919 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14920 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14921 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14922
14923 @item set print object
14924 @itemx show print object
14925 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14926 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14927
14928 @item set print vtbl
14929 @itemx show print vtbl
14930 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14931 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14932 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14933 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14934
14935 @kindex set overload-resolution
14936 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14937 @item set overload-resolution on
14938 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14939 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14940 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14941 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14942 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14943 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14944
14945 @item set overload-resolution off
14946 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14947 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14948 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14949 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14950 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14951 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14952 argument types.
14953
14954 @kindex show overload-resolution
14955 @item show overload-resolution
14956 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14957
14958 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14959 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14960 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14961 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14962 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14963 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14964 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14965 @end table
14966
14967 @node Decimal Floating Point
14968 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14969 @cindex decimal floating point format
14970
14971 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14972 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14973 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14974 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14975
14976 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14977 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14978 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14979 configured target.
14980
14981 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14982 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14983 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14984
14985 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14986 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14987 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14988
14989 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14990 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14991 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14992
14993 @node D
14994 @subsection D
14995
14996 @cindex D
14997 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14998 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14999 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15000
15001 @node Go
15002 @subsection Go
15003
15004 @cindex Go (programming language)
15005 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15006 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15007
15008 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15009
15010 @table @code
15011 @cindex current Go package
15012 @item The current Go package
15013 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15014 specifying global variables and functions.
15015
15016 For example, given the program:
15017
15018 @example
15019 package main
15020 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15021 func main () @{
15022 // ...
15023 @}
15024 @end example
15025
15026 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15027
15028 @example
15029 (gdb) p myglob
15030 (gdb) p main.myglob
15031 @end example
15032
15033 @cindex builtin Go types
15034 @item Builtin Go types
15035 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15036 as a string.
15037
15038 @cindex builtin Go functions
15039 @item Builtin Go functions
15040 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15041 function and handles it internally.
15042
15043 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15044 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15045 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15046 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15047 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15048 @end table
15049
15050 @node Objective-C
15051 @subsection Objective-C
15052
15053 @cindex Objective-C
15054 This section provides information about some commands and command
15055 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15056 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15057 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15058
15059 @menu
15060 * Method Names in Commands::
15061 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15062 @end menu
15063
15064 @node Method Names in Commands
15065 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15066
15067 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15068 names as line specifications:
15069
15070 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15071 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15072 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15073 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15074 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15075 @itemize
15076 @item @code{clear}
15077 @item @code{break}
15078 @item @code{info line}
15079 @item @code{jump}
15080 @item @code{list}
15081 @end itemize
15082
15083 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15084
15085 @smallexample
15086 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15087 @end smallexample
15088
15089 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15090 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15091 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15092 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15093 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15094 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15095 debugged, enter:
15096
15097 @smallexample
15098 break -[Fruit create]
15099 @end smallexample
15100
15101 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15102 enter:
15103
15104 @smallexample
15105 list +[NSText initialize]
15106 @end smallexample
15107
15108 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15109 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15110 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15111 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15112
15113 @smallexample
15114 break create
15115 @end smallexample
15116
15117 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15118 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15119 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15120 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15121 none apply.
15122
15123 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15124 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15125
15126 @smallexample
15127 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15128 @end smallexample
15129
15130 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15131 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15132 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15133 @kindex print-object
15134 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15135
15136 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15137
15138 @smallexample
15139 print -[@var{object} hash]
15140 @end smallexample
15141
15142 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15143 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15144 @noindent
15145 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15146 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15147 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15148 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15149 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15150 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15151
15152 @node OpenCL C
15153 @subsection OpenCL C
15154
15155 @cindex OpenCL C
15156 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15157
15158 @menu
15159 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15160 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15161 * OpenCL C Operators::
15162 @end menu
15163
15164 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15165 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15166
15167 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15168 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15169 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15170 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15171 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15172
15173 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15174 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15175
15176 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15177 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15178 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15179 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15180
15181 @node OpenCL C Operators
15182 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15183
15184 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15185 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15186 vector data types.
15187
15188 @node Fortran
15189 @subsection Fortran
15190 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15191
15192 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15193 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15194
15195 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15196 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15197 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15198 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15199 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15200 underscore.
15201
15202 @menu
15203 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15204 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15205 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15206 @end menu
15207
15208 @node Fortran Operators
15209 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15210
15211 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15212
15213 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15214 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15215 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15216
15217 @table @code
15218 @item **
15219 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15220 of the second one.
15221
15222 @item :
15223 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15224 represent a section of array.
15225
15226 @item %
15227 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15228 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15229 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15230 union type.
15231 @end table
15232
15233 @node Fortran Defaults
15234 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15235
15236 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15237
15238 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15239 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15240 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15241 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15242
15243 @node Special Fortran Commands
15244 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15245
15246 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15247
15248 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15249 such as displaying common blocks.
15250
15251 @table @code
15252 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15253 @kindex info common
15254 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15255 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15256 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15257 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15258 printed.
15259 @end table
15260
15261 @node Pascal
15262 @subsection Pascal
15263
15264 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15265 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15266 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15267 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15268 syntax.
15269
15270 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15271 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15272 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15273
15274 @node Rust
15275 @subsection Rust
15276
15277 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15278 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15279 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15280 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15281
15282 @itemize @bullet
15283 @item
15284 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15285 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15286 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15287
15288 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15289 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15290 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15291 @samp{B}.
15292
15293 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15294 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15295
15296 @item
15297 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15298 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15299 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15300 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15301 @samp{K::x::y}.
15302
15303 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15304 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15305 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15306 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15307 scope.
15308
15309 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15310 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15311
15312 @item
15313 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15314 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15315
15316 @item
15317 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15318
15319 @item
15320 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15321 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15322 never be destroyed.
15323
15324 @item
15325 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15326 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15327 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15328
15329 @item
15330 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15331 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15332 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15333 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15334 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15335 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15336 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15337 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15338
15339 @item
15340 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15341 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15342 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15343 @itemize @bullet
15344
15345 @item
15346 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15347
15348 @item
15349 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15350
15351 @item
15352 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15353
15354 @item
15355 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15356 type names.
15357
15358 @item
15359 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15360
15361 @item
15362 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15363 available in the crate.
15364 @end itemize
15365 @end itemize
15366
15367 @node Modula-2
15368 @subsection Modula-2
15369
15370 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15371
15372 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15373 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15374 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15375 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15376 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15377 table.
15378
15379 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15380 @menu
15381 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15382 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15383 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15384 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15385 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15386 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15387 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15388 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15389 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15390 @end menu
15391
15392 @node M2 Operators
15393 @subsubsection Operators
15394 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15395
15396 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15397 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15398 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15399 following definitions hold:
15400
15401 @itemize @bullet
15402
15403 @item
15404 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15405 their subranges.
15406
15407 @item
15408 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15409
15410 @item
15411 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15412
15413 @item
15414 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15415 @var{type}}.
15416
15417 @item
15418 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15419
15420 @item
15421 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15422
15423 @item
15424 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15425 @end itemize
15426
15427 @noindent
15428 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15429 increasing precedence:
15430
15431 @table @code
15432 @item ,
15433 Function argument or array index separator.
15434
15435 @item :=
15436 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15437 @var{value}.
15438
15439 @item <@r{, }>
15440 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15441 types.
15442
15443 @item <=@r{, }>=
15444 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15445 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15446 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15447
15448 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15449 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15450 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15451 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15452 comment character.
15453
15454 @item IN
15455 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15456 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15457
15458 @item OR
15459 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15460
15461 @item AND@r{, }&
15462 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15463
15464 @item @@
15465 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15466
15467 @item +@r{, }-
15468 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15469 and difference on set types.
15470
15471 @item *
15472 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15473 on set types.
15474
15475 @item /
15476 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15477 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15478
15479 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15480 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15481 precedence as @code{*}.
15482
15483 @item -
15484 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15485
15486 @item ^
15487 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15488
15489 @item NOT
15490 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15491 @code{^}.
15492
15493 @item .
15494 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15495 precedence as @code{^}.
15496
15497 @item []
15498 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15499
15500 @item ()
15501 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15502 as @code{^}.
15503
15504 @item ::@r{, }.
15505 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15506 @end table
15507
15508 @quotation
15509 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15510 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15511 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15512 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15513 @end quotation
15514
15515
15516 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15517 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15518 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15519
15520 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15521 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15522
15523 @table @var
15524
15525 @item a
15526 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15527
15528 @item c
15529 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15530
15531 @item i
15532 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15533
15534 @item m
15535 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15536 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15537 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15538
15539 @item n
15540 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15541
15542 @item r
15543 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15544
15545 @item t
15546 represents a type.
15547
15548 @item v
15549 represents a variable.
15550
15551 @item x
15552 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15553 explanation of the function for details.
15554 @end table
15555
15556 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15557
15558 @table @code
15559 @item ABS(@var{n})
15560 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15561
15562 @item CAP(@var{c})
15563 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15564 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15565
15566 @item CHR(@var{i})
15567 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15568
15569 @item DEC(@var{v})
15570 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15571
15572 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15573 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15574 new value.
15575
15576 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15577 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15578 set.
15579
15580 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15581 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15582
15583 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15584 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15585
15586 @item INC(@var{v})
15587 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15588
15589 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15590 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15591 new value.
15592
15593 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15594 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15595 there. Returns the new set.
15596
15597 @item MAX(@var{t})
15598 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15599
15600 @item MIN(@var{t})
15601 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15602
15603 @item ODD(@var{i})
15604 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15605
15606 @item ORD(@var{x})
15607 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15608 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15609 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15610 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15611
15612 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15613 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15614 variable or a type.
15615
15616 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15617 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15618
15619 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15620 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15621 variable or a type.
15622
15623 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15624 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15625 @end table
15626
15627 @quotation
15628 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15629 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15630 an error.
15631 @end quotation
15632
15633 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15634 @node M2 Constants
15635 @subsubsection Constants
15636
15637 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15638 ways:
15639
15640 @itemize @bullet
15641
15642 @item
15643 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15644 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15645 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15646 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15647
15648 @item
15649 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15650 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15651 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15652 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15653 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15654 digits.
15655
15656 @item
15657 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15658 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15659 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15660 followed by a @samp{C}.
15661
15662 @item
15663 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15664 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15665 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15666 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15667 sequences.
15668
15669 @item
15670 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15671
15672 @item
15673 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15674 @code{FALSE}.
15675
15676 @item
15677 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15678
15679 @item
15680 Set constants are not yet supported.
15681 @end itemize
15682
15683 @node M2 Types
15684 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15685 @cindex Modula-2 types
15686
15687 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15688 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15689 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15690 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15691 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15692 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15693
15694 The first example contains the following section of code:
15695
15696 @smallexample
15697 VAR
15698 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15699 r: [20..40] ;
15700 @end smallexample
15701
15702 @noindent
15703 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15704 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15705
15706 @smallexample
15707 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15708 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15709 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15710 SET OF CHAR
15711 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15712 21
15713 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15714 [20..40]
15715 @end smallexample
15716
15717 @noindent
15718 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15719
15720 @smallexample
15721 VAR
15722 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15723 @end smallexample
15724
15725 @noindent
15726 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15727
15728 @smallexample
15729 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15730 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15731 @end smallexample
15732
15733 @noindent
15734 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15735 expressions using the debugger.
15736
15737 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15738 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15739
15740 @smallexample
15741 VAR
15742 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15743 @end smallexample
15744
15745 @smallexample
15746 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15747 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15748 @end smallexample
15749
15750 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15751 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15752 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15753 above.
15754
15755 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15756
15757 @smallexample
15758 TYPE
15759 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15760 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15761 VAR
15762 s: t ;
15763 BEGIN
15764 s := blue ;
15765 @end smallexample
15766
15767 @noindent
15768 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15769 and value of a variable.
15770
15771 @smallexample
15772 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15773 $1 = blue
15774 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15775 type = [blue..yellow]
15776 @end smallexample
15777
15778 @noindent
15779 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15780 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15781 their @code{C} counterparts.
15782
15783 @smallexample
15784 VAR
15785 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15786 BEGIN
15787 s[1] := 1 ;
15788 @end smallexample
15789
15790 @smallexample
15791 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15792 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15793 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15794 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15795 @end smallexample
15796
15797 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15798 pointer types as shown in this example:
15799
15800 @smallexample
15801 VAR
15802 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15803 BEGIN
15804 NEW(s) ;
15805 s^[1] := 1 ;
15806 @end smallexample
15807
15808 @noindent
15809 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15810
15811 @smallexample
15812 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15813 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15814 @end smallexample
15815
15816 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15817 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15818 types:
15819
15820 @smallexample
15821 TYPE
15822 foo = RECORD
15823 f1: CARDINAL ;
15824 f2: CHAR ;
15825 f3: myarray ;
15826 END ;
15827
15828 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15829 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15830 VAR
15831 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15832 @end smallexample
15833
15834 @noindent
15835 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15836 below.
15837
15838 @smallexample
15839 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15840 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15841 f1 : CARDINAL;
15842 f2 : CHAR;
15843 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15844 END
15845 @end smallexample
15846
15847 @node M2 Defaults
15848 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15849 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15850
15851 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15852 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15853 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15854 selected the working language.
15855
15856 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15857 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15858 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15859 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15860
15861 @node Deviations
15862 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15863 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15864
15865 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15866 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15867
15868 @itemize @bullet
15869 @item
15870 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15871 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15872 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15873 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15874 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15875 returned a pointer.)
15876
15877 @item
15878 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15879 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15880 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15881 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15882
15883 @item
15884 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15885 argument.
15886
15887 @item
15888 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15889 @end itemize
15890
15891 @node M2 Checks
15892 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15893 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15894
15895 @quotation
15896 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15897 range checking.
15898 @end quotation
15899 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15900
15901 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15902
15903 @itemize @bullet
15904 @item
15905 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15906 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15907
15908 @item
15909 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15910 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15911 @end itemize
15912
15913 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15914 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15915
15916 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15917 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15918
15919 @node M2 Scope
15920 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15921 @cindex scope
15922 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15923 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15924 @ifinfo
15925 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15926 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15927 @end ifinfo
15928 @ifnotinfo
15929 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15930 @end ifnotinfo
15931
15932 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15933 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15934 similar syntax:
15935
15936 @smallexample
15937
15938 @var{module} . @var{id}
15939 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15940 @end smallexample
15941
15942 @noindent
15943 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15944 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15945 identifier within your program, except another module.
15946
15947 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15948 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15949 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15950 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15951
15952 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15953 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15954 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15955 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15956 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15957 @var{module}.
15958
15959 @node GDB/M2
15960 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15961
15962 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15963 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15964 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15965 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15966 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15967 analogue in Modula-2.
15968
15969 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15970 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15971 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15972 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15973 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15974 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15975
15976 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15977 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15978 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15979
15980 @node Ada
15981 @subsection Ada
15982 @cindex Ada
15983
15984 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15985 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15986 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15987 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15988 to be difficult.
15989
15990
15991 @cindex expressions in Ada
15992 @menu
15993 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15994 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15995 in @value{GDBN}.
15996 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15997 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15998 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15999 subprograms.
16000 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16001 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16002 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16003 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16004 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16005 Profile
16006 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16007 @end menu
16008
16009 @node Ada Mode Intro
16010 @subsubsection Introduction
16011 @cindex Ada mode, general
16012
16013 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16014 syntax, with some extensions.
16015 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16016
16017 @itemize @bullet
16018 @item
16019 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16020 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16021 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16022 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16023
16024 @item
16025 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16026 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16027
16028 @item
16029 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16030 @end itemize
16031
16032 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16033 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16034 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16035 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16036 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16037
16038 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16039 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16040 was translated from an Ada source file.
16041
16042 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16043 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16044 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16045 middle (to allow based literals).
16046
16047 @node Omissions from Ada
16048 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16049 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16050
16051 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16052
16053 @itemize @bullet
16054 @item
16055 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16056
16057 @itemize @minus
16058 @item
16059 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16060 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16061
16062 @item
16063 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16064
16065 @item
16066 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16067
16068 @item
16069 @t{'Tag}.
16070
16071 @item
16072 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16073 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16074
16075 @item
16076 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16077 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16078
16079 @item
16080 @t{'Address}.
16081 @end itemize
16082
16083 @item
16084 The names in
16085 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16086 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16087 not currently available.
16088
16089 @item
16090 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16091 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16092 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16093 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16094 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16095 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16096 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16097 indeterminate values.
16098
16099 @item
16100 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16101 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16102 are not implemented.
16103
16104 @item
16105 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16106 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16107 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16108 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16109 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16110
16111 @smallexample
16112 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16113 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16114 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16115 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16116 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16117 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16118 @end smallexample
16119
16120 Changing a
16121 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16122 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16123 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16124 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16125 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16126 declared to have a type such as:
16127
16128 @smallexample
16129 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16130 Id : Integer;
16131 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16132 end record;
16133 @end smallexample
16134
16135 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16136 assignments:
16137
16138 @smallexample
16139 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16140 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16141 @end smallexample
16142
16143 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16144 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16145 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16146 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16147 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16148 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16149 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16150 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16151
16152 @item
16153 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16154
16155 @item
16156 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16157 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16158 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16159 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16160 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16161 the proper resolution.
16162
16163 @item
16164 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16165
16166 @item
16167 Entry calls are not implemented.
16168
16169 @item
16170 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16171 formats are not supported.
16172
16173 @item
16174 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16175
16176 @item
16177 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16178 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16179 context.
16180 Should your program
16181 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16182 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16183 @end itemize
16184
16185 @node Additions to Ada
16186 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16187 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16188
16189 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16190 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16191
16192 @itemize @bullet
16193 @item
16194 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16195 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16196 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16197 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16198 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16199 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16200 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16201 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16202
16203 @item
16204 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16205 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16206 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16207
16208 @item
16209 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16210 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16211
16212 @item
16213 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16214 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16215 @end itemize
16216
16217 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16218 additions specific to Ada:
16219
16220 @itemize @bullet
16221 @item
16222 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16223 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16224
16225 @smallexample
16226 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16227 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16228 @end smallexample
16229
16230 @item
16231 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16232 the value of its right-hand operand.
16233 This allows, for example,
16234 complex conditional breaks:
16235
16236 @smallexample
16237 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16238 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16239 @end smallexample
16240
16241 @item
16242 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16243 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16244 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16245 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16246 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16247 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16248 in strings. For example,
16249 @smallexample
16250 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16251 @end smallexample
16252 @noindent
16253 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16254 after each period.
16255
16256 @item
16257 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16258 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16259 to write
16260
16261 @smallexample
16262 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16263 @end smallexample
16264
16265 @item
16266 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16267 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16268 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16269 of 3 might print as
16270
16271 @smallexample
16272 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16273 @end smallexample
16274
16275 @noindent
16276 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16277 clause.
16278
16279 @item
16280 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16281 multi-character subsequence of
16282 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16283 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16284 in place of @t{a'length}.
16285
16286 @item
16287 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16288 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16289 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16290 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16291 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16292 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16293 For example,
16294 @smallexample
16295 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16296 @end smallexample
16297
16298 @item
16299 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16300 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16301 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16302 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16303 object.
16304
16305 @end itemize
16306
16307 @node Overloading support for Ada
16308 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16309 @cindex overloading, Ada
16310
16311 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16312 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16313 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16314 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16315 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16316 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16317
16318 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16319 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16320 use, for instance:
16321
16322 @smallexample
16323 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16324 Multiple matches for f
16325 [0] cancel
16326 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16327 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16328 >
16329 @end smallexample
16330
16331 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16332 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16333 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16334
16335 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16336 case:
16337
16338 @table @code
16339
16340 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16341 @item set ada print-signatures
16342 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16343 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16344 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16345
16346 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16347 @item show ada print-signatures
16348 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16349 overloads selection menu.
16350 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16351
16352 @end table
16353
16354 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16355 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16356
16357 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16358 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16359 before reaching the main procedure.
16360 As defined in the Ada Reference
16361 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16362 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16363 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16364 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16365
16366 @node Ada Exceptions
16367 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16368
16369 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16370
16371 @table @code
16372 @kindex info exceptions
16373 @item info exceptions
16374 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16375 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16376 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16377 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16378 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16379 @end table
16380
16381 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16382 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16383 argument.
16384
16385 @smallexample
16386 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16387 All defined Ada exceptions:
16388 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16389 program_error: 0x613d20
16390 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16391 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16392 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16393 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16394 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16395 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16396 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16397 @end smallexample
16398
16399 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16400 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16401
16402 @node Ada Tasks
16403 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16404 @cindex Ada, tasking
16405
16406 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16407 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16408
16409 @table @code
16410 @kindex info tasks
16411 @item info tasks
16412 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16413
16414
16415 @smallexample
16416 @iftex
16417 @leftskip=0.5cm
16418 @end iftex
16419 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16420 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16421 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16422 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16423 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16424 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16425
16426 @end smallexample
16427
16428 @noindent
16429 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16430 task currently being inspected.
16431
16432 @table @asis
16433 @item ID
16434 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16435
16436 @item TID
16437 The Ada task ID.
16438
16439 @item P-ID
16440 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16441
16442 @item Pri
16443 The base priority of the task.
16444
16445 @item State
16446 Current state of the task.
16447
16448 @table @code
16449 @item Unactivated
16450 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16451 executing.
16452
16453 @item Runnable
16454 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16455 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16456
16457 @item Terminated
16458 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16459 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16460 terminated themselves.
16461
16462 @item Child Activation Wait
16463 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16464
16465 @item Accept Statement
16466 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16467
16468 @item Waiting on entry call
16469 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16470
16471 @item Async Select Wait
16472 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16473 select statement.
16474
16475 @item Delay Sleep
16476 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16477 alternative open.
16478
16479 @item Child Termination Wait
16480 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16481 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16482 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16483
16484 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16485 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16486 finish terminating.
16487
16488 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16489 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16490 @end table
16491
16492 @item Name
16493 Name of the task in the program.
16494
16495 @end table
16496
16497 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16498 @item info task @var{taskno}
16499 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16500 the following example:
16501 @smallexample
16502 @iftex
16503 @leftskip=0.5cm
16504 @end iftex
16505 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16506 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16507 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16508 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16509 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16510 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16511 Name: task_1
16512 Thread: 0x807f378
16513 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16514 Base Priority: 15
16515 State: Runnable
16516 @end smallexample
16517
16518 @item task
16519 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16520 @cindex current Ada task ID
16521 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16522
16523 @smallexample
16524 @iftex
16525 @leftskip=0.5cm
16526 @end iftex
16527 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16528 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16529 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16530 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16531 (@value{GDBP}) task
16532 [Current task is 2]
16533 @end smallexample
16534
16535 @item task @var{taskno}
16536 @cindex Ada task switching
16537 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16538 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16539 from the current task to the given task.
16540
16541 @smallexample
16542 @iftex
16543 @leftskip=0.5cm
16544 @end iftex
16545 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16546 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16547 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16548 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16549 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16550 [Switching to task 1]
16551 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16552 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16553 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16554 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16555 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16556 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16557 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16558 @end smallexample
16559
16560 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16561 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16562 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16563 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16564 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16565 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16566 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16567 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16568 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16569
16570 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16571 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16572 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16573 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16574 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16575
16576 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16577 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16578 program.
16579
16580 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16581 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16582 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16583
16584 For example,
16585
16586 @smallexample
16587 @iftex
16588 @leftskip=0.5cm
16589 @end iftex
16590 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16591 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16592 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16593 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16594 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16595 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16596 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16597 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16598 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16599 Continuing.
16600 task # 1 running
16601 task # 2 running
16602
16603 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16604 15 flush;
16605 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16606 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16607 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16608 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16609 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16610 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16611 @end smallexample
16612 @end table
16613
16614 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16615 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16616 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16617
16618 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16619 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16620 the platform being used.
16621 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16622 switching is not supported.
16623
16624 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16625 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16626 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16627 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16628 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16629 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16630
16631 @node Ravenscar Profile
16632 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16633 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16634
16635 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16636 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16637 requirements.
16638
16639 @table @code
16640 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16641 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16642 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16643 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16644 Profile. This is the default.
16645
16646 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16647 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16648 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16649 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16650 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16651 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16652 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16653
16654 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16655 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16656 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16657 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16658
16659 @end table
16660
16661 @node Ada Glitches
16662 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16663 @cindex Ada, problems
16664
16665 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16666 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16667 @value{GDBN},
16668 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16669 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16670
16671 @itemize @bullet
16672 @item
16673 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16674 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16675
16676 @item
16677 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16678 argument lists are treated as positional).
16679
16680 @item
16681 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16682
16683 @item
16684 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16685 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16686 the host machine.
16687
16688 @item
16689 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16690 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16691 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16692 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16693 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16694 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16695 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16696 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16697 you can usually resolve the confusion
16698 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16699 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16700 @end itemize
16701
16702 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16703 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16704 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16705 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16706 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16707 enabled.
16708
16709 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16710 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16711 @table @code
16712
16713 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16714 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16715 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16716 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16717 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16718 This is the default.
16719
16720 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16721 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16722 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16723 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16724 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16725 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16726 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16727
16728 @end table
16729
16730 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16731 @cindex GNAT encoding
16732 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16733 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16734 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16735 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16736 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16737 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16738
16739 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16740 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16741 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16742 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16743 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16744 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16745 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16746 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16747
16748 @table @code
16749
16750 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16751 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16752 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16753 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16754
16755 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16756 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16757 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16758
16759 @end table
16760
16761 @node Unsupported Languages
16762 @section Unsupported Languages
16763
16764 @cindex unsupported languages
16765 @cindex minimal language
16766 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16767 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16768 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16769 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16770 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16771 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16772
16773 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16774 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16775 language.
16776
16777 @node Symbols
16778 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16779
16780 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16781 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16782 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16783 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16784 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16785 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16786 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16787
16788 @cindex symbol names
16789 @cindex names of symbols
16790 @cindex quoting names
16791 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16792 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16793 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16794 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16795 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16796 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16797 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16798 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16799
16800 @smallexample
16801 p 'foo.c'::x
16802 @end smallexample
16803
16804 @noindent
16805 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16806
16807 @table @code
16808 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16809 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16810 @kindex set case-sensitive
16811 @item set case-sensitive on
16812 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16813 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16814 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16815 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16816 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16817 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16818 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16819 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16820 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16821 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16822 case-insensitive matches.
16823
16824 @kindex show case-sensitive
16825 @item show case-sensitive
16826 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16827 lookups.
16828
16829 @kindex set print type methods
16830 @item set print type methods
16831 @itemx set print type methods on
16832 @itemx set print type methods off
16833 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16834 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16835 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16836 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16837 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16838 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16839
16840 @kindex show print type methods
16841 @item show print type methods
16842 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16843 classes.
16844
16845 @kindex set print type typedefs
16846 @item set print type typedefs
16847 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16848 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16849
16850 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16851 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16852 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16853 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16854 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16855 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16856 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16857 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16858 types.
16859
16860 @kindex show print type typedefs
16861 @item show print type typedefs
16862 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16863 printing classes.
16864
16865 @kindex info address
16866 @cindex address of a symbol
16867 @item info address @var{symbol}
16868 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16869 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16870 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16871 is always stored.
16872
16873 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16874 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16875 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16876
16877 @kindex info symbol
16878 @cindex symbol from address
16879 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16880 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16881 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16882 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16883 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16884
16885 @smallexample
16886 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16887 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16888 @end smallexample
16889
16890 @noindent
16891 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16892 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16893
16894 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16895 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16896
16897 @smallexample
16898 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16899 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16900 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16901 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16902 @end smallexample
16903
16904 @kindex demangle
16905 @cindex demangle
16906 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16907 Demangle @var{name}.
16908 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16909 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16910
16911 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16912 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16913
16914 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16915 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16916
16917 @kindex whatis
16918 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16919 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16920 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16921 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16922
16923 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16924 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16925 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16926
16927 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16928 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16929 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16930 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16931 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16932 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16933 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16934 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16935 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16936
16937 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16938 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16939 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16940 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16941 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16942 unroll it.
16943
16944 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16945 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16946 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16947
16948 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16949 Available flags are:
16950
16951 @table @code
16952 @item r
16953 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16954 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16955 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16956
16957 @item m
16958 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16959
16960 @item M
16961 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16962 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16963
16964 @item t
16965 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16966 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16967 names are substituted when printing other types.
16968
16969 @item T
16970 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16971 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16972 @end table
16973
16974 @kindex ptype
16975 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16976 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16977 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16978 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16979
16980 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16981 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16982 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16983 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16984 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16985 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16986 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16987 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16988
16989 For example, for this variable declaration:
16990
16991 @smallexample
16992 typedef double real_t;
16993 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16994 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16995 complex_t var;
16996 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16997 @end smallexample
16998
16999 @noindent
17000 the two commands give this output:
17001
17002 @smallexample
17003 @group
17004 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17005 type = complex_t
17006 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17007 type = struct complex @{
17008 real_t real;
17009 double imag;
17010 @}
17011 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17012 type = struct complex
17013 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17014 type = struct complex
17015 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17016 type = struct complex @{
17017 real_t real;
17018 double imag;
17019 @}
17020 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17021 type = real_t *
17022 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17023 type = double *
17024 @end group
17025 @end smallexample
17026
17027 @noindent
17028 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17029 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17030
17031 @cindex incomplete type
17032 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17033 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17034 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17035 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17036 given these declarations:
17037
17038 @smallexample
17039 struct foo;
17040 struct foo *fooptr;
17041 @end smallexample
17042
17043 @noindent
17044 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17045
17046 @smallexample
17047 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17048 $1 = <incomplete type>
17049 @end smallexample
17050
17051 @noindent
17052 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17053 completely specified.
17054
17055 @kindex info types
17056 @item info types @var{regexp}
17057 @itemx info types
17058 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17059 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17060 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17061 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17062 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17063 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17064 name is @code{value}.
17065
17066 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17067 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17068 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17069
17070 @kindex info type-printers
17071 @item info type-printers
17072 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17073 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17074 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17075 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17076 type printers.
17077
17078 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17079
17080 @kindex enable type-printer
17081 @kindex disable type-printer
17082 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17083 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17084 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17085
17086 @kindex info scope
17087 @cindex local variables
17088 @item info scope @var{location}
17089 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17090 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17091 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17092 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17093 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17094
17095 @smallexample
17096 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17097 Scope for command_line_handler:
17098 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17099 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17100 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17101 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17102 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17103 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17104 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17105 @end smallexample
17106
17107 @noindent
17108 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17109 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17110 collect}.
17111
17112 @kindex info source
17113 @item info source
17114 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17115 the function containing the current point of execution:
17116 @itemize @bullet
17117 @item
17118 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17119 @item
17120 the directory it was compiled in,
17121 @item
17122 its length, in lines,
17123 @item
17124 which programming language it is written in,
17125 @item
17126 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17127 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17128 @item
17129 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17130 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17131 @item
17132 whether the debugging information includes information about
17133 preprocessor macros.
17134 @end itemize
17135
17136
17137 @kindex info sources
17138 @item info sources
17139 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17140 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17141 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17142
17143 @kindex info functions
17144 @item info functions
17145 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17146
17147 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17148 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17149 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17150 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17151 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17152 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17153 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17154 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17155
17156 @kindex info variables
17157 @item info variables
17158 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17159 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17160
17161 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17162 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17163 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17164 @var{regexp}.
17165
17166 @kindex info classes
17167 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17168 @item info classes
17169 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17170 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17171 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17172 expression.
17173
17174 @kindex info selectors
17175 @item info selectors
17176 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17177 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17178 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17179 expression.
17180
17181 @ignore
17182 This was never implemented.
17183 @kindex info methods
17184 @item info methods
17185 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17186 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17187 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17188 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17189 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17190 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17191 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17192 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17193 @end ignore
17194
17195 @cindex opaque data types
17196 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17197 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17198 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17199 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17200 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17201 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17202 another source file. The default is on.
17203
17204 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17205 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17206
17207 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17208 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17209 is printed as follows:
17210 @smallexample
17211 @{<no data fields>@}
17212 @end smallexample
17213
17214 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17215 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17216 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17217
17218 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17219 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17220 @item set print symbol-loading
17221 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17222 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17223 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17224 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17225 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17226 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17227 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17228 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17229 can be annoying.
17230 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17231 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17232 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17233 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17234
17235 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17236 @item show print symbol-loading
17237 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17238 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17239
17240 @kindex maint print symbols
17241 @cindex symbol dump
17242 @kindex maint print psymbols
17243 @cindex partial symbol dump
17244 @kindex maint print msymbols
17245 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17246 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
17247 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
17248 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
17249 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
17250 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
17251 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
17252 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
17253 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
17254 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
17255 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
17256 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
17257 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
17258 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
17259 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
17260 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
17261 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17262 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17263
17264 @kindex maint info symtabs
17265 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17266 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17267 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17268 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17269 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17270 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17271 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17272
17273 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17274 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17275 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17276 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17277 structure in more detail. For example:
17278
17279 @smallexample
17280 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17281 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17282 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17283 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17284 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17285 readin no
17286 fullname (null)
17287 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17288 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17289 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17290 dependencies (none)
17291 @}
17292 @}
17293 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17294 (@value{GDBP})
17295 @end smallexample
17296 @noindent
17297 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17298 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17299 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17300 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17301 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17302
17303 @smallexample
17304 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17305 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17306 line 1574.
17307 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17308 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17309 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17310 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17311 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17312 dirname (null)
17313 fullname (null)
17314 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17315 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17316 debugformat DWARF 2
17317 @}
17318 @}
17319 (@value{GDBP})
17320 @end smallexample
17321
17322 @kindex maint info line-table
17323 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17324 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17325 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17326
17327 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17328 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17329 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17330
17331 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17332 @cindex symbol cache size
17333 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17334 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17335 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17336 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17337 with different sizes.
17338
17339 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17340 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17341 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17342
17343 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17344 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17345 @item maint print symbol-cache
17346 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17347 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17348
17349 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17350 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17351 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17352 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17353 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17354
17355 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17356 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17357 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17358 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17359 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17360 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17361
17362 @end table
17363
17364 @node Altering
17365 @chapter Altering Execution
17366
17367 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17368 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17369 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17370 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17371 program.
17372
17373 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17374 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17375 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17376
17377 @menu
17378 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17379 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17380 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17381 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17382 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17383 * Patching:: Patching your program
17384 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17385 @end menu
17386
17387 @node Assignment
17388 @section Assignment to Variables
17389
17390 @cindex assignment
17391 @cindex setting variables
17392 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17393 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17394
17395 @smallexample
17396 print x=4
17397 @end smallexample
17398
17399 @noindent
17400 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17401 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17402 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17403 information on operators in supported languages.
17404
17405 @kindex set variable
17406 @cindex variables, setting
17407 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17408 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17409 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17410 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17411 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17412
17413 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17414 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17415 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17416 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17417 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17418 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17419 command @code{set width}:
17420
17421 @smallexample
17422 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17423 type = double
17424 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17425 $4 = 13
17426 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17427 Invalid syntax in expression.
17428 @end smallexample
17429
17430 @noindent
17431 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17432 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17433
17434 @smallexample
17435 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17436 @end smallexample
17437
17438 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17439 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17440 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17441 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17442 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17443 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17444
17445 @smallexample
17446 @group
17447 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17448 type = double
17449 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17450 $1 = 1
17451 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17452 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17453 $2 = 1
17454 (@value{GDBP}) r
17455 The program being debugged has been started already.
17456 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17457 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17458 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17459 Invalid bfd target.
17460 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17461 The current BFD target is "=4".
17462 @end group
17463 @end smallexample
17464
17465 @noindent
17466 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17467 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17468 @code{g}, use
17469
17470 @smallexample
17471 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17472 @end smallexample
17473
17474 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17475 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17476 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17477 same length or shorter.
17478 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17479 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17480
17481 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17482 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17483 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17484 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17485 and representation in memory), and
17486
17487 @smallexample
17488 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17489 @end smallexample
17490
17491 @noindent
17492 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17493
17494 @node Jumping
17495 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17496
17497 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17498 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17499 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17500
17501 @table @code
17502 @kindex jump
17503 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17504 @item jump @var{location}
17505 @itemx j @var{location}
17506 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17507 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17508 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17509 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17510 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17511
17512 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17513 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17514 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17515 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17516 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17517 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17518 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17519 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17520 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17521 @end table
17522
17523 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17524 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17525 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17526 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17527 example,
17528
17529 @smallexample
17530 set $pc = 0x485
17531 @end smallexample
17532
17533 @noindent
17534 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17535 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17536 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17537
17538 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17539 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17540 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17541 detail.
17542
17543 @c @group
17544 @node Signaling
17545 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17546 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17547
17548 @table @code
17549 @kindex signal
17550 @item signal @var{signal}
17551 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17552 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17553 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17554 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17555
17556 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17557 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17558 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17559 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17560 signal.
17561
17562 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17563 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17564 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17565 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17566 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17567 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17568 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17569 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17570
17571 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17572 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17573 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17574 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17575 passes the signal directly to your program.
17576
17577 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17578 after executing the command.
17579
17580 @kindex queue-signal
17581 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17582 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17583 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17584 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17585 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17586 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17587 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17588 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17589 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17590
17591 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17592 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17593 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17594 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17595 @code{continue} command.
17596
17597 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17598 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17599 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17600 (@pxref{Signals}).
17601 @end table
17602 @c @end group
17603
17604 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17605 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17606
17607 @node Returning
17608 @section Returning from a Function
17609
17610 @table @code
17611 @cindex returning from a function
17612 @kindex return
17613 @item return
17614 @itemx return @var{expression}
17615 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17616 command. If you give an
17617 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17618 value.
17619 @end table
17620
17621 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17622 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17623 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17624 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17625
17626 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17627 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17628 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17629 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17630 of functions.
17631
17632 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17633 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17634 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17635 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17636 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17637
17638 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17639 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17640 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17641 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17642 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17643 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17644 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17645 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17646 assignment into the right register(s).
17647
17648 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17649 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17650 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17651 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17652 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17653 into a @code{long long int}:
17654
17655 @smallexample
17656 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17657 29 return 31;
17658 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17659 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17660 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17661 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17662 (@value{GDBP})
17663 @end smallexample
17664
17665 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17666 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17667 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17668 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17669 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17670 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17671 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17672 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17673
17674 @smallexample
17675 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17676 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17677 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17678 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17679 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17680 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17681 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17682 (@value{GDBP})
17683 @end smallexample
17684
17685 @node Calling
17686 @section Calling Program Functions
17687
17688 @table @code
17689 @cindex calling functions
17690 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17691 @item print @var{expr}
17692 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17693 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17694 debugged.
17695
17696 @kindex call
17697 @item call @var{expr}
17698 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17699 returned values.
17700
17701 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17702 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17703 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17704 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17705 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17706 value history.
17707 @end table
17708
17709 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17710 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17711 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17712 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17713
17714 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17715 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17716 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17717 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17718 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17719 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17720 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17721 in that case is controlled by the
17722 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17723
17724 @table @code
17725 @item set unwindonsignal
17726 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17727 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17728 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17729 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17730 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17731 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17732 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17733 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17734 received.
17735
17736 @item show unwindonsignal
17737 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17738 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17739 @value{GDBN}.
17740
17741 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17742 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17743 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17744 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17745 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17746 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17747 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17748 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17749 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17750 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17751
17752 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17753 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17754 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17755 @value{GDBN}.
17756
17757 @end table
17758
17759 @cindex weak alias functions
17760 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17761 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17762 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17763 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17764 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17765 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17766 function instead.
17767
17768 @node Patching
17769 @section Patching Programs
17770
17771 @cindex patching binaries
17772 @cindex writing into executables
17773 @cindex writing into corefiles
17774
17775 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17776 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17777 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17778 patching your program's binary.
17779
17780 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17781 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17782 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17783 repairs.
17784
17785 @table @code
17786 @kindex set write
17787 @item set write on
17788 @itemx set write off
17789 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17790 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17791 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17792
17793 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17794 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17795 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17796
17797 @item show write
17798 @kindex show write
17799 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17800 as well as reading.
17801 @end table
17802
17803 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17804 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17805 @cindex injecting code
17806 @cindex writing into executables
17807 @cindex compiling code
17808
17809 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17810 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17811 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17812 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17813
17814 @table @code
17815 @kindex compile code
17816 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17817 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17818 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17819 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17820 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17821 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17822 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17823 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17824 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17825 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17826 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17827 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17828
17829 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17830 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17831 E.g.:
17832
17833 @smallexample
17834 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17835 @end smallexample
17836
17837 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17838 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17839 from actual source code. E.g.:
17840
17841 @smallexample
17842 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17843 @end smallexample
17844
17845 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17846 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17847 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17848 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17849 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17850 editor.
17851
17852 @smallexample
17853 compile code
17854 >printf ("hello\n");
17855 >printf ("world\n");
17856 >end
17857 @end smallexample
17858
17859 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17860 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17861 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17862 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17863 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17864 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17865 inferior symbols otherwise.
17866
17867 @kindex compile file
17868 @item compile file @var{filename}
17869 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17870 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17871
17872 @smallexample
17873 compile file /home/user/example.c
17874 @end smallexample
17875 @end table
17876
17877 @table @code
17878 @item compile print @var{expr}
17879 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17880 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17881 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17882 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17883 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17884 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17885 Formats}.
17886
17887 @item compile print
17888 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17889 @cindex reprint the last value
17890 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17891 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17892 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17893 multiple-line editor.
17894 @end table
17895
17896 @noindent
17897 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17898
17899 @table @code
17900 @anchor{set debug compile}
17901 @item set debug compile
17902 @cindex compile command debugging info
17903 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17904 injecting the code. The default is off.
17905
17906 @item show debug compile
17907 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17908 compiling and injecting the code.
17909 @end table
17910
17911 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17912
17913 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17914 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17915 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17916 injecting process.
17917
17918 @noindent
17919 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17920
17921 @table @asis
17922 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17923 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17924 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17925 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17926
17927 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17928 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17929 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17930 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17931 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17932 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17933 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17934 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17935
17936 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17937 @end table
17938
17939 @noindent
17940 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17941
17942 @table @code
17943 @item set compile-args
17944 @cindex compile command options override
17945 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17946 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17947 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17948 compilation.
17949
17950 @item show compile-args
17951 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17952 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17953 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17954 @end table
17955
17956 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17957
17958 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17959 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17960 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17961
17962 @table @asis
17963 @item C code examples and caveats
17964 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17965 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17966 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17967 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17968 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17969
17970 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17971 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17972 much like any other normal debugging session.
17973
17974 @smallexample
17975 void function1 (void)
17976 @{
17977 int i = 42;
17978 printf ("function 1\n");
17979 @}
17980
17981 void function2 (void)
17982 @{
17983 int j = 12;
17984 function1 ();
17985 @}
17986
17987 int main(void)
17988 @{
17989 int k = 6;
17990 int *p;
17991 function2 ();
17992 return 0;
17993 @}
17994 @end smallexample
17995
17996 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17997 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17998 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17999
18000 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18001 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18002 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18003 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18004 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18005
18006 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18007 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18008 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18009 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18010 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18011 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18012 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18013 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18014 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18015 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18016
18017 @smallexample
18018 compile code k = 3;
18019 @end smallexample
18020
18021 @noindent
18022 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18023 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18024 @code{compile} command changes it.
18025
18026 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18027 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18028 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18029 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18030 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18031
18032 @smallexample
18033 compile code j = 3;
18034 @end smallexample
18035
18036 @noindent
18037 will result in a compilation error message.
18038
18039 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18040 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18041 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18042
18043 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18044 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18045 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18046 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18047
18048 @smallexample
18049 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18050 @end smallexample
18051
18052 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18053 command has completed:
18054
18055 @smallexample
18056 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18057 @end smallexample
18058
18059 @noindent
18060 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18061 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18062 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18063 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18064 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18065
18066 @smallexample
18067 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18068 @end smallexample
18069
18070 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18071 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18072 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18073 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18074 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18075 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18076 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18077 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18078
18079 @smallexample
18080 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18081 @end smallexample
18082
18083 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18084 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18085 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18086 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18087 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18088 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18089 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18090
18091 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18092 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18093 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18094 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18095 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18096 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18097
18098 @smallexample
18099 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18100 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18101 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18102 Compilation failed.
18103 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18104 42
18105 @end smallexample
18106
18107 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18108 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18109 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18110 will print to the console.
18111 @end table
18112
18113 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18114
18115 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18116 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18117 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18118 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18119 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
18120 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18121 target architecture and operating system.
18122
18123 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18124 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18125 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18126 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18127 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18128 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18129 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18130
18131 @node GDB Files
18132 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18133
18134 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18135 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18136 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18137 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18138
18139 @menu
18140 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18141 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18142 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18143 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18144 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18145 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18146 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18147 @end menu
18148
18149 @node Files
18150 @section Commands to Specify Files
18151
18152 @cindex symbol table
18153 @cindex core dump file
18154
18155 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18156 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18157 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18158 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18159
18160 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18161 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18162 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18163 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18164 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18165 new files are useful.
18166
18167 @table @code
18168 @cindex executable file
18169 @kindex file
18170 @item file @var{filename}
18171 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18172 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18173 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18174 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18175 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18176 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18177 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18178 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18179
18180 @cindex unlinked object files
18181 @cindex patching object files
18182 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18183 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18184 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18185 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18186 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18187 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18188 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18189 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18190
18191 @item file
18192 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18193 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18194
18195 @kindex exec-file
18196 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18197 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18198 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18199 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18200 discard information on the executable file.
18201
18202 @kindex symbol-file
18203 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18204 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18205 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18206 table and program to run from the same file.
18207
18208 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18209 program's symbol table.
18210
18211 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18212 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18213 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18214 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18215 @value{GDBN}.
18216
18217 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18218 executing it once.
18219
18220 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18221 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18222 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18223 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18224 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18225 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18226 optimized code.
18227
18228 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18229 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18230 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18231 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18232 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18233
18234 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18235 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18236 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18237 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18238 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18239 Warnings and Messages}.)
18240
18241 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18242 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18243 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18244 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18245 in stabs format.
18246
18247 @kindex readnow
18248 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18249 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18250 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18251 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18252 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18253 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18254 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18255 entire symbol table available.
18256
18257 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18258 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18259 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18260 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18261 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18262 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18263 @c files.
18264
18265 @kindex core-file
18266 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18267 @itemx core
18268 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18269 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18270 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18271 executable file itself for other parts.
18272
18273 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18274 to be used.
18275
18276 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18277 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18278 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18279 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18280 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18281
18282 @kindex add-symbol-file
18283 @cindex dynamic linking
18284 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18285 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18286 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18287 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18288 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18289 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18290 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18291 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18292 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18293 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18294 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18295 @var{address} as an expression.
18296
18297 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18298 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18299 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18300 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18301
18302 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18303
18304 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18305 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18306 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18307 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18308 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18309 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18310 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18311 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18312 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18313
18314 @itemize @bullet
18315 @item
18316 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18317 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18318 @item
18319 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18320 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18321 @item
18322 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18323 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18324 @end itemize
18325
18326 @noindent
18327 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18328 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18329 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18330 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18331 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18332 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18333 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18334 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18335 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18336 way.
18337
18338 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18339
18340 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18341 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18342 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18343 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18344 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18345 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18346
18347 @smallexample
18348 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18349 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18350 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18351 (y or n) y
18352 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18353 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18354 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18355 (gdb)
18356 @end smallexample
18357
18358
18359 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18360
18361 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18362 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18363 @cindex load symbols from memory
18364 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18365 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18366 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18367 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18368 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18369 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18370 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18371 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18372 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18373
18374 @kindex section
18375 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18376 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18377 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18378 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18379 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18380 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18381 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18382 their addresses.
18383
18384 @kindex info files
18385 @kindex info target
18386 @item info files
18387 @itemx info target
18388 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18389 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18390 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18391 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18392 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18393 current ones.
18394
18395 @kindex maint info sections
18396 @item maint info sections
18397 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18398 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18399 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18400 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18401 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18402 may be arbitrarily combined):
18403
18404 @table @code
18405 @item ALLOBJ
18406 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18407 @item @var{sections}
18408 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18409 @item @var{section-flags}
18410 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18411 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18412 @table @code
18413 @item ALLOC
18414 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18415 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18416 @item LOAD
18417 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18418 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18419 @item RELOC
18420 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18421 @item READONLY
18422 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18423 @item CODE
18424 Section contains executable code only.
18425 @item DATA
18426 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18427 @item ROM
18428 Section will reside in ROM.
18429 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18430 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18431 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18432 Section is not empty.
18433 @item NEVER_LOAD
18434 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18435 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18436 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18437 COFF shared library information.
18438 @item IS_COMMON
18439 Section contains common symbols.
18440 @end table
18441 @end table
18442 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18443 @cindex read-only sections
18444 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18445 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18446 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18447 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18448 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18449 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18450 enhancement to debugging performance.
18451
18452 The default is off.
18453
18454 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18455 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18456 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18457 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18458
18459 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18460 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18461 @end table
18462
18463 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18464 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18465 name and remembers it that way.
18466
18467 @cindex shared libraries
18468 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18469 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18470 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18471 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18472
18473 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18474 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18475
18476 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18477 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18478 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18479 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18480 debugging a core file).
18481
18482 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18483 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18484 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18485
18486 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18487 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18488 particularly large or there are many of them.
18489
18490 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18491 commands:
18492
18493 @table @code
18494 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18495 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18496 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18497 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18498 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18499 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18500 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18501 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18502
18503 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18504 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18505 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18506 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18507 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18508 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18509 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18510 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18511 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18512
18513 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18514 @item show auto-solib-add
18515 Display the current autoloading mode.
18516 @end table
18517
18518 @cindex load shared library
18519 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18520 command:
18521
18522 @table @code
18523 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18524 @kindex info share
18525 @item info share @var{regex}
18526 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18527 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18528 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18529 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18530
18531 @kindex info dll
18532 @item info dll @var{regex}
18533 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18534
18535 @kindex sharedlibrary
18536 @kindex share
18537 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18538 @itemx share @var{regex}
18539 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18540 Unix regular expression.
18541 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18542 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18543 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18544 loaded.
18545
18546 @item nosharedlibrary
18547 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18548 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18549 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18550 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18551 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18552 discarded.
18553 @end table
18554
18555 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18556 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18557 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18558 Catchpoints}).
18559
18560 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18561 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18562 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18563 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18564
18565 @table @code
18566 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18567 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18568 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18569 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18570 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18571 shared library.
18572
18573 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18574 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18575 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18576 library events happen.
18577 @end table
18578
18579 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18580 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18581 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18582 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18583 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18584 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18585 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18586 not.
18587
18588 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18589 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18590 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18591 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18592 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18593
18594 @table @code
18595 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18596 @cindex system root, alternate
18597 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18598 @kindex set sysroot
18599 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18600 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18601 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18602 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18603 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18604 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18605 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18606 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18607 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18608 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18609 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18610 @var{path}.
18611
18612 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18613 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18614 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18615 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18616 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18617 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18618 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18619 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18620 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18621 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18622 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18623 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18624 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18625 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18626
18627 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18628 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18629 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18630 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18631 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18632
18633 @smallexample
18634 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18635 @end smallexample
18636
18637 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18638 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18639 system:
18640
18641 @smallexample
18642 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18643 @end smallexample
18644
18645 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18646 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18647 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18648 colons:
18649
18650 @smallexample
18651 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18652 @end smallexample
18653
18654 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18655 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18656 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18657 @samp{z}):
18658
18659 @smallexample
18660 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18661 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18662 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18663 @end smallexample
18664
18665 @noindent
18666 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18667 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18668 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18669
18670 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18671 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18672
18673 @smallexample
18674 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18675 @end smallexample
18676
18677 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18678 if you don't want or need to.
18679
18680 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18681 sysroot}.
18682
18683 @cindex default system root
18684 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18685 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18686 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18687 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18688 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18689 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18690 location.
18691
18692 @kindex show sysroot
18693 @item show sysroot
18694 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18695
18696 @kindex set solib-search-path
18697 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18698 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18699 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18700 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18701 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18702 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18703 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18704 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18705 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18706 of shared library symbols.
18707
18708 @kindex show solib-search-path
18709 @item show solib-search-path
18710 Display the current shared library search path.
18711
18712 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18713 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18714 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18715 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18716 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18717
18718 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18719 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18720 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18721 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18722 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18723 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18724 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18725 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18726 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18727 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18728 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18729 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18730 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18731 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18732 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18733 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18734 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18735 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18736 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18737 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18738 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18739 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18740
18741 @table @code
18742 @item unix
18743 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18744 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18745 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18746 the forward slash.
18747
18748 @item dos-based
18749 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18750 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18751 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18752 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18753 considered directory separators.
18754
18755 @item auto
18756 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18757 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18758 This is the default.
18759 @end table
18760 @end table
18761
18762 @cindex file name canonicalization
18763 @cindex base name differences
18764 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18765 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18766 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18767 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18768 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18769 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18770 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18771 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18772 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18773 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18774 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18775 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18776 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18777 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18778 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18779
18780 @table @code
18781 @item set basenames-may-differ
18782 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18783 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18784
18785 @item show basenames-may-differ
18786 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18787 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18788 @end table
18789
18790 @node File Caching
18791 @section File Caching
18792 @cindex caching of opened files
18793 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18794
18795 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18796 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18797 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18798 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18799
18800 @table @code
18801 @kindex maint info bfds
18802 @item maint info bfds
18803 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18804 @value{GDBN}.
18805
18806 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18807 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18808 @kindex bfd caching
18809 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18810 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18811 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18812 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18813 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18814 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18815 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18816 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18817 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18818
18819 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18820 @kindex bfd caching
18821 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18822 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18823
18824 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18825 @kindex bfd caching
18826 @item show debug bfd-cache
18827 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18828 @end table
18829
18830 @node Separate Debug Files
18831 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18832 @cindex separate debugging information files
18833 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18834 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18835 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18836 @cindex global debugging information directories
18837 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18838 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18839
18840 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18841 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18842 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18843 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18844 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18845 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18846 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18847
18848 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18849 file:
18850
18851 @itemize @bullet
18852 @item
18853 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18854 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18855 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18856 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18857 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18858 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18859 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18860 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18861
18862 @item
18863 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18864 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18865 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18866 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18867 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18868 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18869 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18870 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18871 below.
18872 @end itemize
18873
18874 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18875 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18876
18877 @itemize @bullet
18878 @item
18879 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18880 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18881 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18882 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18883 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18884
18885 @item
18886 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18887 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18888 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18889 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18890 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18891 hex characters, not 10.)
18892 @end itemize
18893
18894 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18895 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18896 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18897 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18898 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18899 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18900
18901 @itemize @minus
18902 @item
18903 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18904 @item
18905 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18906 @item
18907 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18908 @item
18909 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18910 @end itemize
18911
18912 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18913 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18914 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18915 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18916 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18917
18918 @table @code
18919
18920 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18921 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18922 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18923 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18924 concatenating them by a path separator.
18925
18926 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18927 @item show debug-file-directory
18928 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18929 information files.
18930
18931 @end table
18932
18933 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18934 @cindex debug link sections
18935 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18936 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18937
18938 @itemize
18939 @item
18940 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18941 a zero byte,
18942 @item
18943 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18944 boundary within the section, and
18945 @item
18946 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18947 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18948 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18949 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18950 @end itemize
18951
18952 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18953 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18954 described above.
18955
18956 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18957 @cindex build ID sections
18958 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18959 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18960 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18961 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18962 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18963 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18964 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18965 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18966 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18967
18968 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18969 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18970 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18971 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18972 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18973 in an ordinary executable.
18974
18975 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18976 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18977 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18978 following commands:
18979
18980 @smallexample
18981 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18982 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18983 @end smallexample
18984
18985 @noindent
18986 These commands remove the debugging
18987 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18988 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18989 two files:
18990
18991 @itemize @bullet
18992 @item
18993 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18994 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18995
18996 @smallexample
18997 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18998 @end smallexample
18999
19000 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19001 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19002 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19003 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19004
19005 @item
19006 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19007 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19008 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19009 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19010 @end itemize
19011
19012 @noindent
19013
19014 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19015 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19016 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19017
19018 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19019 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19020 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19021 @c different ways!
19022 @ifhtml
19023 @display
19024 @html
19025 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19026 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19027 @end html
19028 @end display
19029 @end ifhtml
19030 @ifnothtml
19031 @display
19032 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19033 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19034 @end display
19035 @end ifnothtml
19036
19037 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19038 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19039 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19040 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19041 CRC.
19042
19043 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19044 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19045 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19046 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19047 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19048
19049 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19050 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19051 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19052 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19053 @code{0xffffffff}.
19054
19055 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19056 @smallexample
19057 unsigned long
19058 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19059 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19060 @{
19061 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19062 @{
19063 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19064 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19065 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19066 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19067 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19068 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19069 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19070 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19071 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19072 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19073 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19074 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19075 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19076 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19077 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19078 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19079 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19080 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19081 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19082 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19083 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19084 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19085 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19086 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19087 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19088 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19089 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19090 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19091 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19092 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19093 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19094 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19095 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19096 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19097 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19098 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19099 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19100 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19101 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19102 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19103 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19104 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19105 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19106 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19107 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19108 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19109 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19110 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19111 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19112 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19113 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19114 0x2d02ef8d
19115 @};
19116 unsigned char *end;
19117
19118 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19119 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19120 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19121 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19122 @}
19123 @end smallexample
19124
19125 @noindent
19126 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19127
19128 @node MiniDebugInfo
19129 @section Debugging information in a special section
19130 @cindex separate debug sections
19131 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19132
19133 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19134 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19135 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19136 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19137
19138 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19139 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19140 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19141 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19142 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19143 debugging information might be included in the section.
19144
19145 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19146 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19147 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19148
19149 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19150 standard utilities:
19151
19152 @smallexample
19153 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19154 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19155 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19156 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19157
19158 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19159 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19160 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19161 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19162 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19163 | sort > funcsyms
19164
19165 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19166 # table.
19167 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19168
19169 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19170 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19171
19172 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19173 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19174 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19175 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19176
19177 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19178 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19179
19180 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19181 # original binary.
19182 xz mini_debuginfo
19183 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19184 @end smallexample
19185
19186 @node Index Files
19187 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19188 @cindex index files
19189 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19190
19191 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19192 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19193 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19194 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19195 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19196 startup.
19197
19198 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19199 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19200 using @command{objcopy}.
19201
19202 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19203
19204 @table @code
19205 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19206 @kindex save gdb-index
19207 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19208 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19209 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19210 @var{directory}.
19211 @end table
19212
19213 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19214 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19215
19216 @smallexample
19217 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19218 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19219 @end smallexample
19220
19221 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19222 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19223 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19224 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19225 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19226 The default is @code{off}.
19227 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19228 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19229
19230 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19231 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19232
19233 @smallexample
19234 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19235 @end smallexample
19236
19237 Instead you must do, for example,
19238
19239 @smallexample
19240 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19241 @end smallexample
19242
19243 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19244 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19245 currently work for programs using Ada.
19246
19247 @node Symbol Errors
19248 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19249
19250 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19251 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19252 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19253 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19254 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19255 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19256 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19257 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19258 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19259 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19260 Messages}).
19261
19262 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19263
19264 @table @code
19265 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19266
19267 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19268 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19269 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19270 in its outer scope blocks.
19271
19272 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19273 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19274 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19275 function.
19276
19277 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19278
19279 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19280 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19281 do so.
19282
19283 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19284 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19285 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19286 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19287 Messages}.)
19288
19289 @item bad block start address patched
19290
19291 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19292 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19293 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19294
19295 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19296 starting on the previous source line.
19297
19298 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19299
19300 @cindex foo
19301 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19302 larger than the size of the string table.
19303
19304 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19305 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19306 with this name.
19307
19308 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19309
19310 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19311 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19312 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19313
19314 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19315 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19316 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19317 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19318 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19319 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19320
19321 @item stub type has NULL name
19322
19323 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19324
19325 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19326 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19327 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19328 it.
19329
19330 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19331
19332 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19333
19334 @end table
19335
19336 @node Data Files
19337 @section GDB Data Files
19338
19339 @cindex prefix for data files
19340 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19341 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19342
19343 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19344 is currently using.
19345
19346 @table @code
19347 @kindex set data-directory
19348 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19349 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19350 to @var{directory}.
19351
19352 @kindex show data-directory
19353 @item show data-directory
19354 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19355 @end table
19356
19357 @cindex default data directory
19358 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19359 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19360 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19361 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19362 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19363 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19364 location.
19365
19366 The data directory may also be specified with the
19367 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19368 @xref{Mode Options}.
19369
19370 @node Targets
19371 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19372
19373 @cindex debugging target
19374 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19375
19376 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19377 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19378 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19379 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19380 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19381 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19382 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19383 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19384
19385 @cindex target architecture
19386 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19387 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19388 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19389 command.
19390
19391 @table @code
19392 @kindex set architecture
19393 @kindex show architecture
19394 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19395 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19396 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19397 supported architectures.
19398
19399 @item show architecture
19400 Show the current target architecture.
19401
19402 @item set processor
19403 @itemx processor
19404 @kindex set processor
19405 @kindex show processor
19406 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19407 and @code{show architecture}.
19408 @end table
19409
19410 @menu
19411 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19412 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19413 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19414 @end menu
19415
19416 @node Active Targets
19417 @section Active Targets
19418
19419 @cindex stacking targets
19420 @cindex active targets
19421 @cindex multiple targets
19422
19423 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19424 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19425 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19426 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19427 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19428 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19429 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19430 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19431 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19432
19433 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19434 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19435 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19436 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19437
19438 @node Target Commands
19439 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19440
19441 @table @code
19442 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19443 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19444 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19445 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19446 protocol of the target machine.
19447
19448 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19449 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19450 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19451
19452 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19453 after executing the command.
19454
19455 @kindex help target
19456 @item help target
19457 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19458 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19459 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19460
19461 @item help target @var{name}
19462 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19463 select it.
19464
19465 @kindex set gnutarget
19466 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19467 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19468 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19469 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19470 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19471 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19472
19473 @quotation
19474 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19475 you must know the actual BFD name.
19476 @end quotation
19477
19478 @noindent
19479 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19480
19481 @kindex show gnutarget
19482 @item show gnutarget
19483 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19484 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19485 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19486 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19487 @end table
19488
19489 @cindex common targets
19490 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19491 configuration):
19492
19493 @table @code
19494 @kindex target
19495 @item target exec @var{program}
19496 @cindex executable file target
19497 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19498 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19499
19500 @item target core @var{filename}
19501 @cindex core dump file target
19502 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19503 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19504
19505 @item target remote @var{medium}
19506 @cindex remote target
19507 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19508 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19509 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19510
19511 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19512 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19513
19514 @smallexample
19515 target remote /dev/ttya
19516 @end smallexample
19517
19518 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19519 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19520 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19521 clobbered by the download.
19522
19523 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19524 @cindex built-in simulator target
19525 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19526 In general,
19527 @smallexample
19528 target sim
19529 load
19530 run
19531 @end smallexample
19532 @noindent
19533 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19534 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19535 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19536 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19537 Processors}.
19538
19539 @item target native
19540 @cindex native target
19541 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19542 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19543 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19544 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19545
19546 @end table
19547
19548 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19549 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19550
19551 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19552 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19553 various aspects of this process.
19554
19555 @table @code
19556
19557 @item set hash
19558 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19559 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19560 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19561 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19562 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19563 monitor.
19564
19565 @item show hash
19566 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19567 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19568
19569 @item set debug monitor
19570 @kindex set debug monitor
19571 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19572 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19573 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19574
19575 @item show debug monitor
19576 @kindex show debug monitor
19577 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19578 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19579 @end table
19580
19581 @table @code
19582
19583 @kindex load @var{filename}
19584 @item load @var{filename}
19585 @anchor{load}
19586 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19587 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19588 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19589 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19590 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19591 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19592
19593 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19594 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19595 target is @dots{}}''
19596
19597 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19598 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19599 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19600 specifies a fixed address.
19601 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19602
19603 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19604 load programs into flash memory.
19605
19606 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19607 @end table
19608
19609 @node Byte Order
19610 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19611
19612 @cindex choosing target byte order
19613 @cindex target byte order
19614
19615 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19616 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19617 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19618 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19619 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19620 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19621
19622 @table @code
19623 @kindex set endian
19624 @item set endian big
19625 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19626
19627 @item set endian little
19628 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19629
19630 @item set endian auto
19631 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19632 executable.
19633
19634 @item show endian
19635 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19636
19637 @end table
19638
19639 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19640 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19641 target system.
19642
19643
19644 @node Remote Debugging
19645 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19646 @cindex remote debugging
19647
19648 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19649 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19650 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19651 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19652 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19653
19654 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19655 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19656 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19657 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19658 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19659 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19660
19661 Other remote targets may be available in your
19662 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19663
19664 @menu
19665 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19666 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19667 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19668 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19669 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19670 @end menu
19671
19672 @node Connecting
19673 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19674 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19675 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19676 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19677 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19678 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19679 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19680
19681 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19682 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19683 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19684 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19685
19686 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19687
19688 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19689 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19690 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19691 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19692
19693 @table @asis
19694
19695 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19696 @item Result of detach or program exit
19697 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19698 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19699 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19700
19701 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19702 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19703 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19704 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19705
19706 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19707 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19708 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19709 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19710
19711 @item Specifying the program to debug
19712 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19713 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19714 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19715 target.
19716
19717 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19718 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19719 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19720
19721 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19722 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19723 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19724 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19725
19726 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19727 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19728 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19729 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19730 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19731 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19732 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19733 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19734 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19735
19736 @item The @code{run} command
19737 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19738 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19739 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19740 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19741 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19742
19743 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19744 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19745 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19746 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19747 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19748
19749 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19750 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19751 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19752 @code{target remote} mode.
19753
19754 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19755 @item Attaching
19756 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19757 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19758 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19759
19760 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19761 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19762 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19763 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19764 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19765
19766 @end table
19767
19768 @anchor{Host and target files}
19769 @subsection Host and Target Files
19770 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19771 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19772
19773 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19774 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19775 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19776 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19777 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19778
19779 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19780 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19781 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19782 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19783 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19784
19785 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19786 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19787 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19788 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19789 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19790 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19791 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19792 target libraries.
19793
19794 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19795 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19796 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19797 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19798 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19799 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19800 programs.
19801
19802 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19803 @cindex remote connection commands
19804 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19805 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19806 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19807 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19808 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19809 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19810 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19811
19812 @table @code
19813
19814 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19815 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19816 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19817 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19818 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19819
19820 @smallexample
19821 target remote /dev/ttyb
19822 @end smallexample
19823
19824 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19825 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19826 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19827 @code{target} command.
19828
19829 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19830 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19831 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19832 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19833 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19834 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19835 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19836 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19837 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19838 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19839 target.
19840
19841 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19842 @code{manyfarms}:
19843
19844 @smallexample
19845 target remote manyfarms:2828
19846 @end smallexample
19847
19848 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19849 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19850 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19851 port 1234 on your local machine:
19852
19853 @smallexample
19854 target remote :1234
19855 @end smallexample
19856 @noindent
19857
19858 Note that the colon is still required here.
19859
19860 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19861 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19862 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19863 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19864 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19865
19866 @smallexample
19867 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19868 @end smallexample
19869
19870 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19871 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19872 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19873 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19874
19875 @item target remote | @var{command}
19876 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19877 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19878 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19879 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19880 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19881 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19882 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19883 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19884 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19885
19886 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19887 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19888 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19889
19890 @end table
19891
19892 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19893 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19894 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19895 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19896 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19897 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19898 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19899
19900 @smallexample
19901 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19902 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19903 @end smallexample
19904
19905 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19906 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19907 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19908 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19909
19910 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19911 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19912
19913 @table @code
19914 @kindex detach (remote)
19915 @item detach
19916 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19917 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19918 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19919 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19920 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19921 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19922 still connected to the target.
19923
19924 @kindex disconnect
19925 @item disconnect
19926 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19927 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19928 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19929 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19930 another target.
19931
19932 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19933 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19934 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19935 @kindex monitor
19936 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19937 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19938 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19939 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19940 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19941 and implement.
19942 @end table
19943
19944 @node File Transfer
19945 @section Sending files to a remote system
19946 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19947 @cindex file transfer
19948 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19949
19950 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19951 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19952 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19953 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19954 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19955 the only way to upload or download files.
19956
19957 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19958
19959 @table @code
19960 @kindex remote put
19961 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19962 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19963 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19964
19965 @kindex remote get
19966 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19967 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19968 on the host system.
19969
19970 @kindex remote delete
19971 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19972 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19973
19974 @end table
19975
19976 @node Server
19977 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19978
19979 @kindex gdbserver
19980 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19981 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19982 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19983 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19984 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19985
19986 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19987 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19988 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19989 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19990 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19991 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19992 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19993 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19994 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19995 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19996 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19997 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19998 choice for debugging.
19999
20000 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20001 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20002 protocol.
20003
20004 @quotation
20005 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20006 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20007 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20008 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20009 @code{gdbserver}.
20010 @end quotation
20011
20012 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20013 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20014 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20015 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20016
20017 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20018 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20019 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20020 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20021 system does all the symbol handling.
20022
20023 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20024 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20025 syntax is:
20026
20027 @smallexample
20028 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20029 @end smallexample
20030
20031 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20032 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20033 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20034 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20035 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20036 @file{/dev/com1}:
20037
20038 @smallexample
20039 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20040 @end smallexample
20041
20042 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20043 with it.
20044
20045 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20046
20047 @smallexample
20048 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20049 @end smallexample
20050
20051 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20052 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20053 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20054 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20055 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20056 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20057 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20058 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20059 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20060 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20061 @code{target remote} command.
20062
20063 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20064 with ssh:
20065
20066 @smallexample
20067 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20068 @end smallexample
20069
20070 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20071 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20072 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20073 You could elide it if you want to.
20074
20075 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20076 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20077 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20078 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20079
20080 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20081 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20082 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20083 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20084
20085 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20086 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20087
20088 @smallexample
20089 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20090 @end smallexample
20091
20092 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20093 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20094
20095 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20096 @value{GDBN} attach command
20097 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20098
20099 @pindex pidof
20100 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20101 @code{pidof} utility:
20102
20103 @smallexample
20104 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20105 @end smallexample
20106
20107 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20108 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20109 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20110
20111 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20112
20113 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20114 port.
20115
20116 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20117 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20118 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20119 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20120 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20121 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20122 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20123 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20124
20125 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20126 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20127 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20128
20129 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20130 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20131 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20132 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20133 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20134 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20135 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20136 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20137 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20138 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20139 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20140 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20141
20142 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20143 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20144
20145 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20146 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20147 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20148 program. For more information,
20149 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20150
20151 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20152 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20153 status information about the debugging process.
20154 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20155 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20156 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20157 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20158
20159 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20160 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20161 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20162 Possible options are:
20163
20164 @table @code
20165 @item none
20166 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20167 @item all
20168 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20169 @item timestamps
20170 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20171 @end table
20172
20173 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20174 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20175
20176 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20177 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20178 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20179 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20180 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20181
20182 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20183 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20184 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20185 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20186
20187 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20188 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20189 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20190 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20191
20192 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20193 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20194 environment:
20195
20196 @smallexample
20197 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20198 @end smallexample
20199
20200 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20201
20202 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20203 @itemize
20204
20205 @item
20206 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20207
20208 @item
20209 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20210 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20211 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20212 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20213 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20214 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20215
20216 @item
20217 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20218 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20219 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20220 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20221 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20222 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20223 program is already on the target.
20224
20225 @end itemize
20226
20227 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20228 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20229 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20230
20231 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20232 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20233 Here are the available commands.
20234
20235 @table @code
20236 @item monitor help
20237 List the available monitor commands.
20238
20239 @item monitor set debug 0
20240 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20241 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20242
20243 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20244 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20245 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20246 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20247
20248 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20249 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20250 Possible options are:
20251
20252 @table @code
20253 @item none
20254 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20255 @item all
20256 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20257 @item timestamps
20258 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20259 @end table
20260
20261 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20262 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20263
20264 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20265 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20266 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20267 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20268 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20269 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20270
20271 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20272 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20273
20274 @item monitor exit
20275 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20276 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20277 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20278 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20279 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20280
20281 @end table
20282
20283 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20284 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20285
20286 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20287 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20288
20289 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20290 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20291 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20292 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20293 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20294 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20295 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20296 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20297 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20298 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20299 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20300 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20301
20302 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20303
20304 @table @code
20305 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20306
20307 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20308 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20309 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20310
20311 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20312
20313 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20314 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20315 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20316 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20317 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20318 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20319
20320 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20321
20322 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20323 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20324 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20325 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20326 command for that. For example:
20327
20328 @smallexample
20329 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20330 @end smallexample
20331
20332 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20333 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20334 @end table
20335
20336 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20337 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20338 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20339 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20340 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20341 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20342 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20343 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20344 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20345 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20346
20347 @smallexample
20348 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20349 @end smallexample
20350
20351 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20352
20353 @smallexample
20354 $ gdb myprogram
20355 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20356 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20357 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20358 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20359 @end smallexample
20360
20361 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20362 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20363 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20364 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20365 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20366 tracing.
20367
20368 @node Remote Configuration
20369 @section Remote Configuration
20370
20371 @kindex set remote
20372 @kindex show remote
20373 This section documents the configuration options available when
20374 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20375 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20376 system-call-allowed}.
20377
20378 @table @code
20379 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20380 @cindex address size for remote targets
20381 @cindex bits in remote address
20382 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20383 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20384 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20385 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20386
20387 @item show remoteaddresssize
20388 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20389
20390 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20391 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20392 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20393 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20394 remote targets.
20395
20396 @item show serial baud
20397 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20398
20399 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20400 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20401 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20402
20403 @item show serial parity
20404 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20405
20406 @item set remotebreak
20407 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20408 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20409 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20410 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20411 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20412 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20413 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20414 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20415
20416 @item show remotebreak
20417 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20418 interrupt the remote program.
20419
20420 @item set remoteflow on
20421 @itemx set remoteflow off
20422 @kindex set remoteflow
20423 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20424 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20425
20426 @item show remoteflow
20427 @kindex show remoteflow
20428 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20429
20430 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20431 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20432 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20433 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20434 @code{ascii}.
20435
20436 @item show remotelogbase
20437 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20438 protocol.
20439
20440 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20441 @cindex record serial communications on file
20442 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20443 default is not to record at all.
20444
20445 @item show remotelogfile.
20446 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20447 serial communications.
20448
20449 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20450 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20451 @cindex remote timeout
20452 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20453 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20454
20455 @item show remotetimeout
20456 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20457 responses.
20458
20459 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20460 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20461 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20462 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20463 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20464 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20465 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20466 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20467
20468 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20469 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20470 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20471 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20472 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20473 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20474 as unlimited.
20475
20476 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20477 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20478 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20479
20480 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20481 @itemx show remote exec-file
20482 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20483 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20484 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20485 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20486 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20487 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20488
20489 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20490 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20491 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20492 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20493 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20494 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20495 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20496 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20497 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20498 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20499
20500 @item show interrupt-sequence
20501 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20502 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20503 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20504 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20505
20506 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20507 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20508 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20509 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20510 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20511 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20512
20513 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20514 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20515 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20516
20517 @kindex set tcp
20518 @kindex show tcp
20519 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20520 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20521 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20522 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20523 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20524 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20525 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20526 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20527 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20528
20529 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20530 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20531
20532 @item show tcp auto-retry
20533 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20534
20535 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20536 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20537 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20538 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20539 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20540 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20541 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20542 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20543 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20544 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20545 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20546
20547 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20548 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20549 @end table
20550
20551 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20552 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20553 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20554 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20555 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20556 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20557 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20558 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20559 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20560
20561 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20562 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20563 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20564 @value{GDBN} developers.
20565
20566 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20567 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20568 are:
20569
20570 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20571 @item Command Name
20572 @tab Remote Packet
20573 @tab Related Features
20574
20575 @item @code{fetch-register}
20576 @tab @code{p}
20577 @tab @code{info registers}
20578
20579 @item @code{set-register}
20580 @tab @code{P}
20581 @tab @code{set}
20582
20583 @item @code{binary-download}
20584 @tab @code{X}
20585 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20586
20587 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20588 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20589 @tab @code{info auxv}
20590
20591 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20592 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20593 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20594
20595 @item @code{attach}
20596 @tab @code{vAttach}
20597 @tab @code{attach}
20598
20599 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20600 @tab @code{vCont}
20601 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20602
20603 @item @code{run}
20604 @tab @code{vRun}
20605 @tab @code{run}
20606
20607 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20608 @tab @code{Z0}
20609 @tab @code{break}
20610
20611 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20612 @tab @code{Z1}
20613 @tab @code{hbreak}
20614
20615 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20616 @tab @code{Z2}
20617 @tab @code{watch}
20618
20619 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20620 @tab @code{Z3}
20621 @tab @code{rwatch}
20622
20623 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20624 @tab @code{Z4}
20625 @tab @code{awatch}
20626
20627 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20628 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20629 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20630
20631 @item @code{target-features}
20632 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20633 @tab @code{set architecture}
20634
20635 @item @code{library-info}
20636 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20637 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20638
20639 @item @code{memory-map}
20640 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20641 @tab @code{info mem}
20642
20643 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20644 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20645 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20646
20647 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20648 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20649 @tab @code{info spu}
20650
20651 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20652 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20653 @tab @code{info spu}
20654
20655 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20656 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20657 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20658
20659 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20660 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20661 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20662
20663 @item @code{threads}
20664 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20665 @tab @code{info threads}
20666
20667 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20668 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20669 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20670
20671 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20672 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20673 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20674
20675 @item @code{search-memory}
20676 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20677 @tab @code{find}
20678
20679 @item @code{supported-packets}
20680 @tab @code{qSupported}
20681 @tab Remote communications parameters
20682
20683 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20684 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20685 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20686
20687 @item @code{pass-signals}
20688 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20689 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20690
20691 @item @code{program-signals}
20692 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20693 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20694
20695 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20696 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20697 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20698
20699 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20700 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20701 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20702
20703 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20704 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20705 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20706
20707 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20708 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20709 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20710
20711 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20712 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20713 @tab @code{remote delete}
20714
20715 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20716 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20717 @tab Host I/O
20718
20719 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20720 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20721 @tab Host I/O
20722
20723 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20724 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20725 @tab Host I/O
20726
20727 @item @code{noack-packet}
20728 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20729 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20730
20731 @item @code{osdata}
20732 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20733 @tab @code{info os}
20734
20735 @item @code{query-attached}
20736 @tab @code{qAttached}
20737 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20738
20739 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20740 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20741 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20742
20743 @item @code{trace-status}
20744 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20745 @tab @code{tstatus}
20746
20747 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20748 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20749 @tab Traceframe info
20750
20751 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20752 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20753 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20754
20755 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20756 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20757 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20758
20759 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20760 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20761 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20762
20763 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20764 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20765 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20766
20767 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20768 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20769 @tab @code{break}
20770
20771 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20772 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20773 @tab @code{hbreak}
20774
20775 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20776 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20777 @tab @code{fork}
20778
20779 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20780 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20781 @tab @code{vfork}
20782
20783 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20784 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20785 @tab @code{exec}
20786
20787 @item @code{thread-events}
20788 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20789 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20790
20791 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20792 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20793 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20794
20795 @end multitable
20796
20797 @node Remote Stub
20798 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20799
20800 @cindex debugging stub, example
20801 @cindex remote stub, example
20802 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20803 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20804 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20805 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20806 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20807 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20808 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20809 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20810
20811 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20812 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20813 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20814 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20815 program, you need:
20816
20817 @enumerate
20818 @item
20819 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20820 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20821 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20822
20823 @item
20824 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20825 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20826
20827 @item
20828 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20829 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20830 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20831 documentation.
20832 @end enumerate
20833
20834 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20835 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20836 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20837
20838 @table @emph
20839 @item On the host,
20840 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20841 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20842 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20843
20844 @item On the target,
20845 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20846 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20847 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20848
20849 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20850 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20851 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20852 @end table
20853
20854 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20855 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20856 @sc{sparc} boards.
20857
20858 @cindex remote serial stub list
20859 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20860
20861 @table @code
20862
20863 @item i386-stub.c
20864 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20865 @cindex Intel
20866 @cindex i386
20867 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20868
20869 @item m68k-stub.c
20870 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20871 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20872 @cindex m680x0
20873 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20874
20875 @item sh-stub.c
20876 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20877 @cindex Renesas
20878 @cindex SH
20879 For Renesas SH architectures.
20880
20881 @item sparc-stub.c
20882 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20883 @cindex Sparc
20884 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20885
20886 @item sparcl-stub.c
20887 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20888 @cindex Fujitsu
20889 @cindex SparcLite
20890 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20891
20892 @end table
20893
20894 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20895 recently added stubs.
20896
20897 @menu
20898 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20899 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20900 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20901 @end menu
20902
20903 @node Stub Contents
20904 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20905
20906 @cindex remote serial stub
20907 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20908 subroutines:
20909
20910 @table @code
20911 @item set_debug_traps
20912 @findex set_debug_traps
20913 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20914 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20915 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20916 program's startup code.
20917
20918 @item handle_exception
20919 @findex handle_exception
20920 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20921 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20922 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20923 run when a trap is triggered.
20924
20925 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20926 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20927 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20928 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20929 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20930 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20931 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20932 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20933 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20934 machine.
20935
20936 @item breakpoint
20937 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20938 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20939 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20940 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20941 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20942 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20943 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20944 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20945 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20946 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20947 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20948
20949 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20950 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20951 start of your debugging session.
20952 @end table
20953
20954 @node Bootstrapping
20955 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20956
20957 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20958 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20959 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20960 debugging target machine.
20961
20962 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20963 serial port.
20964
20965 @table @code
20966 @item int getDebugChar()
20967 @findex getDebugChar
20968 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20969 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20970 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20971
20972 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20973 @findex putDebugChar
20974 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20975 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20976 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20977 @end table
20978
20979 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20980 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20981 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20982 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20983 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20984 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20985 remote system to stop.
20986
20987 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20988 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20989 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20990 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20991
20992 Other routines you need to supply are:
20993
20994 @table @code
20995 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20996 @findex exceptionHandler
20997 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20998 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20999 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21000 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21001 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21002 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21003 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21004 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21005 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21006 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21007 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21008 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21009 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21010
21011 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21012 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21013 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21014 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21015 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21016
21017 @item void flush_i_cache()
21018 @findex flush_i_cache
21019 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21020 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21021 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21022
21023 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21024 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21025 @end table
21026
21027 @noindent
21028 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21029
21030 @table @code
21031 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21032 @findex memset
21033 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21034 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21035 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21036 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21037 @end table
21038
21039 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21040 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21041 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21042 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21043
21044
21045 @node Debug Session
21046 @subsection Putting it All Together
21047
21048 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21049 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21050 steps.
21051
21052 @enumerate
21053 @item
21054 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21055 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21056 @display
21057 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21058 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21059 @end display
21060
21061 @item
21062 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21063 procedure is called:
21064
21065 @smallexample
21066 set_debug_traps();
21067 breakpoint();
21068 @end smallexample
21069
21070 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21071 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21072 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21073 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21074 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21075 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21076 progress.
21077
21078 @item
21079 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21080 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21081
21082 @smallexample
21083 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21084 @end smallexample
21085
21086 @noindent
21087 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21088 function in your program, that function is called when
21089 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21090 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21091 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21092
21093 @item
21094 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21095 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21096
21097 @item
21098 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21099 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21100
21101 @item
21102 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21103 @c document that. FIXME.
21104 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21105 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21106
21107 @item
21108 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21109 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21110
21111 @end enumerate
21112
21113 @node Configurations
21114 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21115
21116 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21117 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21118 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21119
21120 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21121 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21122 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21123 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21124 are quite different from each other.
21125
21126 @menu
21127 * Native::
21128 * Embedded OS::
21129 * Embedded Processors::
21130 * Architectures::
21131 @end menu
21132
21133 @node Native
21134 @section Native
21135
21136 This section describes details specific to particular native
21137 configurations.
21138
21139 @menu
21140 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21141 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21142 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21143 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21144 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21145 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21146 @end menu
21147
21148 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21149 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21150
21151 @cindex libkvm
21152 @cindex kernel memory image
21153 @cindex kernel crash dump
21154
21155 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21156 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21157 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21158 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21159 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21160 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21161 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21162 @code{kvm} target:
21163
21164 @smallexample
21165 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21166 @end smallexample
21167
21168 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21169 argument:
21170
21171 @smallexample
21172 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21173 @end smallexample
21174
21175 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21176 available:
21177
21178 @table @code
21179 @kindex kvm
21180 @item kvm pcb
21181 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21182
21183 @item kvm proc
21184 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21185 modern FreeBSD systems.
21186 @end table
21187
21188 @node SVR4 Process Information
21189 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21190 @cindex /proc
21191 @cindex examine process image
21192 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21193
21194 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21195 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21196 process using file-system subroutines.
21197
21198 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21199 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21200 information about the process running your program, or about any
21201 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21202 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21203
21204 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21205 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21206
21207 @table @code
21208 @kindex info proc
21209 @cindex process ID
21210 @item info proc
21211 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21212 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21213 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21214 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21215 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21216 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21217 executable file's absolute file name.
21218
21219 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21220 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21221 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21222 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21223 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21224 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21225
21226 @item info proc cmdline
21227 @cindex info proc cmdline
21228 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21229 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21230
21231 @item info proc cwd
21232 @cindex info proc cwd
21233 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21234 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21235
21236 @item info proc exe
21237 @cindex info proc exe
21238 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21239 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21240
21241 @item info proc mappings
21242 @cindex memory address space mappings
21243 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21244 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21245 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21246 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21247 memory access rights to that range.
21248
21249 @item info proc stat
21250 @itemx info proc status
21251 @cindex process detailed status information
21252 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21253 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21254 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21255 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21256 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21257 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21258 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21259
21260 @item info proc all
21261 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21262 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21263
21264 @ignore
21265 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21266 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21267 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21268 @kindex info proc times
21269 @item info proc times
21270 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21271 its children.
21272
21273 @kindex info proc id
21274 @item info proc id
21275 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21276 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21277 @end ignore
21278
21279 @item set procfs-trace
21280 @kindex set procfs-trace
21281 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21282 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21283
21284 @item show procfs-trace
21285 @kindex show procfs-trace
21286 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21287
21288 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21289 @kindex set procfs-file
21290 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21291 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21292 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21293 standard output.
21294
21295 @item show procfs-file
21296 @kindex show procfs-file
21297 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21298
21299 @item proc-trace-entry
21300 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21301 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21302 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21303 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21304 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21305 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21306 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21307 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21308 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21309
21310 @item info pidlist
21311 @kindex info pidlist
21312 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21313 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21314 processes and all the threads within each process.
21315
21316 @item info meminfo
21317 @kindex info meminfo
21318 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21319 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21320 @end table
21321
21322 @node DJGPP Native
21323 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21324 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21325 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21326 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21327
21328 @cindex DPMI
21329 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21330 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21331 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21332 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21333
21334 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21335 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21336 subsection describes those commands.
21337
21338 @table @code
21339 @kindex info dos
21340 @item info dos
21341 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21342 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21343
21344 @kindex sysinfo
21345 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21346 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21347 @item info dos sysinfo
21348 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21349 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21350 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21351
21352 @cindex GDT
21353 @cindex LDT
21354 @cindex IDT
21355 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21356 @cindex descriptor tables display
21357 @item info dos gdt
21358 @itemx info dos ldt
21359 @itemx info dos idt
21360 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21361 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21362 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21363 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21364 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21365 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21366 rights.
21367
21368 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21369 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21370 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21371 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21372 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21373
21374 @cindex garbled pointers
21375 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21376 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21377 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21378 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21379 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21380 debugged program's data segment:
21381
21382 @smallexample
21383 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21384 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21385 @end smallexample
21386
21387 @noindent
21388 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21389 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21390
21391 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21392 @item info dos pde
21393 @itemx info dos pte
21394 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21395 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21396 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21397 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21398 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21399 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21400 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21401 that is currently in use.
21402
21403 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21404 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21405 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21406 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21407 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21408 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21409 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21410
21411 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21412 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21413 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21414 controller.
21415
21416 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21417
21418 @cindex physical address from linear address
21419 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21420 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21421 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21422 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21423 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21424 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21425 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21426
21427 @smallexample
21428 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21429 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21430 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21431 @end smallexample
21432
21433 @noindent
21434 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21435 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21436 attributes of that page.
21437
21438 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21439 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21440 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21441 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21442 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21443 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21444
21445 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21446 transfer buffer:
21447
21448 @smallexample
21449 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21450 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21451 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21452 @end smallexample
21453
21454 @noindent
21455 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21456 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21457 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21458 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21459 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21460
21461 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21462 @end table
21463
21464 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21465 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21466 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21467 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21468
21469 @table @code
21470 @kindex set com1base
21471 @kindex set com1irq
21472 @kindex set com2base
21473 @kindex set com2irq
21474 @kindex set com3base
21475 @kindex set com3irq
21476 @kindex set com4base
21477 @kindex set com4irq
21478 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21479 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21480 port.
21481
21482 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21483 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21484 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21485
21486 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21487 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21488 other 3 COM ports.
21489
21490 @kindex show com1base
21491 @kindex show com1irq
21492 @kindex show com2base
21493 @kindex show com2irq
21494 @kindex show com3base
21495 @kindex show com3irq
21496 @kindex show com4base
21497 @kindex show com4irq
21498 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21499 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21500 lines used by the COM ports.
21501
21502 @item info serial
21503 @kindex info serial
21504 @cindex DOS serial port status
21505 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21506 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21507 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21508 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21509 @end table
21510
21511
21512 @node Cygwin Native
21513 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21514 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21515 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21516 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21517
21518 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21519 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21520
21521 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21522 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21523 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21524 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21525 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21526 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21527 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21528 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21529
21530 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21531 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21532 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21533
21534 @table @code
21535 @kindex info w32
21536 @item info w32
21537 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21538 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21539
21540 @item info w32 selector
21541 This command displays information returned by
21542 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21543 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21544 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21545 Without argument, this command displays information
21546 about the six segment registers.
21547
21548 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21549 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21550 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21551 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21552
21553 @kindex signal-event
21554 @item signal-event @var{id}
21555 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21556 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21557
21558 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21559 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21560 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21561 (for x86_64 versions):
21562
21563 @itemize @minus
21564 @item
21565 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21566 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21567 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21568
21569 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21570 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21571 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21572 to attach.
21573
21574 @item
21575 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21576 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21577 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21578 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21579 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21580 @end itemize
21581
21582 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21583 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21584 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21585 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21586 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21587 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21588 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21589 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21590 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21591 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21592 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21593
21594 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21595 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21596 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21597 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21598
21599 @kindex set new-console
21600 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21601 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21602 be started in a new console on next start.
21603 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21604 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21605
21606 @kindex show new-console
21607 @item show new-console
21608 Displays whether a new console is used
21609 when the debuggee is started.
21610
21611 @kindex set new-group
21612 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21613 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21614 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21615 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21616 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21617
21618 @kindex show new-group
21619 @item show new-group
21620 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21621
21622 @kindex set debugevents
21623 @item set debugevents
21624 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21625 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21626 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21627 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21628 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21629
21630 @kindex set debugexec
21631 @item set debugexec
21632 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21633 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21634
21635 @kindex set debugexceptions
21636 @item set debugexceptions
21637 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21638 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21639
21640 @kindex set debugmemory
21641 @item set debugmemory
21642 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21643 and writes by the debugger.
21644
21645 @kindex set shell
21646 @item set shell
21647 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21648 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21649
21650 @kindex show shell
21651 @item show shell
21652 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21653
21654 @end table
21655
21656 @menu
21657 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21658 @end menu
21659
21660 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21661 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21662 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21663 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21664
21665 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21666 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21667 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21668 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21669 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21670 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21671 ``minimal symbols''.
21672
21673 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21674 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21675 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21676 program run once to completion.
21677
21678 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21679
21680 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21681 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21682 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21683 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21684 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21685 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21686 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21687 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21688 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21689
21690 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21691 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21692 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21693 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21694 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21695 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21696
21697 @smallexample
21698 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21699 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21700
21701 Non-debugging symbols:
21702 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21703 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21704 @end smallexample
21705
21706 @smallexample
21707 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21708 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21709
21710 Non-debugging symbols:
21711 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21712 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21713 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21714 [etc...]
21715 @end smallexample
21716
21717 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21718
21719 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21720 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21721 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21722 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21723 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21724 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21725 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21726
21727 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21728 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21729 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21730 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21731 problem:
21732
21733 @smallexample
21734 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21735 $1 = 268572168
21736 @end smallexample
21737
21738 @smallexample
21739 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21740 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21741 @end smallexample
21742
21743 And two possible solutions:
21744
21745 @smallexample
21746 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21747 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21748 @end smallexample
21749
21750 @smallexample
21751 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21752 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21753 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21754 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21755 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21756 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21757 @end smallexample
21758
21759 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21760 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21761 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21762 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21763 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21764
21765 @smallexample
21766 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21767 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21768 @end smallexample
21769
21770 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21771 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21772 safe.
21773
21774 @node Hurd Native
21775 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21776 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21777
21778 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21779 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21780
21781 @table @code
21782 @item set signals
21783 @itemx set sigs
21784 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21785 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21786 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21787 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21788 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21789 @code{signals}.
21790
21791 @item show signals
21792 @itemx show sigs
21793 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21794 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21795 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21796
21797 @item set signal-thread
21798 @itemx set sigthread
21799 @kindex set signal-thread
21800 @kindex set sigthread
21801 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21802 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21803 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21804 signal-thread}.
21805
21806 @item show signal-thread
21807 @itemx show sigthread
21808 @kindex show signal-thread
21809 @kindex show sigthread
21810 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21811 delivered a signal.
21812
21813 @item set stopped
21814 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21815 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21816 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21817 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21818
21819 @item show stopped
21820 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21821 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21822 stopped.
21823
21824 @item set exceptions
21825 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21826 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21827 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21828 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21829 trapping on.
21830
21831 @item show exceptions
21832 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21833 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21834
21835 @item set task pause
21836 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21837 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21838 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21839 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21840 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21841 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21842 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21843 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21844 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21845
21846 @item show task pause
21847 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21848 Show the current state of task suspension.
21849
21850 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21851 @cindex task suspend count
21852 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21853 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21854 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21855
21856 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21857 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21858
21859 @item set task exception-port
21860 @itemx set task excp
21861 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21862 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21863 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21864 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21865
21866 @item set noninvasive
21867 @cindex noninvasive task options
21868 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21869 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21870 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21871 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21872
21873 @item info send-rights
21874 @itemx info receive-rights
21875 @itemx info port-rights
21876 @itemx info port-sets
21877 @itemx info dead-names
21878 @itemx info ports
21879 @itemx info psets
21880 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21881 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21882 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21883 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21884 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21885 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21886 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21887 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21888 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21889
21890 @item set thread pause
21891 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21892 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21893 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21894 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21895 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21896 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21897 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21898 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21899 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21900 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21901 only the current thread.
21902
21903 @item show thread pause
21904 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21905 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21906
21907 @item set thread run
21908 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21909
21910 @item show thread run
21911 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21912
21913 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21914 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21915 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21916 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21917 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21918 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21919 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21920
21921 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21922 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21923 detaching.
21924
21925 @item set thread exception-port
21926 @itemx set thread excp
21927 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21928 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21929 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21930
21931 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21932 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21933 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21934 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21935
21936 @item set thread default
21937 @itemx show thread default
21938 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21939 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21940 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21941 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21942 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21943 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21944 the non-default commands.
21945 @end table
21946
21947 @node Darwin
21948 @subsection Darwin
21949 @cindex Darwin
21950
21951 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21952
21953 @table @code
21954 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21955 @kindex set debug darwin
21956 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21957 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21958
21959 @item show debug darwin
21960 @kindex show debug darwin
21961 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21962
21963 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21964 @kindex set debug mach-o
21965 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21966 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21967 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21968 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21969 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21970 usage.
21971
21972 @item show debug mach-o
21973 @kindex show debug mach-o
21974 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21975
21976 @item set mach-exceptions on
21977 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21978 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21979 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21980 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21981 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21982 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21983
21984 @item show mach-exceptions
21985 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21986 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21987 @end table
21988
21989
21990 @node Embedded OS
21991 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21992
21993 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21994 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21995 architectures.
21996
21997 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21998 various real-time operating systems.
21999
22000 @node Embedded Processors
22001 @section Embedded Processors
22002
22003 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22004 configurations.
22005
22006 @cindex send command to simulator
22007 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22008 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22009
22010 @table @code
22011 @item sim @var{command}
22012 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22013 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22014 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22015 acceptable commands.
22016 @end table
22017
22018
22019 @menu
22020 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22021 * ARM:: ARM
22022 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22023 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22024 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22025 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22026 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22027 * CRIS:: CRIS
22028 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22029 @end menu
22030
22031 @node ARC
22032 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22033 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22034 @cindex ARC specific commands
22035 @cindex ARC600
22036 @cindex ARC700
22037 @cindex ARC EM
22038 @cindex ARC HS
22039
22040 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22041
22042 @table @code
22043 @item set debug arc
22044 @kindex set debug arc
22045 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22046 default) and 1 for debug messages. At present higher values offer no further
22047 messages.
22048
22049 @item show debug arc
22050 @kindex show debug arc
22051 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22052
22053 @end table
22054
22055 @node ARM
22056 @subsection ARM
22057
22058 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22059
22060 @table @code
22061 @item set arm disassembler
22062 @kindex set arm
22063 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22064 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22065
22066 @item show arm disassembler
22067 @kindex show arm
22068 Show the current disassembly style.
22069
22070 @item set arm apcs32
22071 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22072 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22073
22074 @item show arm apcs32
22075 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22076
22077 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22078 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22079 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22080
22081 @table @code
22082 @item auto
22083 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22084 @item softfpa
22085 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22086 processors.
22087 @item fpa
22088 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22089 @item softvfp
22090 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22091 @item vfp
22092 VFP co-processor.
22093 @end table
22094
22095 @item show arm fpu
22096 Show the current type of the FPU.
22097
22098 @item set arm abi
22099 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22100
22101 @item show arm abi
22102 Show the currently used ABI.
22103
22104 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22105 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22106 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22107 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22108 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22109 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22110 register).
22111
22112 @item show arm fallback-mode
22113 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22114
22115 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22116 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22117 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22118 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22119 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22120
22121 @item show arm force-mode
22122 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22123
22124 @item set debug arm
22125 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22126 target support subsystem.
22127
22128 @item show debug arm
22129 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22130 @end table
22131
22132 @table @code
22133 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22134 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22135
22136 @table @code
22137 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22138 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22139 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22140 The default value is @code{all}.
22141
22142 @table @code
22143 @item none
22144 @item demon
22145 @item angel
22146 @item redboot
22147 @item all
22148 @end table
22149 @end table
22150 @end table
22151
22152 @node M68K
22153 @subsection M68k
22154
22155 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22156
22157 @node MicroBlaze
22158 @subsection MicroBlaze
22159 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22160 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22161
22162 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22163 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22164 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22165 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22166 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22167 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22168 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22169 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22170 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22171 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22172 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22173
22174 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22175
22176 @table @code
22177 @item target remote :1234
22178 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22179 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22180
22181 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22182 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22183 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22184
22185 @item load
22186 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22187
22188 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22189 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22190
22191 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22192 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22193 @end table
22194
22195 @node MIPS Embedded
22196 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22197
22198 @noindent
22199 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22200
22201 @table @code
22202 @item set mipsfpu double
22203 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22204 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22205 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22206 @itemx show mipsfpu
22207 @kindex set mipsfpu
22208 @kindex show mipsfpu
22209 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22210 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22211 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22212 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22213 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22214 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22215 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22216 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22217 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22218 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22219 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22220 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22221 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22222
22223 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22224 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22225 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22226
22227 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22228 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22229 @end table
22230
22231 @node PowerPC Embedded
22232 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22233
22234 @cindex DVC register
22235 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22236 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22237
22238 @smallexample
22239 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22240 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22241 @end smallexample
22242
22243 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22244 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22245 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22246 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22247 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22248 or newer.
22249
22250 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22251 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22252 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22253 watching variables of scalar types.
22254
22255 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22256 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22257
22258 @smallexample
22259 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22260 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22261 @end smallexample
22262
22263 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22264 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22265
22266 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22267 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22268 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22269 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22270 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22271 use the @code{break-range} command.
22272
22273 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22274
22275 @table @code
22276 @kindex break-range
22277 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22278 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22279 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22280 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22281 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22282 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22283 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22284 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22285 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22286
22287 @kindex set powerpc
22288 @item set powerpc soft-float
22289 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22290 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22291 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22292 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22293
22294 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22295 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22296 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22297 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22298 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22299 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22300 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22301 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22302
22303 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22304 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22305 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22306 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22307 address of its first byte.
22308
22309 @end table
22310
22311 @node AVR
22312 @subsection Atmel AVR
22313 @cindex AVR
22314
22315 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22316 following AVR-specific commands:
22317
22318 @table @code
22319 @item info io_registers
22320 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22321 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22322 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22323 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22324 @end table
22325
22326 @node CRIS
22327 @subsection CRIS
22328 @cindex CRIS
22329
22330 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22331 following CRIS-specific commands:
22332
22333 @table @code
22334 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22335 @cindex CRIS version
22336 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22337 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22338 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22339
22340 @item show cris-version
22341 Show the current CRIS version.
22342
22343 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22344 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22345 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22346 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22347 @code{R59}.
22348
22349 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22350 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22351
22352 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22353 @cindex CRIS mode
22354 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22355 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22356 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22357
22358 @item show cris-mode
22359 Show the current CRIS mode.
22360 @end table
22361
22362 @node Super-H
22363 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22364 @cindex Super-H
22365
22366 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22367 commands:
22368
22369 @table @code
22370 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22371 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22372 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22373 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22374 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22375 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22376 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22377 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22378 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22379 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22380 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22381 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22382
22383 @item show sh calling-convention
22384 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22385 Show the current calling convention setting.
22386
22387 @end table
22388
22389
22390 @node Architectures
22391 @section Architectures
22392
22393 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22394 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22395
22396 @menu
22397 * AArch64::
22398 * i386::
22399 * Alpha::
22400 * MIPS::
22401 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22402 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22403 * PowerPC::
22404 * Nios II::
22405 @end menu
22406
22407 @node AArch64
22408 @subsection AArch64
22409 @cindex AArch64 support
22410
22411 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22412 following special commands:
22413
22414 @table @code
22415 @item set debug aarch64
22416 @kindex set debug aarch64
22417 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22418 messages are to be displayed.
22419
22420 @item show debug aarch64
22421 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22422
22423 @end table
22424
22425 @node i386
22426 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22427
22428 @table @code
22429 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22430 @kindex set struct-convention
22431 @cindex struct return convention
22432 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22433 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22434 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22435 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22436 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22437 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22438 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22439 be returned in a register.
22440
22441 @item show struct-convention
22442 @kindex show struct-convention
22443 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22444 from functions.
22445 @end table
22446
22447
22448 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22449 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22450
22451 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22452 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22453 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22454 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22455 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22456 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22457 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22458
22459 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22460 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22461 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22462 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22463 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22464 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22465
22466 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22467 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22468 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22469
22470 @smallexample
22471 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22472 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22473 @end smallexample
22474
22475 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22476 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22477 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22478 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22479 the pointer.
22480
22481 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22482 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22483 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22484 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22485 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22486
22487 @table @code
22488 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22489 @kindex show mpx bound
22490 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22491
22492 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22493 @kindex set mpx bound
22494 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22495 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22496 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22497 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22498 @end table
22499
22500 @node Alpha
22501 @subsection Alpha
22502
22503 See the following section.
22504
22505 @node MIPS
22506 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22507
22508 @cindex stack on Alpha
22509 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22510 @cindex Alpha stack
22511 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22512 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22513 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22514 find the beginning of a function.
22515
22516 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22517 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22518 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22519 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22520 commands:
22521
22522 @table @code
22523 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22524 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22525 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22526 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22527 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22528 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22529 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22530 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22531
22532 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22533 Display the current limit.
22534 @end table
22535
22536 @noindent
22537 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22538 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22539
22540 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22541 programs:
22542
22543 @table @code
22544 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22545 @kindex set mips abi
22546 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22547 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22548 values of @var{arg} are:
22549
22550 @table @samp
22551 @item auto
22552 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22553 default).
22554 @item o32
22555 @item o64
22556 @item n32
22557 @item n64
22558 @item eabi32
22559 @item eabi64
22560 @end table
22561
22562 @item show mips abi
22563 @kindex show mips abi
22564 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22565
22566 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22567 @kindex set mips compression
22568 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22569 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22570 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22571 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22572 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22573 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22574 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22575 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22576 provided by the executable.
22577
22578 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22579 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22580 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22581 identified as such.
22582
22583 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22584 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22585 implicitly from an executable.
22586
22587 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22588 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22589 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22590 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22591 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22592
22593 @item show mips compression
22594 @kindex show mips compression
22595 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22596 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22597
22598 @item set mipsfpu
22599 @itemx show mipsfpu
22600 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22601
22602 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22603 @kindex set mips mask-address
22604 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22605 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22606 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22607 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22608 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22609
22610 @item show mips mask-address
22611 @kindex show mips mask-address
22612 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22613 not.
22614
22615 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22616 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22617 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22618 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22619 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22620 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22621
22622 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22623 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22624 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22625
22626 @item set debug mips
22627 @kindex set debug mips
22628 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22629 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22630
22631 @item show debug mips
22632 @kindex show debug mips
22633 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22634 @end table
22635
22636
22637 @node HPPA
22638 @subsection HPPA
22639 @cindex HPPA support
22640
22641 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22642 following special commands:
22643
22644 @table @code
22645 @item set debug hppa
22646 @kindex set debug hppa
22647 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22648 messages are to be displayed.
22649
22650 @item show debug hppa
22651 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22652
22653 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22654 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22655 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22656 given @var{address}.
22657
22658 @end table
22659
22660
22661 @node SPU
22662 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22663 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22664 @cindex SPU
22665
22666 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22667 it provides the following special commands:
22668
22669 @table @code
22670 @item info spu event
22671 @kindex info spu
22672 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22673 and pending event status.
22674
22675 @item info spu signal
22676 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22677 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22678 notification channels.
22679
22680 @item info spu mailbox
22681 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22682 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22683 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22684
22685 @item info spu dma
22686 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22687 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22688 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22689
22690 @item info spu proxydma
22691 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22692 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22693 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22694
22695 @end table
22696
22697 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22698 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22699 special commands:
22700
22701 @table @code
22702 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22703 @kindex set spu
22704 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22705 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22706 function. The default is @code{off}.
22707
22708 @item show spu stop-on-load
22709 @kindex show spu
22710 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22711
22712 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22713 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22714 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22715 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22716 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22717 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22718
22719 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22720 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22721
22722 @end table
22723
22724 @node PowerPC
22725 @subsection PowerPC
22726 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22727
22728 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22729 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22730 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22731 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22732 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22733
22734 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22735 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22736 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22737
22738 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22739 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22740
22741 @node Nios II
22742 @subsection Nios II
22743 @cindex Nios II architecture
22744
22745 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22746 it provides the following special commands:
22747
22748 @table @code
22749
22750 @item set debug nios2
22751 @kindex set debug nios2
22752 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22753 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22754
22755 @item show debug nios2
22756 @kindex show debug nios2
22757 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22758 @end table
22759
22760 @node Controlling GDB
22761 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22762
22763 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22764 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22765 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22766 described here.
22767
22768 @menu
22769 * Prompt:: Prompt
22770 * Editing:: Command editing
22771 * Command History:: Command history
22772 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22773 * Numbers:: Numbers
22774 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22775 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22776 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22777 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22778 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22779 @end menu
22780
22781 @node Prompt
22782 @section Prompt
22783
22784 @cindex prompt
22785
22786 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22787 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22788 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22789 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22790 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22791 which one you are talking to.
22792
22793 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22794 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22795 or a prompt that does not.
22796
22797 @table @code
22798 @kindex set prompt
22799 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22800 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22801
22802 @kindex show prompt
22803 @item show prompt
22804 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22805 @end table
22806
22807 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22808 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22809 are:
22810
22811 @table @code
22812 @kindex set extended-prompt
22813 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22814 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22815 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22816 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22817 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22818 is displayed.
22819
22820 For example:
22821
22822 @smallexample
22823 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22824 @end smallexample
22825
22826 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22827 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22828
22829 @kindex show extended-prompt
22830 @item show extended-prompt
22831 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22832 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22833 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22834 @end table
22835
22836 @node Editing
22837 @section Command Editing
22838 @cindex readline
22839 @cindex command line editing
22840
22841 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22842 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22843 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22844 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22845 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22846 debugging sessions.
22847
22848 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22849 command @code{set}.
22850
22851 @table @code
22852 @kindex set editing
22853 @cindex editing
22854 @item set editing
22855 @itemx set editing on
22856 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22857
22858 @item set editing off
22859 Disable command line editing.
22860
22861 @kindex show editing
22862 @item show editing
22863 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22864 @end table
22865
22866 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22867 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22868 @end ifset
22869 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22870 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22871 @end ifclear
22872 for more details about the Readline
22873 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22874 encouraged to read that chapter.
22875
22876 @node Command History
22877 @section Command History
22878 @cindex command history
22879
22880 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22881 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22882 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22883 history facility.
22884
22885 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22886 package, to provide the history facility.
22887 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22888 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22889 @end ifset
22890 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22891 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22892 @end ifclear
22893 for the detailed description of the History library.
22894
22895 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22896 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22897 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22898 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22899 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22900 pressed on a line by itself.
22901
22902 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22903 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22904 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22905 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22906
22907 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22908 history.
22909
22910 @table @code
22911 @cindex history substitution
22912 @cindex history file
22913 @kindex set history filename
22914 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22915 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22916 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22917 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22918 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22919 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22920 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22921 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22922 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22923 is not set.
22924
22925 @cindex save command history
22926 @kindex set history save
22927 @item set history save
22928 @itemx set history save on
22929 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22930 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22931
22932 @item set history save off
22933 Stop recording command history in a file.
22934
22935 @cindex history size
22936 @kindex set history size
22937 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22938 @item set history size @var{size}
22939 @itemx set history size unlimited
22940 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22941 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22942 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22943 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22944 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22945 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22946
22947 @cindex remove duplicate history
22948 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22949 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22950 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22951 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22952 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22953 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22954 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22955 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22956 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22957
22958 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22959 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22960
22961 @end table
22962
22963 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22964 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22965 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22966 @end ifset
22967 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22968 @xref{Event Designators},
22969 @end ifclear
22970 for more details.
22971
22972 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22973 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22974 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22975 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22976 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22977 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22978 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22979 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22980
22981 The commands to control history expansion are:
22982
22983 @table @code
22984 @item set history expansion on
22985 @itemx set history expansion
22986 @kindex set history expansion
22987 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22988
22989 @item set history expansion off
22990 Disable history expansion.
22991
22992 @c @group
22993 @kindex show history
22994 @item show history
22995 @itemx show history filename
22996 @itemx show history save
22997 @itemx show history size
22998 @itemx show history expansion
22999 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23000 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23001 @c @end group
23002 @end table
23003
23004 @table @code
23005 @kindex show commands
23006 @cindex show last commands
23007 @cindex display command history
23008 @item show commands
23009 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23010
23011 @item show commands @var{n}
23012 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23013
23014 @item show commands +
23015 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23016 @end table
23017
23018 @node Screen Size
23019 @section Screen Size
23020 @cindex size of screen
23021 @cindex screen size
23022 @cindex pagination
23023 @cindex page size
23024 @cindex pauses in output
23025
23026 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23027 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23028 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23029 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23030 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23031 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23032 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23033 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23034
23035 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23036 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23037 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23038 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23039 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23040 width} commands:
23041
23042 @table @code
23043 @kindex set height
23044 @kindex set width
23045 @kindex show width
23046 @kindex show height
23047 @item set height @var{lpp}
23048 @itemx set height unlimited
23049 @itemx show height
23050 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23051 @itemx set width unlimited
23052 @itemx show width
23053 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23054 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23055 commands display the current settings.
23056
23057 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23058 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23059 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23060 buffer.
23061
23062 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23063 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23064
23065 @item set pagination on
23066 @itemx set pagination off
23067 @kindex set pagination
23068 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23069 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23070 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23071 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23072
23073 @item show pagination
23074 @kindex show pagination
23075 Show the current pagination mode.
23076 @end table
23077
23078 @node Numbers
23079 @section Numbers
23080 @cindex number representation
23081 @cindex entering numbers
23082
23083 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23084 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23085 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23086 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23087 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23088 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23089 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23090 both input and output with the commands described below.
23091
23092 @table @code
23093 @kindex set input-radix
23094 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23095 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23096 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23097 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23098 example, any of
23099
23100 @smallexample
23101 set input-radix 012
23102 set input-radix 10.
23103 set input-radix 0xa
23104 @end smallexample
23105
23106 @noindent
23107 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23108 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23109 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23110 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23111 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23112 change the radix.
23113
23114 @kindex set output-radix
23115 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23116 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23117 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23118 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23119
23120 @kindex show input-radix
23121 @item show input-radix
23122 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23123
23124 @kindex show output-radix
23125 @item show output-radix
23126 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23127
23128 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23129 @itemx show radix
23130 @kindex set radix
23131 @kindex show radix
23132 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23133 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23134 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23135 default value of 10.
23136
23137 @end table
23138
23139 @node ABI
23140 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23141
23142 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23143 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23144 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23145 current ABI.
23146
23147 @cindex OS ABI
23148 @kindex set osabi
23149 @kindex show osabi
23150 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23151
23152 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23153 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23154 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23155 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23156 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23157 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23158 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23159 platform provides.
23160
23161 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23162 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23163 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23164 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23165
23166 @table @code
23167 @item show osabi
23168 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23169
23170 @item set osabi
23171 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23172
23173 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23174 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23175 @end table
23176
23177 @cindex float promotion
23178
23179 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23180 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23181 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23182 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23183 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23184 @code{double} and then passed.
23185
23186 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23187 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23188 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23189
23190 @table @code
23191 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23192 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23193 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23194 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23195 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23196
23197 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23198 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23199 functions.
23200
23201 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23202 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23203 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23204 @end table
23205
23206 @kindex set cp-abi
23207 @kindex show cp-abi
23208 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23209 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23210 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23211 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23212 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23213 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23214 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23215 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23216 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23217 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23218 ``auto''.
23219
23220 @table @code
23221 @item show cp-abi
23222 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23223
23224 @item set cp-abi
23225 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23226
23227 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23228 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23229 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23230 @end table
23231
23232 @node Auto-loading
23233 @section Automatically loading associated files
23234 @cindex auto-loading
23235
23236 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23237 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23238 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23239 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23240 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23241 sources).
23242
23243 @menu
23244 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23245 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23246
23247 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23248 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23249 @end menu
23250
23251 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23252 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23253 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23254
23255 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23256 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23257 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23258
23259 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23260 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23261
23262 @table @code
23263 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23264 @kindex set auto-load off
23265 @item set auto-load off
23266 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23267 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23268 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23269 @smallexample
23270 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23271 @end smallexample
23272
23273 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23274 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23275 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23276 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23277 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23278 @code{set auto-load no}.
23279
23280 @anchor{show auto-load}
23281 @kindex show auto-load
23282 @item show auto-load
23283 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23284 or disabled.
23285
23286 @smallexample
23287 (gdb) show auto-load
23288 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23289 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23290 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23291 is on.
23292 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23293 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23294 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23295 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23296 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23297 @end smallexample
23298
23299 @anchor{info auto-load}
23300 @kindex info auto-load
23301 @item info auto-load
23302 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23303 not.
23304
23305 @smallexample
23306 (gdb) info auto-load
23307 gdb-scripts:
23308 Loaded Script
23309 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23310 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23311 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23312 loaded.
23313 python-scripts:
23314 Loaded Script
23315 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23316 @end smallexample
23317 @end table
23318
23319 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23320
23321 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23322 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23323 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23324 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23325 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23326 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23327 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23328 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23329 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23330 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23331 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23332 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23333 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23334 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23335 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23336 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23337 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23338 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23339 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23340 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23341 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23342 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23343 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23344 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23345 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23346 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23347 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23348 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23349 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23350 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23351 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23352 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23353 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23354 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23355 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23356 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23357 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23358 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23359 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23360 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23361 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23362 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23363 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23364 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23365 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23366 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23367 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23368 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23369 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23370 @end multitable
23371
23372 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23373 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23374 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23375
23376 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23377 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23378 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23379
23380 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23381 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23382
23383 @table @code
23384 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23385 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23386 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23387 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23388 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23389
23390 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23391 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23392 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23393 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23394 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23395
23396 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23397 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23398 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23399 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23400 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23401 @end table
23402
23403 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23404 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23405 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23406
23407 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23408
23409 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23410 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23411
23412 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23413 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23414 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23415 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23416 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23417 library.
23418
23419 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23420 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23421
23422 @table @code
23423 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23424 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23425 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23426 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23427
23428 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23429 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23430 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23431 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23432 enabled or disabled.
23433
23434 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23435 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23436 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23437 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23438 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23439 @end table
23440
23441 @node Auto-loading safe path
23442 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23443 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23444
23445 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23446 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23447 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23448 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23449 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23450
23451 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23452 get loaded:
23453
23454 @smallexample
23455 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23456 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23457 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23458 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23459 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23460 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23461 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23462 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23463 @end smallexample
23464
23465 @noindent
23466 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23467 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23468
23469 @smallexample
23470 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23471 @end smallexample
23472
23473 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23474
23475 @table @code
23476 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23477 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23478 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23479 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23480 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23481 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23482 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23483 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23484 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23485 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23486
23487 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23488 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23489 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23490
23491 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23492 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23493 @item show auto-load safe-path
23494 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23495 scripts.
23496
23497 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23498 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23499 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23500 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23501 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23502 by the host platform path separator in use.
23503 @end table
23504
23505 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23506 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23507 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23508 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23509 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23510
23511 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23512 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23513 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23514 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23515 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23516 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23517 init file in the current directory
23518 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23519
23520 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23521 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23522
23523 @table @asis
23524 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23525 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23526 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23527 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23528
23529 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23530 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23531 @value{GDBN} session.
23532
23533 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23534 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23535 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23536 from trusted sources.
23537
23538 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23539 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23540 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23541 trusted sources.
23542 @end table
23543
23544 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23545 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23546
23547 @table @asis
23548 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23549 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23550
23551 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23552 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23553 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23554 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23555 @end table
23556
23557 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23558 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23559 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23560 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23561 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23562 recommended to be entered.
23563
23564 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23565 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23566 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23567
23568 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23569 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23570 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23571 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23572 be printed.
23573
23574 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23575 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23576 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23577
23578 @smallexample
23579 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23580 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23581 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23582 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23583 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23584 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23585 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23586 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23587 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23588 @end smallexample
23589
23590 @table @code
23591 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23592 @kindex set debug auto-load
23593 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23594 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23595
23596 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23597 @kindex show debug auto-load
23598 @item show debug auto-load
23599 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23600 on or off.
23601 @end table
23602
23603 @node Messages/Warnings
23604 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23605
23606 @cindex verbose operation
23607 @cindex optional warnings
23608 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23609 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23610 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23611 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23612
23613 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23614 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23615 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23616
23617 @table @code
23618 @kindex set verbose
23619 @item set verbose on
23620 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23621
23622 @item set verbose off
23623 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23624
23625 @kindex show verbose
23626 @item show verbose
23627 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23628 @end table
23629
23630 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23631 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23632 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23633 Symbol Files}).
23634
23635 @table @code
23636
23637 @kindex set complaints
23638 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23639 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23640 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23641 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23642 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23643
23644 @kindex show complaints
23645 @item show complaints
23646 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23647
23648 @end table
23649
23650 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23651 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23652 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23653 you try to run a program which is already running:
23654
23655 @smallexample
23656 (@value{GDBP}) run
23657 The program being debugged has been started already.
23658 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23659 @end smallexample
23660
23661 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23662 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23663
23664 @table @code
23665
23666 @kindex set confirm
23667 @cindex flinching
23668 @cindex confirmation
23669 @cindex stupid questions
23670 @item set confirm off
23671 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23672 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23673 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23674
23675 @item set confirm on
23676 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23677
23678 @kindex show confirm
23679 @item show confirm
23680 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23681
23682 @end table
23683
23684 @cindex command tracing
23685 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23686 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23687 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23688 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23689
23690 @table @code
23691 @kindex set trace-commands
23692 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23693 @item set trace-commands on
23694 Enable command tracing.
23695 @item set trace-commands off
23696 Disable command tracing.
23697 @item show trace-commands
23698 Display the current state of command tracing.
23699 @end table
23700
23701 @node Debugging Output
23702 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23703 @cindex optional debugging messages
23704
23705 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23706 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23707 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23708 section documents those commands.
23709
23710 @table @code
23711 @kindex set exec-done-display
23712 @item set exec-done-display
23713 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23714 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23715 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23716 @kindex show exec-done-display
23717 @item show exec-done-display
23718 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23719 notification.
23720 @kindex set debug
23721 @cindex ARM AArch64
23722 @item set debug aarch64
23723 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23724 The default is off.
23725 @kindex show debug
23726 @item show debug aarch64
23727 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23728 ARM AArch64.
23729 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23730 @cindex architecture debugging info
23731 @item set debug arch
23732 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23733 @item show debug arch
23734 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23735 @item set debug aix-solib
23736 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23737 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23738 support module. The default is off.
23739 @item show debug aix-thread
23740 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23741 @item set debug aix-thread
23742 @cindex AIX threads
23743 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23744 module.
23745 @item show debug aix-thread
23746 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23747 @item set debug check-physname
23748 @cindex physname
23749 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23750 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23751 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23752 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23753 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23754 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23755 @item show debug check-physname
23756 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23757 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23758 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23759 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23760 exported symbols. The default is off.
23761 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23762 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23763 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23764 @item set debug dwarf-die
23765 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23766 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23767 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23768 A value of zero turns off the display.
23769 @item show debug dwarf-die
23770 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23771 @item set debug dwarf-line
23772 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23773 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23774 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23775 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23776 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23777 @item show debug dwarf-line
23778 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23779 @item set debug dwarf-read
23780 @cindex DWARF Reading
23781 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23782 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23783 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23784 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23785 @item show debug dwarf-read
23786 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23787 @item set debug displaced
23788 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23789 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23790 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23791 @item show debug displaced
23792 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23793 related to displaced stepping.
23794 @item set debug event
23795 @cindex event debugging info
23796 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23797 default is off.
23798 @item show debug event
23799 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23800 info.
23801 @item set debug expression
23802 @cindex expression debugging info
23803 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23804 expression parsing. The default is off.
23805 @item show debug expression
23806 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23807 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23808 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23809 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23810 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23811 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23812 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23813 @item set debug frame
23814 @cindex frame debugging info
23815 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23816 default is off.
23817 @item show debug frame
23818 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23819 info.
23820 @item set debug gnu-nat
23821 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23822 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23823 @item show debug gnu-nat
23824 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23825 @item set debug infrun
23826 @cindex inferior debugging info
23827 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23828 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23829 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23830 @item show debug infrun
23831 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23832 @item set debug jit
23833 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23834 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23835 @item show debug jit
23836 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23837 @item set debug lin-lwp
23838 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23839 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23840 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23841 @item show debug lin-lwp
23842 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23843 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23844 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23845 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23846 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23847 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23848 @item set debug mach-o
23849 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23850 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23851 processing. The default is off.
23852 @item show debug mach-o
23853 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23854 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23855 @item set debug notification
23856 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23857 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23858 The default is off.
23859 @item show debug notification
23860 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23861 @item set debug observer
23862 @cindex observer debugging info
23863 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23864 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23865 @item show debug observer
23866 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23867 @item set debug overload
23868 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23869 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23870 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23871 is off.
23872 @item show debug overload
23873 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23874 debugging info.
23875 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23876 @cindex debug expression parser
23877 @item set debug parser
23878 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23879 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23880 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23881 details. The default is off.
23882 @item show debug parser
23883 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23884 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23885 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23886 @cindex debug remote protocol
23887 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23888 @cindex display remote packets
23889 @item set debug remote
23890 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23891 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23892 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23893 @item show debug remote
23894 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23895 @item set debug serial
23896 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23897 default is off.
23898 @item show debug serial
23899 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23900 info.
23901 @item set debug solib-frv
23902 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23903 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23904 @item show debug solib-frv
23905 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23906 messages.
23907 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23908 @cindex symbol lookup
23909 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23910 The default is 0 (off).
23911 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23912 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23913 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23914 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23915 @item set debug symfile
23916 @cindex symbol file functions
23917 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23918 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23919 @item show debug symfile
23920 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23921 @item set debug symtab-create
23922 @cindex symbol table creation
23923 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23924 The default is 0 (off).
23925 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23926 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23927 @item show debug symtab-create
23928 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23929 @item set debug target
23930 @cindex target debugging info
23931 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23932 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23933 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23934 value of large memory transfers.
23935 @item show debug target
23936 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23937 info.
23938 @item set debug timestamp
23939 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23940 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23941 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23942 message.
23943 @item show debug timestamp
23944 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23945 debugging info.
23946 @item set debug varobj
23947 @cindex variable object debugging info
23948 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23949 info. The default is off.
23950 @item show debug varobj
23951 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23952 debugging info.
23953 @item set debug xml
23954 @cindex XML parser debugging
23955 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23956 @item show debug xml
23957 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23958 @end table
23959
23960 @node Other Misc Settings
23961 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23962 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23963
23964 @table @code
23965 @kindex set interactive-mode
23966 @item set interactive-mode
23967 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23968 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23969 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23970 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23971 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23972 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23973 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23974 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23975
23976 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23977 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23978 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23979 inside a cygwin window.
23980
23981 @kindex show interactive-mode
23982 @item show interactive-mode
23983 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23984 @end table
23985
23986 @node Extending GDB
23987 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23988 @cindex extending GDB
23989
23990 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23991 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23992 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23993 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23994 being debugged.
23995
23996 @menu
23997 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23998 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23999 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24000 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24001 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24002 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24003 @end menu
24004
24005 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24006 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24007 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24008 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24009 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24010 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24011
24012 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24013 setting:
24014
24015 @table @code
24016 @kindex set script-extension
24017 @kindex show script-extension
24018 @item set script-extension off
24019 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24020
24021 @item set script-extension soft
24022 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24023 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24024 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24025 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24026
24027 @item set script-extension strict
24028 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24029 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24030 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24031
24032 @item show script-extension
24033 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24034
24035 @end table
24036
24037 @node Sequences
24038 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24039
24040 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24041 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24042 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24043 files.
24044
24045 @menu
24046 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24047 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24048 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24049 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24050 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24051 @end menu
24052
24053 @node Define
24054 @subsection User-defined Commands
24055
24056 @cindex user-defined command
24057 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24058 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24059 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24060 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
24061 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24062 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
24063
24064 @smallexample
24065 define adder
24066 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24067 end
24068 @end smallexample
24069
24070 @noindent
24071 To execute the command use:
24072
24073 @smallexample
24074 adder 1 2 3
24075 @end smallexample
24076
24077 @noindent
24078 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24079 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24080 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24081 functions calls.
24082
24083 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24084 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24085 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24086 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
24087
24088 @smallexample
24089 define adder
24090 if $argc == 2
24091 print $arg0 + $arg1
24092 end
24093 if $argc == 3
24094 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24095 end
24096 end
24097 @end smallexample
24098
24099 @table @code
24100
24101 @kindex define
24102 @item define @var{commandname}
24103 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24104 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24105 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24106 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24107 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24108 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24109
24110 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24111 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24112 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24113
24114 @kindex document
24115 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24116 @item document @var{commandname}
24117 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24118 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24119 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24120 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24121 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24122 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24123
24124 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24125 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24126 does not change the documentation.
24127
24128 @kindex dont-repeat
24129 @cindex don't repeat command
24130 @item dont-repeat
24131 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24132 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24133 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24134
24135 @kindex help user-defined
24136 @item help user-defined
24137 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24138 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24139 included (if any).
24140
24141 @kindex show user
24142 @item show user
24143 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24144 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24145 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24146 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24147 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24148
24149 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24150 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24151 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24152 @item show max-user-call-depth
24153 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24154 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24155 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24156 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24157 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24158 @end table
24159
24160 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24161 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24162
24163 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24164 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24165 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24166
24167 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24168 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24169 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24170 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24171
24172 @node Hooks
24173 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24174 @cindex command hooks
24175 @cindex hooks, for commands
24176 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24177
24178 @kindex hook
24179 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24180 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24181 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24182 before that command.
24183
24184 @cindex hooks, post-command
24185 @kindex hookpost
24186 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24187 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24188 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24189 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24190 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24191
24192 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24193 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24194
24195 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24196 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24197
24198 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24199 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24200 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24201 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24202 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24203
24204 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24205 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24206 you could define:
24207
24208 @smallexample
24209 define hook-stop
24210 handle SIGALRM nopass
24211 end
24212
24213 define hook-run
24214 handle SIGALRM pass
24215 end
24216
24217 define hook-continue
24218 handle SIGALRM pass
24219 end
24220 @end smallexample
24221
24222 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24223 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24224 you could define:
24225
24226 @smallexample
24227 define hook-echo
24228 echo <<<---
24229 end
24230
24231 define hookpost-echo
24232 echo --->>>\n
24233 end
24234
24235 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24236 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24237 (@value{GDBP})
24238
24239 @end smallexample
24240
24241 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24242 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24243 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24244 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24245 @c or not?
24246 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24247 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24248 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24249
24250 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24251 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24252 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24253
24254 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24255 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24256
24257 @node Command Files
24258 @subsection Command Files
24259
24260 @cindex command files
24261 @cindex scripting commands
24262 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24263 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24264 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24265 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24266 terminal.
24267
24268 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24269 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24270 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24271 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24272 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24273
24274 @table @code
24275 @kindex source
24276 @cindex execute commands from a file
24277 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24278 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24279 @end table
24280
24281 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24282 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24283 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24284 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24285 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24286
24287 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24288 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24289 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24290 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24291 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24292 is not relevant to scripts.
24293
24294 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24295 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24296 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24297 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24298 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24299 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24300 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24301 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24302 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24303 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24304 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24305 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24306 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24307 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24308
24309 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24310 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24311 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24312
24313 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24314 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24315 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24316 when called from command files.
24317
24318 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24319 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24320 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24321 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24322 the next command.
24323
24324 @smallexample
24325 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24326 @end smallexample
24327
24328 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24329 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24330 would be directed to @file{log}.
24331
24332 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24333 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24334 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24335 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24336 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24337 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24338 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24339 conditionally, etc.
24340
24341 @table @code
24342 @kindex if
24343 @kindex else
24344 @item if
24345 @itemx else
24346 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24347 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24348 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24349 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24350 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24351 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24352 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24353
24354 @kindex while
24355 @item while
24356 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24357 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24358 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24359 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24360 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24361 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24362
24363 @kindex loop_break
24364 @item loop_break
24365 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24366 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24367 line.
24368
24369 @kindex loop_continue
24370 @item loop_continue
24371 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24372 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24373 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24374 the controlling expression.
24375
24376 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24377 @item end
24378 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24379 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24380 @end table
24381
24382
24383 @node Output
24384 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24385
24386 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24387 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24388 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24389 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24390 want.
24391
24392 @table @code
24393 @kindex echo
24394 @item echo @var{text}
24395 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24396 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24397 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24398 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24399 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24400 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24401 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24402 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24403 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24404 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24405 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24406
24407 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24408 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24409
24410 @smallexample
24411 echo This is some text\n\
24412 which is continued\n\
24413 onto several lines.\n
24414 @end smallexample
24415
24416 produces the same output as
24417
24418 @smallexample
24419 echo This is some text\n
24420 echo which is continued\n
24421 echo onto several lines.\n
24422 @end smallexample
24423
24424 @kindex output
24425 @item output @var{expression}
24426 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24427 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24428 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24429 on expressions.
24430
24431 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24432 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24433 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24434 Formats}, for more information.
24435
24436 @kindex printf
24437 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24438 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24439 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24440 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24441 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24442 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24443 executing the code below:
24444
24445 @smallexample
24446 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24447 @end smallexample
24448
24449 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24450 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24451 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24452 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24453 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24454 printed.
24455
24456 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24457
24458 @smallexample
24459 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24460 @end smallexample
24461
24462 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24463 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24464 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24465
24466 @itemize @bullet
24467 @item
24468 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24469
24470 @item
24471 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24472 width.
24473
24474 @item
24475 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24476 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24477
24478 @item
24479 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24480 supported.
24481
24482 @item
24483 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24484
24485 @item
24486 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24487 @end itemize
24488
24489 @noindent
24490 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24491 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24492 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24493 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24494
24495 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24496 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24497 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24498 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24499 supported.
24500
24501 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24502 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24503 together with a floating point specifier.
24504 letters:
24505
24506 @itemize @bullet
24507 @item
24508 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24509
24510 @item
24511 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24512
24513 @item
24514 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24515 @end itemize
24516
24517 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24518 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24519 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24520
24521 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24522 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24523
24524 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24525 @smallexample
24526 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24527 @end smallexample
24528
24529 @kindex eval
24530 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24531 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24532 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24533
24534 @end table
24535
24536 @node Auto-loading sequences
24537 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24538 @cindex native script auto-loading
24539
24540 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24541 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24542 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24543 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24544
24545 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24546 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24547
24548 @table @code
24549 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24550 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24551 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24552 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24553
24554 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24555 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24556 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24557 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24558 disabled.
24559
24560 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24561 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24562 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24563 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24564 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24565 auto-loaded.
24566 @end table
24567
24568 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24569 matching names are printed.
24570
24571 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24572 @include python.texi
24573
24574 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24575 @include guile.texi
24576
24577 @node Auto-loading extensions
24578 @section Auto-loading extensions
24579 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24580
24581 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24582 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24583 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24584 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24585 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24586
24587 @menu
24588 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24589 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24590 * Which flavor to choose?::
24591 @end menu
24592
24593 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24594 debugging commands and features.
24595
24596 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24597 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24598 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24599 for more information.
24600 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24601 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24602
24603 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24604 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24605
24606 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24607 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24608 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24609 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24610 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24611
24612 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24613 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24614 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24615 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24616
24617 @table @code
24618 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24619 GDB's own command language
24620 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24621 Python
24622 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24623 Guile
24624 @end table
24625
24626 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24627 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24628 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24629 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24630 script in the specified extension language.
24631
24632 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24633 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24634
24635 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24636 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24637
24638 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24639 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24640 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24641 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24642 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24643 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24644
24645 @table @code
24646 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24647 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24648 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24649 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24650 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24651 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24652
24653 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24654 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24655
24656 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24657 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24658 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24659 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24660
24661 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24662 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24663 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24664 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24665 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24666 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24667 platform.
24668
24669 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24670 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24671 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24672
24673 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24674 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24675 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24676 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24677
24678 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24679 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24680 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24681 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24682 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24683 @end table
24684
24685 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24686 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24687 @var{objfile} is opened.
24688 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24689 is evaluated more than once.
24690
24691 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24692 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24693 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24694
24695 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24696 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24697 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24698 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24699 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24700 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24701 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24702
24703 The following entries are supported:
24704
24705 @table @code
24706 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24707 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24708 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24709 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24710 @end table
24711
24712 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24713
24714 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24715 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24716 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24717 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24718 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24719
24720 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24721 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24722
24723 @example
24724 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24725 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24726 asm("\
24727 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24728 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24729 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24730 .popsection \n\
24731 ");
24732 @end example
24733
24734 @noindent
24735 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24736 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24737
24738 @example
24739 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24740 @end example
24741
24742 The script name may include directories if desired.
24743
24744 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24745 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24746
24747 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24748 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24749 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24750 will remove duplicates.
24751
24752 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24753
24754 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24755 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24756 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24757 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24758 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24759 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24760 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24761 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24762 on its name.
24763
24764 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24765 testsuite.
24766
24767 @example
24768 #include "symcat.h"
24769 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24770 asm(
24771 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24772 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24773 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24774 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24775 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24776 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24777 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24778 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24779 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24780 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24781 ".byte 0\n"
24782 ".popsection\n"
24783 );
24784 @end example
24785
24786 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24787 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24788 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24789 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24790
24791 @node Which flavor to choose?
24792 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24793
24794 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24795 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24796
24797 @noindent
24798 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24799
24800 @itemize @bullet
24801 @item
24802 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24803
24804 @item
24805 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24806
24807 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24808 in the source search path.
24809 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24810 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24811
24812 @item
24813 Doesn't require source code additions.
24814 @end itemize
24815
24816 @noindent
24817 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24818
24819 @itemize @bullet
24820 @item
24821 Works with static linking.
24822
24823 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24824 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24825 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24826 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24827 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24828
24829 @item
24830 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24831
24832 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24833 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24834
24835 @item
24836 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24837
24838 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24839 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24840 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24841 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24842 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24843 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24844 @end itemize
24845
24846 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24847 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24848
24849 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24850 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24851 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24852
24853 @subsection Python comes first
24854
24855 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24856 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24857 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24858 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24859 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24860 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24861 pretty-printed form of a value).
24862 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24863 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24864 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24865
24866 @node Aliases
24867 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24868 @cindex aliases for commands
24869
24870 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24871 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24872 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24873 that involves less typing.
24874
24875 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24876 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24877 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24878
24879 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24880 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24881 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24882
24883 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24884
24885 @table @code
24886
24887 @kindex alias
24888 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24889
24890 @end table
24891
24892 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24893 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24894 underscores.
24895
24896 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24897 that is being aliased.
24898
24899 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24900 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24901 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24902
24903 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24904 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24905
24906 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24907 of a command so that there is less to type.
24908 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24909 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24910 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24911 The following will accomplish this.
24912
24913 @smallexample
24914 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24915 @end smallexample
24916
24917 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24918 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24919 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24920 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24921
24922 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24923 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24924 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24925 of a command.
24926
24927 @smallexample
24928 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24929 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24930 (gdb) set p elms 20
24931 (gdb) show p elms
24932 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24933 @end smallexample
24934
24935 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24936 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24937 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24938
24939 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24940 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24941
24942 @smallexample
24943 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24944 @end smallexample
24945
24946 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24947 alias for a more complex command.
24948 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24949
24950 @smallexample
24951 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24952 (gdb) spe 20
24953 @end smallexample
24954
24955 @node Interpreters
24956 @chapter Command Interpreters
24957 @cindex command interpreters
24958
24959 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24960 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24961 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24962
24963 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24964 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24965 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24966 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24967
24968 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24969 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24970 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24971 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24972
24973 @table @code
24974 @item console
24975 @cindex console interpreter
24976 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24977 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24978 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24979
24980 @item mi
24981 @cindex mi interpreter
24982 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24983 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24984 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24985 Interface}.
24986
24987 @item mi2
24988 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24989 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24990
24991 @item mi1
24992 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24993 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24994
24995 @end table
24996
24997 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24998
24999 @kindex interpreter-exec
25000 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25001 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25002 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25003
25004 @smallexample
25005 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25006 @end smallexample
25007
25008 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25009 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25010
25011 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25012 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25013 permanently.
25014
25015 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25016
25017 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25018 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25019 device (usually a tty).
25020
25021 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25022 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25023 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25024 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25025 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25026 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25027 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25028 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25029 the separate MI interpreter.
25030
25031 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25032 @code{new-ui} command:
25033
25034 @kindex new-ui
25035 @cindex new user interface
25036 @smallexample
25037 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25038 @end smallexample
25039
25040 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25041 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25042 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25043 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25044 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25045 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25046
25047 @smallexample
25048 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25049 @end smallexample
25050
25051 @noindent
25052 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25053
25054 @node TUI
25055 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25056 @cindex TUI
25057 @cindex Text User Interface
25058
25059 @menu
25060 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25061 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25062 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25063 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25064 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25065 @end menu
25066
25067 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25068 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25069 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25070 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25071 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25072 is available.
25073
25074 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25075 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25076 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25077 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25078 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25079 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25080
25081 @node TUI Overview
25082 @section TUI Overview
25083
25084 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25085
25086 @table @emph
25087 @item command
25088 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25089 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25090 managed using readline.
25091
25092 @item source
25093 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25094 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25095
25096 @item assembly
25097 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25098
25099 @item register
25100 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25101 when their values change.
25102 @end table
25103
25104 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25105 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25106 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25107 indicates the breakpoint type:
25108
25109 @table @code
25110 @item B
25111 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25112
25113 @item b
25114 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25115
25116 @item H
25117 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25118
25119 @item h
25120 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25121 @end table
25122
25123 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25124
25125 @table @code
25126 @item +
25127 Breakpoint is enabled.
25128
25129 @item -
25130 Breakpoint is disabled.
25131 @end table
25132
25133 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25134 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25135 changes.
25136
25137 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25138 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25139 layouts:
25140
25141 @itemize @bullet
25142 @item
25143 source only,
25144
25145 @item
25146 assembly only,
25147
25148 @item
25149 source and assembly,
25150
25151 @item
25152 source and registers, or
25153
25154 @item
25155 assembly and registers.
25156 @end itemize
25157
25158 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25159
25160 @table @emph
25161 @item target
25162 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25163 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25164
25165 @item process
25166 Gives the current process or thread number.
25167 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25168
25169 @item function
25170 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25171 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25172 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25173 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25174
25175 @item line
25176 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25177 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25178
25179 @item pc
25180 Indicates the current program counter address.
25181 @end table
25182
25183 @node TUI Keys
25184 @section TUI Key Bindings
25185 @cindex TUI key bindings
25186
25187 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25188 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25189 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25190 @end ifset
25191 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25192 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25193 @end ifclear
25194 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25195 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25196
25197 @table @kbd
25198 @kindex C-x C-a
25199 @item C-x C-a
25200 @kindex C-x a
25201 @itemx C-x a
25202 @kindex C-x A
25203 @itemx C-x A
25204 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25205 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25206 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25207 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25208 The screen is then refreshed.
25209
25210 @kindex C-x 1
25211 @item C-x 1
25212 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25213 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25214 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25215
25216 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25217
25218 @kindex C-x 2
25219 @item C-x 2
25220 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25221 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25222 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25223 previous layout and the new one.
25224
25225 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25226
25227 @kindex C-x o
25228 @item C-x o
25229 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25230 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25231 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25232
25233 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25234
25235 @kindex C-x s
25236 @item C-x s
25237 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25238 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25239 @end table
25240
25241 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25242
25243 @table @asis
25244 @kindex PgUp
25245 @item @key{PgUp}
25246 Scroll the active window one page up.
25247
25248 @kindex PgDn
25249 @item @key{PgDn}
25250 Scroll the active window one page down.
25251
25252 @kindex Up
25253 @item @key{Up}
25254 Scroll the active window one line up.
25255
25256 @kindex Down
25257 @item @key{Down}
25258 Scroll the active window one line down.
25259
25260 @kindex Left
25261 @item @key{Left}
25262 Scroll the active window one column left.
25263
25264 @kindex Right
25265 @item @key{Right}
25266 Scroll the active window one column right.
25267
25268 @kindex C-L
25269 @item @kbd{C-L}
25270 Refresh the screen.
25271 @end table
25272
25273 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25274 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25275 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25276 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25277 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25278
25279 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25280 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25281 @cindex TUI single key mode
25282
25283 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25284 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25285 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25286
25287 @table @kbd
25288 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25289 @item c
25290 continue
25291
25292 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25293 @item d
25294 down
25295
25296 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25297 @item f
25298 finish
25299
25300 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25301 @item n
25302 next
25303
25304 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25305 @item q
25306 exit the SingleKey mode.
25307
25308 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25309 @item r
25310 run
25311
25312 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25313 @item s
25314 step
25315
25316 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25317 @item u
25318 up
25319
25320 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25321 @item v
25322 info locals
25323
25324 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25325 @item w
25326 where
25327 @end table
25328
25329 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25330 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25331 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25332 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25333 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25334 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25335
25336
25337 @node TUI Commands
25338 @section TUI-specific Commands
25339 @cindex TUI commands
25340
25341 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25342 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25343 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25344 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25345
25346 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25347 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25348 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25349 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25350 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25351
25352 @table @code
25353 @item tui enable
25354 @kindex tui enable
25355 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25356 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25357 otherwise a default layout is used.
25358
25359 @item tui disable
25360 @kindex tui disable
25361 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25362
25363 @item info win
25364 @kindex info win
25365 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25366
25367 @item layout @var{name}
25368 @kindex layout
25369 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25370 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25371 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25372
25373 @table @code
25374 @item next
25375 Display the next layout.
25376
25377 @item prev
25378 Display the previous layout.
25379
25380 @item src
25381 Display the source and command windows.
25382
25383 @item asm
25384 Display the assembly and command windows.
25385
25386 @item split
25387 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25388
25389 @item regs
25390 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25391 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25392 register, assembler, and command windows.
25393 @end table
25394
25395 @item focus @var{name}
25396 @kindex focus
25397 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25398 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25399
25400 @table @code
25401 @item next
25402 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25403
25404 @item prev
25405 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25406
25407 @item src
25408 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25409
25410 @item asm
25411 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25412
25413 @item regs
25414 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25415
25416 @item cmd
25417 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25418 @end table
25419
25420 @item refresh
25421 @kindex refresh
25422 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25423
25424 @item tui reg @var{group}
25425 @kindex tui reg
25426 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25427 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25428 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25429 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25430 following groups are available on most targets:
25431 @table @code
25432 @item next
25433 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25434 through all of the available register groups.
25435
25436 @item prev
25437 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25438 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25439 @var{next}.
25440
25441 @item general
25442 Display the general registers.
25443 @item float
25444 Display the floating point registers.
25445 @item system
25446 Display the system registers.
25447 @item vector
25448 Display the vector registers.
25449 @item all
25450 Display all registers.
25451 @end table
25452
25453 @item update
25454 @kindex update
25455 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25456
25457 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25458 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25459 @kindex winheight
25460 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25461 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25462 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25463 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25464 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25465
25466 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25467 @kindex tabset
25468 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25469 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25470 assembly windows.
25471 @end table
25472
25473 @node TUI Configuration
25474 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25475 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25476
25477 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25478
25479 @table @code
25480 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25481 @kindex set tui border-kind
25482 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25483 The possible values are the following:
25484 @table @code
25485 @item space
25486 Use a space character to draw the border.
25487
25488 @item ascii
25489 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25490
25491 @item acs
25492 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25493 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25494 @end table
25495
25496 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25497 @kindex set tui border-mode
25498 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25499 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25500 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25501 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25502 @table @code
25503 @item normal
25504 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25505
25506 @item standout
25507 Use standout mode.
25508
25509 @item reverse
25510 Use reverse video mode.
25511
25512 @item half
25513 Use half bright mode.
25514
25515 @item half-standout
25516 Use half bright and standout mode.
25517
25518 @item bold
25519 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25520
25521 @item bold-standout
25522 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25523 @end table
25524 @end table
25525
25526 @node Emacs
25527 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25528
25529 @cindex Emacs
25530 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25531 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25532 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25533 @value{GDBN}.
25534
25535 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25536 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25537 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25538 created Emacs buffer.
25539 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25540
25541 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25542 things:
25543
25544 @itemize @bullet
25545 @item
25546 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25547 the GUD buffer.
25548
25549 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25550 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25551
25552 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25553 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25554 in this way.
25555
25556 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25557 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25558 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25559 stop.
25560
25561 @item
25562 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25563
25564 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25565 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25566 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25567 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25568 and the source.
25569
25570 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25571 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25572 @end itemize
25573
25574 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25575 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25576 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25577 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25578
25579 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25580 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25581 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25582 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25583 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25584 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25585 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25586 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25587 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25588
25589 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25590 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25591 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25592 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25593
25594 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25595 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25596 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25597 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25598 one you want.
25599
25600 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25601 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25602
25603 @table @kbd
25604 @item C-h m
25605 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25606
25607 @item C-c C-s
25608 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25609 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25610
25611 @item C-c C-n
25612 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25613 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25614 to show the current file and location.
25615
25616 @item C-c C-i
25617 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25618 display window accordingly.
25619
25620 @item C-c C-f
25621 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25622 @code{finish} command.
25623
25624 @item C-c C-r
25625 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25626 command.
25627
25628 @item C-c <
25629 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25630 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25631 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25632
25633 @item C-c >
25634 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25635 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25636 @end table
25637
25638 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25639 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25640
25641 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25642 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25643 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25644 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25645 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25646 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25647 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25648
25649 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25650 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25651 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25652 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25653 frame.
25654
25655 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25656 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25657 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25658 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25659 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25660 to correspond properly with the code.
25661
25662 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25663 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25664 Emacs Manual}).
25665
25666 @node GDB/MI
25667 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25668
25669 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25670
25671 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25672 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25673 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25674 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25675 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25676 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25677
25678 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25679 in the form of a reference manual.
25680
25681 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25682 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25683 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25684
25685 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25686
25687 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25688 This chapter uses the following notation:
25689
25690 @itemize @bullet
25691 @item
25692 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25693
25694 @item
25695 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25696 it may or may not be given.
25697
25698 @item
25699 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25700 may repeat zero or more times.
25701
25702 @item
25703 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25704 may repeat one or more times.
25705
25706 @item
25707 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25708 @end itemize
25709
25710 @ignore
25711 @heading Dependencies
25712 @end ignore
25713
25714 @menu
25715 * GDB/MI General Design::
25716 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25717 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25718 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25719 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25720 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25721 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25722 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25723 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25724 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25725 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25726 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25727 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25728 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25729 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25730 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25731 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25732 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25733 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25734 @ignore
25735 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25736 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25737 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25738 @end ignore
25739 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25740 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25741 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25742 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25743 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25744 @end menu
25745
25746 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25747 @node GDB/MI General Design
25748 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25749 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25750
25751 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25752 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25753 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25754 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25755 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25756 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25757 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25758 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25759 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25760 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25761
25762 The important examples of notifications are:
25763 @itemize @bullet
25764
25765 @item
25766 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25767 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25768 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25769 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25770 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25771 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25772 command itself was successfully executed.
25773
25774 @item
25775 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25776 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25777 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25778 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25779 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25780 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25781
25782 @item
25783 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25784 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25785 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25786 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25787 orthogonal frontend design.
25788
25789 @end itemize
25790
25791 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25792 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25793 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25794 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25795 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25796 the user interface.
25797
25798
25799 @menu
25800 * Context management::
25801 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25802 * Thread groups::
25803 @end menu
25804
25805 @node Context management
25806 @subsection Context management
25807
25808 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25809
25810 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25811 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25812 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25813 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25814 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25815 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25816 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25817 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25818 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25819
25820 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25821 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25822 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25823 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25824 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25825 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25826 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25827 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25828 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25829 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25830 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25831
25832 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25833 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25834 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25835 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
25836 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
25837 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
25838 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
25839 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
25840 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
25841 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25842
25843 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25844 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25845 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25846 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25847 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25848 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25849 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25850 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25851 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25852 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25853 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25854 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25855 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25856 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25857 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25858 @samp{--frame} options.
25859
25860 @subsubsection Language
25861
25862 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25863 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25864 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25865 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25866 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25867 For instance:
25868
25869 @smallexample
25870 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25871 ^done,value="4"
25872 (gdb)
25873 @end smallexample
25874
25875 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25876 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25877 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25878
25879 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25880 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25881
25882 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25883 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25884 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25885 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25886 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25887 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25888 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25889 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25890 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25891
25892 @table @code
25893 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25894 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25895 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25896
25897 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25898 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25899 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25900
25901 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25902 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25903 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25904 MI commands even while the target is running.
25905
25906 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25907 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25908 @end table
25909
25910 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25911 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25912 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25913 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25914 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25915 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25916
25917 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25918 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25919 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25920 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25921 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25922 are running.
25923
25924 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25925 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25926 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25927 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25928 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25929 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25930 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25931 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25932 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25933 @samp{--thread} option).
25934
25935 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25936 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25937 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25938 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25939
25940 @node Thread groups
25941 @subsection Thread groups
25942 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25943 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25944 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25945 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25946 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25947
25948 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25949 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25950 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25951 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25952 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25953 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25954 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25955 into processes.
25956
25957 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25958 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25959 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25960 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25961 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25962 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25963 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25964 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25965 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25966 the members of specific thread group.
25967
25968 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25969 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25970 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25971 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25972 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25973 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25974 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25975 after attaching to that thread group.
25976
25977 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25978 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25979 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25980 such thread groups.
25981
25982 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25983 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25984 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25985
25986 @menu
25987 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25988 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25989 @end menu
25990
25991 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25992 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25993
25994 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25995 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25996 @table @code
25997 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25998 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25999
26000 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26001 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26002 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26003
26004 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26005 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26006 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26007
26008 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26009 "any sequence of digits"
26010
26011 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26012 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26013
26014 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26015 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26016
26017 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26018 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26019
26020 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26021 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26022 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26023
26024 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26025 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26026
26027 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26028 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26029 @end table
26030
26031 @noindent
26032 Notes:
26033
26034 @itemize @bullet
26035 @item
26036 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26037 output is described below.
26038
26039 @item
26040 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26041 finishes.
26042
26043 @item
26044 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26045 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26046 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26047 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26048 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26049 @end itemize
26050
26051 Pragmatics:
26052
26053 @itemize @bullet
26054 @item
26055 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26056
26057 @item
26058 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26059 @end itemize
26060
26061 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26062 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26063
26064 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26065 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26066 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26067 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26068 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26069 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26070
26071 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26072 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26073 @var{token}.
26074
26075 @table @code
26076 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26077 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26078
26079 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26080 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26081
26082 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26083 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26084
26085 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26086 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26087
26088 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26089 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26090
26091 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26092 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26093
26094 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26095 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26096
26097 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26098 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26099
26100 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26101 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26102
26103 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26104 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26105 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26106
26107 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26108 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26109
26110 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26111 @code{ @var{string} }
26112
26113 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26114 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26115
26116 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26117 @code{@var{c-string}}
26118
26119 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26120 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26121
26122 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26123 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26124 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26125
26126 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26127 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26128
26129 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26130 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26131
26132 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26133 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26134
26135 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26136 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26137
26138 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26139 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26140
26141 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26142 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26143 @end table
26144
26145 @noindent
26146 Notes:
26147
26148 @itemize @bullet
26149 @item
26150 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26151
26152 @item
26153 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26154 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26155 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26156 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26157 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26158 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26159 prior command.
26160
26161 @item
26162 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26163 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26164 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26165 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26166
26167 @item
26168 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26169 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26170 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26171 @samp{*}.
26172
26173 @item
26174 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26175 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26176 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26177 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26178
26179 @item
26180 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26181 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26182 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26183 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26184
26185 @item
26186 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26187 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26188 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26189
26190 @item
26191 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26192 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26193 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26194 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26195
26196 @item
26197 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26198 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26199 @var{values}.
26200
26201
26202 @end itemize
26203
26204 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26205 details about the various output records.
26206
26207 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26208 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26209 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26210
26211 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26212 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26213
26214 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26215 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26216 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26217 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26218 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26219 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26220
26221 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26222 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26223 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26224
26225 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26226 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26227 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26228 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26229
26230 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26231 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26232
26233 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26234 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26235 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26236 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26237 might change.
26238
26239 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26240 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26241 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26242 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26243
26244 @itemize @bullet
26245 @item
26246 New MI commands may be added.
26247
26248 @item
26249 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26250
26251 @item
26252 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26253 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26254
26255 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26256 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26257
26258 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26259 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26260 @end itemize
26261
26262 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26263 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26264 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26265 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26266 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26267
26268 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26269 @c version?
26270
26271 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26272 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26273 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26274 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26275 @cindex mailing lists
26276
26277 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26278 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26279 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26280
26281 @menu
26282 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26283 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26284 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26285 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26286 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26287 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26288 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26289 @end menu
26290
26291 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26292 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26293
26294 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26295 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26296 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26297 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26298
26299 @table @code
26300 @findex ^done
26301 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26302 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26303 values.
26304
26305 @item "^running"
26306 @findex ^running
26307 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26308 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26309 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26310 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26311 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26312 which threads are resumed.
26313
26314 @item "^connected"
26315 @findex ^connected
26316 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26317
26318 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26319 @findex ^error
26320 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26321 the corresponding error message.
26322
26323 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26324 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26325 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26326
26327 @table @samp
26328 @item "undefined-command"
26329 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26330 @end table
26331
26332 @item "^exit"
26333 @findex ^exit
26334 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26335
26336 @end table
26337
26338 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26339 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26340
26341 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26342 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26343 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26344 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26345 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26346
26347 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26348 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26349 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26350 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26351 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26352
26353 @table @code
26354 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26355 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26356 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26357
26358 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26359 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26360 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26361 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26362
26363 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26364 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26365 internals.
26366 @end table
26367
26368 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26369 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26370
26371 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26372 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26373 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26374 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26375 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26376 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26377
26378 The following is the list of possible async records:
26379
26380 @table @code
26381
26382 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26383 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26384 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26385 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26386 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26387 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26388 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26389 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26390 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26391 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26392 it run freely.
26393
26394 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26395 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26396 following values:
26397
26398 @table @code
26399 @item breakpoint-hit
26400 A breakpoint was reached.
26401 @item watchpoint-trigger
26402 A watchpoint was triggered.
26403 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26404 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26405 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26406 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26407 @item function-finished
26408 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26409 @item location-reached
26410 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26411 @item watchpoint-scope
26412 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26413 @item end-stepping-range
26414 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26415 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26416 @item exited-signalled
26417 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26418 @item exited
26419 The inferior exited.
26420 @item exited-normally
26421 The inferior exited normally.
26422 @item signal-received
26423 A signal was received by the inferior.
26424 @item solib-event
26425 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26426 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26427 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26428 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26429 @item fork
26430 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26431 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26432 @item vfork
26433 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26434 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26435 @item syscall-entry
26436 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26437 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26438 @item syscall-return
26439 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26440 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26441 @item exec
26442 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26443 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26444 @end table
26445
26446 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26447 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26448 Depending on whether all-stop
26449 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26450 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26451 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26452 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26453 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26454 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26455 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26456 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26457 if such information is not available.
26458
26459 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26460 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26461 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26462 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26463 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26464 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26465 cannot be used in any way.
26466
26467 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26468 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26469 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26470 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26471 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26472 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26473
26474 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26475 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26476 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26477 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26478 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26479 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26480
26481 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26482 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26483 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26484 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26485 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26486
26487 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26488 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26489 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26490 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26491 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26492 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26493 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26494 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26495 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26496
26497 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26498 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26499
26500 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26501 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26502 that thread.
26503
26504 @item =library-loaded,...
26505 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26506 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26507 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26508 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26509 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26510 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26511 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26512 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26513 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26514 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26515 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26516 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26517 thread groups.
26518
26519 @item =library-unloaded,...
26520 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26521 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26522 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26523 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26524 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26525 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26526 thread groups.
26527
26528 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26529 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26530 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26531 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26532 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26533
26534 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26535 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26536 initial value @var{initial}.
26537
26538 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26539 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26540 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26541 trace state variables are deleted.
26542
26543 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26544 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26545 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26546 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26547 value of trace state variable is known.
26548
26549 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26550 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26551 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26552 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26553 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26554 user.
26555
26556 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26557 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26558 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26559
26560 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26561 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26562
26563 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26564 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26565 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26566 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26567 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26568
26569 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26570 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26571 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay}
26572 for existing method and format values.
26573
26574 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26575 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26576 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26577 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26578 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26579 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26580
26581 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26582 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26583 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26584 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26585 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26586 executable code.
26587 @end table
26588
26589 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26590 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26591
26592 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26593 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26594 following fields:
26595
26596 @table @code
26597 @item number
26598 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26599 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26600 @samp{1.2}.
26601
26602 @item type
26603 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26604 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26605
26606 @item catch-type
26607 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26608 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26609
26610 @item disp
26611 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26612 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26613 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26614
26615 @item enabled
26616 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26617 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26618 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26619
26620 @item addr
26621 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26622 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26623 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26624 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26625 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26626
26627 @item func
26628 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26629 If not known, this field is not present.
26630
26631 @item filename
26632 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26633 If not known, this field is not present.
26634
26635 @item fullname
26636 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26637 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26638
26639 @item line
26640 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26641 If not known, this field is not present.
26642
26643 @item at
26644 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26645 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26646 by a symbol name.
26647
26648 @item pending
26649 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26650 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26651
26652 @item evaluated-by
26653 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26654 @samp{target}.
26655
26656 @item thread
26657 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26658 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26659
26660 @item task
26661 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26662 field will hold the task identifier.
26663
26664 @item cond
26665 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26666
26667 @item ignore
26668 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26669
26670 @item enable
26671 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26672
26673 @item traceframe-usage
26674 FIXME.
26675
26676 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26677 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26678
26679 @item mask
26680 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26681
26682 @item pass
26683 A tracepoint's pass count.
26684
26685 @item original-location
26686 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26687 This field is optional.
26688
26689 @item times
26690 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26691
26692 @item installed
26693 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26694 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26695 is not.
26696
26697 @item what
26698 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26699
26700 @end table
26701
26702 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26703 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26704
26705 @smallexample
26706 -> -break-insert main
26707 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26708 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26709 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26710 times="0"@}
26711 <- (gdb)
26712 @end smallexample
26713
26714 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26715 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26716
26717 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26718 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26719 fields:
26720
26721 @table @code
26722 @item level
26723 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26724 zero. This field is always present.
26725
26726 @item func
26727 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26728 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26729
26730 @item addr
26731 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26732
26733 @item file
26734 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26735 address. This field may be absent.
26736
26737 @item line
26738 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26739 may be absent.
26740
26741 @item from
26742 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26743 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26744
26745 @end table
26746
26747 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26748 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26749
26750 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26751 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26752
26753 @table @code
26754 @item id
26755 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26756 always present.
26757
26758 @item target-id
26759 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26760
26761 @item details
26762 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26763 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26764 frontend. This field is optional.
26765
26766 @item state
26767 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26768 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26769
26770 @item core
26771 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26772 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26773 @end table
26774
26775 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26776 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26777
26778 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26779 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26780 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26781 the @code{exception-name} field.
26782
26783 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26784 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26785 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26786 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26787
26788 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26789 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26790 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26791 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26792
26793 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26794 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26795
26796 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26797
26798 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26799 information of the breakpoint.
26800
26801 @smallexample
26802 -> -break-insert main
26803 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26804 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26805 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26806 times="0"@}
26807 <- (gdb)
26808 @end smallexample
26809
26810 @subheading Program Execution
26811
26812 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26813 reason that execution stopped.
26814
26815 @smallexample
26816 -> -exec-run
26817 <- ^running
26818 <- (gdb)
26819 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26820 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26821 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26822 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26823 <- (gdb)
26824 -> -exec-continue
26825 <- ^running
26826 <- (gdb)
26827 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26828 <- (gdb)
26829 @end smallexample
26830
26831 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26832
26833 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26834
26835 @smallexample
26836 -> (gdb)
26837 <- -gdb-exit
26838 <- ^exit
26839 @end smallexample
26840
26841 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26842 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26843 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26844 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26845 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26846 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26847
26848 @subheading A Bad Command
26849
26850 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26851
26852 @smallexample
26853 -> -rubbish
26854 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26855 <- (gdb)
26856 @end smallexample
26857
26858
26859 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26860 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26861 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26862
26863 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26864 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26865
26866 @subheading Motivation
26867
26868 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26869
26870 @subheading Introduction
26871
26872 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26873
26874 @subheading Commands
26875
26876 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26877
26878 @subsubheading Synopsis
26879
26880 @smallexample
26881 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26882 @end smallexample
26883
26884 @subsubheading Result
26885
26886 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26887
26888 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26889
26890 @subsubheading Example
26891
26892 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26893 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26894
26895
26896 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26897 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26898 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26899
26900 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26901 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26902 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26903 breakpoints.
26904
26905 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26906 @findex -break-after
26907
26908 @subsubheading Synopsis
26909
26910 @smallexample
26911 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26912 @end smallexample
26913
26914 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26915 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26916 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26917 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26918
26919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26920
26921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26922
26923 @subsubheading Example
26924
26925 @smallexample
26926 (gdb)
26927 -break-insert main
26928 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26929 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26930 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26931 times="0"@}
26932 (gdb)
26933 -break-after 1 3
26934 ~
26935 ^done
26936 (gdb)
26937 -break-list
26938 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26939 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26940 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26941 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26942 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26943 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26944 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26945 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26946 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26947 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26948 (gdb)
26949 @end smallexample
26950
26951 @ignore
26952 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26953 @findex -break-catch
26954 @end ignore
26955
26956 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26957 @findex -break-commands
26958
26959 @subsubheading Synopsis
26960
26961 @smallexample
26962 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26963 @end smallexample
26964
26965 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26966 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26967 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26968 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26969 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26970 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26971
26972 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26973
26974 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26975
26976 @subsubheading Example
26977
26978 @smallexample
26979 (gdb)
26980 -break-insert main
26981 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26982 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26983 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26984 times="0"@}
26985 (gdb)
26986 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26987 ^done
26988 (gdb)
26989 @end smallexample
26990
26991 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26992 @findex -break-condition
26993
26994 @subsubheading Synopsis
26995
26996 @smallexample
26997 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26998 @end smallexample
26999
27000 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27001 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27002 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27003 command below).
27004
27005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27006
27007 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27008
27009 @subsubheading Example
27010
27011 @smallexample
27012 (gdb)
27013 -break-condition 1 1
27014 ^done
27015 (gdb)
27016 -break-list
27017 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27018 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27019 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27020 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27021 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27022 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27023 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27024 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27025 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27026 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27027 (gdb)
27028 @end smallexample
27029
27030 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27031 @findex -break-delete
27032
27033 @subsubheading Synopsis
27034
27035 @smallexample
27036 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27037 @end smallexample
27038
27039 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27040 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27041
27042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27043
27044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27045
27046 @subsubheading Example
27047
27048 @smallexample
27049 (gdb)
27050 -break-delete 1
27051 ^done
27052 (gdb)
27053 -break-list
27054 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27055 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27056 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27057 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27058 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27059 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27060 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27061 body=[]@}
27062 (gdb)
27063 @end smallexample
27064
27065 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27066 @findex -break-disable
27067
27068 @subsubheading Synopsis
27069
27070 @smallexample
27071 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27072 @end smallexample
27073
27074 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27075 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27076
27077 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27078
27079 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27080
27081 @subsubheading Example
27082
27083 @smallexample
27084 (gdb)
27085 -break-disable 2
27086 ^done
27087 (gdb)
27088 -break-list
27089 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27090 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27091 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27092 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27093 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27094 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27095 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27096 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27097 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27098 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27099 (gdb)
27100 @end smallexample
27101
27102 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27103 @findex -break-enable
27104
27105 @subsubheading Synopsis
27106
27107 @smallexample
27108 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27109 @end smallexample
27110
27111 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27112
27113 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27114
27115 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27116
27117 @subsubheading Example
27118
27119 @smallexample
27120 (gdb)
27121 -break-enable 2
27122 ^done
27123 (gdb)
27124 -break-list
27125 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27126 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27127 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27128 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27129 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27130 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27131 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27132 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27133 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27134 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27135 (gdb)
27136 @end smallexample
27137
27138 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27139 @findex -break-info
27140
27141 @subsubheading Synopsis
27142
27143 @smallexample
27144 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27145 @end smallexample
27146
27147 @c REDUNDANT???
27148 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27149
27150 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27151 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27152 table.
27153
27154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27155
27156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27157
27158 @subsubheading Example
27159 N.A.
27160
27161 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27162 @findex -break-insert
27163 @anchor{-break-insert}
27164
27165 @subsubheading Synopsis
27166
27167 @smallexample
27168 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27169 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27170 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27171 @end smallexample
27172
27173 @noindent
27174 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27175
27176 @table @var
27177 @item linespec location
27178 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27179
27180 @item explicit location
27181 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27182 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27183 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27184
27185 @table @samp
27186 @item --source @var{filename}
27187 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27188 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27189
27190 @item --function @var{function}
27191 The name of a function or method.
27192
27193 @item --label @var{label}
27194 The name of a label.
27195
27196 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27197 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27198 @end table
27199
27200 @item address location
27201 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27202 @end table
27203
27204 @noindent
27205 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27206
27207 @table @samp
27208 @item -t
27209 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27210 @item -h
27211 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27212 @item -f
27213 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27214 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27215 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27216 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27217 cannot be parsed.
27218 @item -d
27219 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27220 @item -a
27221 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27222 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27223 @item -c @var{condition}
27224 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27225 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27226 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27227 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27228 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27229 @var{thread-id}.
27230 @end table
27231
27232 @subsubheading Result
27233
27234 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27235 resulting breakpoint.
27236
27237 Note: this format is open to change.
27238 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27239
27240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27241
27242 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27243 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27244
27245 @subsubheading Example
27246
27247 @smallexample
27248 (gdb)
27249 -break-insert main
27250 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27251 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27252 times="0"@}
27253 (gdb)
27254 -break-insert -t foo
27255 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27256 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27257 times="0"@}
27258 (gdb)
27259 -break-list
27260 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27261 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27262 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27263 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27264 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27265 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27266 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27267 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27268 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27269 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27270 times="0"@},
27271 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27272 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27273 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27274 times="0"@}]@}
27275 (gdb)
27276 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27277 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27278 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27279 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27280 @c times="0"@}
27281 @c (gdb)
27282 @end smallexample
27283
27284 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27285 @findex -dprintf-insert
27286
27287 @subsubheading Synopsis
27288
27289 @smallexample
27290 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27291 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27292 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27293 [ @var{argument} ]
27294 @end smallexample
27295
27296 @noindent
27297 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27298 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27299
27300 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27301
27302 @table @samp
27303 @item -t
27304 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27305 @item -f
27306 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27307 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27308 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27309 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27310 cannot be parsed.
27311 @item -d
27312 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27313 @item -c @var{condition}
27314 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27315 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27316 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27317 to @var{ignore-count}.
27318 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27319 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27320 @var{thread-id}.
27321 @end table
27322
27323 @subsubheading Result
27324
27325 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27326 resulting breakpoint.
27327
27328 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27329
27330 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27331
27332 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27333
27334 @subsubheading Example
27335
27336 @smallexample
27337 (gdb)
27338 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27339 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27340 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27341 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27342 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27343 original-location="foo"@}
27344 (gdb)
27345 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27346 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27347 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27348 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27349 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27350 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27351 (gdb)
27352 @end smallexample
27353
27354 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27355 @findex -break-list
27356
27357 @subsubheading Synopsis
27358
27359 @smallexample
27360 -break-list
27361 @end smallexample
27362
27363 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27364
27365 @table @samp
27366 @item Number
27367 number of the breakpoint
27368 @item Type
27369 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27370 @item Disposition
27371 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27372 or @samp{nokeep}
27373 @item Enabled
27374 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27375 @item Address
27376 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27377 @item What
27378 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27379 name, line number
27380 @item Thread-groups
27381 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27382 @item Times
27383 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27384 @end table
27385
27386 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27387 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27388
27389 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27390
27391 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27392
27393 @subsubheading Example
27394
27395 @smallexample
27396 (gdb)
27397 -break-list
27398 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27399 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27400 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27401 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27402 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27403 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27404 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27405 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27406 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27407 times="0"@},
27408 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27409 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27410 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27411 (gdb)
27412 @end smallexample
27413
27414 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27415
27416 @smallexample
27417 (gdb)
27418 -break-list
27419 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27420 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27421 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27422 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27423 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27424 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27425 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27426 body=[]@}
27427 (gdb)
27428 @end smallexample
27429
27430 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27431 @findex -break-passcount
27432
27433 @subsubheading Synopsis
27434
27435 @smallexample
27436 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27437 @end smallexample
27438
27439 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27440 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27441 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27442 command @samp{passcount}.
27443
27444 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27445 @findex -break-watch
27446
27447 @subsubheading Synopsis
27448
27449 @smallexample
27450 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27451 @end smallexample
27452
27453 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27454 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27455 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27456 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27457 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27458 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27459 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27460 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27461
27462 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27463 breakpoints inserted.
27464
27465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27466
27467 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27468 @samp{rwatch}.
27469
27470 @subsubheading Example
27471
27472 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27473
27474 @smallexample
27475 (gdb)
27476 -break-watch x
27477 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27478 (gdb)
27479 -exec-continue
27480 ^running
27481 (gdb)
27482 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27483 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27484 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27485 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27486 (gdb)
27487 @end smallexample
27488
27489 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27490 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27491 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27492
27493 @smallexample
27494 (gdb)
27495 -break-watch C
27496 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27497 (gdb)
27498 -exec-continue
27499 ^running
27500 (gdb)
27501 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27502 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27503 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27504 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27505 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27506 (gdb)
27507 -exec-continue
27508 ^running
27509 (gdb)
27510 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27511 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27512 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27513 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27514 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27515 (gdb)
27516 @end smallexample
27517
27518 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27519 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27520 deleted.
27521
27522 @smallexample
27523 (gdb)
27524 -break-watch C
27525 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27526 (gdb)
27527 -break-list
27528 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27529 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27530 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27531 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27532 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27533 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27534 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27535 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27536 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27537 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27538 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27539 times="1"@},
27540 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27541 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27542 (gdb)
27543 -exec-continue
27544 ^running
27545 (gdb)
27546 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27547 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27548 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27549 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27550 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27551 (gdb)
27552 -break-list
27553 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27554 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27555 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27556 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27557 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27558 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27559 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27560 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27561 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27562 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27563 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27564 times="1"@},
27565 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27566 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27567 (gdb)
27568 -exec-continue
27569 ^running
27570 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27571 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27572 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27573 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27574 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27575 (gdb)
27576 -break-list
27577 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27578 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27579 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27580 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27581 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27582 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27583 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27584 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27585 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27586 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27587 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27588 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27589 (gdb)
27590 @end smallexample
27591
27592
27593 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27594 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27595 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27596
27597 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27598 catchpoints.
27599
27600 @menu
27601 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27602 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27603 @end menu
27604
27605 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27606 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27607
27608 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27609 @findex -catch-load
27610
27611 @subsubheading Synopsis
27612
27613 @smallexample
27614 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27615 @end smallexample
27616
27617 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27618 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27619 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27620 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27621 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27622
27623
27624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27625
27626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27627
27628 @subsubheading Example
27629
27630 @smallexample
27631 -catch-load -t foo.so
27632 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27633 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27634 (gdb)
27635 @end smallexample
27636
27637
27638 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27639 @findex -catch-unload
27640
27641 @subsubheading Synopsis
27642
27643 @smallexample
27644 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27645 @end smallexample
27646
27647 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27648 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27649 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27650 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27651 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27652
27653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27654
27655 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27656
27657 @subsubheading Example
27658
27659 @smallexample
27660 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27661 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27662 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27663 (gdb)
27664 @end smallexample
27665
27666 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27667 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27668
27669 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27670 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27671
27672 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27673 @findex -catch-assert
27674
27675 @subsubheading Synopsis
27676
27677 @smallexample
27678 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27679 @end smallexample
27680
27681 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27682
27683 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27684
27685 @table @samp
27686 @item -c @var{condition}
27687 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27688 @item -d
27689 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27690 @item -t
27691 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27692 @end table
27693
27694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27695
27696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27697
27698 @subsubheading Example
27699
27700 @smallexample
27701 -catch-assert
27702 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27703 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27704 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27705 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27706 (gdb)
27707 @end smallexample
27708
27709 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27710 @findex -catch-exception
27711
27712 @subsubheading Synopsis
27713
27714 @smallexample
27715 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27716 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27717 @end smallexample
27718
27719 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27720 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27721 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27722 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27723 catchpoints.
27724
27725 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27726
27727 @table @samp
27728 @item -c @var{condition}
27729 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27730 @item -d
27731 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27732 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27733 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27734 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27735 @item -t
27736 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27737 @item -u
27738 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27739 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27740 @end table
27741
27742 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27743
27744 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27745 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27746
27747 @subsubheading Example
27748
27749 @smallexample
27750 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27751 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27752 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27753 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27754 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27755 (gdb)
27756 @end smallexample
27757
27758 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27759 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27760 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27761
27762 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27763 @findex -exec-arguments
27764
27765
27766 @subsubheading Synopsis
27767
27768 @smallexample
27769 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27770 @end smallexample
27771
27772 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27773 @samp{-exec-run}.
27774
27775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27776
27777 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27778
27779 @subsubheading Example
27780
27781 @smallexample
27782 (gdb)
27783 -exec-arguments -v word
27784 ^done
27785 (gdb)
27786 @end smallexample
27787
27788
27789 @ignore
27790 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27791 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27792
27793 @subsubheading Synopsis
27794
27795 @smallexample
27796 -exec-show-arguments
27797 @end smallexample
27798
27799 Print the arguments of the program.
27800
27801 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27802
27803 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27804
27805 @subsubheading Example
27806 N.A.
27807 @end ignore
27808
27809
27810 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27811 @findex -environment-cd
27812
27813 @subsubheading Synopsis
27814
27815 @smallexample
27816 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27817 @end smallexample
27818
27819 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27820
27821 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27822
27823 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27824
27825 @subsubheading Example
27826
27827 @smallexample
27828 (gdb)
27829 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27830 ^done
27831 (gdb)
27832 @end smallexample
27833
27834
27835 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27836 @findex -environment-directory
27837
27838 @subsubheading Synopsis
27839
27840 @smallexample
27841 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27842 @end smallexample
27843
27844 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27845 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27846 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27847 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27848 occurs as normal.
27849 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27850 multiple directories in a single command
27851 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27852 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27853 If blanks are needed as
27854 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27855 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27856 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27857 character must not be used
27858 in any directory name.
27859 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27860
27861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27862
27863 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27864
27865 @subsubheading Example
27866
27867 @smallexample
27868 (gdb)
27869 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27870 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27871 (gdb)
27872 -environment-directory ""
27873 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27874 (gdb)
27875 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27876 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27877 (gdb)
27878 -environment-directory -r
27879 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27880 (gdb)
27881 @end smallexample
27882
27883
27884 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27885 @findex -environment-path
27886
27887 @subsubheading Synopsis
27888
27889 @smallexample
27890 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27891 @end smallexample
27892
27893 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27894 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27895 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27896 supplied in addition to the
27897 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27898 occurs as normal.
27899 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27900 multiple directories in a single command
27901 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27902 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27903 If blanks are needed as
27904 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27905 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27906 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27907 character must not be used
27908 in any directory name.
27909 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27910
27911
27912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27913
27914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27915
27916 @subsubheading Example
27917
27918 @smallexample
27919 (gdb)
27920 -environment-path
27921 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27922 (gdb)
27923 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27924 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27925 (gdb)
27926 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27927 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27928 (gdb)
27929 @end smallexample
27930
27931
27932 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27933 @findex -environment-pwd
27934
27935 @subsubheading Synopsis
27936
27937 @smallexample
27938 -environment-pwd
27939 @end smallexample
27940
27941 Show the current working directory.
27942
27943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27944
27945 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27946
27947 @subsubheading Example
27948
27949 @smallexample
27950 (gdb)
27951 -environment-pwd
27952 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27953 (gdb)
27954 @end smallexample
27955
27956 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27957 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27958 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27959
27960
27961 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27962 @findex -thread-info
27963
27964 @subsubheading Synopsis
27965
27966 @smallexample
27967 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27968 @end smallexample
27969
27970 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27971 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27972 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
27973 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
27974 current thread.
27975
27976 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27977
27978 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27979 about all threads.
27980
27981 @subsubheading Result
27982
27983 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27984 defined for a given thread:
27985
27986 @table @samp
27987 @item current
27988 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27989
27990 @item id
27991 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27992
27993 @item target-id
27994 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27995
27996 @item details
27997 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27998 field is optional.
27999
28000 @item name
28001 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28002 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28003 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28004 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28005 field is omitted.
28006
28007 @item frame
28008 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
28009
28010 @item state
28011 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
28012 values:
28013
28014 @table @code
28015 @item stopped
28016 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
28017 threads.
28018
28019 @item running
28020 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
28021 threads.
28022
28023 @end table
28024
28025 @item core
28026 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
28027 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
28028
28029 @end table
28030
28031 @subsubheading Example
28032
28033 @smallexample
28034 -thread-info
28035 ^done,threads=[
28036 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28037 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28038 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28039 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28040 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28041 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28042 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28043 state="running"@}],
28044 current-thread-id="1"
28045 (gdb)
28046 @end smallexample
28047
28048 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28049 @findex -thread-list-ids
28050
28051 @subsubheading Synopsis
28052
28053 @smallexample
28054 -thread-list-ids
28055 @end smallexample
28056
28057 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28058 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28059 threads.
28060
28061 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28062 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28063
28064 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28065
28066 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28067
28068 @subsubheading Example
28069
28070 @smallexample
28071 (gdb)
28072 -thread-list-ids
28073 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28074 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28075 (gdb)
28076 @end smallexample
28077
28078
28079 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28080 @findex -thread-select
28081
28082 @subsubheading Synopsis
28083
28084 @smallexample
28085 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28086 @end smallexample
28087
28088 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28089 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28090 topmost frame for that thread.
28091
28092 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28093 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28094
28095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28096
28097 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28098
28099 @subsubheading Example
28100
28101 @smallexample
28102 (gdb)
28103 -exec-next
28104 ^running
28105 (gdb)
28106 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28107 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28108 (gdb)
28109 -thread-list-ids
28110 ^done,
28111 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28112 number-of-threads="3"
28113 (gdb)
28114 -thread-select 3
28115 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28116 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28117 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28118 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28119 (gdb)
28120 @end smallexample
28121
28122 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28123 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28124 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28125
28126 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28127 @findex -ada-task-info
28128
28129 @subsubheading Synopsis
28130
28131 @smallexample
28132 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28133 @end smallexample
28134
28135 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28136 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28137
28138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28139
28140 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28141 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28142
28143 @subsubheading Result
28144
28145 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28146 defined for each Ada task:
28147
28148 @table @samp
28149 @item current
28150 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28151
28152 @item id
28153 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28154
28155 @item task-id
28156 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28157
28158 @item thread-id
28159 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28160 task.
28161
28162 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28163 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28164 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28165
28166 @item parent-id
28167 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28168 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28169
28170 @item priority
28171 The base priority of the task.
28172
28173 @item state
28174 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28175 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28176
28177 @item name
28178 The name of the task.
28179
28180 @end table
28181
28182 @subsubheading Example
28183
28184 @smallexample
28185 -ada-task-info
28186 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28187 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28188 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28189 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28190 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28191 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28192 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28193 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28194 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28195 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28196 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28197 (gdb)
28198 @end smallexample
28199
28200 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28201 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28202 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28203
28204 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28205 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28206 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28207 other cases.
28208
28209 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28210 @findex -exec-continue
28211
28212 @subsubheading Synopsis
28213
28214 @smallexample
28215 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28216 @end smallexample
28217
28218 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28219 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28220 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28221 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28222 @itemize @bullet
28223 @item
28224 breakpoints or watchpoints
28225 @item
28226 signals or exceptions
28227 @item
28228 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28229 @item
28230 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28231 @end itemize
28232 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28233 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28234 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28235 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28236 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28237 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28238
28239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28240
28241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28242
28243 @subsubheading Example
28244
28245 @smallexample
28246 -exec-continue
28247 ^running
28248 (gdb)
28249 @@Hello world
28250 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28251 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28252 line="13"@}
28253 (gdb)
28254 @end smallexample
28255
28256
28257 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28258 @findex -exec-finish
28259
28260 @subsubheading Synopsis
28261
28262 @smallexample
28263 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28264 @end smallexample
28265
28266 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28267 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28268 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28269 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28270 function was called.
28271
28272 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28273
28274 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28275
28276 @subsubheading Example
28277
28278 Function returning @code{void}.
28279
28280 @smallexample
28281 -exec-finish
28282 ^running
28283 (gdb)
28284 @@hello from foo
28285 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28286 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28287 (gdb)
28288 @end smallexample
28289
28290 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28291 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28292 value itself.
28293
28294 @smallexample
28295 -exec-finish
28296 ^running
28297 (gdb)
28298 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28299 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28300 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28301 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28302 (gdb)
28303 @end smallexample
28304
28305
28306 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28307 @findex -exec-interrupt
28308
28309 @subsubheading Synopsis
28310
28311 @smallexample
28312 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28313 @end smallexample
28314
28315 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28316 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28317 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28318 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28319 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28320
28321 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28322 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28323 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28324 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28325
28326 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28327 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28328 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28329 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28330
28331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28332
28333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28334
28335 @subsubheading Example
28336
28337 @smallexample
28338 (gdb)
28339 111-exec-continue
28340 111^running
28341
28342 (gdb)
28343 222-exec-interrupt
28344 222^done
28345 (gdb)
28346 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28347 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28348 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28349 (gdb)
28350
28351 (gdb)
28352 -exec-interrupt
28353 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28354 (gdb)
28355 @end smallexample
28356
28357 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28358 @findex -exec-jump
28359
28360 @subsubheading Synopsis
28361
28362 @smallexample
28363 -exec-jump @var{location}
28364 @end smallexample
28365
28366 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28367 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28368 different forms of @var{location}.
28369
28370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28371
28372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28373
28374 @subsubheading Example
28375
28376 @smallexample
28377 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28378 *running,thread-id="all"
28379 ^running
28380 @end smallexample
28381
28382
28383 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28384 @findex -exec-next
28385
28386 @subsubheading Synopsis
28387
28388 @smallexample
28389 -exec-next [--reverse]
28390 @end smallexample
28391
28392 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28393 of the next source line is reached.
28394
28395 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28396 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28397 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28398 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28399 source line where the function was called.
28400
28401
28402 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28403
28404 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28405
28406 @subsubheading Example
28407
28408 @smallexample
28409 -exec-next
28410 ^running
28411 (gdb)
28412 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28413 (gdb)
28414 @end smallexample
28415
28416
28417 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28418 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28419
28420 @subsubheading Synopsis
28421
28422 @smallexample
28423 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28424 @end smallexample
28425
28426 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28427 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28428 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28429 printed as well.
28430
28431 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28432 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28433 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28434 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28435 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28436
28437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28438
28439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28440
28441 @subsubheading Example
28442
28443 @smallexample
28444 (gdb)
28445 -exec-next-instruction
28446 ^running
28447
28448 (gdb)
28449 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28450 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28451 (gdb)
28452 @end smallexample
28453
28454
28455 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28456 @findex -exec-return
28457
28458 @subsubheading Synopsis
28459
28460 @smallexample
28461 -exec-return
28462 @end smallexample
28463
28464 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28465 Displays the new current frame.
28466
28467 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28468
28469 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28470
28471 @subsubheading Example
28472
28473 @smallexample
28474 (gdb)
28475 200-break-insert callee4
28476 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28477 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28478 (gdb)
28479 000-exec-run
28480 000^running
28481 (gdb)
28482 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28483 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28484 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28485 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28486 (gdb)
28487 205-break-delete
28488 205^done
28489 (gdb)
28490 111-exec-return
28491 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28492 args=[@{name="strarg",
28493 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28494 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28495 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28496 (gdb)
28497 @end smallexample
28498
28499
28500 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28501 @findex -exec-run
28502
28503 @subsubheading Synopsis
28504
28505 @smallexample
28506 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28507 @end smallexample
28508
28509 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28510 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28511 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28512 the program has exited exceptionally.
28513
28514 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28515 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28516 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28517 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28518 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28519
28520 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28521 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28522 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28523 (@pxref{Starting}).
28524
28525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28526
28527 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28528
28529 @subsubheading Examples
28530
28531 @smallexample
28532 (gdb)
28533 -break-insert main
28534 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28535 (gdb)
28536 -exec-run
28537 ^running
28538 (gdb)
28539 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28540 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28541 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28542 (gdb)
28543 @end smallexample
28544
28545 @noindent
28546 Program exited normally:
28547
28548 @smallexample
28549 (gdb)
28550 -exec-run
28551 ^running
28552 (gdb)
28553 x = 55
28554 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28555 (gdb)
28556 @end smallexample
28557
28558 @noindent
28559 Program exited exceptionally:
28560
28561 @smallexample
28562 (gdb)
28563 -exec-run
28564 ^running
28565 (gdb)
28566 x = 55
28567 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28568 (gdb)
28569 @end smallexample
28570
28571 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28572 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28573
28574 @smallexample
28575 (gdb)
28576 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28577 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28578 @end smallexample
28579
28580
28581 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28582
28583
28584 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28585 @findex -exec-step
28586
28587 @subsubheading Synopsis
28588
28589 @smallexample
28590 -exec-step [--reverse]
28591 @end smallexample
28592
28593 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28594 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28595 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28596 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28597 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28598 previously executed source line.
28599
28600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28601
28602 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28603
28604 @subsubheading Example
28605
28606 Stepping into a function:
28607
28608 @smallexample
28609 -exec-step
28610 ^running
28611 (gdb)
28612 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28613 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28614 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28615 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28616 (gdb)
28617 @end smallexample
28618
28619 Regular stepping:
28620
28621 @smallexample
28622 -exec-step
28623 ^running
28624 (gdb)
28625 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28626 (gdb)
28627 @end smallexample
28628
28629
28630 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28631 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28632
28633 @subsubheading Synopsis
28634
28635 @smallexample
28636 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28637 @end smallexample
28638
28639 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28640 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28641 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28642 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28643 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28644 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28645 as well.
28646
28647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28648
28649 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28650
28651 @subsubheading Example
28652
28653 @smallexample
28654 (gdb)
28655 -exec-step-instruction
28656 ^running
28657
28658 (gdb)
28659 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28660 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28661 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28662 (gdb)
28663 -exec-step-instruction
28664 ^running
28665
28666 (gdb)
28667 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28668 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28669 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28670 (gdb)
28671 @end smallexample
28672
28673
28674 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28675 @findex -exec-until
28676
28677 @subsubheading Synopsis
28678
28679 @smallexample
28680 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28681 @end smallexample
28682
28683 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28684 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28685 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28686 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28687
28688 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28689
28690 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28691
28692 @subsubheading Example
28693
28694 @smallexample
28695 (gdb)
28696 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28697 ^running
28698 (gdb)
28699 x = 55
28700 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28701 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28702 (gdb)
28703 @end smallexample
28704
28705 @ignore
28706 @subheading -file-clear
28707 Is this going away????
28708 @end ignore
28709
28710 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28711 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28712 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28713
28714 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28715 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28716
28717 @smallexample
28718 -enable-frame-filters
28719 @end smallexample
28720
28721 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28722 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28723 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28724 request that this functionality be enabled.
28725
28726 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28727
28728 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28729 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28730
28731 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28732 @findex -stack-info-frame
28733
28734 @subsubheading Synopsis
28735
28736 @smallexample
28737 -stack-info-frame
28738 @end smallexample
28739
28740 Get info on the selected frame.
28741
28742 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28743
28744 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28745 (without arguments).
28746
28747 @subsubheading Example
28748
28749 @smallexample
28750 (gdb)
28751 -stack-info-frame
28752 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28753 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28754 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28755 (gdb)
28756 @end smallexample
28757
28758 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28759 @findex -stack-info-depth
28760
28761 @subsubheading Synopsis
28762
28763 @smallexample
28764 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28765 @end smallexample
28766
28767 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28768 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28769
28770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28771
28772 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28773
28774 @subsubheading Example
28775
28776 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28777
28778 @smallexample
28779 (gdb)
28780 -stack-info-depth
28781 ^done,depth="12"
28782 (gdb)
28783 -stack-info-depth 4
28784 ^done,depth="4"
28785 (gdb)
28786 -stack-info-depth 12
28787 ^done,depth="12"
28788 (gdb)
28789 -stack-info-depth 11
28790 ^done,depth="11"
28791 (gdb)
28792 -stack-info-depth 13
28793 ^done,depth="12"
28794 (gdb)
28795 @end smallexample
28796
28797 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28798 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28799 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28800
28801 @subsubheading Synopsis
28802
28803 @smallexample
28804 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28805 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28806 @end smallexample
28807
28808 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28809 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28810 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28811 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28812 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28813 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28814 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28815 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28816
28817 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28818 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28819 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28820 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28821 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28822 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28823
28824 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28825 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28826 are still displayed, however.
28827
28828 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28829 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28830
28831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28832
28833 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28834 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28835 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28836
28837 @subsubheading Example
28838
28839 @smallexample
28840 (gdb)
28841 -stack-list-frames
28842 ^done,
28843 stack=[
28844 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28845 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28846 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28847 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28848 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28849 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28850 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28851 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28852 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28853 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28854 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28855 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28856 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28857 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28858 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28859 (gdb)
28860 -stack-list-arguments 0
28861 ^done,
28862 stack-args=[
28863 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28864 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28865 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28866 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28867 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28868 (gdb)
28869 -stack-list-arguments 1
28870 ^done,
28871 stack-args=[
28872 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28873 frame=@{level="1",
28874 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28875 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28876 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28877 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28878 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28879 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28880 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28881 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28882 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28883 (gdb)
28884 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28885 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28886 (gdb)
28887 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28888 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28889 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28890 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28891 (gdb)
28892 @end smallexample
28893
28894 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28895
28896
28897 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28898 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28899 @findex -stack-list-frames
28900
28901 @subsubheading Synopsis
28902
28903 @smallexample
28904 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28905 @end smallexample
28906
28907 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28908 following info:
28909
28910 @table @samp
28911 @item @var{level}
28912 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28913 @item @var{addr}
28914 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28915 @item @var{func}
28916 Function name.
28917 @item @var{file}
28918 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28919 @item @var{fullname}
28920 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28921 @item @var{line}
28922 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28923 @item @var{from}
28924 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28925 if the frame's function is not known.
28926 @end table
28927
28928 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28929 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28930 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28931 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28932 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28933 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28934 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28935 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28936 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28937
28938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28939
28940 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28941
28942 @subsubheading Example
28943
28944 Full stack backtrace:
28945
28946 @smallexample
28947 (gdb)
28948 -stack-list-frames
28949 ^done,stack=
28950 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28951 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28952 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28953 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28954 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28955 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28956 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28957 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28958 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28959 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28960 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28961 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28962 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28963 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28964 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28965 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28966 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28967 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28968 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28969 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28970 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28971 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28972 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28973 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28974 (gdb)
28975 @end smallexample
28976
28977 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28978
28979 @smallexample
28980 (gdb)
28981 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28982 ^done,stack=
28983 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28984 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28985 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28986 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28987 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28988 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28989 (gdb)
28990 @end smallexample
28991
28992 Show a single frame:
28993
28994 @smallexample
28995 (gdb)
28996 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28997 ^done,stack=
28998 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28999 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29000 (gdb)
29001 @end smallexample
29002
29003
29004 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29005 @findex -stack-list-locals
29006 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29007
29008 @subsubheading Synopsis
29009
29010 @smallexample
29011 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29012 @end smallexample
29013
29014 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29015 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29016 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29017 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29018 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29019 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29020 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29021 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29022 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29023 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29024
29025 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29026 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29027 variables are still displayed, however.
29028
29029 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29030 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29031
29032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29033
29034 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29035
29036 @subsubheading Example
29037
29038 @smallexample
29039 (gdb)
29040 -stack-list-locals 0
29041 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29042 (gdb)
29043 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29044 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29045 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29046 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29047 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29048 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29049 (gdb)
29050 @end smallexample
29051
29052 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29053 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29054 @findex -stack-list-variables
29055
29056 @subsubheading Synopsis
29057
29058 @smallexample
29059 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29060 @end smallexample
29061
29062 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29063 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29064 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29065 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29066 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29067 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29068 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29069
29070 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29071 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29072 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29073
29074 @subsubheading Example
29075
29076 @smallexample
29077 (gdb)
29078 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29079 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29080 (gdb)
29081 @end smallexample
29082
29083
29084 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29085 @findex -stack-select-frame
29086
29087 @subsubheading Synopsis
29088
29089 @smallexample
29090 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29091 @end smallexample
29092
29093 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29094 the stack.
29095
29096 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29097 option to every command.
29098
29099 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29100
29101 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29102 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29103
29104 @subsubheading Example
29105
29106 @smallexample
29107 (gdb)
29108 -stack-select-frame 2
29109 ^done
29110 (gdb)
29111 @end smallexample
29112
29113 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29114 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29115 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29116
29117 @ignore
29118
29119 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29120
29121 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29122 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29123 used by @code{Insight}.
29124
29125 The two main reasons for that are:
29126
29127 @enumerate 1
29128 @item
29129 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29130
29131 @item
29132 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29133 now).
29134 @end enumerate
29135
29136 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29137 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29138 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29139 hints about their use.
29140
29141 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29142 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29143 least, the following operations:
29144
29145 @itemize @bullet
29146 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29147 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29148 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29149 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29150 @end itemize
29151
29152 @end ignore
29153
29154 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29155
29156 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29157
29158 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29159 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29160 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29161 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29162 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29163 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29164 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29165 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29166 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29167 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29168 object, or to change display format.
29169
29170 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29171 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29172 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29173 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29174 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29175 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29176 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29177 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29178 child will be created.
29179
29180 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29181 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29182 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29183 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29184 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29185
29186 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29187 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29188 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29189 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29190 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29191 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29192 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29193 variables that frontend has created.
29194
29195 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29196 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29197 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29198 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29199 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29200 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29201 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29202 implicitly updated.
29203
29204 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29205 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29206 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29207 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29208 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29209 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29210 frame. Consider this example:
29211
29212 @smallexample
29213 void do_work(...)
29214 @{
29215 struct work_state state;
29216
29217 if (...)
29218 do_work(...);
29219 @}
29220 @end smallexample
29221
29222 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29223 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29224 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29225 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29226 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29227
29228 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29229 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29230 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29231 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29232 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29233 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29234
29235 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29236 access this functionality:
29237
29238 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29239 @item @strong{Operation}
29240 @tab @strong{Description}
29241
29242 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29243 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29244 @item @code{-var-create}
29245 @tab create a variable object
29246 @item @code{-var-delete}
29247 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29248 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29249 @tab set the display format of this variable
29250 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29251 @tab show the display format of this variable
29252 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29253 @tab tells how many children this object has
29254 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29255 @tab return a list of the object's children
29256 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29257 @tab show the type of this variable object
29258 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29259 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29260 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29261 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29262 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29263 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29264 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29265 @tab get the value of this variable
29266 @item @code{-var-assign}
29267 @tab set the value of this variable
29268 @item @code{-var-update}
29269 @tab update the variable and its children
29270 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29271 @tab set frozeness attribute
29272 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29273 @tab set range of children to display on update
29274 @end multitable
29275
29276 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29277 how it can be used.
29278
29279 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29280
29281 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29282 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29283
29284 @smallexample
29285 -enable-pretty-printing
29286 @end smallexample
29287
29288 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29289 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29290 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29291 request that this functionality be enabled.
29292
29293 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29294
29295 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29296 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29297
29298 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29299 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29300
29301 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29302 @findex -var-create
29303
29304 @subsubheading Synopsis
29305
29306 @smallexample
29307 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29308 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29309 @end smallexample
29310
29311 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29312 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29313 register.
29314
29315 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29316 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29317 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29318 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29319 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29320
29321 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29322 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29323 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29324 object must be created.
29325
29326 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29327 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29328
29329 @itemize @bullet
29330 @item
29331 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29332
29333 @item
29334 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29335
29336 @item
29337 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29338 @end itemize
29339
29340 @cindex dynamic varobj
29341 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29342 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29343 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29344 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29345 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29346 compatibility for existing clients.
29347
29348 @subsubheading Result
29349
29350 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29351 are:
29352
29353 @table @samp
29354 @item name
29355 The name of the varobj.
29356
29357 @item numchild
29358 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29359 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29360 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29361
29362 @item value
29363 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29364 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29365 will not be interesting.
29366
29367 @item type
29368 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29369 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29370 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29371 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29372 @emph{declared} one.
29373
29374 @item thread-id
29375 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29376 thread's global identifier.
29377
29378 @item has_more
29379 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29380 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29381
29382 @item dynamic
29383 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29384 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29385 then this attribute will not be present.
29386
29387 @item displayhint
29388 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29389 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29390 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29391 @end table
29392
29393 Typical output will look like this:
29394
29395 @smallexample
29396 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29397 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29398 @end smallexample
29399
29400
29401 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29402 @findex -var-delete
29403
29404 @subsubheading Synopsis
29405
29406 @smallexample
29407 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29408 @end smallexample
29409
29410 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29411 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29412
29413 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29414
29415
29416 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29417 @findex -var-set-format
29418
29419 @subsubheading Synopsis
29420
29421 @smallexample
29422 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29423 @end smallexample
29424
29425 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29426 @var{format-spec}.
29427
29428 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29429 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29430
29431 @smallexample
29432 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29433 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29434 @end smallexample
29435
29436 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29437 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29438 for pointers, etc.).
29439
29440 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29441 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29442 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29443 zero-hexadecimal format.
29444
29445 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29446 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29447
29448 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29449 @findex -var-show-format
29450
29451 @subsubheading Synopsis
29452
29453 @smallexample
29454 -var-show-format @var{name}
29455 @end smallexample
29456
29457 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29458
29459 @smallexample
29460 @var{format} @expansion{}
29461 @var{format-spec}
29462 @end smallexample
29463
29464
29465 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29466 @findex -var-info-num-children
29467
29468 @subsubheading Synopsis
29469
29470 @smallexample
29471 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29472 @end smallexample
29473
29474 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29475
29476 @smallexample
29477 numchild=@var{n}
29478 @end smallexample
29479
29480 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29481 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29482 be available.
29483
29484
29485 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29486 @findex -var-list-children
29487
29488 @subsubheading Synopsis
29489
29490 @smallexample
29491 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29492 @end smallexample
29493 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29494
29495 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29496 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29497 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29498 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29499 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29500 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29501 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29502 and unions.
29503
29504 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29505 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29506 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29507 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29508 reported.
29509
29510 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29511 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29512 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29513 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29514 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29515 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29516 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29517 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29518 the visible items.
29519
29520 For each child the following results are returned:
29521
29522 @table @var
29523
29524 @item name
29525 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29526
29527 @item exp
29528 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29529 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29530
29531 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29532 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29533
29534 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29535 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29536 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29537 type and value are not present.
29538
29539 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29540 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29541 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29542
29543 @item numchild
29544 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29545 0.
29546
29547 @item type
29548 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29549 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29550 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29551 @emph{declared} one.
29552
29553 @item value
29554 If values were requested, this is the value.
29555
29556 @item thread-id
29557 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29558 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29559
29560 @item frozen
29561 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29562
29563 @item displayhint
29564 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29565 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29566 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29567
29568 @item dynamic
29569 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29570 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29571 then this attribute will not be present.
29572
29573 @end table
29574
29575 The result may have its own attributes:
29576
29577 @table @samp
29578 @item displayhint
29579 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29580 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29581 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29582
29583 @item has_more
29584 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29585 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29586 @end table
29587
29588 @subsubheading Example
29589
29590 @smallexample
29591 (gdb)
29592 -var-list-children n
29593 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29594 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29595 (gdb)
29596 -var-list-children --all-values n
29597 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29598 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29599 @end smallexample
29600
29601
29602 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29603 @findex -var-info-type
29604
29605 @subsubheading Synopsis
29606
29607 @smallexample
29608 -var-info-type @var{name}
29609 @end smallexample
29610
29611 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29612 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29613 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29614
29615 @smallexample
29616 type=@var{typename}
29617 @end smallexample
29618
29619
29620 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29621 @findex -var-info-expression
29622
29623 @subsubheading Synopsis
29624
29625 @smallexample
29626 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29627 @end smallexample
29628
29629 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29630 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29631 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29632
29633 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29634 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29635
29636 @smallexample
29637 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29638 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29639 @end smallexample
29640
29641 @noindent
29642 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29643 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29644
29645 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29646 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29647 is of limited use.
29648
29649 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29650 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29651
29652 @subsubheading Synopsis
29653
29654 @smallexample
29655 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29656 @end smallexample
29657
29658 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29659 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29660 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29661 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29662 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29663 watchpoint from a variable object.
29664
29665 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29666 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29667
29668 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29669 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29670 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29671 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29672 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29673 @smallexample
29674 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29675 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29676 @end smallexample
29677
29678 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29679 @findex -var-show-attributes
29680
29681 @subsubheading Synopsis
29682
29683 @smallexample
29684 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29685 @end smallexample
29686
29687 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29688
29689 @smallexample
29690 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29691 @end smallexample
29692
29693 @noindent
29694 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29695
29696 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29697 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29698
29699 @subsubheading Synopsis
29700
29701 @smallexample
29702 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29703 @end smallexample
29704
29705 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29706 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29707 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29708 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29709 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29710 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29711 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29712
29713 @smallexample
29714 value=@var{value}
29715 @end smallexample
29716
29717 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29718 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29719
29720 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29721 @findex -var-assign
29722
29723 @subsubheading Synopsis
29724
29725 @smallexample
29726 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29727 @end smallexample
29728
29729 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29730 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29731 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29732 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29733
29734 @subsubheading Example
29735
29736 @smallexample
29737 (gdb)
29738 -var-assign var1 3
29739 ^done,value="3"
29740 (gdb)
29741 -var-update *
29742 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29743 (gdb)
29744 @end smallexample
29745
29746 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29747 @findex -var-update
29748
29749 @subsubheading Synopsis
29750
29751 @smallexample
29752 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29753 @end smallexample
29754
29755 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29756 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29757 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29758 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29759 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29760 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29761 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29762 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29763 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29764 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29765 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29766 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29767 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29768
29769 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29770 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29771 diagnostic.
29772
29773 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29774 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29775
29776 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29777 @samp{changelist}.
29778
29779 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29780
29781 @table @samp
29782 @item name
29783 The name of the varobj.
29784
29785 @item value
29786 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29787 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29788
29789 @item in_scope
29790 @anchor{-var-update}
29791 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29792
29793 @table @code
29794 @item "true"
29795 The variable object's current value is valid.
29796
29797 @item "false"
29798 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29799 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29800 scope.
29801
29802 @item "invalid"
29803 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29804 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29805 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29806 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29807 objects.
29808 @end table
29809
29810 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29811 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29812
29813 @item type_changed
29814 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29815 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29816 be @samp{false}.
29817
29818 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29819 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29820 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29821 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29822 unset.
29823
29824 @item new_type
29825 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29826 hold the new type.
29827
29828 @item new_num_children
29829 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29830 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29831
29832 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29833 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29834 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29835 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29836 children which may be available.
29837
29838 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29839 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29840 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29841 only happen at the end of the update range).
29842
29843 @item displayhint
29844 The display hint, if any.
29845
29846 @item has_more
29847 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29848 available outside the varobj's update range.
29849
29850 @item dynamic
29851 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29852 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29853 then this attribute will not be present.
29854
29855 @item new_children
29856 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29857 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29858 be listed in this attribute.
29859 @end table
29860
29861 @subsubheading Example
29862
29863 @smallexample
29864 (gdb)
29865 -var-assign var1 3
29866 ^done,value="3"
29867 (gdb)
29868 -var-update --all-values var1
29869 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29870 type_changed="false"@}]
29871 (gdb)
29872 @end smallexample
29873
29874 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29875 @findex -var-set-frozen
29876 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29877
29878 @subsubheading Synopsis
29879
29880 @smallexample
29881 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29882 @end smallexample
29883
29884 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29885 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29886 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29887 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29888 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29889 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29890 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29891 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29892 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29893 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29894 @code{-var-update} does.
29895
29896 @subsubheading Example
29897
29898 @smallexample
29899 (gdb)
29900 -var-set-frozen V 1
29901 ^done
29902 (gdb)
29903 @end smallexample
29904
29905 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29906 @findex -var-set-update-range
29907 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29908
29909 @subsubheading Synopsis
29910
29911 @smallexample
29912 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29913 @end smallexample
29914
29915 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29916 @code{-var-update}.
29917
29918 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29919 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29920 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29921 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29922
29923 @subsubheading Example
29924
29925 @smallexample
29926 (gdb)
29927 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29928 ^done
29929 @end smallexample
29930
29931 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29932 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29933 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29934
29935 @subsubheading Synopsis
29936
29937 @smallexample
29938 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29939 @end smallexample
29940
29941 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29942
29943 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29944 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29945
29946 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29947 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29948 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29949 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29950 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29951 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29952 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29953
29954 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29955 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29956 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29957 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29958
29959 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29960 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29961 can be used to check this.
29962
29963 @subsubheading Example
29964
29965 Resetting the visualizer:
29966
29967 @smallexample
29968 (gdb)
29969 -var-set-visualizer V None
29970 ^done
29971 @end smallexample
29972
29973 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29974
29975 @smallexample
29976 (gdb)
29977 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29978 ^done
29979 @end smallexample
29980
29981 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29982 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29983
29984 @smallexample
29985 (gdb)
29986 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29987 ^done
29988 @end smallexample
29989
29990 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29991 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29992 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29993
29994 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29995 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29996 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29997 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29998
29999 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30000 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30001
30002 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30003 @c @subheading -data-assign
30004 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30005 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30006 @c set variable
30007 @c @subsubheading Example
30008 @c N.A.
30009
30010 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30011 @findex -data-disassemble
30012
30013 @subsubheading Synopsis
30014
30015 @smallexample
30016 -data-disassemble
30017 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30018 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30019 -- @var{mode}
30020 @end smallexample
30021
30022 @noindent
30023 Where:
30024
30025 @table @samp
30026 @item @var{start-addr}
30027 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30028 @item @var{end-addr}
30029 is the end address
30030 @item @var{filename}
30031 is the name of the file to disassemble
30032 @item @var{linenum}
30033 is the line number to disassemble around
30034 @item @var{lines}
30035 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30036 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30037 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30038 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30039 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30040 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30041 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30042 are displayed.
30043 @item @var{mode}
30044 is one of:
30045 @itemize @bullet
30046 @item 0 disassembly only
30047 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30048 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30049 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30050 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30051 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30052 @end itemize
30053
30054 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30055 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30056 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30057 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30058 @end table
30059
30060 @subsubheading Result
30061
30062 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30063 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30064 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30065
30066 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30067 following fields:
30068
30069 @table @code
30070 @item address
30071 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30072
30073 @item func-name
30074 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30075
30076 @item offset
30077 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30078
30079 @item inst
30080 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30081
30082 @item opcodes
30083 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30084 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30085
30086 @end table
30087
30088 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30089 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30090
30091 @table @code
30092 @item line
30093 The line number within @samp{file}.
30094
30095 @item file
30096 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30097 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30098 used.
30099
30100 @item fullname
30101 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30102 using the source file search path
30103 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30104 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30105
30106 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30107 present in the debug information.
30108
30109 @item line_asm_insn
30110 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30111 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30112 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30113 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30114 @samp{opcodes}.
30115
30116 @end table
30117
30118 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30119 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30120 adjust its format.
30121
30122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30123
30124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30125
30126 @subsubheading Example
30127
30128 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30129
30130 @smallexample
30131 (gdb)
30132 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30133 ^done,
30134 asm_insns=[
30135 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30136 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30137 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30138 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30139 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30140 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30141 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30142 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30143 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30144 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30145 (gdb)
30146 @end smallexample
30147
30148 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30149 @code{main}.
30150
30151 @smallexample
30152 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30153 ^done,asm_insns=[
30154 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30155 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30156 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30157 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30158 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30159 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30160 [@dots{}]
30161 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30162 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30163 (gdb)
30164 @end smallexample
30165
30166 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30167
30168 @smallexample
30169 (gdb)
30170 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30171 ^done,asm_insns=[
30172 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30173 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30174 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30175 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30176 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30177 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30178 (gdb)
30179 @end smallexample
30180
30181 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30182
30183 @smallexample
30184 (gdb)
30185 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30186 ^done,asm_insns=[
30187 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30188 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30189 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30190 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30191 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30192 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30193 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30194 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30195 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30196 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30197 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30198 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30199 (gdb)
30200 @end smallexample
30201
30202
30203 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30204 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30205
30206 @subsubheading Synopsis
30207
30208 @smallexample
30209 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30210 @end smallexample
30211
30212 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30213 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30214 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30215
30216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30217
30218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30219 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30220 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30221
30222 @subsubheading Example
30223
30224 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30225 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30226 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30227 output.
30228
30229 @smallexample
30230 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30231 211^done,value="1"
30232 (gdb)
30233 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30234 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30235 (gdb)
30236 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30237 411^done,value="4"
30238 (gdb)
30239 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30240 511^done,value="4"
30241 (gdb)
30242 @end smallexample
30243
30244
30245 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30246 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30247
30248 @subsubheading Synopsis
30249
30250 @smallexample
30251 -data-list-changed-registers
30252 @end smallexample
30253
30254 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30255
30256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30257
30258 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30259 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30260
30261 @subsubheading Example
30262
30263 On a PPC MBX board:
30264
30265 @smallexample
30266 (gdb)
30267 -exec-continue
30268 ^running
30269
30270 (gdb)
30271 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30272 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30273 line="5"@}
30274 (gdb)
30275 -data-list-changed-registers
30276 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30277 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30278 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30279 (gdb)
30280 @end smallexample
30281
30282
30283 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30284 @findex -data-list-register-names
30285
30286 @subsubheading Synopsis
30287
30288 @smallexample
30289 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30290 @end smallexample
30291
30292 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30293 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30294 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30295 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30296 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30297 include empty register names.
30298
30299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30300
30301 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30302 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30303 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30304
30305 @subsubheading Example
30306
30307 For the PPC MBX board:
30308 @smallexample
30309 (gdb)
30310 -data-list-register-names
30311 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30312 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30313 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30314 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30315 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30316 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30317 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30318 (gdb)
30319 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30320 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30321 (gdb)
30322 @end smallexample
30323
30324 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30325 @findex -data-list-register-values
30326
30327 @subsubheading Synopsis
30328
30329 @smallexample
30330 -data-list-register-values
30331 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30332 @end smallexample
30333
30334 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30335 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30336 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30337 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30338 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30339 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30340
30341 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30342
30343 @table @code
30344 @item x
30345 Hexadecimal
30346 @item o
30347 Octal
30348 @item t
30349 Binary
30350 @item d
30351 Decimal
30352 @item r
30353 Raw
30354 @item N
30355 Natural
30356 @end table
30357
30358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30359
30360 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30361 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30362
30363 @subsubheading Example
30364
30365 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30366 don't appear in the actual output):
30367
30368 @smallexample
30369 (gdb)
30370 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30371 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30372 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30373 (gdb)
30374 -data-list-register-values x
30375 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30376 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30377 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30378 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30379 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30380 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30381 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30382 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30383 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30384 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30385 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30386 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30387 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30388 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30389 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30390 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30391 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30392 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30393 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30394 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30395 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30396 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30397 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30398 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30399 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30400 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30401 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30402 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30403 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30404 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30405 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30406 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30407 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30408 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30409 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30410 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30411 (gdb)
30412 @end smallexample
30413
30414
30415 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30416 @findex -data-read-memory
30417
30418 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30419
30420 @subsubheading Synopsis
30421
30422 @smallexample
30423 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30424 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30425 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30426 @end smallexample
30427
30428 @noindent
30429 where:
30430
30431 @table @samp
30432 @item @var{address}
30433 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30434 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30435 quoted using the C convention.
30436
30437 @item @var{word-format}
30438 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30439 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30440 ,Output Formats}).
30441
30442 @item @var{word-size}
30443 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30444
30445 @item @var{nr-rows}
30446 The number of rows in the output table.
30447
30448 @item @var{nr-cols}
30449 The number of columns in the output table.
30450
30451 @item @var{aschar}
30452 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30453 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30454 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30455 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30456
30457 @item @var{byte-offset}
30458 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30459 @end table
30460
30461 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30462 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30463 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30464 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30465 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30466 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30467 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30468 @samp{addr}.
30469
30470 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30471 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30472 @samp{prev-page}.
30473
30474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30475
30476 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30477 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30478
30479 @subsubheading Example
30480
30481 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30482 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30483 word. Display each word in hex.
30484
30485 @smallexample
30486 (gdb)
30487 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30488 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30489 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30490 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30491 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30492 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30493 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30494 (gdb)
30495 @end smallexample
30496
30497 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30498 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30499
30500 @smallexample
30501 (gdb)
30502 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30503 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30504 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30505 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30506 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30507 (gdb)
30508 @end smallexample
30509
30510 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30511 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30512 used as the non-printable character.
30513
30514 @smallexample
30515 (gdb)
30516 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30517 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30518 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30519 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30520 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30521 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30522 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30523 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30524 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30525 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30526 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30527 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30528 (gdb)
30529 @end smallexample
30530
30531 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30532 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30533
30534 @subsubheading Synopsis
30535
30536 @smallexample
30537 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30538 @var{address} @var{count}
30539 @end smallexample
30540
30541 @noindent
30542 where:
30543
30544 @table @samp
30545 @item @var{address}
30546 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30547 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30548 quoted using the C convention.
30549
30550 @item @var{count}
30551 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30552 literal.
30553
30554 @item @var{offset}
30555 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30556 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30557 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30558 arithmetics itself.
30559
30560 @end table
30561
30562 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30563 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30564 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30565 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30566 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30567 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30568
30569 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30570 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30571 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30572 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30573 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30574 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30575 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30576 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30577
30578 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30579 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30580 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30581 and has the following fields:
30582
30583 @table @code
30584 @item begin
30585 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30586
30587 @item end
30588 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30589
30590 @item offset
30591 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30592 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30593
30594 @item contents
30595 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30596
30597 @end table
30598
30599
30600
30601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30602
30603 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30604
30605 @subsubheading Example
30606
30607 @smallexample
30608 (gdb)
30609 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30610 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30611 end="0xbffff15e",
30612 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30613 (gdb)
30614 @end smallexample
30615
30616
30617 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30618 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30619
30620 @subsubheading Synopsis
30621
30622 @smallexample
30623 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30624 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30625 @end smallexample
30626
30627 @noindent
30628 where:
30629
30630 @table @samp
30631 @item @var{address}
30632 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30633 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30634 be quoted using the C convention.
30635
30636 @item @var{contents}
30637 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30638 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30639
30640 @item @var{count}
30641 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30642 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30643 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30644 @var{count} memory units.
30645
30646 @end table
30647
30648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30649
30650 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30651
30652 @subsubheading Example
30653
30654 @smallexample
30655 (gdb)
30656 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30657 ^done
30658 (gdb)
30659 @end smallexample
30660
30661 @smallexample
30662 (gdb)
30663 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30664 ^done
30665 (gdb)
30666 @end smallexample
30667
30668 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30669 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30670 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30671
30672 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30673 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30674
30675 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30676 @findex -trace-find
30677
30678 @subsubheading Synopsis
30679
30680 @smallexample
30681 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30682 @end smallexample
30683
30684 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30685 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30686 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30687
30688 @table @samp
30689
30690 @item none
30691 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30692
30693 @item frame-number
30694 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30695 that index.
30696
30697 @item tracepoint-number
30698 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30699 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30700
30701 @item pc
30702 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30703 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30704 address.
30705
30706 @item pc-inside-range
30707 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30708 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30709 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30710
30711 @item pc-outside-range
30712 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30713 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30714 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30715
30716 @item line
30717 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30718 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30719 the specified location.
30720
30721 @end table
30722
30723 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30724 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30725
30726 @table @samp
30727 @item found
30728 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30729 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30730
30731 @item traceframe
30732 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30733 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30734
30735 @item tracepoint
30736 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30737 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30738
30739 @item frame
30740 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30741 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30742 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30743
30744 @end table
30745
30746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30747
30748 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30749
30750 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30751 @findex -trace-define-variable
30752
30753 @subsubheading Synopsis
30754
30755 @smallexample
30756 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30757 @end smallexample
30758
30759 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30760 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30761 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30762 with the @samp{$} character.
30763
30764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30765
30766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30767
30768 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30769 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30770
30771 @subsubheading Synopsis
30772
30773 @smallexample
30774 -trace-frame-collected
30775 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30776 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30777 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30778 [--memory-contents]
30779 @end smallexample
30780
30781 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30782 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30783 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30784 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30785 See the output description table below for more details.
30786
30787 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30788 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30789 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30790 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30791 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30792
30793 For instance, if the actions were
30794 @smallexample
30795 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30796 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30797 @end smallexample
30798
30799 @noindent
30800 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30801 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30802 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30803 objects would be computed expressions.
30804
30805 An example output would be:
30806
30807 @smallexample
30808 (gdb)
30809 -trace-frame-collected
30810 ^done,
30811 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30812 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30813 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30814 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30815 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30816 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30817 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30818 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30819 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30820 ...
30821 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30822 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30823 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30824 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30825 (gdb)
30826 @end smallexample
30827
30828 Where:
30829
30830 @table @code
30831 @item explicit-variables
30832 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30833 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30834 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30835 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30836 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30837 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30838 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30839 arrays, structures and unions.
30840
30841 @item computed-expressions
30842 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30843 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30844 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30845 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30846
30847 @item registers
30848 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30849 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30850 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30851 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30852 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30853
30854 @item tvars
30855 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30856 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30857 current value are returned.
30858
30859 @item memory
30860 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30861 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30862 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30863
30864 @table @code
30865 @item address
30866 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30867
30868 @item length
30869 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30870
30871 @item contents
30872 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30873 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30874
30875 @end table
30876
30877 @end table
30878
30879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30880
30881 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30882
30883 @subsubheading Example
30884
30885 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30886 @findex -trace-list-variables
30887
30888 @subsubheading Synopsis
30889
30890 @smallexample
30891 -trace-list-variables
30892 @end smallexample
30893
30894 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30895 table has the following fields:
30896
30897 @table @samp
30898 @item name
30899 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30900
30901 @item initial
30902 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30903 field is always present.
30904
30905 @item current
30906 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30907 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30908 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30909 presently running.
30910
30911 @end table
30912
30913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30914
30915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30916
30917 @subsubheading Example
30918
30919 @smallexample
30920 (gdb)
30921 -trace-list-variables
30922 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30923 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30924 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30925 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30926 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30927 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30928 (gdb)
30929 @end smallexample
30930
30931 @subheading -trace-save
30932 @findex -trace-save
30933
30934 @subsubheading Synopsis
30935
30936 @smallexample
30937 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
30938 @end smallexample
30939
30940 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30941 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30942 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30943 to perform the save.
30944
30945 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
30946 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
30947 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
30948
30949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30950
30951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30952
30953
30954 @subheading -trace-start
30955 @findex -trace-start
30956
30957 @subsubheading Synopsis
30958
30959 @smallexample
30960 -trace-start
30961 @end smallexample
30962
30963 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
30964 have any fields.
30965
30966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30967
30968 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30969
30970 @subheading -trace-status
30971 @findex -trace-status
30972
30973 @subsubheading Synopsis
30974
30975 @smallexample
30976 -trace-status
30977 @end smallexample
30978
30979 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30980 the following fields:
30981
30982 @table @samp
30983
30984 @item supported
30985 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30986 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30987 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30988 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30989 started. This field is always present.
30990
30991 @item running
30992 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30993 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30994 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30995
30996 @item stop-reason
30997 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30998 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30999 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31000 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31001 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31002 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31003 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31004 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31005 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31006
31007 @item stopping-tracepoint
31008 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31009 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31010 @samp{passcount}.
31011
31012 @item frames
31013 @itemx frames-created
31014 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31015 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31016 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31017 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31018
31019 @item buffer-size
31020 @itemx buffer-free
31021 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31022 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31023
31024 @item circular
31025 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31026 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31027 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31028 and may fill up.
31029
31030 @item disconnected
31031 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31032 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31033 that the trace run will stop.
31034
31035 @item trace-file
31036 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31037 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31038
31039 @end table
31040
31041 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31042
31043 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31044
31045 @subheading -trace-stop
31046 @findex -trace-stop
31047
31048 @subsubheading Synopsis
31049
31050 @smallexample
31051 -trace-stop
31052 @end smallexample
31053
31054 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31055 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31056 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31057
31058 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31059
31060 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31061
31062
31063 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31064 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31065 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31066
31067
31068 @ignore
31069 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31070 @findex -symbol-info-address
31071
31072 @subsubheading Synopsis
31073
31074 @smallexample
31075 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31076 @end smallexample
31077
31078 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31079
31080 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31081
31082 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31083
31084 @subsubheading Example
31085 N.A.
31086
31087
31088 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31089 @findex -symbol-info-file
31090
31091 @subsubheading Synopsis
31092
31093 @smallexample
31094 -symbol-info-file
31095 @end smallexample
31096
31097 Show the file for the symbol.
31098
31099 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31100
31101 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31102 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31103
31104 @subsubheading Example
31105 N.A.
31106
31107
31108 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31109 @findex -symbol-info-function
31110
31111 @subsubheading Synopsis
31112
31113 @smallexample
31114 -symbol-info-function
31115 @end smallexample
31116
31117 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31118
31119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31120
31121 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31122
31123 @subsubheading Example
31124 N.A.
31125
31126
31127 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31128 @findex -symbol-info-line
31129
31130 @subsubheading Synopsis
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 -symbol-info-line
31134 @end smallexample
31135
31136 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31137
31138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31139
31140 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31141 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31142
31143 @subsubheading Example
31144 N.A.
31145
31146
31147 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31148 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31149
31150 @subsubheading Synopsis
31151
31152 @smallexample
31153 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31154 @end smallexample
31155
31156 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31157
31158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31159
31160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31161
31162 @subsubheading Example
31163 N.A.
31164
31165
31166 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31167 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31168
31169 @subsubheading Synopsis
31170
31171 @smallexample
31172 -symbol-list-functions
31173 @end smallexample
31174
31175 List the functions in the executable.
31176
31177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31178
31179 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31180 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31181
31182 @subsubheading Example
31183 N.A.
31184 @end ignore
31185
31186
31187 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31188 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31189
31190 @subsubheading Synopsis
31191
31192 @smallexample
31193 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31194 @end smallexample
31195
31196 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31197 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31198 ascending PC order.
31199
31200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31201
31202 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31203
31204 @subsubheading Example
31205 @smallexample
31206 (gdb)
31207 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31208 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31209 (gdb)
31210 @end smallexample
31211
31212
31213 @ignore
31214 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31215 @findex -symbol-list-types
31216
31217 @subsubheading Synopsis
31218
31219 @smallexample
31220 -symbol-list-types
31221 @end smallexample
31222
31223 List all the type names.
31224
31225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31226
31227 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31228 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31229
31230 @subsubheading Example
31231 N.A.
31232
31233
31234 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31235 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31236
31237 @subsubheading Synopsis
31238
31239 @smallexample
31240 -symbol-list-variables
31241 @end smallexample
31242
31243 List all the global and static variable names.
31244
31245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31246
31247 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31248
31249 @subsubheading Example
31250 N.A.
31251
31252
31253 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31254 @findex -symbol-locate
31255
31256 @subsubheading Synopsis
31257
31258 @smallexample
31259 -symbol-locate
31260 @end smallexample
31261
31262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31263
31264 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31265
31266 @subsubheading Example
31267 N.A.
31268
31269
31270 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31271 @findex -symbol-type
31272
31273 @subsubheading Synopsis
31274
31275 @smallexample
31276 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31277 @end smallexample
31278
31279 Show type of @var{variable}.
31280
31281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31282
31283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31284 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31285
31286 @subsubheading Example
31287 N.A.
31288 @end ignore
31289
31290
31291 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31292 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31293 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31294
31295 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31296 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31297
31298 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31299 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31300
31301 @subsubheading Synopsis
31302
31303 @smallexample
31304 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31305 @end smallexample
31306
31307 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31308 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31309 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31310 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31311 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31312 notification.
31313
31314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31315
31316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31317
31318 @subsubheading Example
31319
31320 @smallexample
31321 (gdb)
31322 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31323 ^done
31324 (gdb)
31325 @end smallexample
31326
31327
31328 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31329 @findex -file-exec-file
31330
31331 @subsubheading Synopsis
31332
31333 @smallexample
31334 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31335 @end smallexample
31336
31337 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31338 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31339 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31340 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31341 notification.
31342
31343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31344
31345 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31346
31347 @subsubheading Example
31348
31349 @smallexample
31350 (gdb)
31351 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31352 ^done
31353 (gdb)
31354 @end smallexample
31355
31356
31357 @ignore
31358 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31359 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31360
31361 @subsubheading Synopsis
31362
31363 @smallexample
31364 -file-list-exec-sections
31365 @end smallexample
31366
31367 List the sections of the current executable file.
31368
31369 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31370
31371 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31372 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31373 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31374
31375 @subsubheading Example
31376 N.A.
31377 @end ignore
31378
31379
31380 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31381 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31382
31383 @subsubheading Synopsis
31384
31385 @smallexample
31386 -file-list-exec-source-file
31387 @end smallexample
31388
31389 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31390 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31391 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31392 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31393
31394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31395
31396 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31397
31398 @subsubheading Example
31399
31400 @smallexample
31401 (gdb)
31402 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31403 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31404 (gdb)
31405 @end smallexample
31406
31407
31408 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31409 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31410
31411 @subsubheading Synopsis
31412
31413 @smallexample
31414 -file-list-exec-source-files
31415 @end smallexample
31416
31417 List the source files for the current executable.
31418
31419 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31420 name) of a source file.
31421
31422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31423
31424 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31425 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31426
31427 @subsubheading Example
31428 @smallexample
31429 (gdb)
31430 -file-list-exec-source-files
31431 ^done,files=[
31432 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31433 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31434 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31435 (gdb)
31436 @end smallexample
31437
31438 @ignore
31439 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31440 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31441
31442 @subsubheading Synopsis
31443
31444 @smallexample
31445 -file-list-shared-libraries
31446 @end smallexample
31447
31448 List the shared libraries in the program.
31449
31450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31451
31452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31453
31454 @subsubheading Example
31455 N.A.
31456
31457
31458 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31459 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31460
31461 @subsubheading Synopsis
31462
31463 @smallexample
31464 -file-list-symbol-files
31465 @end smallexample
31466
31467 List symbol files.
31468
31469 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31470
31471 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31472
31473 @subsubheading Example
31474 N.A.
31475 @end ignore
31476
31477
31478 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31479 @findex -file-symbol-file
31480
31481 @subsubheading Synopsis
31482
31483 @smallexample
31484 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31485 @end smallexample
31486
31487 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31488 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31489 produced, except for a completion notification.
31490
31491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31492
31493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31494
31495 @subsubheading Example
31496
31497 @smallexample
31498 (gdb)
31499 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31500 ^done
31501 (gdb)
31502 @end smallexample
31503
31504 @ignore
31505 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31506 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31507 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31508
31509 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31510
31511 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31512
31513 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31514
31515 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31516
31517 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31518
31519 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31520
31521 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31522
31523 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31524
31525 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31526 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31527 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31528
31529 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31530
31531 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31532
31533 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31534
31535 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31536 @end ignore
31537
31538
31539 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31540 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31541 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31542
31543
31544 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31545 @findex -target-attach
31546
31547 @subsubheading Synopsis
31548
31549 @smallexample
31550 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31551 @end smallexample
31552
31553 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31554 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31555 group, the id previously returned by
31556 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31557
31558 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31559
31560 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31561
31562 @subsubheading Example
31563 @smallexample
31564 (gdb)
31565 -target-attach 34
31566 =thread-created,id="1"
31567 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31568 ^done
31569 (gdb)
31570 @end smallexample
31571
31572 @ignore
31573 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31574 @findex -target-compare-sections
31575
31576 @subsubheading Synopsis
31577
31578 @smallexample
31579 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31580 @end smallexample
31581
31582 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31583 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31584
31585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31586
31587 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31588
31589 @subsubheading Example
31590 N.A.
31591 @end ignore
31592
31593
31594 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31595 @findex -target-detach
31596
31597 @subsubheading Synopsis
31598
31599 @smallexample
31600 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31601 @end smallexample
31602
31603 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31604 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31605 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31606
31607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31608
31609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31610
31611 @subsubheading Example
31612
31613 @smallexample
31614 (gdb)
31615 -target-detach
31616 ^done
31617 (gdb)
31618 @end smallexample
31619
31620
31621 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31622 @findex -target-disconnect
31623
31624 @subsubheading Synopsis
31625
31626 @smallexample
31627 -target-disconnect
31628 @end smallexample
31629
31630 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31631 generally not resumed.
31632
31633 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31634
31635 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31636
31637 @subsubheading Example
31638
31639 @smallexample
31640 (gdb)
31641 -target-disconnect
31642 ^done
31643 (gdb)
31644 @end smallexample
31645
31646
31647 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31648 @findex -target-download
31649
31650 @subsubheading Synopsis
31651
31652 @smallexample
31653 -target-download
31654 @end smallexample
31655
31656 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31657 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31658
31659 @table @samp
31660 @item section
31661 The name of the section.
31662 @item section-sent
31663 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31664 @item section-size
31665 The size of the section.
31666 @item total-sent
31667 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31668 @item total-size
31669 The size of the overall executable to download.
31670 @end table
31671
31672 @noindent
31673 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31674 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31675
31676 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31677 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31678
31679 @table @samp
31680 @item section
31681 The name of the section.
31682 @item section-size
31683 The size of the section.
31684 @item total-size
31685 The size of the overall executable to download.
31686 @end table
31687
31688 @noindent
31689 At the end, a summary is printed.
31690
31691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31692
31693 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31694
31695 @subsubheading Example
31696
31697 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31698 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31699
31700 @smallexample
31701 (gdb)
31702 -target-download
31703 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31704 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31705 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31706 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31707 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31708 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31709 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31710 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31711 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31712 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31713 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31714 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31715 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31716 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31717 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31718 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31719 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31720 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31721 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31722 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31723 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31724 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31725 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31726 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31727 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31728 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31729 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31730 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31731 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31732 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31733 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31734 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31735 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31736 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31737 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31738 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31739 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31740 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31741 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31742 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31743 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31744 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31745 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31746 write-rate="429"
31747 (gdb)
31748 @end smallexample
31749
31750
31751 @ignore
31752 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31753 @findex -target-exec-status
31754
31755 @subsubheading Synopsis
31756
31757 @smallexample
31758 -target-exec-status
31759 @end smallexample
31760
31761 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31762 not, for instance).
31763
31764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31765
31766 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31767
31768 @subsubheading Example
31769 N.A.
31770
31771
31772 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31773 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31774
31775 @subsubheading Synopsis
31776
31777 @smallexample
31778 -target-list-available-targets
31779 @end smallexample
31780
31781 List the possible targets to connect to.
31782
31783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31784
31785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31786
31787 @subsubheading Example
31788 N.A.
31789
31790
31791 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31792 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31793
31794 @subsubheading Synopsis
31795
31796 @smallexample
31797 -target-list-current-targets
31798 @end smallexample
31799
31800 Describe the current target.
31801
31802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31803
31804 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31805 other things).
31806
31807 @subsubheading Example
31808 N.A.
31809
31810
31811 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31812 @findex -target-list-parameters
31813
31814 @subsubheading Synopsis
31815
31816 @smallexample
31817 -target-list-parameters
31818 @end smallexample
31819
31820 @c ????
31821 @end ignore
31822
31823 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31824
31825 No equivalent.
31826
31827 @subsubheading Example
31828 N.A.
31829
31830
31831 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31832 @findex -target-select
31833
31834 @subsubheading Synopsis
31835
31836 @smallexample
31837 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31838 @end smallexample
31839
31840 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31841
31842 @table @samp
31843 @item @var{type}
31844 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31845 @item @var{parameters}
31846 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31847 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31848 @end table
31849
31850 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31851 which the target program is, in the following form:
31852
31853 @smallexample
31854 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31855 args=[@var{arg list}]
31856 @end smallexample
31857
31858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31859
31860 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31861
31862 @subsubheading Example
31863
31864 @smallexample
31865 (gdb)
31866 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31867 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31868 (gdb)
31869 @end smallexample
31870
31871 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31872 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31873 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31874
31875
31876 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31877 @findex -target-file-put
31878
31879 @subsubheading Synopsis
31880
31881 @smallexample
31882 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31883 @end smallexample
31884
31885 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31886 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31887
31888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31889
31890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31891
31892 @subsubheading Example
31893
31894 @smallexample
31895 (gdb)
31896 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31897 ^done
31898 (gdb)
31899 @end smallexample
31900
31901
31902 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31903 @findex -target-file-get
31904
31905 @subsubheading Synopsis
31906
31907 @smallexample
31908 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31909 @end smallexample
31910
31911 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31912 on the host system.
31913
31914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31915
31916 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31917
31918 @subsubheading Example
31919
31920 @smallexample
31921 (gdb)
31922 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31923 ^done
31924 (gdb)
31925 @end smallexample
31926
31927
31928 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31929 @findex -target-file-delete
31930
31931 @subsubheading Synopsis
31932
31933 @smallexample
31934 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31935 @end smallexample
31936
31937 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31938
31939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31940
31941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31942
31943 @subsubheading Example
31944
31945 @smallexample
31946 (gdb)
31947 -target-file-delete remotefile
31948 ^done
31949 (gdb)
31950 @end smallexample
31951
31952
31953 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31954 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31955 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31956
31957 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31958 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31959
31960 @subsubheading Synopsis
31961
31962 @smallexample
31963 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31964 @end smallexample
31965
31966 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31967 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31968 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31969
31970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31971
31972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31973
31974 @subsubheading Result
31975
31976 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31977 defined for each exception:
31978
31979 @table @samp
31980 @item name
31981 The name of the exception.
31982
31983 @item address
31984 The address of the exception.
31985
31986 @end table
31987
31988 @subsubheading Example
31989
31990 @smallexample
31991 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31992 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31993 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31994 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31995 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31996 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31997 @end smallexample
31998
31999 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32000
32001 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32002 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32003 Catchpoint Commands}.
32004
32005
32006 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32007 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32008 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32009
32010 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32011 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32012 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32013 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32014
32015 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32016 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32017 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32018
32019 @subsubheading Synopsis
32020
32021 @smallexample
32022 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32023 @end smallexample
32024
32025 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32026
32027 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32028 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32029 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32030 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32031 dash.
32032
32033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32034
32035 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32036
32037 @subsubheading Result
32038
32039 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32040
32041 @table @samp
32042 @item exists
32043 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32044 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32045
32046 @end table
32047
32048 @subsubheading Example
32049
32050 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32051
32052 @smallexample
32053 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32054 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32055 @end smallexample
32056
32057 @noindent
32058 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32059 to the debugger:
32060
32061 @smallexample
32062 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32063 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32064 @end smallexample
32065
32066 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32067 @findex -list-features
32068 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32069
32070 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32071 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32072 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32073 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32074 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32075 startup.
32076
32077 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32078 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32079 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32080 is given below.
32081
32082 Example output:
32083
32084 @smallexample
32085 (gdb) -list-features
32086 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32087 @end smallexample
32088
32089 The current list of features is:
32090
32091 @ftable @samp
32092 @item frozen-varobjs
32093 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32094 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32095 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32096 @item pending-breakpoints
32097 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32098 command.
32099 @item python
32100 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32101 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32102 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32103 @item thread-info
32104 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32105 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32106 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32107 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32108 @item breakpoint-notifications
32109 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32110 CLI will be announced via async records.
32111 @item ada-task-info
32112 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32113 @item language-option
32114 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32115 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32116 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32117 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32118 @item undefined-command-error-code
32119 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32120 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32121 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32122 @item exec-run-start-option
32123 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32124 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32125 @end ftable
32126
32127 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32128 @findex -list-target-features
32129
32130 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32131 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32132 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32133 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32134 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32135 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32136 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32137 Example output:
32138
32139 @smallexample
32140 (gdb) -list-target-features
32141 ^done,result=["async"]
32142 @end smallexample
32143
32144 The current list of features is:
32145
32146 @table @samp
32147 @item async
32148 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32149 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32150 while the target is running.
32151
32152 @item reverse
32153 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32154 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32155
32156 @end table
32157
32158 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32159 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32160 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32161
32162 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32163
32164 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32165 @findex -gdb-exit
32166
32167 @subsubheading Synopsis
32168
32169 @smallexample
32170 -gdb-exit
32171 @end smallexample
32172
32173 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32174
32175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32176
32177 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32178
32179 @subsubheading Example
32180
32181 @smallexample
32182 (gdb)
32183 -gdb-exit
32184 ^exit
32185 @end smallexample
32186
32187
32188 @ignore
32189 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32190 @findex -exec-abort
32191
32192 @subsubheading Synopsis
32193
32194 @smallexample
32195 -exec-abort
32196 @end smallexample
32197
32198 Kill the inferior running program.
32199
32200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32201
32202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32203
32204 @subsubheading Example
32205 N.A.
32206 @end ignore
32207
32208
32209 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32210 @findex -gdb-set
32211
32212 @subsubheading Synopsis
32213
32214 @smallexample
32215 -gdb-set
32216 @end smallexample
32217
32218 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32219 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32220
32221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32222
32223 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32224
32225 @subsubheading Example
32226
32227 @smallexample
32228 (gdb)
32229 -gdb-set $foo=3
32230 ^done
32231 (gdb)
32232 @end smallexample
32233
32234
32235 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32236 @findex -gdb-show
32237
32238 @subsubheading Synopsis
32239
32240 @smallexample
32241 -gdb-show
32242 @end smallexample
32243
32244 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32245
32246 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32247
32248 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32249
32250 @subsubheading Example
32251
32252 @smallexample
32253 (gdb)
32254 -gdb-show annotate
32255 ^done,value="0"
32256 (gdb)
32257 @end smallexample
32258
32259 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32260
32261
32262 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32263 @findex -gdb-version
32264
32265 @subsubheading Synopsis
32266
32267 @smallexample
32268 -gdb-version
32269 @end smallexample
32270
32271 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32272
32273 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32274
32275 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32276 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32277
32278 @subsubheading Example
32279
32280 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32281 @c box in TeX.
32282 @smallexample
32283 (gdb)
32284 -gdb-version
32285 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32286 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32287 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32288 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32289 ~ certain conditions.
32290 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32291 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32292 ~ details.
32293 ~This GDB was configured as
32294 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32295 ^done
32296 (gdb)
32297 @end smallexample
32298
32299 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32300 @findex -list-thread-groups
32301
32302 @subheading Synopsis
32303
32304 @smallexample
32305 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32306 @end smallexample
32307
32308 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32309 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32310 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32311 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32312 top-level thread groups.
32313
32314 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32315 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32316 available on the target.
32317
32318 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32319 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32320 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32321 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32322 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32323 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32324 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32325 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32326
32327 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32328 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32329 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32330 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32331 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32332 @samp{threads} field.
32333
32334 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32335 the following caveats:
32336
32337 @itemize @bullet
32338 @item
32339 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32340 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32341 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32342
32343 @item
32344 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32345 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32346 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32347 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32348 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32349 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32350
32351 @end itemize
32352
32353 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32354 have the following fields:
32355
32356 @table @code
32357 @item id
32358 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32359 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32360 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32361
32362 @item type
32363 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32364 valid type.
32365
32366 @item pid
32367 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32368 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32369
32370 @item exit-code
32371 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32372 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32373 only if the process is not running.
32374
32375 @item num_children
32376 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32377 absent for an available thread group.
32378
32379 @item threads
32380 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32381 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32382 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32383
32384 @item cores
32385 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32386 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32387 such information is not available.
32388
32389 @item executable
32390 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32391 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32392 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32393
32394 @end table
32395
32396 @subheading Example
32397
32398 @smallexample
32399 @value{GDBP}
32400 -list-thread-groups
32401 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32402 -list-thread-groups 17
32403 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32404 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32405 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32406 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32407 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32408 -list-thread-groups --available
32409 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32410 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32411 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32412 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32413 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32414 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32415 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32416 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32417 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32418 @end smallexample
32419
32420 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32421 @findex -info-os
32422
32423 @subsubheading Synopsis
32424
32425 @smallexample
32426 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32427 @end smallexample
32428
32429 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32430 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32431 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32432 of data of that type.
32433
32434 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32435 system.
32436
32437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32438
32439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32440
32441 @subsubheading Example
32442
32443 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32444 like this:
32445
32446 @smallexample
32447 @value{GDBP}
32448 -info-os
32449 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32450 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32451 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32452 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32453 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32454 col2="CPUs"@},
32455 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32456 col2="File descriptors"@},
32457 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32458 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32459 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32460 col2="Message queues"@},
32461 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32462 col2="Processes"@},
32463 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32464 col2="Process groups"@},
32465 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32466 col2="Semaphores"@},
32467 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32468 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32469 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32470 col2="Sockets"@},
32471 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32472 col2="Threads"@}]
32473 @value{GDBP}
32474 -info-os processes
32475 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32476 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32477 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32478 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32479 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32480 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32481 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32482 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32483 ...
32484 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32485 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32486 (gdb)
32487 @end smallexample
32488
32489 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32490 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32491 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32492 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32493 @code{info os} omits it.)
32494
32495 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32496 @findex -add-inferior
32497
32498 @subheading Synopsis
32499
32500 @smallexample
32501 -add-inferior
32502 @end smallexample
32503
32504 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32505 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32506 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32507 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32508 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32509 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32510
32511 @subheading Example
32512
32513 @smallexample
32514 @value{GDBP}
32515 -add-inferior
32516 ^done,inferior="i3"
32517 @end smallexample
32518
32519 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32520 @findex -interpreter-exec
32521
32522 @subheading Synopsis
32523
32524 @smallexample
32525 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32526 @end smallexample
32527 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32528
32529 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32530
32531 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32532
32533 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32534
32535 @subheading Example
32536
32537 @smallexample
32538 (gdb)
32539 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32540 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32541 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32542 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32543 ^done
32544 (gdb)
32545 @end smallexample
32546
32547 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32548 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32549
32550 @subheading Synopsis
32551
32552 @smallexample
32553 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32554 @end smallexample
32555
32556 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32557
32558 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32559
32560 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32561
32562 @subheading Example
32563
32564 @smallexample
32565 (gdb)
32566 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32567 ^done
32568 (gdb)
32569 @end smallexample
32570
32571 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32572 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32573
32574 @subheading Synopsis
32575
32576 @smallexample
32577 -inferior-tty-show
32578 @end smallexample
32579
32580 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32581
32582 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32583
32584 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32585
32586 @subheading Example
32587
32588 @smallexample
32589 (gdb)
32590 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32591 ^done
32592 (gdb)
32593 -inferior-tty-show
32594 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32595 (gdb)
32596 @end smallexample
32597
32598 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32599 @findex -enable-timings
32600
32601 @subheading Synopsis
32602
32603 @smallexample
32604 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32605 @end smallexample
32606
32607 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32608 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32609 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32610 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32611
32612 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32613
32614 No equivalent.
32615
32616 @subheading Example
32617
32618 @smallexample
32619 (gdb)
32620 -enable-timings
32621 ^done
32622 (gdb)
32623 -break-insert main
32624 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32625 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32626 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32627 times="0"@},
32628 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32629 (gdb)
32630 -enable-timings no
32631 ^done
32632 (gdb)
32633 -exec-run
32634 ^running
32635 (gdb)
32636 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32637 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32638 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32639 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32640 (gdb)
32641 @end smallexample
32642
32643 @node Annotations
32644 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32645
32646 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32647 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32648 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32649 relatively high level.
32650
32651 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32652 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32653
32654 @ignore
32655 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32656 @end ignore
32657
32658 @menu
32659 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32660 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32661 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32662 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32663 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32664 * Annotations for Running::
32665 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32666 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32667 @end menu
32668
32669 @node Annotations Overview
32670 @section What is an Annotation?
32671 @cindex annotations
32672
32673 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32674 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32675 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32676 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32677 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32678 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32679 cannot contain newline characters.
32680
32681 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32682 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32683 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32684 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32685 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32686 means those three characters as output.
32687
32688 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32689 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32690 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32691 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32692 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32693 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32694 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32695 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32696 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32697
32698 @table @code
32699 @kindex set annotate
32700 @item set annotate @var{level}
32701 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32702 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32703
32704 @item show annotate
32705 @kindex show annotate
32706 Show the current annotation level.
32707 @end table
32708
32709 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32710
32711 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32712
32713 @smallexample
32714 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32715 GNU gdb 6.0
32716 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32717 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32718 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32719 under certain conditions.
32720 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32721 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32722 for details.
32723 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32724
32725 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32726 (@value{GDBP})
32727 ^Z^Zprompt
32728 @kbd{quit}
32729
32730 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32731 $
32732 @end smallexample
32733
32734 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32735 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32736 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32737 output from @value{GDBN}.
32738
32739 @node Server Prefix
32740 @section The Server Prefix
32741 @cindex server prefix
32742
32743 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32744 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32745 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32746 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32747 a transparent manner.
32748
32749 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32750 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32751 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32752 @code{print} command.
32753
32754 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32755 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32756
32757 @node Prompting
32758 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32759
32760 @cindex annotations for prompts
32761 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32762 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32763 over, etc.
32764
32765 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32766 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32767 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32768 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32769 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32770 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32771 features the following annotations:
32772
32773 @smallexample
32774 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32775 ^Z^Zprompt
32776 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32777 @end smallexample
32778
32779 The input types are
32780
32781 @table @code
32782 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32783 @findex prompt annotation
32784 @findex post-prompt annotation
32785 @item prompt
32786 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32787
32788 @findex pre-commands annotation
32789 @findex commands annotation
32790 @findex post-commands annotation
32791 @item commands
32792 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32793 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32794
32795 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32796 @findex overload-choice annotation
32797 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32798 @item overload-choice
32799 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32800
32801 @findex pre-query annotation
32802 @findex query annotation
32803 @findex post-query annotation
32804 @item query
32805 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32806
32807 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32808 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32809 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32810 @item prompt-for-continue
32811 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32812 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32813 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32814 presence of annotations.
32815 @end table
32816
32817 @node Errors
32818 @section Errors
32819 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32820
32821 @findex quit annotation
32822 @smallexample
32823 ^Z^Zquit
32824 @end smallexample
32825
32826 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32827
32828 @findex error annotation
32829 @smallexample
32830 ^Z^Zerror
32831 @end smallexample
32832
32833 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32834
32835 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32836 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32837 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32838 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32839 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32840 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32841 to the top level.
32842
32843 @findex error-begin annotation
32844 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32845
32846 @smallexample
32847 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32848 @end smallexample
32849
32850 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32851 message.
32852
32853 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32854 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32855 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32856
32857 @node Invalidation
32858 @section Invalidation Notices
32859
32860 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32861 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32862 changed.
32863
32864 @table @code
32865 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32866 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32867
32868 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32869 have changed.
32870
32871 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32872 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32873
32874 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32875 deleted a breakpoint.
32876 @end table
32877
32878 @node Annotations for Running
32879 @section Running the Program
32880 @cindex annotations for running programs
32881
32882 @findex starting annotation
32883 @findex stopping annotation
32884 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32885 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32886
32887 @smallexample
32888 ^Z^Zstarting
32889 @end smallexample
32890
32891 is output. When the program stops,
32892
32893 @smallexample
32894 ^Z^Zstopped
32895 @end smallexample
32896
32897 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32898 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32899
32900 @table @code
32901 @findex exited annotation
32902 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32903 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32904 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32905
32906 @findex signalled annotation
32907 @findex signal-name annotation
32908 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32909 @findex signal-string annotation
32910 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32911 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32912 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32913 annotation continues:
32914
32915 @smallexample
32916 @var{intro-text}
32917 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32918 @var{name}
32919 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32920 @var{middle-text}
32921 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32922 @var{string}
32923 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32924 @var{end-text}
32925 @end smallexample
32926
32927 @noindent
32928 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32929 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32930 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32931 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32932 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32933
32934 @findex signal annotation
32935 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32936 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32937 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32938 terminated with it.
32939
32940 @findex breakpoint annotation
32941 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32942 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32943
32944 @findex watchpoint annotation
32945 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32946 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32947 @end table
32948
32949 @node Source Annotations
32950 @section Displaying Source
32951 @cindex annotations for source display
32952
32953 @findex source annotation
32954 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32955
32956 @smallexample
32957 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32958 @end smallexample
32959
32960 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32961 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32962 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32963 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32964 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32965 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32966 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32967 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32968 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32969 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32970 depend on the language).
32971
32972 @node JIT Interface
32973 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32974 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32975 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32976
32977 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32978 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32979 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32980 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32981
32982 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32983 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32984 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32985 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32986 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32987 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32988
32989 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32990 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32991 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32992 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32993 LLVM JIT.
32994
32995 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32996 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32997 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32998 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32999 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33000 out about additional code.
33001
33002 @menu
33003 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33004 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33005 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33006 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33007 @end menu
33008
33009 @node Declarations
33010 @section JIT Declarations
33011
33012 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33013 implement the interface:
33014
33015 @smallexample
33016 typedef enum
33017 @{
33018 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33019 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33020 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33021 @} jit_actions_t;
33022
33023 struct jit_code_entry
33024 @{
33025 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33026 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33027 const char *symfile_addr;
33028 uint64_t symfile_size;
33029 @};
33030
33031 struct jit_descriptor
33032 @{
33033 uint32_t version;
33034 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33035 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33036 uint32_t action_flag;
33037 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33038 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33039 @};
33040
33041 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33042 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33043
33044 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33045 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33046 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33047 @end smallexample
33048
33049 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33050 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33051 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33052
33053 @node Registering Code
33054 @section Registering Code
33055
33056 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33057
33058 @itemize @bullet
33059 @item
33060 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33061 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33062
33063 @item
33064 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33065 file.
33066
33067 @item
33068 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33069
33070 @item
33071 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33072
33073 @item
33074 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33075 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33076 @end itemize
33077
33078 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33079 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33080 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33081 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33082
33083 @node Unregistering Code
33084 @section Unregistering Code
33085
33086 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33087
33088 @itemize @bullet
33089 @item
33090 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33091
33092 @item
33093 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33094
33095 @item
33096 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33097 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33098 @end itemize
33099
33100 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33101 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33102
33103 @node Custom Debug Info
33104 @section Custom Debug Info
33105 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33106 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33107
33108 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33109 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33110 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33111 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33112 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33113 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33114 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33115 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33116 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33117
33118 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33119 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33120 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33121 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33122 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33123 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33124 compiler.
33125
33126 @menu
33127 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33128 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33129 @end menu
33130
33131 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33132 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33133 @kindex jit-reader-load
33134 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33135
33136 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33137 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33138
33139 @table @code
33140 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33141 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33142 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33143 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33144 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33145 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33146 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33147
33148 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33149 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33150 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33151 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33152 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33153
33154 @item jit-reader-unload
33155 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33156
33157 @end table
33158
33159 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33160 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33161 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33162
33163 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33164 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33165
33166 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33167 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33168 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33169 the system include directory.
33170
33171 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33172 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33173 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33174
33175 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33176 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33177
33178 @findex gdb_init_reader
33179 @smallexample
33180 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33181 @end smallexample
33182
33183 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33184
33185 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33186 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33187 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33188 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33189 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33190 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33191
33192 @smallexample
33193 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33194 @{
33195 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33196 int reader_version;
33197
33198 /* For use by the reader. */
33199 void *priv_data;
33200
33201 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33202 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33203 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33204 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33205 @};
33206 @end smallexample
33207
33208 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33209 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33210
33211 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33212 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33213 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33214 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33215 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33216 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33217 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33218 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33219 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33220 target's address space.
33221
33222 @node In-Process Agent
33223 @chapter In-Process Agent
33224 @cindex debugging agent
33225 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33226 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33227 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33228 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33229 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33230 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33231 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33232 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33233 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33234 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33235 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33236 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33237 behavior without interrupting it.
33238
33239 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33240 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33241 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33242 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33243 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33244 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33245 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33246 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33247 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33248
33249 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33250 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33251 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33252 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33253
33254 @anchor{Control Agent}
33255 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33256 debugging with the following commands:
33257
33258 @table @code
33259 @kindex set agent on
33260 @item set agent on
33261 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33262 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33263 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33264 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33265 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33266 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33267
33268 @kindex set agent off
33269 @item set agent off
33270 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33271 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33272
33273 @kindex show agent
33274 @item show agent
33275 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33276 the in-process agent.
33277 @end table
33278
33279 @menu
33280 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33281 @end menu
33282
33283 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33284 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33285 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33286
33287 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33288 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33289 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33290 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33291 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33292 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33293 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33294 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33295 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33296
33297 @menu
33298 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33299 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33300 @end menu
33301
33302 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33303 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33304 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33305
33306 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33307 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33308
33309 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33310 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33311 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33312 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33313
33314 @enumerate
33315 @item
33316 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33317 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33318 @item
33319 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33320 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33321 the other one.
33322 @end enumerate
33323
33324 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33325
33326 @enumerate
33327 @item
33328 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33329 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33330 @anchor{agent expression object}
33331 @item
33332 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33333 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33334 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33335 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33336 @item
33337 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33338 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33339
33340 @end enumerate
33341
33342 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33343 object:
33344
33345 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33346 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33347 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33348 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33349 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33350 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33351 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33352 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33353 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33354 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33355 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33356 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33357 memory address for collecting.
33358 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33359 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33360 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33361 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33362 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33363 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33364 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33365 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33366 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33367 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33368 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33369 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33370 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33371 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33372 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33373 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33374 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33375 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33376 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33377 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33378 @ref{agent expression object}
33379 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33380 @ref{agent expression object}
33381 @item actions @tab variable
33382 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33383 @end multitable
33384
33385 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33386 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33387 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33388
33389 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33390 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33391
33392 @table @samp
33393
33394 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33395 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33396 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33397 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33398 in IPA finally.
33399
33400 Replies:
33401 @table @samp
33402 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33403 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33404 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33405 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33406 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33407 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33408 @item E @var{NN}
33409 for an error
33410
33411 @end table
33412
33413 @item close
33414 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33415 is about to kill inferiors.
33416
33417 @item qTfSTM
33418 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33419 @item qTsSTM
33420 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33421 @item qTSTMat
33422 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33423 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33424 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33425
33426 Replies:
33427 @table @samp
33428 @item E @var{NN}
33429 for an error
33430 @end table
33431 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33432 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33433 @end table
33434
33435 @node GDB Bugs
33436 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33437 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33438 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33439
33440 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33441
33442 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33443 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33444 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33445 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33446
33447 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33448 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33449
33450 @menu
33451 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33452 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33453 @end menu
33454
33455 @node Bug Criteria
33456 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33457 @cindex bug criteria
33458
33459 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33460
33461 @itemize @bullet
33462 @cindex fatal signal
33463 @cindex debugger crash
33464 @cindex crash of debugger
33465 @item
33466 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33467 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33468
33469 @cindex error on valid input
33470 @item
33471 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33472 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33473 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33474
33475 @cindex invalid input
33476 @item
33477 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33478 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33479 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33480 for traditional practice''.
33481
33482 @item
33483 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33484 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33485 @end itemize
33486
33487 @node Bug Reporting
33488 @section How to Report Bugs
33489 @cindex bug reports
33490 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33491
33492 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33493 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33494 contact that organization first.
33495
33496 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33497 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33498 distribution.
33499 @c should add a web page ref...
33500
33501 @ifset BUGURL
33502 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33503 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33504 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33505 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33506 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33507 be used.
33508
33509 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33510 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33511 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33512 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33513
33514 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33515 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33516 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33517 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33518 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33519 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33520 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33521 bug reports to the mailing list.
33522 @end ifset
33523 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33524 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33525 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33526 @end ifclear
33527 @end ifset
33528
33529 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33530 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33531 fact or leave it out, state it!
33532
33533 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33534 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33535 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33536 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33537 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33538 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33539 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33540 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33541 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33542
33543 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33544 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33545 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33546 self-contained.
33547
33548 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33549 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33550 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33551 bugs properly.
33552
33553 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33554
33555 @itemize @bullet
33556 @item
33557 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33558 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33559 version}.
33560
33561 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33562 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33563
33564 @item
33565 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33566 version number.
33567
33568 @item
33569 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33570 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33571 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33572 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33573
33574 @item
33575 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33576 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33577
33578 @item
33579 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33580 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33581 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33582 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33583 those compilers.
33584
33585 @item
33586 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33587 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33588 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33589 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33590
33591 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33592 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33593
33594 @item
33595 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33596 reproduce the bug.
33597
33598 @item
33599 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33600 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33601
33602 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33603 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33604 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33605 a chance to make a mistake.
33606
33607 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33608 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33609 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33610 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33611 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33612 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33613 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33614 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33615
33616 @pindex script
33617 @cindex recording a session script
33618 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33619 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33620 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33621 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33622
33623 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33624 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33625
33626 @item
33627 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33628 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33629 it by context, not by line number.
33630
33631 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33632 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33633
33634 @end itemize
33635
33636 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33637
33638 @itemize @bullet
33639 @item
33640 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33641
33642 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33643 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33644 changes will not affect it.
33645
33646 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33647 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33648 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33649 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33650
33651 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33652 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33653 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33654 less time, and so on.
33655
33656 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33657 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33658
33659 @item
33660 A patch for the bug.
33661
33662 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33663 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33664 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33665 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33666
33667 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33668 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33669 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33670 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33671
33672 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33673 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33674 help us to understand.
33675
33676 @item
33677 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33678
33679 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33680 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33681 @end itemize
33682
33683 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33684 @c and consists of the two following files:
33685 @c rluser.texi
33686 @c hsuser.texi
33687 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33688 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33689 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33690 @include rluser.texi
33691 @include hsuser.texi
33692 @end ifclear
33693
33694 @node In Memoriam
33695 @appendix In Memoriam
33696
33697 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33698 contributors:
33699
33700 @table @code
33701 @item Fred Fish
33702 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33703 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33704 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33705
33706 @item Michael Snyder
33707 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33708 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33709 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33710 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33711 @end table
33712
33713 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33714 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33715
33716 @node Formatting Documentation
33717 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33718
33719 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33720 @cindex reference card
33721 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33722 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33723 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33724 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33725 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33726 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33727
33728 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33729 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33730
33731 @smallexample
33732 make refcard.dvi
33733 @end smallexample
33734
33735 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33736 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33737 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33738 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33739 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33740
33741 @cindex documentation
33742
33743 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33744 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33745 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33746 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33747 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33748 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33749
33750 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33751 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33752 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33753 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33754 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33755 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33756 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33757 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33758
33759 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33760 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33761 @code{makeinfo}.
33762
33763 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33764 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33765 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33766
33767 @smallexample
33768 cd gdb
33769 make gdb.info
33770 @end smallexample
33771
33772 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33773 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33774 Texinfo definitions file.
33775
33776 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33777 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33778 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33779 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33780 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33781 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33782 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33783
33784 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33785 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33786 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33787 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33788 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33789 directory.
33790
33791 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33792 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33793 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33794 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33795
33796 @smallexample
33797 make gdb.dvi
33798 @end smallexample
33799
33800 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33801
33802 @node Installing GDB
33803 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33804 @cindex installation
33805
33806 @menu
33807 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33808 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33809 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33810 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33811 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33812 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33813 @end menu
33814
33815 @node Requirements
33816 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33817 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33818
33819 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33820 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33821
33822 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33823 @table @asis
33824 @item ISO C90 compiler
33825 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33826 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33827
33828 @end table
33829
33830 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33831 @table @asis
33832 @item Expat
33833 @anchor{Expat}
33834 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33835 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33836 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33837 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33838 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33839 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33840
33841 Expat is used for:
33842
33843 @itemize @bullet
33844 @item
33845 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33846 @item
33847 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33848 @item
33849 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33850 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33851 @item
33852 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33853 @item
33854 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33855 @item
33856 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33857 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33858 @end itemize
33859
33860 @item zlib
33861 @cindex compressed debug sections
33862 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33863 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33864 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33865 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33866 information in such binaries.
33867
33868 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33869 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33870 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33871
33872 @item iconv
33873 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33874 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33875 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33876 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33877
33878 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33879 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33880 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33881 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33882
33883 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33884 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33885 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33886
33887 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33888 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33889 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33890 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33891 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33892 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33893 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33894 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33895 @end table
33896
33897 @node Running Configure
33898 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33899 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33900 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33901 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33902 build the @code{gdb} program.
33903 @iftex
33904 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33905 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33906 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33907 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33908 @end iftex
33909
33910 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33911 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33912 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33913
33914 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33915 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33916
33917 @table @code
33918 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33919 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33920
33921 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33922 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33923
33924 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33925 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33926
33927 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33928 @sc{gnu} include files
33929
33930 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33931 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33932
33933 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33934 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33935
33936 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33937 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33938
33939 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33940 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33941
33942 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33943 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33944 @end table
33945
33946 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33947 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33948 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33949
33950 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33951 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33952 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33953 argument.
33954
33955 For example:
33956
33957 @smallexample
33958 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33959 ./configure @var{host}
33960 make
33961 @end smallexample
33962
33963 @noindent
33964 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33965 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33966 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33967 correct value by examining your system.)
33968
33969 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33970 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33971 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33972 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33973
33974 @need 750
33975 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33976 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33977 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33978
33979 @smallexample
33980 sh configure @var{host}
33981 @end smallexample
33982
33983 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33984 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33985 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33986 @file{configure}
33987 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33988 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33989
33990 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33991 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33992 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33993 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33994 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33995 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33996 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33997 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33998 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33999
34000 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34001 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34002 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34003 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34004 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34005
34006 @node Separate Objdir
34007 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34008
34009 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34010 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34011 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34012 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34013 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34014 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34015 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34016 program specified there.
34017
34018 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34019 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34020 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34021 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34022 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34023 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34024
34025 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34026 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34027
34028 @smallexample
34029 @group
34030 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34031 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34032 cd ../gdb-sun4
34033 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34034 make
34035 @end group
34036 @end smallexample
34037
34038 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34039 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34040 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34041 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34042 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34043 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34044
34045 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34046 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34047 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34048 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34049 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34050
34051 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34052 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34053 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34054 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34055 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34056 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34057
34058 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34059 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34060 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34061
34062 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34063 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34064 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34065 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34066 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34067
34068 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34069 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34070 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34071 with each other.
34072
34073 @node Config Names
34074 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34075
34076 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34077 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34078 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34079 of information in the following pattern:
34080
34081 @smallexample
34082 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34083 @end smallexample
34084
34085 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34086 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34087 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34088
34089 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34090 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34091 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34092 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34093 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34094 abbreviations---for example:
34095
34096 @smallexample
34097 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34098 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34099 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34100 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34101 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34102 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34103 % sh config.sub sun4
34104 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34105 % sh config.sub sun3
34106 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34107 % sh config.sub i986v
34108 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34109 @end smallexample
34110
34111 @noindent
34112 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34113 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34114
34115 @node Configure Options
34116 @section @file{configure} Options
34117
34118 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34119 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34120 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34121 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34122
34123 @smallexample
34124 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34125 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34126 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34127 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34128 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34129 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34130 @var{host}
34131 @end smallexample
34132
34133 @noindent
34134 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34135 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34136 @samp{--}.
34137
34138 @table @code
34139 @item --help
34140 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34141
34142 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34143 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34144 @file{@var{dir}}.
34145
34146 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34147 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34148 @file{@var{dir}}.
34149
34150 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34151 @need 2000
34152 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34153 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34154 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34155 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34156 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34157 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34158 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34159 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34160 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34161 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34162 @var{dirname}.
34163
34164 @item --norecursion
34165 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34166 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34167
34168 @item --target=@var{target}
34169 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34170 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34171 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34172
34173 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34174
34175 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34176 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34177
34178 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34179 @end table
34180
34181 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34182 needed for special purposes only.
34183
34184 @node System-wide configuration
34185 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34186 @cindex system-wide init file
34187
34188 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34189 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34190 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34191
34192 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34193
34194 @table @code
34195 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34196 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34197 @var{file}.
34198 @end table
34199
34200 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34201 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34202
34203 @itemize @bullet
34204 @item
34205 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34206 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34207 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34208 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34209 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34210 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34211
34212 @item
34213 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34214 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34215 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34216 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34217 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34218 @end itemize
34219
34220 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34221 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34222 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34223 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34224 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34225 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34226 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34227 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34228 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34229 reread.
34230
34231 @menu
34232 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34233 @end menu
34234
34235 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34236 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34237 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34238
34239 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34240 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34241 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34242 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34243 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34244 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34245
34246 The following scripts are currently available:
34247 @itemize @bullet
34248
34249 @item @file{elinos.py}
34250 @pindex elinos.py
34251 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34252 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34253 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34254 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34255 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34256 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34257
34258 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34259 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34260 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34261 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34262 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34263 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34264
34265 @end itemize
34266
34267 @node Maintenance Commands
34268 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34269 @cindex maintenance commands
34270 @cindex internal commands
34271
34272 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34273 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34274 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34275 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34276 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34277
34278 @table @code
34279 @kindex maint agent
34280 @kindex maint agent-eval
34281 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34282 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34283 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34284 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34285 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34286 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34287 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34288 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34289 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34290 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34291 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34292 addition and return the sum.
34293 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34294 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34295
34296 @kindex maint agent-printf
34297 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34298 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34299 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34300 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34301 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34302
34303 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34304 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34305 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34306 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34307 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34308 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34309 is shown:
34310
34311 @table @code
34312 @item breakpoint
34313 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34314
34315 @item watchpoint
34316 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34317
34318 @item longjmp
34319 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34320 @code{longjmp} calls.
34321
34322 @item longjmp resume
34323 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34324
34325 @item until
34326 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34327
34328 @item finish
34329 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34330
34331 @item shlib events
34332 Shared library events.
34333
34334 @end table
34335
34336 @kindex maint info btrace
34337 @item maint info btrace
34338 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34339
34340 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34341 @item maint btrace packet-history
34342 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34343 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34344 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34345 recording format.
34346
34347 @table @code
34348 @item bts
34349 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34350 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34351
34352 @table @asis
34353 @item Block number
34354 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34355 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34356 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34357 @end table
34358
34359 @item pt
34360 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34361 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34362 information is printed:
34363
34364 @table @asis
34365 @item Packet number
34366 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34367 @item Trace offset
34368 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34369 @item Packet opcode and payload
34370 @end table
34371 @end table
34372
34373 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34374 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34375 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34376 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34377 needed.
34378
34379 @kindex maint btrace clear
34380 @item maint btrace clear
34381 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34382 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34383
34384 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34385 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34386 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34387 buffer.
34388
34389 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34390 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34391 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34392 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34393 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34394 packet history.
34395
34396 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34397 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34398 @cindex displaced stepping support
34399 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34400 @item set displaced-stepping
34401 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34402 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34403 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34404 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34405 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34406 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34407
34408 @table @code
34409 @item set displaced-stepping on
34410 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34411 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34412
34413 @item set displaced-stepping off
34414 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34415 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34416
34417 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34418 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34419 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34420 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34421 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34422 @end table
34423
34424 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34425 @item maint check-psymtabs
34426 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34427 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34428
34429 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34430 @item maint check-symtabs
34431 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34432
34433 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34434 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34435 Expand symbol tables.
34436 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34437 names matching @var{regexp}.
34438
34439 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34440 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34441 @cindex demangler crashes
34442 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34443 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34444 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34445 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34446 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34447 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34448 option to terminate the current session.
34449
34450 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34451 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34452 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34453
34454 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34455 @item maint cplus namespace
34456 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34457
34458 @kindex maint deprecate
34459 @kindex maint undeprecate
34460 @cindex deprecated commands
34461 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34462 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34463 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34464 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34465 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34466 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34467 the replacement as part of the warning.
34468
34469 @kindex maint dump-me
34470 @item maint dump-me
34471 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34472 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34473 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34474 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34475
34476 @kindex maint internal-error
34477 @kindex maint internal-warning
34478 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34479 @cindex demangler crashes
34480 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34481 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34482 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34483
34484 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34485 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34486 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34487 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34488 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34489 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34490 @value{GDBN} session.
34491
34492 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34493 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34494
34495 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34496
34497 @smallexample
34498 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34499 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34500 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34501 debugging may prove unreliable.
34502 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34503 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34504 (@value{GDBP})
34505 @end smallexample
34506
34507 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34508 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34509 @cindex demangler crashes
34510
34511 @kindex maint set internal-error
34512 @kindex maint show internal-error
34513 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34514 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34515 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34516 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34517 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34518 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34519 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34520 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34521 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34522 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34523 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34524 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34525 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34526 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34527 described in the table below.
34528
34529 @table @samp
34530 @item quit
34531 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34532 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34533
34534 @item corefile
34535 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34536 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34537 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34538 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34539 disabled.
34540 @end table
34541
34542 @kindex maint packet
34543 @item maint packet @var{text}
34544 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34545 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34546 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34547 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34548 checksum.
34549
34550 @kindex maint print architecture
34551 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34552 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34553 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34554
34555 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34556 @item maint print c-tdesc
34557 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34558 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34559 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34560
34561 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34562 @item maint print dummy-frames
34563 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34564
34565 @smallexample
34566 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34567 @dots{}
34568 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34569 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34570 58 return (a + b);
34571 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34572 @dots{}
34573 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34574 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34575 (@value{GDBP})
34576 @end smallexample
34577
34578 Takes an optional file parameter.
34579
34580 @kindex maint print registers
34581 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34582 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34583 @kindex maint print register-groups
34584 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34585 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34586 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34587 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34588 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34589 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34590 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34591
34592 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34593 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34594 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34595 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34596 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34597 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34598 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34599 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34600
34601 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34602 write the information.
34603
34604 @kindex maint print reggroups
34605 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34606 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34607 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34608 information.
34609
34610 The register groups info looks like this:
34611
34612 @smallexample
34613 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34614 Group Type
34615 general user
34616 float user
34617 all user
34618 vector user
34619 system user
34620 save internal
34621 restore internal
34622 @end smallexample
34623
34624 @kindex flushregs
34625 @item flushregs
34626 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34627
34628 @kindex maint print objfiles
34629 @cindex info for known object files
34630 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34631 Print a dump of all known object files.
34632 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34633 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34634 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34635
34636 @kindex maint print user-registers
34637 @cindex user registers
34638 @item maint print user-registers
34639 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34640 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34641 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34642 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34643 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34644 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34645 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34646
34647 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34648 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34649 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34650 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34651 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34652 matching @var{regexp}.
34653 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34654 and the full path if known.
34655 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34656
34657 @kindex maint print statistics
34658 @cindex bcache statistics
34659 @item maint print statistics
34660 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34661 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34662 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34663 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34664 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34665 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34666 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34667 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34668 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34669 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34670 lengths.
34671
34672 @kindex maint print target-stack
34673 @cindex target stack description
34674 @item maint print target-stack
34675 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34676 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34677 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34678 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34679 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34680 address.
34681
34682 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34683 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34684
34685 @kindex maint print type
34686 @cindex type chain of a data type
34687 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34688 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34689 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34690 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34691 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34692 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34693
34694 @kindex maint selftest
34695 @cindex self tests
34696 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
34697 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34698
34699 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34700 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34701 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34702 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34703 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34704 information.
34705
34706 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34707 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34708 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34709 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34710 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34711 always see the disassembly form.
34712
34713 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34714
34715 @smallexample
34716 (gdb) info addr argc
34717 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34718 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34719 @end smallexample
34720
34721 For more information on these expressions, see
34722 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34723
34724 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34725 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34726 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34727 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34728 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34729
34730 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34731 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34732 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34733 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34734 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34735 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34736 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34737 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34738 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34739
34740 @kindex maint set profile
34741 @kindex maint show profile
34742 @cindex profiling GDB
34743 @item maint set profile
34744 @itemx maint show profile
34745 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34746
34747 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34748 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34749 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34750 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34751 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34752 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34753 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34754
34755 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34756 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34757
34758 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34759 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34760 @cindex hardware debug registers
34761 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34762 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34763 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34764 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34765 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34766 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34767 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34768
34769 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34770 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34771 @item maint set show-all-tib
34772 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34773 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34774 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34775 command.
34776
34777 @kindex maint set target-async
34778 @kindex maint show target-async
34779 @item maint set target-async
34780 @itemx maint show target-async
34781 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34782 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34783 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34784 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34785
34786 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34787 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34788 @item maint set target-non-stop
34789 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34790
34791 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34792 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34793 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34794 if supported by the target.
34795
34796 @table @code
34797 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34798 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34799 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34800
34801 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34802 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34803 does not indicate support.
34804
34805 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34806 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34807 target supports it.
34808 @end table
34809
34810 @kindex maint set per-command
34811 @kindex maint show per-command
34812 @item maint set per-command
34813 @itemx maint show per-command
34814 @cindex resources used by commands
34815
34816 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34817 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34818
34819 @table @code
34820 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34821 @itemx maint show per-command space
34822 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34823 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34824 took, following the command's own output.
34825 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34826 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34827
34828 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34829 @itemx maint show per-command time
34830 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34831 for each command.
34832 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34833 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34834 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34835 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34836 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34837 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34838 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34839 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34840 spent by the program been debugged.
34841 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34842 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34843
34844 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34845 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34846 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34847 for each command.
34848 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34849
34850 @enumerate a
34851 @item
34852 number of symbol tables
34853 @item
34854 number of primary symbol tables
34855 @item
34856 number of blocks in the blockvector
34857 @end enumerate
34858 @end table
34859
34860 @kindex maint space
34861 @cindex memory used by commands
34862 @item maint space @var{value}
34863 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34864 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34865
34866 @kindex maint time
34867 @cindex time of command execution
34868 @item maint time @var{value}
34869 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34870 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34871
34872 @kindex maint translate-address
34873 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34874 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34875 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34876 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34877 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34878 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34879 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34880
34881 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34882 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34883 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34884
34885 @end table
34886
34887 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34888 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34889
34890 @table @code
34891 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34892 @kindex set watchdog
34893 @cindex watchdog timer
34894 @cindex timeout for commands
34895 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34896 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34897 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34898
34899 @item show watchdog
34900 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34901 @end table
34902
34903 @node Remote Protocol
34904 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34905
34906 @menu
34907 * Overview::
34908 * Packets::
34909 * Stop Reply Packets::
34910 * General Query Packets::
34911 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34912 * Tracepoint Packets::
34913 * Host I/O Packets::
34914 * Interrupts::
34915 * Notification Packets::
34916 * Remote Non-Stop::
34917 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34918 * Examples::
34919 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34920 * Library List Format::
34921 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34922 * Memory Map Format::
34923 * Thread List Format::
34924 * Traceframe Info Format::
34925 * Branch Trace Format::
34926 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34927 @end menu
34928
34929 @node Overview
34930 @section Overview
34931
34932 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34933 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34934 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34935 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34936
34937 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34938 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34939
34940 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34941 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34942 @cindex remote serial protocol
34943 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34944 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34945 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34946 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34947 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34948
34949 @smallexample
34950 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34951 @end smallexample
34952 @noindent
34953
34954 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34955 @noindent
34956 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34957 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34958 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34959
34960 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34961 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34962
34963 @smallexample
34964 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34965 @end smallexample
34966
34967 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34968 @noindent
34969 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34970 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34971 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34972
34973 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34974 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34975 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34976 retransmission):
34977
34978 @smallexample
34979 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34980 <- @code{+}
34981 @end smallexample
34982 @noindent
34983
34984 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34985 once a connection is established.
34986 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34987
34988 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34989 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34990 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34991 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34992 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34993 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34994 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34995
34996 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34997 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34998 exceptions).
34999
35000 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35001 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35002 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35003 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35004
35005 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35006 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35007 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35008
35009 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35010 @anchor{Binary Data}
35011 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35012 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35013 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35014 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35015 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35016 binary data.
35017
35018 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35019 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35020 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35021 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35022 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35023 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35024 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35025 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35026 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35027 (described next).
35028
35029 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35030 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35031 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35032 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35033 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35034 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35035 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35036 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35037 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35038 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35039 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35040 3}} more times.
35041
35042 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35043 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35044 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35045 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35046 @samp{0*"00}.
35047
35048 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35049 error number. That number is not well defined.
35050
35051 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35052 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35053 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35054 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35055 on that response.
35056
35057 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35058 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35059 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35060 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35061 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35062 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35063
35064 @node Packets
35065 @section Packets
35066
35067 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35068 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35069 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35070 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35071
35072 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35073 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35074 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35075 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35076 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35077 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35078 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35079 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35080 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35081 @var{baz}.
35082
35083 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35084 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35085 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35086 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35087 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35088 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35089 pick any thread.
35090
35091 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35092 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35093 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35094 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35095 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35096 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35097 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35098 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35099 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35100 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35101 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35102 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35103 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35104
35105 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35106 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35107 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35108 more information.
35109
35110 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35111 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35112
35113 Here are the packet descriptions.
35114
35115 @table @samp
35116
35117 @item !
35118 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35119 @anchor{extended mode}
35120 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35121 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35122 debugged.
35123
35124 Reply:
35125 @table @samp
35126 @item OK
35127 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35128 @end table
35129
35130 @item ?
35131 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35132 @anchor{? packet}
35133 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35134 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35135 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35136
35137 Reply:
35138 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35139
35140 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35141 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35142 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35143 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35144 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35145
35146 Reply:
35147 @table @samp
35148 @item OK
35149 The arguments were set.
35150 @item E @var{NN}
35151 An error occurred.
35152 @end table
35153
35154 @item b @var{baud}
35155 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35156 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35157 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35158
35159 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35160 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35161 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35162
35163 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35164 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35165 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35166 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35167 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35168
35169 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35170 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35171 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35172 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35173
35174 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35175 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35176
35177 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35178 @anchor{bc}
35179 @item bc
35180 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35181 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35182
35183 Reply:
35184 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35185
35186 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35187 @anchor{bs}
35188 @item bs
35189 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35190 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35191
35192 Reply:
35193 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35194
35195 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35196 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35197 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35198 is omitted, resume at current address.
35199
35200 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35201 packet}.
35202
35203 Reply:
35204 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35205
35206 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35207 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35208 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35209 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35210
35211 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35212 packet}.
35213
35214 Reply:
35215 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35216
35217 @item d
35218 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35219 Toggle debug flag.
35220
35221 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35222 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35223
35224 @item D
35225 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35226 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35227 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35228 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35229 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35230
35231 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35232 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35233 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35234 big-endian hex string.
35235
35236 Reply:
35237 @table @samp
35238 @item OK
35239 for success
35240 @item E @var{NN}
35241 for an error
35242 @end table
35243
35244 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35245 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35246 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35247 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35248 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35249
35250 @item g
35251 @anchor{read registers packet}
35252 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35253 Read general registers.
35254
35255 Reply:
35256 @table @samp
35257 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35258 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35259 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35260 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35261 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35262 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35263
35264 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35265 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35266 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35267 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35268 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35269 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35270 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35271 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35272
35273 @smallexample
35274 -> @code{g}
35275 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35276 @end smallexample
35277
35278 @item E @var{NN}
35279 for an error.
35280 @end table
35281
35282 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35283 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35284 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35285 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35286
35287 Reply:
35288 @table @samp
35289 @item OK
35290 for success
35291 @item E @var{NN}
35292 for an error
35293 @end table
35294
35295 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35296 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35297 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35298 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35299 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35300 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35301 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35302 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35303 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35304
35305 Reply:
35306 @table @samp
35307 @item OK
35308 for success
35309 @item E @var{NN}
35310 for an error
35311 @end table
35312
35313 @c FIXME: JTC:
35314 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35315 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35316 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35317 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35318 @c described. For example:
35319 @c
35320 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35321 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35322 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35323 @c
35324 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35325 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35326 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35327
35328 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35329 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35330 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35331 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35332 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35333 step starting at that address.
35334
35335 @item I
35336 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35337 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35338 step packet}.
35339
35340 @item k
35341 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35342 Kill request.
35343
35344 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35345
35346 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35347 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35348
35349 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35350
35351 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35352 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35353 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35354
35355 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35356 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35357 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35358
35359 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35360 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35361 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35362 (@pxref{? packet}).
35363
35364 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35365 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35366 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35367 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35368 any particular boundary.
35369
35370 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35371 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35372 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35373 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35374 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35375 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35376 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35377 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35378
35379 Reply:
35380 @table @samp
35381 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35382 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35383 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35384 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35385 @item E @var{NN}
35386 @var{NN} is errno
35387 @end table
35388
35389 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35390 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35391 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35392 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35393 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35394
35395 Reply:
35396 @table @samp
35397 @item OK
35398 for success
35399 @item E @var{NN}
35400 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35401 written).
35402 @end table
35403
35404 @item p @var{n}
35405 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35406 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35407 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35408 register value is encoded.
35409
35410 Reply:
35411 @table @samp
35412 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35413 the register's value
35414 @item E @var{NN}
35415 for an error
35416 @item @w{}
35417 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35418 @end table
35419
35420 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35421 @anchor{write register packet}
35422 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35423 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35424 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35425 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35426
35427 Reply:
35428 @table @samp
35429 @item OK
35430 for success
35431 @item E @var{NN}
35432 for an error
35433 @end table
35434
35435 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35436 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35437 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35438 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35439 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35440 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35441
35442 @item r
35443 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35444 Reset the entire system.
35445
35446 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35447
35448 @item R @var{XX}
35449 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35450 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35451 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35452
35453 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35454
35455 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35456 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35457 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35458 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35459
35460 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35461 packet}.
35462
35463 Reply:
35464 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35465
35466 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35467 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35468 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35469 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35470 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35471
35472 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35473 packet}.
35474
35475 Reply:
35476 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35477
35478 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35479 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35480 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35481 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35482 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35483
35484 @item T @var{thread-id}
35485 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35486 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35487
35488 Reply:
35489 @table @samp
35490 @item OK
35491 thread is still alive
35492 @item E @var{NN}
35493 thread is dead
35494 @end table
35495
35496 @item v
35497 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35498 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35499
35500 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35501 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35502 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35503 The process ID is a
35504 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35505 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35506 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35507
35508 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35509 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35510 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35511 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35512 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35513 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35514 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35515 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35516
35517 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35518
35519 Reply:
35520 @table @samp
35521 @item E @var{nn}
35522 for an error
35523 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35524 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35525 @item OK
35526 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35527 @end table
35528
35529 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35530 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35531 @anchor{vCont packet}
35532 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35533
35534 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35535 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35536 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35537 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35538 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35539 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35540 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35541 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35542 error.
35543
35544 Currently supported actions are:
35545
35546 @table @samp
35547 @item c
35548 Continue.
35549 @item C @var{sig}
35550 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35551 @item s
35552 Step.
35553 @item S @var{sig}
35554 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35555 @item t
35556 Stop.
35557 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35558 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35559 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35560 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35561 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35562 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35563
35564 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35565 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35566 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35567 jumps to @var{start}).
35568
35569 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35570 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35571 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35572
35573 @end table
35574
35575 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35576 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35577 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35578
35579 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35580 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35581 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35582 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35583 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35584 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35585 as an implementation detail.
35586
35587 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
35588 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
35589 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
35590 stopped.
35591
35592 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
35593 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
35594 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
35595
35596 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35597 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
35598
35599 Reply:
35600 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35601
35602 @item vCont?
35603 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35604 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35605
35606 Reply:
35607 @table @samp
35608 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35609 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35610 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35611 @item @w{}
35612 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35613 @end table
35614
35615 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35616 @item vCtrlC
35617 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35618 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35619 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35620 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35621 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35622 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35623 variant.
35624
35625 Reply:
35626 @table @samp
35627 @item E @var{nn}
35628 for an error
35629 @item OK
35630 for success
35631 @end table
35632
35633 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35634 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35635 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35636 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35637
35638 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35639 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35640 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35641 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35642 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35643 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35644 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35645 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35646 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35647 packet is received.
35648
35649 Reply:
35650 @table @samp
35651 @item OK
35652 for success
35653 @item E @var{NN}
35654 for an error
35655 @end table
35656
35657 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35658 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35659 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35660 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35661 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35662 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35663 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35664 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35665 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35666 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35667 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35668 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35669
35670
35671 Reply:
35672 @table @samp
35673 @item OK
35674 for success
35675 @item E.memtype
35676 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35677 @item E @var{NN}
35678 for an error
35679 @end table
35680
35681 @item vFlashDone
35682 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35683 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35684 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35685 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35686 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35687 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35688 request is completed.
35689
35690 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35691 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35692 @anchor{vKill packet}
35693 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35694 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35695 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35696 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35697
35698 Reply:
35699 @table @samp
35700 @item E @var{nn}
35701 for an error
35702 @item OK
35703 for success
35704 @end table
35705
35706 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35707 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35708 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35709 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35710 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35711 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35712 state.
35713
35714 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35715
35716 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35717
35718 Reply:
35719 @table @samp
35720 @item E @var{nn}
35721 for an error
35722 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35723 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35724 @end table
35725
35726 @item vStopped
35727 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35728 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35729
35730 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35731 @anchor{X packet}
35732 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35733 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35734 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35735 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35736 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35737
35738 Reply:
35739 @table @samp
35740 @item OK
35741 for success
35742 @item E @var{NN}
35743 for an error
35744 @end table
35745
35746 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35747 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35748 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35749 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35750 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35751 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35752 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35753
35754 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35755 separately.
35756
35757 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35758 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35759 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35760 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35761 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35762 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35763
35764 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35765 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35766 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35767 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35768 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
35769 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35770
35771 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35772 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35773 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
35774 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
35775 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35776 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
35777 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
35778 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
35779 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
35780 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
35781 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
35782 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
35783 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35784
35785 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35786 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35787
35788 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35789 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35790
35791 @table @samp
35792
35793 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35794 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35795 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35796
35797 @end table
35798
35799 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35800 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35801 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35802 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35803 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35804 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35805 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35806
35807 @table @samp
35808
35809 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35810 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35811 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35812
35813 @end table
35814
35815 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35816 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35817 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35818 target, is not defined.}
35819
35820 Reply:
35821 @table @samp
35822 @item OK
35823 success
35824 @item @w{}
35825 not supported
35826 @item E @var{NN}
35827 for an error
35828 @end table
35829
35830 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35831 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35832 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35833 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35834 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35835 address @var{addr}.
35836
35837 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35838 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
35839 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
35840 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35841
35842 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35843 movement.}
35844
35845 Reply:
35846 @table @samp
35847 @item OK
35848 success
35849 @item @w{}
35850 not supported
35851 @item E @var{NN}
35852 for an error
35853 @end table
35854
35855 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35856 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35857 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35858 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35859 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35860 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35861
35862 Reply:
35863 @table @samp
35864 @item OK
35865 success
35866 @item @w{}
35867 not supported
35868 @item E @var{NN}
35869 for an error
35870 @end table
35871
35872 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35873 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35874 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35875 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35876 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35877 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35878
35879 Reply:
35880 @table @samp
35881 @item OK
35882 success
35883 @item @w{}
35884 not supported
35885 @item E @var{NN}
35886 for an error
35887 @end table
35888
35889 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35890 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35891 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35892 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35893 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35894 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35895
35896 Reply:
35897 @table @samp
35898 @item OK
35899 success
35900 @item @w{}
35901 not supported
35902 @item E @var{NN}
35903 for an error
35904 @end table
35905
35906 @end table
35907
35908 @node Stop Reply Packets
35909 @section Stop Reply Packets
35910 @cindex stop reply packets
35911
35912 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35913 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35914 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35915 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35916 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35917 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35918 @value{GDBN} source code.
35919
35920 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
35921 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
35922 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35923
35924 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35925 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35926 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35927 components.
35928
35929 @table @samp
35930
35931 @item S @var{AA}
35932 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35933 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35934 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35935
35936 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35937 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35938 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35939 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35940 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35941 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35942 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35943 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35944
35945 @itemize @bullet
35946 @item
35947 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35948 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35949 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35950 two-digit hex number.
35951
35952 @item
35953 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35954 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35955
35956 @item
35957 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35958 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35959
35960 @item
35961 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35962 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35963 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35964 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35965
35966 @item
35967 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35968 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35969 future.
35970 @end itemize
35971
35972 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35973
35974 @table @samp
35975 @item watch
35976 @itemx rwatch
35977 @itemx awatch
35978 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35979 hex.
35980
35981 @item syscall_entry
35982 @itemx syscall_return
35983 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35984 syscall number, in hex.
35985
35986 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35987 @item library
35988 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35989 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35990 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35991
35992 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35993 @item replaylog
35994 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35995 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35996 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35997 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35998 for more information.
35999
36000 @item swbreak
36001 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36002 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36003 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36004 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36005 part must be left empty.
36006
36007 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36008 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36009 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36010 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36011 address.
36012
36013 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36014 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36015 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36016 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36017 indicating support.
36018
36019 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36020
36021 @item hwbreak
36022 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36023 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36024
36025 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36026 apply.
36027
36028 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36029 @item fork
36030 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36031 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36032 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36033 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36034 fork events.
36035
36036 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36037 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36038 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36039 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36040 indicating support.
36041
36042 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36043 @item vfork
36044 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36045 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36046 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36047 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36048 vfork events.
36049
36050 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36051 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36052 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36053 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36054 indicating support.
36055
36056 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36057 @item vforkdone
36058 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36059 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36060 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36061 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36062 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36063
36064 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36065 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36066 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36067 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36068 indicating support.
36069
36070 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36071 @item exec
36072 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36073 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36074 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36075
36076 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36077 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36078 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36079 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36080 indicating support.
36081
36082 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36083 @anchor{thread create event}
36084 @item create
36085 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36086 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36087 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36088 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36089 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36090 @var{r} part is ignored.
36091
36092 @end table
36093
36094 @item W @var{AA}
36095 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36096 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36097 applicable to certain targets.
36098
36099 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36100 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36101 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36102 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36103 hex strings.
36104
36105 @item X @var{AA}
36106 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36107 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36108
36109 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36110 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36111 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36112 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36113 hex strings.
36114
36115 @anchor{thread exit event}
36116 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36117 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36118
36119 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36120 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36121 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36122 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36123
36124 @item N
36125 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36126 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36127 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36128 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36129 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36130 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36131 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36132 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36133 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36134 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36135 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36136 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36137 support.
36138
36139 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36140 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36141 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36142 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36143 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36144
36145 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36146 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36147 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36148 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36149 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36150 system calls.
36151
36152 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36153 this very system call.
36154
36155 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36156 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36157 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36158 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36159 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36160 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36161
36162 @end table
36163
36164 @node General Query Packets
36165 @section General Query Packets
36166 @cindex remote query requests
36167
36168 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36169 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36170 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36171 sending information to and from the stub.
36172
36173 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36174 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36175 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36176 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36177 conventions:
36178
36179 @itemize @bullet
36180 @item
36181 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36182 @item
36183 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36184 letter.
36185 @item
36186 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36187 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36188 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36189 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36190 @end itemize
36191
36192 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36193 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36194 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36195 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36196 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36197 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36198 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36199 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36200 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36201 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36202 packet.}.
36203
36204 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36205 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36206 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36207 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36208 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36209
36210 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36211
36212 @table @samp
36213
36214 @item QAgent:1
36215 @itemx QAgent:0
36216 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36217 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36218
36219 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36220 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36221 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36222 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36223 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36224 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36225 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36226 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36227 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36228 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36229 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36230
36231 @item qC
36232 @cindex current thread, remote request
36233 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36234 Return the current thread ID.
36235
36236 Reply:
36237 @table @samp
36238 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36239 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36240 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36241 @item @r{(anything else)}
36242 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36243 @end table
36244
36245 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36246 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36247 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36248 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36249 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36250 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36251 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36252 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36253
36254 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36255 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36256 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36257 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36258 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36259 detect trailing zeros.
36260
36261 Reply:
36262 @table @samp
36263 @item E @var{NN}
36264 An error (such as memory fault)
36265 @item C @var{crc32}
36266 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36267 @end table
36268
36269 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36270 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36271 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36272 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36273 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36274 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36275 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36276 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36277 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36278 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36279 randomization.
36280
36281 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36282
36283 Reply:
36284 @table @samp
36285 @item OK
36286 The request succeeded.
36287
36288 @item E @var{nn}
36289 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36290
36291 @item @w{}
36292 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36293 by the stub.
36294 @end table
36295
36296 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36297 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36298 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36299 address space randomization.
36300
36301 @item qfThreadInfo
36302 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36303 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36304 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36305 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36306 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36307 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36308 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36309 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36310 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36311 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36312
36313 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36314
36315 Reply:
36316 @table @samp
36317 @item m @var{thread-id}
36318 A single thread ID
36319 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36320 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36321 @item l
36322 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36323 @end table
36324
36325 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36326 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36327 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36328 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36329 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36330 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36331 fields.
36332
36333 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36334 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36335 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36336 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36337 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36338
36339 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36340 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36341 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36342 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36343 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36344
36345 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36346 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36347
36348 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36349 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36350 information associated with the variable.)
36351
36352 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36353 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36354 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36355 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36356 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36357 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36358
36359 Reply:
36360 @table @samp
36361 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36362 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36363 local storage requested.
36364
36365 @item E @var{nn}
36366 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36367
36368 @item @w{}
36369 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36370 @end table
36371
36372 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36373 @cindex get thread information block address
36374 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36375 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36376
36377 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36378
36379 Reply:
36380 @table @samp
36381 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36382 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36383 thread information block.
36384
36385 @item E @var{nn}
36386 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36387 address could not be retrieved.
36388
36389 @item @w{}
36390 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36391 @end table
36392
36393 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36394 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36395 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36396 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36397 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36398 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36399 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36400
36401 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36402
36403 Reply:
36404 @table @samp
36405 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36406 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36407 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36408 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36409 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36410 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36411 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36412 @end table
36413
36414 @item qOffsets
36415 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36416 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36417 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36418 image.
36419
36420 Reply:
36421 @table @samp
36422 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36423 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36424 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36425 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36426 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36427 segments by the supplied offsets.
36428
36429 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36430 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36431 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36432
36433 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36434 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36435 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36436 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36437 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36438 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36439 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36440 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36441 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36442 @end table
36443
36444 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36445 @cindex thread information, remote request
36446 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36447 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36448 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36449 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36450
36451 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36452 (see below).
36453
36454 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36455
36456 @item QNonStop:1
36457 @itemx QNonStop:0
36458 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36459 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36460 @anchor{QNonStop}
36461 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36462 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36463
36464 Reply:
36465 @table @samp
36466 @item OK
36467 The request succeeded.
36468
36469 @item E @var{nn}
36470 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36471
36472 @item @w{}
36473 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36474 the stub.
36475 @end table
36476
36477 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36478 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36479 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36480 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36481
36482 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36483 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36484 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36485 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36486 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36487 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36488 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36489
36490 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36491 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36492 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36493
36494 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36495 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36496 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36497 report the requested syscalls.
36498
36499 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36500 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36501
36502 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36503 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36504 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36505 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36506
36507 Reply:
36508 @table @samp
36509 @item OK
36510 The request succeeded.
36511
36512 @item E @var{nn}
36513 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36514
36515 @item @w{}
36516 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36517 the stub.
36518 @end table
36519
36520 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36521 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36522 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36523 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36524
36525 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36526 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36527 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36528 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36529 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36530 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36531 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36532 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36533 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36534 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36535 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36536 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36537 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36538
36539 Reply:
36540 @table @samp
36541 @item OK
36542 The request succeeded.
36543
36544 @item E @var{nn}
36545 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36546
36547 @item @w{}
36548 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36549 the stub.
36550 @end table
36551
36552 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36553 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36554 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36555 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36556
36557 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36558 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36559 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36560 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36561 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36562 Others should be silently discarded.
36563
36564 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36565 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36566 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36567 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36568 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36569 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36570 signals.
36571
36572 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36573 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36574
36575 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36576 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36577 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36578 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36579 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36580
36581 Reply:
36582 @table @samp
36583 @item OK
36584 The request succeeded.
36585
36586 @item E @var{nn}
36587 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36588
36589 @item @w{}
36590 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36591 by the stub.
36592 @end table
36593
36594 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36595 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36596 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36597 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36598
36599 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36600 @item QThreadEvents:1
36601 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36602 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36603 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36604
36605 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36606 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36607 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36608 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36609 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36610 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36611 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36612 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36613 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36614 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36615
36616 Reply:
36617 @table @samp
36618 @item OK
36619 The request succeeded.
36620
36621 @item E @var{nn}
36622 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36623
36624 @item @w{}
36625 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36626 the stub.
36627 @end table
36628
36629 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36630 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36631
36632 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36633 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36634 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36635 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36636 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36637 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36638 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36639 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36640 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36641
36642 Reply:
36643 @table @samp
36644 @item OK
36645 A command response with no output.
36646 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36647 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36648 @item E @var{NN}
36649 Indicate a badly formed request.
36650 @item @w{}
36651 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36652 @end table
36653
36654 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36655 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36656 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36657 packets.)
36658
36659 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36660 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36661 @ifnotinfo
36662 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36663 @end ifnotinfo
36664 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36665 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36666 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36667 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36668 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36669
36670 Reply:
36671 @table @samp
36672 @item 0
36673 The pattern was not found.
36674 @item 1,address
36675 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36676 @item E @var{NN}
36677 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36678 @item @w{}
36679 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36680 @end table
36681
36682 @item QStartNoAckMode
36683 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36684 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36685 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36686 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36687
36688 Reply:
36689 @table @samp
36690 @item OK
36691 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36692 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36693 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36694 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36695 @item @w{}
36696 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36697 @end table
36698
36699 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36700 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36701 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36702 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36703 @anchor{qSupported}
36704 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36705 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36706 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36707 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36708 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36709 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36710 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36711 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36712 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36713 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36714 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36715 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36716 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36717 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36718
36719 Reply:
36720 @table @samp
36721 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36722 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36723 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36724 possible forms).
36725 @item @w{}
36726 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36727 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36728 @end table
36729
36730 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36731 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36732 are:
36733
36734 @table @samp
36735 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36736 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36737 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36738 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36739 @item @var{name}+
36740 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36741 need an associated value.
36742 @item @var{name}-
36743 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36744 @item @var{name}?
36745 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36746 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36747 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36748 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36749 @end table
36750
36751 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36752 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36753 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36754 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36755 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36756
36757 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36758 are defined:
36759
36760 @table @samp
36761 @item multiprocess
36762 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36763 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36764 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36765 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36766 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36767
36768 @item xmlRegisters
36769 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36770 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36771 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36772 description.
36773
36774 @item qRelocInsn
36775 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36776 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36777 instruction reply packet}).
36778
36779 @item swbreak
36780 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36781 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36782
36783 @item hwbreak
36784 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36785 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36786
36787 @item fork-events
36788 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36789 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36790 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36791 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36792
36793 @item vfork-events
36794 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36795 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36796 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36797 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36798
36799 @item exec-events
36800 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36801 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36802 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36803 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36804
36805 @item vContSupported
36806 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36807 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36808 @end table
36809
36810 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36811 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36812 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36813 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36814 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36815 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36816 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36817 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36818 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36819 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36820 all the features it supports.
36821
36822 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36823 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36824
36825 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36826 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36827 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36828 form response.
36829
36830 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36831 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36832 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36833 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36834
36835 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36836 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36837 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36838 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36839 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36840
36841 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36842
36843 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36844 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36845 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36846 @item Feature Name
36847 @tab Value Required
36848 @tab Default
36849 @tab Probe Allowed
36850
36851 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36852 @tab Yes
36853 @tab @samp{-}
36854 @tab No
36855
36856 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36857 @tab No
36858 @tab @samp{-}
36859 @tab Yes
36860
36861 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36862 @tab No
36863 @tab @samp{-}
36864 @tab Yes
36865
36866 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36867 @tab No
36868 @tab @samp{-}
36869 @tab Yes
36870
36871 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36872 @tab No
36873 @tab @samp{-}
36874 @tab Yes
36875
36876 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36877 @tab No
36878 @tab @samp{-}
36879 @tab Yes
36880
36881 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36882 @tab No
36883 @tab @samp{-}
36884 @tab Yes
36885
36886 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36887 @tab No
36888 @tab @samp{-}
36889 @tab Yes
36890
36891 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36892 @tab No
36893 @tab @samp{-}
36894 @tab No
36895
36896 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36897 @tab No
36898 @tab @samp{-}
36899 @tab Yes
36900
36901 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36902 @tab No
36903 @tab @samp{-}
36904 @tab Yes
36905
36906 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36907 @tab No
36908 @tab @samp{-}
36909 @tab Yes
36910
36911 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36912 @tab No
36913 @tab @samp{-}
36914 @tab Yes
36915
36916 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36917 @tab No
36918 @tab @samp{-}
36919 @tab Yes
36920
36921 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36922 @tab No
36923 @tab @samp{-}
36924 @tab Yes
36925
36926 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36927 @tab No
36928 @tab @samp{-}
36929 @tab Yes
36930
36931 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36932 @tab No
36933 @tab @samp{-}
36934 @tab Yes
36935
36936 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36937 @tab No
36938 @tab @samp{-}
36939 @tab Yes
36940
36941 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36942 @tab No
36943 @tab @samp{-}
36944 @tab Yes
36945
36946 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36947 @tab Yes
36948 @tab @samp{-}
36949 @tab Yes
36950
36951 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36952 @tab Yes
36953 @tab @samp{-}
36954 @tab Yes
36955
36956 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36957 @tab Yes
36958 @tab @samp{-}
36959 @tab Yes
36960
36961 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36962 @tab Yes
36963 @tab @samp{-}
36964 @tab Yes
36965
36966 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36967 @tab Yes
36968 @tab @samp{-}
36969 @tab Yes
36970
36971 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36972 @tab No
36973 @tab @samp{-}
36974 @tab Yes
36975
36976 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36977 @tab No
36978 @tab @samp{-}
36979 @tab Yes
36980
36981 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36982 @tab No
36983 @tab @samp{-}
36984 @tab Yes
36985
36986 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36987 @tab No
36988 @tab @samp{-}
36989 @tab Yes
36990
36991 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36992 @tab No
36993 @tab @samp{-}
36994 @tab No
36995
36996 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36997 @tab No
36998 @tab @samp{-}
36999 @tab No
37000
37001 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37002 @tab No
37003 @tab @samp{-}
37004 @tab No
37005
37006 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37007 @tab No
37008 @tab @samp{-}
37009 @tab No
37010
37011 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37012 @tab No
37013 @tab @samp{-}
37014 @tab No
37015
37016 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37017 @tab No
37018 @tab @samp{-}
37019 @tab No
37020
37021 @item @samp{QAgent}
37022 @tab No
37023 @tab @samp{-}
37024 @tab No
37025
37026 @item @samp{QAllow}
37027 @tab No
37028 @tab @samp{-}
37029 @tab No
37030
37031 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37032 @tab No
37033 @tab @samp{-}
37034 @tab No
37035
37036 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37037 @tab No
37038 @tab @samp{-}
37039 @tab No
37040
37041 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37042 @tab No
37043 @tab @samp{-}
37044 @tab No
37045
37046 @item @samp{tracenz}
37047 @tab No
37048 @tab @samp{-}
37049 @tab No
37050
37051 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37052 @tab No
37053 @tab @samp{-}
37054 @tab No
37055
37056 @item @samp{swbreak}
37057 @tab No
37058 @tab @samp{-}
37059 @tab No
37060
37061 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37062 @tab No
37063 @tab @samp{-}
37064 @tab No
37065
37066 @item @samp{fork-events}
37067 @tab No
37068 @tab @samp{-}
37069 @tab No
37070
37071 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37072 @tab No
37073 @tab @samp{-}
37074 @tab No
37075
37076 @item @samp{exec-events}
37077 @tab No
37078 @tab @samp{-}
37079 @tab No
37080
37081 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37082 @tab No
37083 @tab @samp{-}
37084 @tab No
37085
37086 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37087 @tab No
37088 @tab @samp{-}
37089 @tab No
37090
37091 @end multitable
37092
37093 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37094
37095 @table @samp
37096 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37097 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37098 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37099 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37100 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37101 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37102 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37103 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37104 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37105 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37106
37107 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37108 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37109 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37110
37111 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37112 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37113 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37114
37115 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37116 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37117 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37118
37119 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37120 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37121 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37122
37123 @item qXfer:features:read
37124 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37125 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37126
37127 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37128 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37129 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37130
37131 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37132 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37133 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37134
37135 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37136 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37137 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37138 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37139
37140 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37141 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37142 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37143
37144 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37145 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37146 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37147
37148 @item qXfer:spu:read
37149 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37150 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37151
37152 @item qXfer:spu:write
37153 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37154 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37155
37156 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37157 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37158 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37159
37160 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37161 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37162 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37163
37164 @item qXfer:threads:read
37165 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37166 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37167
37168 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37169 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37170 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37171
37172 @item qXfer:uib:read
37173 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37174 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37175
37176 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37177 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37178 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37179
37180 @item QNonStop
37181 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37182 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37183
37184 @item QCatchSyscalls
37185 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37186 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37187
37188 @item QPassSignals
37189 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37190 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37191
37192 @item QStartNoAckMode
37193 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37194 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37195
37196 @item multiprocess
37197 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37198 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37199 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37200 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37201 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37202 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37203 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37204 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37205 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37206 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37207 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37208
37209 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37210 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37211 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37212
37213 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37214 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37215 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37216 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37217
37218 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37219 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37220 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37221
37222 @item ReverseContinue
37223 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37224 (@pxref{bc}).
37225
37226 @item ReverseStep
37227 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37228 (@pxref{bs}).
37229
37230 @item TracepointSource
37231 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37232 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37233
37234 @item QAgent
37235 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37236
37237 @item QAllow
37238 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37239
37240 @item QDisableRandomization
37241 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37242
37243 @item StaticTracepoint
37244 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37245 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37246
37247 @item InstallInTrace
37248 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37249 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37250
37251 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37252 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37253 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37254 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37255
37256 @item QTBuffer:size
37257 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37258 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37259
37260 @item tracenz
37261 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37262 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37263 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37264
37265 @item BreakpointCommands
37266 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37267 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37268 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37269
37270 @item Qbtrace:off
37271 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37272
37273 @item Qbtrace:bts
37274 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37275
37276 @item Qbtrace:pt
37277 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37278
37279 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37280 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37281
37282 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37283 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37284
37285 @item swbreak
37286 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37287 breakpoints.
37288
37289 @item hwbreak
37290 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37291 breakpoints.
37292
37293 @item fork-events
37294 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37295
37296 @item vfork-events
37297 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37298 and vforkdone events.
37299
37300 @item exec-events
37301 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37302
37303 @item vContSupported
37304 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37305 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37306
37307 @item QThreadEvents
37308 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37309
37310 @item no-resumed
37311 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37312
37313 @end table
37314
37315 @item qSymbol::
37316 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37317 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37318 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37319 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37320
37321 Reply:
37322 @table @samp
37323 @item OK
37324 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37325 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37326 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37327 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37328 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37329 below.
37330 @end table
37331
37332 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37333 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37334
37335 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37336 target has previously requested.
37337
37338 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37339 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37340 will be empty.
37341
37342 Reply:
37343 @table @samp
37344 @item OK
37345 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37346 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37347 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37348 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37349 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37350 @end table
37351
37352 @item qTBuffer
37353 @itemx QTBuffer
37354 @itemx QTDisconnected
37355 @itemx QTDP
37356 @itemx QTDPsrc
37357 @itemx QTDV
37358 @itemx qTfP
37359 @itemx qTfV
37360 @itemx QTFrame
37361 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37362
37363 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37364
37365 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37366 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37367 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37368 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37369 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37370 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37371 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37372 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37373 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37374 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37375 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37376
37377 Reply:
37378 @table @samp
37379 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37380 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37381 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37382 the thread's attributes.
37383 @end table
37384
37385 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37386 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37387 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37388 packets.)
37389
37390 @item QTNotes
37391 @itemx qTP
37392 @itemx QTSave
37393 @itemx qTsP
37394 @itemx qTsV
37395 @itemx QTStart
37396 @itemx QTStop
37397 @itemx QTEnable
37398 @itemx QTDisable
37399 @itemx QTinit
37400 @itemx QTro
37401 @itemx qTStatus
37402 @itemx qTV
37403 @itemx qTfSTM
37404 @itemx qTsSTM
37405 @itemx qTSTMat
37406 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37407
37408 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37409 @cindex read special object, remote request
37410 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37411 @anchor{qXfer read}
37412 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37413 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37414 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37415 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37416 additional details about what data to access.
37417
37418 Reply:
37419 @table @samp
37420 @item m @var{data}
37421 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37422 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37423 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37424 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37425 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37426 request.
37427
37428 @item l @var{data}
37429 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37430 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37431 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37432
37433 @item l
37434 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37435 There is no more data to be read.
37436
37437 @item E00
37438 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37439
37440 @item E @var{nn}
37441 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37442 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37443
37444 @item @w{}
37445 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37446 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37447 @end table
37448
37449 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37450 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37451 formats, listed above.
37452
37453 @table @samp
37454 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37455 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37456 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37457 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37458
37459 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37460 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37461
37462 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37463 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37464
37465 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37466 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37467 packet may have one of the following values:
37468
37469 @table @code
37470 @item all
37471 Returns all available branch trace.
37472
37473 @item new
37474 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37475 the last read request.
37476
37477 @item delta
37478 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37479 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37480 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37481 used to stitch traces together.
37482
37483 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37484 @end table
37485
37486 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37487 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37488
37489 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37490 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37491
37492 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37493 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37494
37495 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37496 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37497
37498 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37499 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37500 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37501 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37502 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37503 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37504 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37505
37506 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37507 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37508
37509 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37510 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37511 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37512 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37513 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37514
37515 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37516 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37517
37518 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37519 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37520 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37521 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37522 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37523
37524 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37525 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37526 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37527
37528 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37529 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37530
37531 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37532 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37533 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37534 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37535 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37536 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37537 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37538 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37539
37540 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37541 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37542
37543 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37544 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37545
37546 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37547 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37548 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37549 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37550
37551 @table @code
37552 @item start=@var{address}
37553 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37554 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37555 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37556 chosen as the starting point.
37557
37558 @item prev=@var{address}
37559 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37560 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37561 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37562 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37563 exists prior to the starting point.
37564
37565 @end table
37566
37567 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37568 ignored.
37569
37570 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37571 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37572 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37573 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37574 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37575
37576 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37577 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37578
37579 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37580 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37581
37582 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37583 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37584 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37585 Action Lists}.
37586
37587 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37588 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37589 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37590
37591 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37592 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37593 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37594 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37595 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37596
37597 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37598 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37599 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37600
37601 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37602 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37603 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37604 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37605 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37606 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37607 in that context to be accessed.
37608
37609 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37610 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37611 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37612
37613 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37614 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37615 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37616 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37617 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37618
37619 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37620 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37621
37622 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37623 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37624
37625 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37626 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37627 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37628
37629 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37630 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37631
37632 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37633 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37634
37635 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37636 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37637
37638 This packet is not probed by default.
37639
37640 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37641 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37642 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37643 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37644 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37645
37646 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37647 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37648
37649 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37650 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37651 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37652 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37653
37654 @end table
37655
37656 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37657 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37658 @anchor{qXfer write}
37659 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37660 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37661 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37662 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37663 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37664 to access.
37665
37666 Reply:
37667 @table @samp
37668 @item @var{nn}
37669 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37670 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37671
37672 @item E00
37673 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37674
37675 @item E @var{nn}
37676 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37677 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37678
37679 @item @w{}
37680 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37681 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37682 @end table
37683
37684 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37685 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37686 formats, listed above.
37687
37688 @table @samp
37689 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37690 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37691 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37692 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37693 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37694
37695 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37696 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37697 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37698
37699 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37700 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37701 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37702 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37703 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37704 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37705 in that context to be accessed.
37706
37707 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37708 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37709 @end table
37710
37711 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37712 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37713 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37714 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37715 must respond with an empty packet.
37716
37717 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37718 @cindex query attached, remote request
37719 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37720 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37721 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37722 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37723 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37724 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37725 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37726
37727 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37728 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37729 the @code{quit} command.
37730
37731 Reply:
37732 @table @samp
37733 @item 1
37734 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37735 @item 0
37736 The remote server created a new process.
37737 @item E @var{NN}
37738 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37739 @end table
37740
37741 @item Qbtrace:bts
37742 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37743
37744 Reply:
37745 @table @samp
37746 @item OK
37747 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37748 @item E.errtext
37749 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37750 @end table
37751
37752 @item Qbtrace:pt
37753 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37754
37755 Reply:
37756 @table @samp
37757 @item OK
37758 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37759 @item E.errtext
37760 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37761 @end table
37762
37763 @item Qbtrace:off
37764 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37765
37766 Reply:
37767 @table @samp
37768 @item OK
37769 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37770 @item E.errtext
37771 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37772 @end table
37773
37774 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37775 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37776 btrace recording method in bts format.
37777
37778 Reply:
37779 @table @samp
37780 @item OK
37781 The ring buffer size has been set.
37782 @item E.errtext
37783 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37784 @end table
37785
37786 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37787 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37788 btrace recording method in pt format.
37789
37790 Reply:
37791 @table @samp
37792 @item OK
37793 The ring buffer size has been set.
37794 @item E.errtext
37795 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37796 @end table
37797
37798 @end table
37799
37800 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37801 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37802
37803 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37804 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37805 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37806
37807 @menu
37808 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37809 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37810 @end menu
37811
37812 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37813 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37814
37815 @menu
37816 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37817 @end menu
37818
37819 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37820 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37821 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37822
37823 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37824
37825 @table @r
37826
37827 @item 2
37828 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37829
37830 @item 3
37831 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37832
37833 @item 4
37834 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37835
37836 @end table
37837
37838 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37839 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37840
37841 @menu
37842 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37843 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37844 @end menu
37845
37846 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37847 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37848 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37849
37850 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37851 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37852 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37853 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37854 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37855 most-significant -- least-significant.
37856
37857 @table @r
37858
37859 @item MIPS32
37860 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37861 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37862 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37863
37864 @item MIPS64
37865 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37866 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37867 as @code{MIPS32}.
37868
37869 @end table
37870
37871 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37872 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37873 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37874
37875 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37876
37877 @table @r
37878
37879 @item 2
37880 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37881
37882 @item 3
37883 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37884
37885 @item 4
37886 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37887
37888 @item 5
37889 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37890
37891 @end table
37892
37893 @node Tracepoint Packets
37894 @section Tracepoint Packets
37895 @cindex tracepoint packets
37896 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37897
37898 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37899 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37900
37901 @table @samp
37902
37903 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37904 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37905 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37906 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37907 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37908 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37909 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37910 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37911 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37912 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37913 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37914 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37915 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37916 actions.
37917
37918 Replies:
37919 @table @samp
37920 @item OK
37921 The packet was understood and carried out.
37922 @item qRelocInsn
37923 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37924 @item @w{}
37925 The packet was not recognized.
37926 @end table
37927
37928 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37929 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37930 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37931 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37932 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37933 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37934 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37935
37936 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37937 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37938 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37939 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37940 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37941 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37942 tracepoint actions.
37943
37944 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37945 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37946 following forms:
37947
37948 @table @samp
37949
37950 @item R @var{mask}
37951 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37952 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37953 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37954 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37955 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37956
37957 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37958 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37959 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37960 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37961 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37962 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37963 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37964
37965 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37966 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37967 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37968 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37969 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37970 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37971 packet).
37972
37973 @end table
37974
37975 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37976 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37977 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37978 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37979 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37980 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37981 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37982 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37983
37984 Replies:
37985 @table @samp
37986 @item OK
37987 The packet was understood and carried out.
37988 @item qRelocInsn
37989 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37990 @item @w{}
37991 The packet was not recognized.
37992 @end table
37993
37994 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37995 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37996 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37997 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37998 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37999 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38000 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38001 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38002
38003 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38004 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38005 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38006 fit in a single packet.
38007 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38008 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38009
38010 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38011 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38012 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38013 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38014
38015 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38016 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38017 query packets.
38018
38019 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38020 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38021 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38022 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38023 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38024 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38025 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38026 be found.
38027
38028 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38029 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38030 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38031 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38032 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38033 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38034 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38035 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38036 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38037 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38038 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38039 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38040 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38041 variable.
38042
38043 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38044 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38045 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38046 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38047 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38048
38049 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38050 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38051 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38052 one of the following forms:
38053
38054 @table @samp
38055 @item F @var{f}
38056 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38057 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38058 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38059
38060 @item T @var{t}
38061 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38062 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38063
38064 @end table
38065
38066 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38067 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38068 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38069 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38070
38071 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38072 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38073 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38074 is a hexadecimal number.
38075
38076 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38077 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38078 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38079 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38080 numbers.
38081
38082 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38083 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38084 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38085
38086 @item qTMinFTPILen
38087 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38088 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38089 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38090 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38091 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38092 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38093 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38094 arrange for that.
38095
38096 Replies:
38097
38098 @table @samp
38099 @item 0
38100 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38101 @item @var{length}
38102 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38103 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38104 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38105 regardless of size.
38106 @item E
38107 An error has occurred.
38108 @item @w{}
38109 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38110 @end table
38111
38112 @item QTStart
38113 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38114 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38115 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38116 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38117 instruction reply packet}).
38118
38119 @item QTStop
38120 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38121 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38122
38123 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38124 @anchor{QTEnable}
38125 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38126 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38127 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38128 of data from it will resume.
38129
38130 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38131 @anchor{QTDisable}
38132 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38133 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38134 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38135 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38136
38137 @item QTinit
38138 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38139 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38140
38141 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38142 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38143 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38144 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38145 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38146
38147 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38148 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38149 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38150 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38151
38152 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38153 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38154 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38155 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38156 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38157 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38158
38159 @item qTStatus
38160 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38161 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38162
38163 The reply has the form:
38164
38165 @table @samp
38166
38167 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38168 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38169 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38170 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38171
38172 @end table
38173
38174 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38175 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38176
38177 @table @samp
38178
38179 @item tnotrun:0
38180 No trace has been run yet.
38181
38182 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38183 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38184 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38185 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38186 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38187
38188 @item tfull:0
38189 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38190
38191 @item tdisconnected:0
38192 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38193
38194 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38195 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38196
38197 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38198 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38199 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38200 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38201 is hex encoded.
38202
38203 @item tunknown:0
38204 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38205
38206 @end table
38207
38208 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38209 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38210 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38211 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38212 trace.
38213
38214 @table @samp
38215
38216 @item tframes:@var{n}
38217 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38218
38219 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38220 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38221 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38222
38223 @item tsize:@var{n}
38224 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38225
38226 @item tfree:@var{n}
38227 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38228
38229 @item circular:@var{n}
38230 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38231 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38232 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38233 and may fill up.
38234
38235 @item disconn:@var{n}
38236 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38237 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38238 that the trace run will stop.
38239
38240 @end table
38241
38242 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38243 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38244 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38245 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38246 address @var{addr}.
38247
38248 Replies:
38249 @table @samp
38250 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38251 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38252 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38253 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38254 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38255
38256 @end table
38257
38258 @item qTV:@var{var}
38259 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38260 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38261 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38262
38263 Replies:
38264 @table @samp
38265 @item V@var{value}
38266 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38267 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38268 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38269 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38270 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38271 program is running.
38272
38273 @item U
38274 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38275 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38276 was not collected.
38277 @end table
38278
38279 @item qTfP
38280 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38281 @itemx qTsP
38282 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38283 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38284 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38285 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38286 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38287 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38288
38289 @item qTfV
38290 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38291 @itemx qTsV
38292 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38293 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38294 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38295 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38296 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38297 trace state variables.
38298
38299 @item qTfSTM
38300 @itemx qTsSTM
38301 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38302 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38303 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38304 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38305 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38306 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38307 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38308 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38309
38310 Reply:
38311 @table @samp
38312 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38313 A single marker
38314 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38315 a comma-separated list of markers
38316 @item l
38317 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38318 @item E @var{nn}
38319 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38320 @item @w{}
38321 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38322 stub.
38323 @end table
38324
38325 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38326 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38327
38328 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38329 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38330 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38331 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38332 @dfn{last}).
38333
38334 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38335 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38336 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38337 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38338 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38339 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38340 tracepoint markers.
38341
38342 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38343 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38344 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38345 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38346 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38347 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38348
38349 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38350 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38351 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38352 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38353 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38354 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38355 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38356 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38357 available.
38358
38359 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38360 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38361 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38362
38363 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38364 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38365 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38366 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38367 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38368 use whatever size it prefers.
38369
38370 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38371 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38372 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38373 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38374 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38375
38376 @end table
38377
38378 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38379 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38380 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38381 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38382 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38383 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38384 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38385 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38386 it had executed in the original location.
38387
38388 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38389 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38390 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38391 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38392 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38393 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38394 format of the request is:
38395
38396 @table @samp
38397 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38398
38399 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38400 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38401 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38402 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38403 memory starting at @var{to}.
38404 @end table
38405
38406 Replies:
38407 @table @samp
38408 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38409 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38410 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38411 @item E @var{NN}
38412 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38413 relocating the instruction.
38414 @end table
38415
38416 @node Host I/O Packets
38417 @section Host I/O Packets
38418 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38419 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38420
38421 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38422 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38423 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38424 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38425 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38426 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38427 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38428 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38429 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38430 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38431
38432 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38433 its arguments. They have this format:
38434
38435 @table @samp
38436
38437 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38438 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38439 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38440 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38441 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38442 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38443 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38444 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38445 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38446
38447 @end table
38448
38449 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38450
38451 @table @samp
38452
38453 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38454 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38455 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38456 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38457 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38458 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38459 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38460 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38461 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38462 @var{attachment}.
38463
38464 @item @w{}
38465 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38466
38467 @end table
38468
38469 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38470
38471 @table @samp
38472 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38473 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38474 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38475 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38476 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38477 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38478 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38479
38480 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38481 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38482 -1 if an error occurs.
38483
38484 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38485 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38486 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38487 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38488 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38489 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38490 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38491 @var{count} was zero.
38492
38493 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38494 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38495 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38496 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38497 some characters were escaped.
38498
38499 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38500 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38501 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38502 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38503 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38504 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38505 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38506 error occurred.
38507
38508 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38509 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38510 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38511 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38512 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38513 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38514
38515 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38516 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38517 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38518
38519 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38520 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38521 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38522
38523 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38524 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38525 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38526 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38527 some characters were escaped.
38528
38529 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38530 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38531 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38532 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38533 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38534 inferior(s).
38535
38536 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38537 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38538 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38539 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38540 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38541 operation.
38542
38543 @end table
38544
38545 @node Interrupts
38546 @section Interrupts
38547 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38548 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38549
38550 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38551 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38552 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38553 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38554
38555 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38556 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38557 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38558 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38559 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38560
38561 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38562 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38563 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38564 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38565 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38566 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38567 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38568 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38569
38570 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38571 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38572 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38573
38574 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38575 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38576 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38577 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38578 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38579 @code{0x03}.
38580
38581 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38582 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38583 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38584 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38585 currently-executing threads and processes.
38586 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38587 running program, it should send one of the stop
38588 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38589 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38590 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38591 Interrupts received while the
38592 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38593 it is resumed next time.
38594
38595 @node Notification Packets
38596 @section Notification Packets
38597 @cindex notification packets
38598 @cindex packets, notification
38599
38600 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38601 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38602 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38603 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38604 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38605 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38606 is not a problem.
38607
38608 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38609 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38610 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38611 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38612 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38613 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38614 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38615
38616 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38617 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38618
38619 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38620 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38621 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38622 not they understand it.
38623
38624 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38625 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38626 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38627 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38628 recipients.
38629
38630 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38631 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38632 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38633 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38634 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38635
38636 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38637 @table @samp
38638 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38639 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38640 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38641 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38642 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38643 @item @var{ack}
38644 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38645 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38646 @end table
38647
38648 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38649 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38650
38651 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38652 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38653 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38654 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38655 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38656 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38657 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38658 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38659 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38660 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38661
38662 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38663 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38664 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38665 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38666 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38667 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38668
38669 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38670 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38671 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38672 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38673 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38674
38675 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38676 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38677 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38678 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38679 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38680 normally.
38681
38682 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38683 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38684 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38685 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38686 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38687 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38688 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38689 the process shall be repeated.
38690
38691 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38692 following example:
38693 @smallexample
38694 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38695 @code{...}
38696 -> @code{vStopped}
38697 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38698 -> @code{vStopped}
38699 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38700 -> @code{vStopped}
38701 <- @code{OK}
38702 @end smallexample
38703
38704 The following notifications are defined:
38705 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38706
38707 @item Notification
38708 @tab Ack
38709 @tab Event
38710 @tab Description
38711
38712 @item Stop
38713 @tab vStopped
38714 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38715 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38716 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38717 @value{GDBN}.
38718 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38719
38720 @end multitable
38721
38722 @node Remote Non-Stop
38723 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38724
38725 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38726 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38727 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38728 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38729
38730 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38731 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38732 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38733 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38734 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38735 probe the target state after a mode change.
38736
38737 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38738 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38739 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38740 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38741 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38742 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38743 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38744 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38745 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38746 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38747 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38748
38749 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38750 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38751 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38752 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38753 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38754 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38755 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38756 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38757 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38758 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38759 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38760 @samp{OK}.
38761
38762 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38763 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38764 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38765 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38766 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38767 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38768 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38769 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38770 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38771 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38772 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38773 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38774 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38775
38776 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38777 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38778
38779 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38780 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38781 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38782 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38783 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38784 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38785 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38786
38787 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38788 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38789 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38790 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38791 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38792
38793 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38794 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38795 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38796 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38797
38798 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38799 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38800 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38801 @pxref{qSupported}.
38802 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38803 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38804 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38805 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38806 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38807 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38808 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38809
38810 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38811 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38812 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38813 connection.
38814 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38815 new connection is established,
38816 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38817 for the current connection, once disabled.
38818
38819 @node Examples
38820 @section Examples
38821
38822 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38823 does not get any direct output:
38824
38825 @smallexample
38826 -> @code{R00}
38827 <- @code{+}
38828 @emph{target restarts}
38829 -> @code{?}
38830 <- @code{+}
38831 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38832 -> @code{+}
38833 @end smallexample
38834
38835 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38836
38837 @smallexample
38838 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38839 <- @code{+}
38840 -> @code{s}
38841 <- @code{+}
38842 @emph{time passes}
38843 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38844 -> @code{+}
38845 -> @code{g}
38846 <- @code{+}
38847 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38848 -> @code{+}
38849 @end smallexample
38850
38851 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38852 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38853 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38854
38855 @menu
38856 * File-I/O Overview::
38857 * Protocol Basics::
38858 * The F Request Packet::
38859 * The F Reply Packet::
38860 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38861 * Console I/O::
38862 * List of Supported Calls::
38863 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38864 * Constants::
38865 * File-I/O Examples::
38866 @end menu
38867
38868 @node File-I/O Overview
38869 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38870 @cindex file-i/o overview
38871
38872 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38873 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38874 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38875 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38876 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38877 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38878
38879 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38880 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38881 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38882 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38883 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38884
38885 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38886 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38887 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38888 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38889 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38890 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38891 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38892
38893 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38894 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38895 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38896 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38897 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38898
38899 @smallexample
38900 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38901 <- target requests 'system call X'
38902 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38903 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38904 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38905 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38906 @end smallexample
38907
38908 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38909 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38910 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38911 system are not supported by this protocol.
38912
38913 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38914
38915 @node Protocol Basics
38916 @subsection Protocol Basics
38917 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38918
38919 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38920 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38921 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38922 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38923 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38924 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38925 to call the appropriate host system call:
38926
38927 @itemize @bullet
38928 @item
38929 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38930
38931 @item
38932 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38933 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38934 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38935 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38936
38937 @end itemize
38938
38939 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38940
38941 @itemize @bullet
38942 @item
38943 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38944 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38945 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38946 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38947 packet.
38948
38949 @item
38950 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38951 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38952
38953 @item
38954 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38955
38956 @item
38957 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38958
38959 @item
38960 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38961 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38962 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38963 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38964 packet.
38965
38966 @end itemize
38967
38968 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38969 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38970
38971 @itemize @bullet
38972 @item
38973 Return value.
38974
38975 @item
38976 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38977
38978 @item
38979 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38980
38981 @end itemize
38982
38983 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38984 the latest continue or step action.
38985
38986 @node The F Request Packet
38987 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38988 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38989 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38990
38991 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38992
38993 @table @samp
38994 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38995
38996 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38997 This is just the name of the function.
38998
38999 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39000 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39001 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39002 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39003 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39004 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39005 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39006
39007 @end table
39008
39009
39010
39011 @node The F Reply Packet
39012 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39013 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39014 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39015
39016 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39017
39018 @table @samp
39019
39020 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39021
39022 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39023
39024 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39025 representation.
39026 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39027
39028 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39029 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39030 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39031
39032 @smallexample
39033 F0,0,C
39034 @end smallexample
39035
39036 @noindent
39037 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39038
39039 @smallexample
39040 F-1,4,C
39041 @end smallexample
39042
39043 @noindent
39044 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39045
39046 @end table
39047
39048
39049 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39050 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39051 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39052
39053 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39054 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39055 the target should behave as if it had
39056 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39057 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39058 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39059 packet.
39060
39061 It's important for the target to know in which
39062 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39063
39064 @itemize @bullet
39065 @item
39066 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39067
39068 @item
39069 The system call on the host has been finished.
39070
39071 @end itemize
39072
39073 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39074 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39075 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39076 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39077 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39078 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39079
39080 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39081 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39082 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39083 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39084 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39085 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39086 or the full action has been completed.
39087
39088 @node Console I/O
39089 @subsection Console I/O
39090 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39091
39092 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39093 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39094 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39095 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39096 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39097 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39098 conditions is met:
39099
39100 @itemize @bullet
39101 @item
39102 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39103 @code{read}
39104 system call is treated as finished.
39105
39106 @item
39107 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39108 newline.
39109
39110 @item
39111 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39112 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39113
39114 @end itemize
39115
39116 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39117 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39118 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39119 is stopped at the user's request.
39120
39121
39122 @node List of Supported Calls
39123 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39124 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39125
39126 @menu
39127 * open::
39128 * close::
39129 * read::
39130 * write::
39131 * lseek::
39132 * rename::
39133 * unlink::
39134 * stat/fstat::
39135 * gettimeofday::
39136 * isatty::
39137 * system::
39138 @end menu
39139
39140 @node open
39141 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39142 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39143
39144 @table @asis
39145 @item Synopsis:
39146 @smallexample
39147 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39148 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39149 @end smallexample
39150
39151 @item Request:
39152 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39153
39154 @noindent
39155 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39156
39157 @table @code
39158 @item O_CREAT
39159 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39160 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39161 are concerned.
39162
39163 @item O_EXCL
39164 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39165 an error and open() fails.
39166
39167 @item O_TRUNC
39168 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39169 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39170 truncated to zero length.
39171
39172 @item O_APPEND
39173 The file is opened in append mode.
39174
39175 @item O_RDONLY
39176 The file is opened for reading only.
39177
39178 @item O_WRONLY
39179 The file is opened for writing only.
39180
39181 @item O_RDWR
39182 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39183 @end table
39184
39185 @noindent
39186 Other bits are silently ignored.
39187
39188
39189 @noindent
39190 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39191
39192 @table @code
39193 @item S_IRUSR
39194 User has read permission.
39195
39196 @item S_IWUSR
39197 User has write permission.
39198
39199 @item S_IRGRP
39200 Group has read permission.
39201
39202 @item S_IWGRP
39203 Group has write permission.
39204
39205 @item S_IROTH
39206 Others have read permission.
39207
39208 @item S_IWOTH
39209 Others have write permission.
39210 @end table
39211
39212 @noindent
39213 Other bits are silently ignored.
39214
39215
39216 @item Return value:
39217 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39218 occurred.
39219
39220 @item Errors:
39221
39222 @table @code
39223 @item EEXIST
39224 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39225
39226 @item EISDIR
39227 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39228
39229 @item EACCES
39230 The requested access is not allowed.
39231
39232 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39233 @var{pathname} was too long.
39234
39235 @item ENOENT
39236 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39237
39238 @item ENODEV
39239 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39240
39241 @item EROFS
39242 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39243 write access was requested.
39244
39245 @item EFAULT
39246 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39247
39248 @item ENOSPC
39249 No space on device to create the file.
39250
39251 @item EMFILE
39252 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39253
39254 @item ENFILE
39255 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39256 has been reached.
39257
39258 @item EINTR
39259 The call was interrupted by the user.
39260 @end table
39261
39262 @end table
39263
39264 @node close
39265 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39266 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39267
39268 @table @asis
39269 @item Synopsis:
39270 @smallexample
39271 int close(int fd);
39272 @end smallexample
39273
39274 @item Request:
39275 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39276
39277 @item Return value:
39278 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39279
39280 @item Errors:
39281
39282 @table @code
39283 @item EBADF
39284 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39285
39286 @item EINTR
39287 The call was interrupted by the user.
39288 @end table
39289
39290 @end table
39291
39292 @node read
39293 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39294 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39295
39296 @table @asis
39297 @item Synopsis:
39298 @smallexample
39299 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39300 @end smallexample
39301
39302 @item Request:
39303 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39304
39305 @item Return value:
39306 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39307 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39308 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39309
39310 @item Errors:
39311
39312 @table @code
39313 @item EBADF
39314 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39315 reading.
39316
39317 @item EFAULT
39318 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39319
39320 @item EINTR
39321 The call was interrupted by the user.
39322 @end table
39323
39324 @end table
39325
39326 @node write
39327 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39328 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39329
39330 @table @asis
39331 @item Synopsis:
39332 @smallexample
39333 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39334 @end smallexample
39335
39336 @item Request:
39337 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39338
39339 @item Return value:
39340 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39341 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39342 is returned.
39343
39344 @item Errors:
39345
39346 @table @code
39347 @item EBADF
39348 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39349 writing.
39350
39351 @item EFAULT
39352 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39353
39354 @item EFBIG
39355 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39356 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39357
39358 @item ENOSPC
39359 No space on device to write the data.
39360
39361 @item EINTR
39362 The call was interrupted by the user.
39363 @end table
39364
39365 @end table
39366
39367 @node lseek
39368 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39369 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39370
39371 @table @asis
39372 @item Synopsis:
39373 @smallexample
39374 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39375 @end smallexample
39376
39377 @item Request:
39378 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39379
39380 @var{flag} is one of:
39381
39382 @table @code
39383 @item SEEK_SET
39384 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39385
39386 @item SEEK_CUR
39387 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39388 bytes.
39389
39390 @item SEEK_END
39391 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39392 bytes.
39393 @end table
39394
39395 @item Return value:
39396 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39397 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39398 value of -1 is returned.
39399
39400 @item Errors:
39401
39402 @table @code
39403 @item EBADF
39404 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39405
39406 @item ESPIPE
39407 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39408
39409 @item EINVAL
39410 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39411
39412 @item EINTR
39413 The call was interrupted by the user.
39414 @end table
39415
39416 @end table
39417
39418 @node rename
39419 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39420 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39421
39422 @table @asis
39423 @item Synopsis:
39424 @smallexample
39425 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39426 @end smallexample
39427
39428 @item Request:
39429 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39430
39431 @item Return value:
39432 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39433
39434 @item Errors:
39435
39436 @table @code
39437 @item EISDIR
39438 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39439 directory.
39440
39441 @item EEXIST
39442 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39443
39444 @item EBUSY
39445 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39446 process.
39447
39448 @item EINVAL
39449 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39450 of itself.
39451
39452 @item ENOTDIR
39453 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39454 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39455 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39456
39457 @item EFAULT
39458 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39459
39460 @item EACCES
39461 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39462
39463 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39464
39465 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39466
39467 @item ENOENT
39468 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39469
39470 @item EROFS
39471 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39472
39473 @item ENOSPC
39474 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39475 directory entry.
39476
39477 @item EINTR
39478 The call was interrupted by the user.
39479 @end table
39480
39481 @end table
39482
39483 @node unlink
39484 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39485 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39486
39487 @table @asis
39488 @item Synopsis:
39489 @smallexample
39490 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39491 @end smallexample
39492
39493 @item Request:
39494 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39495
39496 @item Return value:
39497 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39498
39499 @item Errors:
39500
39501 @table @code
39502 @item EACCES
39503 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39504
39505 @item EPERM
39506 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39507
39508 @item EBUSY
39509 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39510 being used by another process.
39511
39512 @item EFAULT
39513 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39514
39515 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39516 @var{pathname} was too long.
39517
39518 @item ENOENT
39519 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39520
39521 @item ENOTDIR
39522 A component of the path is not a directory.
39523
39524 @item EROFS
39525 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39526
39527 @item EINTR
39528 The call was interrupted by the user.
39529 @end table
39530
39531 @end table
39532
39533 @node stat/fstat
39534 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39535 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39536 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39537
39538 @table @asis
39539 @item Synopsis:
39540 @smallexample
39541 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39542 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39543 @end smallexample
39544
39545 @item Request:
39546 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39547 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39548
39549 @item Return value:
39550 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39551
39552 @item Errors:
39553
39554 @table @code
39555 @item EBADF
39556 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39557
39558 @item ENOENT
39559 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39560 path is an empty string.
39561
39562 @item ENOTDIR
39563 A component of the path is not a directory.
39564
39565 @item EFAULT
39566 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39567
39568 @item EACCES
39569 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39570
39571 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39572 @var{pathname} was too long.
39573
39574 @item EINTR
39575 The call was interrupted by the user.
39576 @end table
39577
39578 @end table
39579
39580 @node gettimeofday
39581 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39582 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39583
39584 @table @asis
39585 @item Synopsis:
39586 @smallexample
39587 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39588 @end smallexample
39589
39590 @item Request:
39591 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39592
39593 @item Return value:
39594 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39595
39596 @item Errors:
39597
39598 @table @code
39599 @item EINVAL
39600 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39601
39602 @item EFAULT
39603 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39604 @end table
39605
39606 @end table
39607
39608 @node isatty
39609 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39610 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39611
39612 @table @asis
39613 @item Synopsis:
39614 @smallexample
39615 int isatty(int fd);
39616 @end smallexample
39617
39618 @item Request:
39619 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39620
39621 @item Return value:
39622 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39623
39624 @item Errors:
39625
39626 @table @code
39627 @item EINTR
39628 The call was interrupted by the user.
39629 @end table
39630
39631 @end table
39632
39633 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39634 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39635 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39636 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39637 needed.
39638
39639
39640 @node system
39641 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39642 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39643
39644 @table @asis
39645 @item Synopsis:
39646 @smallexample
39647 int system(const char *command);
39648 @end smallexample
39649
39650 @item Request:
39651 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39652
39653 @item Return value:
39654 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39655 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39656 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39657 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39658 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39659 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39660 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39661
39662 @item Errors:
39663
39664 @table @code
39665 @item EINTR
39666 The call was interrupted by the user.
39667 @end table
39668
39669 @end table
39670
39671 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39672 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39673 the host is simplified before it's returned
39674 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39675 is discarded, and the return value consists
39676 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39677
39678 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39679 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39680 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39681
39682 @table @code
39683 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39684 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39685 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39686 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39687
39688 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39689 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39690 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39691 protocol.
39692 @end table
39693
39694 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39695 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39696 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39697
39698 @menu
39699 * Integral Datatypes::
39700 * Pointer Values::
39701 * Memory Transfer::
39702 * struct stat::
39703 * struct timeval::
39704 @end menu
39705
39706 @node Integral Datatypes
39707 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39708 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39709
39710 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39711 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39712 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39713
39714 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39715 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39716
39717 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39718
39719 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39720 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39721
39722 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39723
39724 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39725 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39726 byte order.
39727
39728 @node Pointer Values
39729 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39730 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39731
39732 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39733 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39734 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39735 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39736
39737 @smallexample
39738 @code{1aaf/12}
39739 @end smallexample
39740
39741 @noindent
39742 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39743 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39744 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39745 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39746
39747 @smallexample
39748 @code{123456/d}
39749 @end smallexample
39750
39751 @node Memory Transfer
39752 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39753 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39754
39755 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39756 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39757 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39758 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39759 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39760 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39761 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39762
39763
39764 @node struct stat
39765 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39766 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39767
39768 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39769 is defined as follows:
39770
39771 @smallexample
39772 struct stat @{
39773 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39774 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39775 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39776 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39777 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39778 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39779 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39780 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39781 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39782 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39783 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39784 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39785 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39786 @};
39787 @end smallexample
39788
39789 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39790 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39791 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39792
39793 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39794 range of values.
39795
39796 @table @code
39797
39798 @item st_dev
39799 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39800
39801 @item st_ino
39802 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39803
39804 @item st_mode
39805 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39806 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39807
39808 @item st_uid
39809 @itemx st_gid
39810 @itemx st_rdev
39811 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39812
39813 @item st_atime
39814 @itemx st_mtime
39815 @itemx st_ctime
39816 These values have a host and file system dependent
39817 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39818 support exact timing values.
39819 @end table
39820
39821 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39822 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39823 continuing.
39824
39825 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39826 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39827 get truncated on the target.
39828
39829 @node struct timeval
39830 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39831 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39832
39833 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39834 is defined as follows:
39835
39836 @smallexample
39837 struct timeval @{
39838 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39839 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39840 @};
39841 @end smallexample
39842
39843 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39844 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39845 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39846
39847 @node Constants
39848 @subsection Constants
39849 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39850
39851 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39852 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39853 values before and after the call as needed.
39854
39855 @menu
39856 * Open Flags::
39857 * mode_t Values::
39858 * Errno Values::
39859 * Lseek Flags::
39860 * Limits::
39861 @end menu
39862
39863 @node Open Flags
39864 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39865 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39866
39867 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39868
39869 @smallexample
39870 O_RDONLY 0x0
39871 O_WRONLY 0x1
39872 O_RDWR 0x2
39873 O_APPEND 0x8
39874 O_CREAT 0x200
39875 O_TRUNC 0x400
39876 O_EXCL 0x800
39877 @end smallexample
39878
39879 @node mode_t Values
39880 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39881 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39882
39883 All values are given in octal representation.
39884
39885 @smallexample
39886 S_IFREG 0100000
39887 S_IFDIR 040000
39888 S_IRUSR 0400
39889 S_IWUSR 0200
39890 S_IXUSR 0100
39891 S_IRGRP 040
39892 S_IWGRP 020
39893 S_IXGRP 010
39894 S_IROTH 04
39895 S_IWOTH 02
39896 S_IXOTH 01
39897 @end smallexample
39898
39899 @node Errno Values
39900 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39901 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39902
39903 All values are given in decimal representation.
39904
39905 @smallexample
39906 EPERM 1
39907 ENOENT 2
39908 EINTR 4
39909 EBADF 9
39910 EACCES 13
39911 EFAULT 14
39912 EBUSY 16
39913 EEXIST 17
39914 ENODEV 19
39915 ENOTDIR 20
39916 EISDIR 21
39917 EINVAL 22
39918 ENFILE 23
39919 EMFILE 24
39920 EFBIG 27
39921 ENOSPC 28
39922 ESPIPE 29
39923 EROFS 30
39924 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39925 EUNKNOWN 9999
39926 @end smallexample
39927
39928 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39929 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39930
39931 @node Lseek Flags
39932 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39933 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39934
39935 @smallexample
39936 SEEK_SET 0
39937 SEEK_CUR 1
39938 SEEK_END 2
39939 @end smallexample
39940
39941 @node Limits
39942 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39943 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39944
39945 All values are given in decimal representation.
39946
39947 @smallexample
39948 INT_MIN -2147483648
39949 INT_MAX 2147483647
39950 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39951 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39952 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39953 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39954 @end smallexample
39955
39956 @node File-I/O Examples
39957 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39958 @cindex file-i/o examples
39959
39960 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39961 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39962
39963 @smallexample
39964 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39965 @emph{request memory read from target}
39966 -> @code{m1234,6}
39967 <- XXXXXX
39968 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39969 -> @code{F6}
39970 @end smallexample
39971
39972 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39973 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39974
39975 @smallexample
39976 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39977 @emph{request memory write to target}
39978 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39979 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39980 -> @code{F6}
39981 @end smallexample
39982
39983 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39984 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39985
39986 @smallexample
39987 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39988 -> @code{F-1,9}
39989 @end smallexample
39990
39991 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39992 host is called:
39993
39994 @smallexample
39995 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39996 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39997 <- @code{T02}
39998 @end smallexample
39999
40000 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40001 host is called:
40002
40003 @smallexample
40004 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40005 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40006 <- @code{T02}
40007 @end smallexample
40008
40009 @node Library List Format
40010 @section Library List Format
40011 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40012
40013 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40014 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40015 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40016 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40017 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40018 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40019 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40020 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40021 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40022 are loaded.
40023
40024 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40025 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40026 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40027 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40028
40029 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40030 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40031 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40032 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40033 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40034 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40035
40036 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40037 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40038
40039 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40040 offset, looks like this:
40041
40042 @smallexample
40043 <library-list>
40044 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40045 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40046 </library>
40047 </library-list>
40048 @end smallexample
40049
40050 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40051 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40052
40053 @smallexample
40054 <library-list>
40055 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40056 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40057 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40058 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40059 </library>
40060 </library-list>
40061 @end smallexample
40062
40063 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40064
40065 @smallexample
40066 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40067 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40068 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40069 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40070 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40071 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40072 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40073 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40074 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40075 @end smallexample
40076
40077 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40078 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40079 section for each library.
40080
40081 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40082 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40083 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40084
40085 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40086 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40087 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40088 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40089
40090 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40091 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40092 target, the following parameters are reported:
40093
40094 @itemize @minus
40095 @item
40096 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40097 @code{struct link_map}.
40098 @item
40099 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40100 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40101 @item
40102 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40103 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40104 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40105 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40106 @item
40107 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40108 @end itemize
40109
40110 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40111 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40112 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40113
40114 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40115 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40116
40117 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40118 looks like this:
40119
40120 @smallexample
40121 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40122 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40123 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40124 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40125 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40126 </library-list-svr>
40127 @end smallexample
40128
40129 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40130
40131 @smallexample
40132 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40133 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40134 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40135 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40136 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40137 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40138 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40139 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40140 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40141 @end smallexample
40142
40143 @node Memory Map Format
40144 @section Memory Map Format
40145 @cindex memory map format
40146
40147 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40148 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40149 memory map.
40150
40151 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40152 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40153 lists memory regions.
40154
40155 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40156 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40157
40158 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40159
40160 @smallexample
40161 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40162 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40163 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40164 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40165 <memory-map>
40166 region...
40167 </memory-map>
40168 @end smallexample
40169
40170 Each region can be either:
40171
40172 @itemize
40173
40174 @item
40175 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40176 bytes from there:
40177
40178 @smallexample
40179 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40180 @end smallexample
40181
40182
40183 @item
40184 A region of read-only memory:
40185
40186 @smallexample
40187 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40188 @end smallexample
40189
40190
40191 @item
40192 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40193 bytes in length:
40194
40195 @smallexample
40196 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40197 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40198 </memory>
40199 @end smallexample
40200
40201 @end itemize
40202
40203 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40204 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40205 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40206
40207 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40208
40209 @smallexample
40210 <!-- ................................................... -->
40211 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40212 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40213 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40214 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40215 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40216 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40217 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40218 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40219 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40220 and its type, or device. -->
40221 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40222 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40223 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40224 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40225 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40226 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40227 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40228 @end smallexample
40229
40230 @node Thread List Format
40231 @section Thread List Format
40232 @cindex thread list format
40233
40234 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40235 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40236 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40237 the following structure:
40238
40239 @smallexample
40240 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40241 <threads>
40242 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40243 ... description ...
40244 </thread>
40245 </threads>
40246 @end smallexample
40247
40248 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40249 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40250 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40251 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40252 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40253 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40254 auxiliary information.
40255
40256 @node Traceframe Info Format
40257 @section Traceframe Info Format
40258 @cindex traceframe info format
40259
40260 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40261 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40262 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40263 collected in a traceframe.
40264
40265 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40266 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40267
40268 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40269 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40270
40271 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40272
40273 @smallexample
40274 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40275 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40276 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40277 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40278 <traceframe-info>
40279 block...
40280 </traceframe-info>
40281 @end smallexample
40282
40283 Each traceframe block can be either:
40284
40285 @itemize
40286
40287 @item
40288 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40289 @var{length} bytes from there:
40290
40291 @smallexample
40292 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40293 @end smallexample
40294
40295 @item
40296 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40297 collected:
40298
40299 @smallexample
40300 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40301 @end smallexample
40302
40303 @end itemize
40304
40305 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40306
40307 @smallexample
40308 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40309 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40310
40311 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40312 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40313 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40314 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40315 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40316 @end smallexample
40317
40318 @node Branch Trace Format
40319 @section Branch Trace Format
40320 @cindex branch trace format
40321
40322 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40323 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40324 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40325 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40326
40327 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40328 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40329
40330 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40331 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40332
40333 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40334
40335 @smallexample
40336 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40337 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40338 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40339 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40340 <btrace>
40341 block...
40342 </btrace>
40343 @end smallexample
40344
40345 @itemize
40346
40347 @item
40348 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40349 and ending at @var{end}:
40350
40351 @smallexample
40352 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40353 @end smallexample
40354
40355 @end itemize
40356
40357 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40358
40359 @smallexample
40360 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40361 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40362
40363 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40364 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40365 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40366
40367 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40368
40369 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40370
40371 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40372 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40373 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40374 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40375 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40376
40377 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40378 @end smallexample
40379
40380 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40381 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40382 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40383
40384 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40385 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40386 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40387
40388 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40389 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40390
40391 @table @code
40392 @item bts
40393 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40394 @table @code
40395 @item size
40396 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40397 @end table
40398 @item pt
40399 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40400 PT}) format.
40401 @table @code
40402 @item size
40403 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40404 @end table
40405 @end table
40406
40407 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40408 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40409
40410 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40411
40412 @smallexample
40413 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40414 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40415
40416 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40417 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40418
40419 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40420 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40421 @end smallexample
40422
40423 @include agentexpr.texi
40424
40425 @node Target Descriptions
40426 @appendix Target Descriptions
40427 @cindex target descriptions
40428
40429 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40430 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40431 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40432 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40433 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40434 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40435 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40436
40437 @itemize @bullet
40438 @item
40439 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40440 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40441 @item
40442 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40443 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40444 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40445 @item
40446 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40447 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40448 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40449 @end itemize
40450
40451 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40452 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40453 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40454 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40455 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40456
40457 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40458 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40459
40460 @menu
40461 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40462 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40463 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40464 descriptions.
40465 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40466 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40467 @end menu
40468
40469 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40470 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40471
40472 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40473 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40474 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40475 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40476 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40477 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40478 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40479 Format}.
40480
40481 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40482 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40483 specify a file are:
40484
40485 @table @code
40486 @cindex set tdesc filename
40487 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40488 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40489
40490 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40491 @item unset tdesc filename
40492 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40493 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40494
40495 @cindex show tdesc filename
40496 @item show tdesc filename
40497 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40498 @end table
40499
40500
40501 @node Target Description Format
40502 @section Target Description Format
40503 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40504
40505 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40506 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40507 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40508 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40509 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40510 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40511 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40512
40513 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40514 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40515 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40516 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40517 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40518
40519 Here is a simple target description:
40520
40521 @smallexample
40522 <target version="1.0">
40523 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40524 </target>
40525 @end smallexample
40526
40527 @noindent
40528 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40529 the x86-64 architecture.
40530
40531 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40532 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40533 are explained further below.
40534
40535 @smallexample
40536 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40537 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40538 <target version="1.0">
40539 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40540 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40541 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40542 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40543 </target>
40544 @end smallexample
40545
40546 @noindent
40547 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40548 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40549 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40550 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40551 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40552 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40553 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40554 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40555 the version mismatch.
40556
40557 @subsection Inclusion
40558 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40559 @cindex XInclude
40560 @ifnotinfo
40561 @cindex <xi:include>
40562 @end ifnotinfo
40563
40564 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40565 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40566 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40567 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40568 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40569
40570 @smallexample
40571 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40572 @end smallexample
40573
40574 @noindent
40575 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40576 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40577 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40578 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40579 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40580 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40581 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40582 original description.
40583
40584 @subsection Architecture
40585 @cindex <architecture>
40586
40587 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40588
40589 @smallexample
40590 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40591 @end smallexample
40592
40593 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40594 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40595
40596 @subsection OS ABI
40597 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40598
40599 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40600 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40601
40602 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40603
40604 @smallexample
40605 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40606 @end smallexample
40607
40608 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40609 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40610
40611 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40612 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40613
40614 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40615 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40616
40617 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40618
40619 @smallexample
40620 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40621 @end smallexample
40622
40623 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40624 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40625
40626 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40627 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40628 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40629 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40630 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40631 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40632 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40633
40634 @smallexample
40635 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40636 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40637 @end smallexample
40638
40639 @subsection Features
40640 @cindex <feature>
40641
40642 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40643 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40644 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40645 has this form:
40646
40647 @smallexample
40648 <feature name="@var{name}">
40649 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40650 @var{reg}@dots{}
40651 </feature>
40652 @end smallexample
40653
40654 @noindent
40655 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40656 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40657 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40658 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40659
40660 @subsection Types
40661
40662 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40663 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40664 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40665 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40666 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40667 and enum types.
40668
40669 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40670 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40671 Types must be defined before they are used.
40672
40673 @cindex <vector>
40674 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40675 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40676 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40677 @var{count}:
40678
40679 @smallexample
40680 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40681 @end smallexample
40682
40683 @cindex <union>
40684 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40685 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40686 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40687 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40688
40689 @smallexample
40690 <union id="@var{id}">
40691 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40692 @dots{}
40693 </union>
40694 @end smallexample
40695
40696 @cindex <struct>
40697 @cindex <flags>
40698 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40699 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40700 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40701 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40702 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40703 specified.
40704
40705 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40706
40707 @smallexample
40708 <struct id="@var{id}">
40709 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40710 @dots{}
40711 </struct>
40712 @end smallexample
40713
40714 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40715 No implicit padding is added.
40716
40717 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40718
40719 @smallexample
40720 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40721 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40722 @dots{}
40723 </struct>
40724 @end smallexample
40725
40726 @smallexample
40727 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40728 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40729 @dots{}
40730 </flags>
40731 @end smallexample
40732
40733 The @var{name} value is required.
40734 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40735 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40736 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40737
40738 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
40739 is optional.
40740 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40741 and zero represents the least significant bit.
40742
40743 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
40744 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
40745
40746 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
40747
40748 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40749 defining them with @samp{struct}:
40750
40751 @itemize @bullet
40752 @item
40753 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40754 @item
40755 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40756 @end itemize
40757
40758 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40759 defining them with @samp{flags}:
40760
40761 @itemize @bullet
40762 @item
40763 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40764
40765 @smallexample
40766 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40767 $1 = 42
40768 @end smallexample
40769
40770 @end itemize
40771
40772 @subsection Registers
40773 @cindex <reg>
40774
40775 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40776
40777 @smallexample
40778 <reg name="@var{name}"
40779 bitsize="@var{size}"
40780 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40781 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40782 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40783 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40784 @end smallexample
40785
40786 @noindent
40787 The components are as follows:
40788
40789 @table @var
40790
40791 @item name
40792 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40793
40794 @item bitsize
40795 The register's size, in bits.
40796
40797 @item regnum
40798 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40799 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40800 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40801 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40802 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40803 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40804 in order of increasing register number.
40805
40806 @item save-restore
40807 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40808 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40809 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40810 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40811 ABI.
40812
40813 @item type
40814 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40815 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40816 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40817 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40818 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40819 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40820
40821 @item group
40822 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40823 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40824 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40825 in @code{info registers}.
40826
40827 @end table
40828
40829 @node Predefined Target Types
40830 @section Predefined Target Types
40831 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40832
40833 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40834 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40835 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40836 types. The currently supported types are:
40837
40838 @table @code
40839
40840 @item bool
40841 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40842
40843 @item int8
40844 @itemx int16
40845 @itemx int32
40846 @itemx int64
40847 @itemx int128
40848 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40849
40850 @item uint8
40851 @itemx uint16
40852 @itemx uint32
40853 @itemx uint64
40854 @itemx uint128
40855 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40856
40857 @item code_ptr
40858 @itemx data_ptr
40859 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40860 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40861 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40862 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40863 may be marked as data pointers.
40864
40865 @item ieee_single
40866 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40867
40868 @item ieee_double
40869 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40870
40871 @item arm_fpa_ext
40872 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40873
40874 @item i387_ext
40875 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40876
40877 @item i386_eflags
40878 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40879
40880 @item i386_mxcsr
40881 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40882
40883 @end table
40884
40885 @node Enum Target Types
40886 @section Enum Target Types
40887 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
40888
40889 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
40890 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
40891
40892 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
40893
40894 @smallexample
40895 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40896 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
40897 @dots{}
40898 </enum>
40899 @end smallexample
40900
40901 Enums must be defined before they are used.
40902
40903 @smallexample
40904 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
40905 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
40906 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
40907 </enum>
40908 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
40909 <field name="X" start="0"/>
40910 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
40911 </flags>
40912 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
40913 @end smallexample
40914
40915 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
40916 would be printed as:
40917
40918 @smallexample
40919 (gdb) info register flags
40920 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
40921 @end smallexample
40922
40923 @node Standard Target Features
40924 @section Standard Target Features
40925 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40926
40927 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40928 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40929 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40930 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40931 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40932 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40933 can recognize them.
40934
40935 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40936 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40937 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40938 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40939 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40940 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40941 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40942 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40943
40944 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40945 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40946 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40947
40948 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40949 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40950 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40951 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40952
40953 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40954 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40955 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40956
40957 @menu
40958 * AArch64 Features::
40959 * ARC Features::
40960 * ARM Features::
40961 * i386 Features::
40962 * MicroBlaze Features::
40963 * MIPS Features::
40964 * M68K Features::
40965 * NDS32 Features::
40966 * Nios II Features::
40967 * PowerPC Features::
40968 * S/390 and System z Features::
40969 * TIC6x Features::
40970 @end menu
40971
40972
40973 @node AArch64 Features
40974 @subsection AArch64 Features
40975 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40976
40977 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40978 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40979 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40980
40981 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40982 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40983 and @samp{fpcr}.
40984
40985 @node ARC Features
40986 @subsection ARC Features
40987 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
40988
40989 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
40990 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
40991 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
40992 that one of the core registers features is present.
40993 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
40994
40995 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
40996 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
40997 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
40998 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
40999 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41000 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41001 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41002
41003 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41004 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41005 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41006 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41007 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41008 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41009
41010 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41011 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41012 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41013 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41014 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41015 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41016 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41017 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41018 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41019 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41020
41021 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41022 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41023
41024 @node ARM Features
41025 @subsection ARM Features
41026 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41027
41028 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41029 ARM targets.
41030 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41031 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41032
41033 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41034 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41035 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41036 and @samp{xpsr}.
41037
41038 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41039 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41040
41041 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41042 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41043 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41044 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41045
41046 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41047 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41048 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41049 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41050 halves of the double-precision registers.
41051
41052 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41053 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41054 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41055 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41056 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41057 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41058
41059 @node i386 Features
41060 @subsection i386 Features
41061 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41062
41063 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41064 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41065
41066 @itemize @minus
41067 @item
41068 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41069 @item
41070 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41071 @item
41072 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41073 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41074 @item
41075 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41076 @item
41077 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41078 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41079 @end itemize
41080
41081 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41082
41083 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41084 describe registers:
41085
41086 @itemize @minus
41087 @item
41088 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41089 @item
41090 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41091 @item
41092 @samp{mxcsr}
41093 @end itemize
41094
41095 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41096 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41097 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41098
41099 @itemize @minus
41100 @item
41101 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41102 @item
41103 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41104 @end itemize
41105
41106 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41107 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41108
41109 @itemize @minus
41110 @item
41111 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41112 @item
41113 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41114 @end itemize
41115
41116 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41117 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41118
41119 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41120 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41121 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41122
41123 @itemize @minus
41124 @item
41125 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41126 @end itemize
41127
41128 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41129
41130 @itemize @minus
41131 @item
41132 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41133 @end itemize
41134
41135 It should
41136 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41137
41138 @itemize @minus
41139 @item
41140 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41141 @item
41142 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41143 @end itemize
41144
41145 It should
41146 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41147
41148 @itemize @minus
41149 @item
41150 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41151 @end itemize
41152
41153 @node MicroBlaze Features
41154 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41155 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41156
41157 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41158 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41159 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41160 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41161 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41162
41163 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41164 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41165
41166 @node MIPS Features
41167 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41168 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41169
41170 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41171 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41172 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41173 on the target.
41174
41175 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41176 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41177 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41178
41179 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41180 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41181 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41182 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41183
41184 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41185 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41186 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41187 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41188
41189 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41190 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41191 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41192
41193 @node M68K Features
41194 @subsection M68K Features
41195 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41196
41197 @table @code
41198 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41199 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41200 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41201 One of those features must be always present.
41202 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41203 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41204 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41205 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41206
41207 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41208 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41209 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41210 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41211 @end table
41212
41213 @node NDS32 Features
41214 @subsection NDS32 Features
41215 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41216
41217 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41218 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41219 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41220 and @samp{pc}.
41221
41222 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41223 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41224 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41225 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41226
41227 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41228 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41229 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41230 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41231 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41232 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41233 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41234
41235 @node Nios II Features
41236 @subsection Nios II Features
41237 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41238
41239 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41240 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41241 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41242 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41243 @samp{mpuacc}).
41244
41245 @node PowerPC Features
41246 @subsection PowerPC Features
41247 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41248
41249 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41250 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41251 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41252 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41253
41254 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41255 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41256
41257 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41258 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41259 and @samp{vrsave}.
41260
41261 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41262 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41263 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41264 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41265 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41266 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41267
41268 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41269 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41270 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41271 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41272 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41273 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41274 user.
41275
41276 @node S/390 and System z Features
41277 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41278 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41279 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41280
41281 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41282 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41283 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41284 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41285 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41286 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41287 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41288 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41289 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41290
41291 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41292 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41293 @samp{fpc}.
41294
41295 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41296 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41297
41298 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41299 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41300 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41301 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41302 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41303 32-bit wide.
41304
41305 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41306 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41307 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41308
41309 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41310 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41311 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41312 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41313 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41314 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41315 @samp{v31}.
41316
41317 @node TIC6x Features
41318 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41319 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41320 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41321 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41322 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41323 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41324
41325 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41326 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41327 through @samp{B31}.
41328
41329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41330 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41331
41332 @node Operating System Information
41333 @appendix Operating System Information
41334 @cindex operating system information
41335
41336 @menu
41337 * Process list::
41338 @end menu
41339
41340 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41341 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41342 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41343 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41344 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41345 on a different aspect of target.
41346
41347 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41348 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41349 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41350 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41351
41352 @node Process list
41353 @appendixsection Process list
41354 @cindex operating system information, process list
41355
41356 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41357 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41358 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41359 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41360
41361 An example document is:
41362
41363 @smallexample
41364 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41365 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41366 <osdata type="processes">
41367 <item>
41368 <column name="pid">1</column>
41369 <column name="user">root</column>
41370 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41371 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41372 </item>
41373 </osdata>
41374 @end smallexample
41375
41376 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41377 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41378 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41379 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41380 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41381 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41382 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41383
41384 @node Trace File Format
41385 @appendix Trace File Format
41386 @cindex trace file format
41387
41388 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41389 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41390
41391 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41392 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41393 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41394 in the future.
41395
41396 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41397 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41398 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41399 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41400 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41401 of this section.
41402
41403 @table @code
41404 @item R @var{size}
41405 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41406 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41407 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41408 a single trace file.
41409
41410 @item status @var{status}
41411 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41412 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41413 file.
41414
41415 @item tp @var{payload}
41416 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41417 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41418 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41419 reply packets.
41420
41421 @item tsv @var{payload}
41422 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41423 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41424 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41425 reply packets.
41426
41427 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41428 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41429 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41430 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41431 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41432 file. Includes are not allowed.
41433
41434 @end table
41435
41436 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41437 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41438 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41439 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41440 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41441 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41442 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41443 endianness.
41444
41445 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41446
41447 @table @code
41448 @item R @var{bytes}
41449 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41450 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41451 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41452
41453 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41454 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41455 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41456 @var{length} bytes.
41457
41458 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41459 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41460 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41461
41462 @end table
41463
41464 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41465 of blocks.
41466
41467 @node Index Section Format
41468 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41469 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41470 @cindex index section format
41471
41472 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41473 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41474 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41475 description.
41476
41477 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41478 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41479 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41480 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41481 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41482 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41483
41484 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41485
41486 @enumerate
41487 @item
41488 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41489 unless otherwise noted:
41490
41491 @enumerate
41492 @item
41493 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41494 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41495 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41496 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41497 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41498 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41499 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41500
41501 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41502 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41503 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41504 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41505
41506 @item
41507 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41508
41509 @item
41510 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41511 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41512 to the next offset.
41513
41514 @item
41515 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41516
41517 @item
41518 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41519
41520 @item
41521 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41522 @end enumerate
41523
41524 @item
41525 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41526 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41527 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41528 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41529 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41530 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41531 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41532 CU indices.
41533
41534 @item
41535 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41536 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41537 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41538 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41539
41540 @item
41541 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41542 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41543
41544 @enumerate
41545 @item
41546 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41547
41548 @item
41549 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41550 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41551
41552 @item
41553 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41554 @end enumerate
41555
41556 @item
41557 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41558 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41559
41560 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41561 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41562 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41563 constant pool.
41564
41565 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41566 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41567 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41568
41569 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41570 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41571 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41572 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41573 index version:
41574
41575 @table @asis
41576 @item Version 4
41577 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41578
41579 @item Versions 5 to 7
41580 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41581 @end table
41582
41583 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41584
41585 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41586 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41587 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41588 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41589 collision.
41590
41591 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41592 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41593 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41594 the code.
41595
41596 @item
41597 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41598 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41599 strings.
41600
41601 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41602 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41603 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41604 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41605 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41606 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41607
41608 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41609 @end enumerate
41610
41611 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41612 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41613 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41614
41615 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41616 (bit 0 = LSB):
41617
41618 @table @asis
41619
41620 @item Bits 0-23
41621 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41622 @item Bits 24-27
41623 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41624 @item Bits 28-30
41625 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41626
41627 @table @asis
41628 @item 0
41629 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41630 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41631 with previous versions of the index.
41632 @item 1
41633 The symbol is a type.
41634 @item 2
41635 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41636 @item 3
41637 The symbol is a function.
41638 @item 4
41639 Any other kind of symbol.
41640 @item 5,6,7
41641 These values are reserved.
41642 @end table
41643
41644 @item Bit 31
41645 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41646
41647 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41648 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41649 @value{GDBN} sources.
41650
41651 @end table
41652
41653 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41654 global/static attributes in the index.
41655
41656 @smallexample
41657 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41658 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41659 switch (die->tag)
41660 @{
41661 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41662 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41663 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41664 kind = TYPE;
41665 is_static = 1;
41666 break;
41667 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41668 kind = VARIABLE;
41669 is_static = language != CPLUS;
41670 break;
41671 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41672 kind = FUNCTION;
41673 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41674 break;
41675 case DW_TAG_constant:
41676 kind = VARIABLE;
41677 is_static = ! is_external;
41678 break;
41679 case DW_TAG_variable:
41680 kind = VARIABLE;
41681 is_static = ! is_external;
41682 break;
41683 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41684 kind = TYPE;
41685 is_static = 0;
41686 break;
41687 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41688 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41689 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41690 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41691 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41692 kind = TYPE;
41693 is_static = language != CPLUS;
41694 break;
41695 default:
41696 assert (0);
41697 @}
41698 @end smallexample
41699
41700 @node Man Pages
41701 @appendix Manual pages
41702 @cindex Man pages
41703
41704 @menu
41705 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41706 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41707 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41708 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41709 @end menu
41710
41711 @node gdb man
41712 @heading gdb man
41713
41714 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41715
41716 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41717 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41718 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41719 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41720 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41721 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41722 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41723 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41724 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41725 @c man end
41726
41727 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41728 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41729 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41730 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41731
41732 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41733 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41734
41735 @itemize @bullet
41736 @item
41737 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41738
41739 @item
41740 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41741
41742 @item
41743 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41744
41745 @item
41746 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41747 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41748 @end itemize
41749
41750 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41751 Modula-2.
41752
41753 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41754 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41755 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41756 by using the command @code{help}.
41757
41758 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41759 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41760 executable program as the argument:
41761
41762 @smallexample
41763 gdb program
41764 @end smallexample
41765
41766 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41767
41768 @smallexample
41769 gdb program core
41770 @end smallexample
41771
41772 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41773 to debug a running process:
41774
41775 @smallexample
41776 gdb program 1234
41777 gdb -p 1234
41778 @end smallexample
41779
41780 @noindent
41781 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41782 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41783 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41784
41785 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41786
41787 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41788 @table @env
41789 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41790 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41791
41792 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41793 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41794
41795 @item bt
41796 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41797
41798 @item print @var{expr}
41799 Display the value of an expression.
41800
41801 @item c
41802 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41803
41804 @item next
41805 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41806 function calls in the line.
41807
41808 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41809 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41810
41811 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41812 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41813
41814 @item step
41815 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41816 function calls in the line.
41817
41818 @item help [@var{name}]
41819 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41820 about using @value{GDBN}.
41821
41822 @item quit
41823 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41824 @end table
41825
41826 @ifset man
41827 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41828 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41829 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41830 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41831 @end ifset
41832 @c man end
41833
41834 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41835 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41836 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41837 encountered with no
41838 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41839 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41840 Many options have
41841 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41842 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41843 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41844 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41845 more usual convention.)
41846
41847 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41848 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41849 option is used.
41850
41851 @table @env
41852 @item -help
41853 @itemx -h
41854 List all options, with brief explanations.
41855
41856 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41857 @itemx -s @var{file}
41858 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41859
41860 @item -write
41861 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41862
41863 @item -exec=@var{file}
41864 @itemx -e @var{file}
41865 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41866 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41867 dump.
41868
41869 @item -se=@var{file}
41870 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41871 file.
41872
41873 @item -core=@var{file}
41874 @itemx -c @var{file}
41875 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41876
41877 @item -command=@var{file}
41878 @itemx -x @var{file}
41879 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41880
41881 @item -ex @var{command}
41882 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41883
41884 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41885 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41886 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41887
41888 @item -nh
41889 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41890
41891 @item -nx
41892 @itemx -n
41893 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41894
41895 @item -quiet
41896 @itemx -q
41897 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41898 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41899
41900 @item -batch
41901 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41902 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41903 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41904 commands in the command files.
41905
41906 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41907 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41908 more useful, the message
41909
41910 @smallexample
41911 Program exited normally.
41912 @end smallexample
41913
41914 @noindent
41915 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41916 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41917
41918 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41919 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41920 instead of the current directory.
41921
41922 @item -fullname
41923 @itemx -f
41924 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41925 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41926 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41927 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41928 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41929 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41930 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41931 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41932
41933 @item -b @var{bps}
41934 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41935 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41936
41937 @item -tty=@var{device}
41938 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41939 @end table
41940 @c man end
41941
41942 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41943 @ifset man
41944 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41945 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41946 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41947
41948 @smallexample
41949 info gdb
41950 @end smallexample
41951
41952 @noindent
41953 should give you access to the complete manual.
41954
41955 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41956 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41957 @end ifset
41958 @c man end
41959
41960 @node gdbserver man
41961 @heading gdbserver man
41962
41963 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41964 @format
41965 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41966 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41967
41968 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41969
41970 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41971 @c man end
41972 @end format
41973
41974 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41975 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41976 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41977
41978 @ifclear man
41979 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41980 @end ifclear
41981 @ifset man
41982 Usage (server (target) side):
41983 @end ifset
41984
41985 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41986 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41987 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41988 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41989
41990 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41991 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41992 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41993
41994 @smallexample
41995 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41996 @end smallexample
41997
41998 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41999
42000 @smallexample
42001 @ifset man
42002 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42003 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42004 @end ifset
42005 @ifclear man
42006 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42007 @end ifclear
42008 @end smallexample
42009
42010 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42011 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42012 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42013
42014 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42015
42016 @smallexample
42017 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42018 @end smallexample
42019
42020 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42021 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42022 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42023 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42024 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42025 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42026 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42027 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42028 print an error message and exit.
42029
42030 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42031 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42032
42033 @smallexample
42034 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42035 @end smallexample
42036
42037 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42038 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42039
42040 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42041 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42042 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42043 the program you want to debug.
42044
42045 @smallexample
42046 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42047 @end smallexample
42048
42049 @ifclear man
42050 @subheading Usage (host side)
42051 @end ifclear
42052 @ifset man
42053 Usage (host side):
42054 @end ifset
42055
42056 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42057 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42058 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42059 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42060 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42061 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42062 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42063 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42064 descriptor. For example:
42065
42066 @smallexample
42067 @ifset man
42068 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42069 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42070 @end ifset
42071 @ifclear man
42072 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42073 @end ifclear
42074 @end smallexample
42075
42076 @noindent
42077 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42078
42079 @smallexample
42080 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42081 @end smallexample
42082
42083 @noindent
42084 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42085 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42086 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42087 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42088 `Connection refused'.
42089
42090 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42091 described in
42092 @ifset man
42093 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42094 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42095 @end ifset
42096 @ifclear man
42097 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42098 @end ifclear
42099 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42100
42101 @smallexample
42102 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42103 @end smallexample
42104
42105 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42106 case.
42107 @c man end
42108
42109 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42110 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42111
42112 @itemize @bullet
42113
42114 @item
42115 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42116
42117 @smallexample
42118 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42119 @end smallexample
42120
42121 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42122 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42123 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42124 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42125 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42126 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42127 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42128
42129 @item
42130 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42131 program:
42132
42133 @smallexample
42134 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42135 @end smallexample
42136
42137 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42138 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42139 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42140 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42141
42142 @item
42143 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42144
42145 @smallexample
42146 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42147 @end smallexample
42148
42149 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42150 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42151 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42152 debug several processes in the same session.
42153 @end itemize
42154
42155 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42156
42157 @table @env
42158
42159 @item --help
42160 List all options, with brief explanations.
42161
42162 @item --version
42163 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42164
42165 @item --attach
42166 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42167
42168 @smallexample
42169 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42170 @end smallexample
42171
42172 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42173 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42174
42175 @item --multi
42176 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42177 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42178 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42179 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42180
42181 @smallexample
42182 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42183 @end smallexample
42184
42185 @item --debug
42186 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42187 process.
42188 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42189 the developers.
42190
42191 @item --remote-debug
42192 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42193 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42194 the developers.
42195
42196 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42197 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42198 of debugging output.
42199 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42200
42201 @item --wrapper
42202 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42203 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42204 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42205 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42206
42207 @item --once
42208 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42209 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42210 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42211 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42212
42213 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42214
42215 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42216 @c QDisableRandomization.
42217
42218 @end table
42219 @c man end
42220
42221 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42222 @ifset man
42223 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42224 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42225 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42226
42227 @smallexample
42228 info gdb
42229 @end smallexample
42230
42231 should give you access to the complete manual.
42232
42233 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42234 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42235 @end ifset
42236 @c man end
42237
42238 @node gcore man
42239 @heading gcore
42240
42241 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42242
42243 @format
42244 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42245 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42246 @c man end
42247 @end format
42248
42249 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42250 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42251 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42252 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42253 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42254 running without any change.
42255 @c man end
42256
42257 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42258 @table @env
42259 @item -o @var{filename}
42260 The optional argument
42261 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42262 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42263 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42264 @end table
42265 @c man end
42266
42267 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42268 @ifset man
42269 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42270 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42271 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42272
42273 @smallexample
42274 info gdb
42275 @end smallexample
42276
42277 @noindent
42278 should give you access to the complete manual.
42279
42280 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42281 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42282 @end ifset
42283 @c man end
42284
42285 @node gdbinit man
42286 @heading gdbinit
42287
42288 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42289
42290 @format
42291 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42292 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42293 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42294 @end ifset
42295
42296 ~/.gdbinit
42297
42298 ./.gdbinit
42299 @c man end
42300 @end format
42301
42302 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42303 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42304 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42305 described in
42306 @ifset man
42307 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42308 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42309 @end ifset
42310 @ifclear man
42311 @ref{Sequences}.
42312 @end ifclear
42313
42314 Please read more in
42315 @ifset man
42316 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42317 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42318 @end ifset
42319 @ifclear man
42320 @ref{Startup}.
42321 @end ifclear
42322
42323 @table @env
42324 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42325 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42326 @end ifset
42327 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42328 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42329 @end ifclear
42330 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42331 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42332 See more in
42333 @ifset man
42334 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42335 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42336 @end ifset
42337 @ifclear man
42338 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42339 @end ifclear
42340
42341 @item ~/.gdbinit
42342 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42343 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42344
42345 @item ./.gdbinit
42346 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42347 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42348 See more in
42349 @ifset man
42350 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42351 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42352 @end ifset
42353 @ifclear man
42354 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42355 @end ifclear
42356 @end table
42357 @c man end
42358
42359 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42360 @ifset man
42361 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42362
42363 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42364 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42365 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42366
42367 @smallexample
42368 info gdb
42369 @end smallexample
42370
42371 should give you access to the complete manual.
42372
42373 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42374 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42375 @end ifset
42376 @c man end
42377
42378 @include gpl.texi
42379
42380 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42381 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42382 @include fdl.texi
42383
42384 @node Concept Index
42385 @unnumbered Concept Index
42386
42387 @printindex cp
42388
42389 @node Command and Variable Index
42390 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42391
42392 @printindex fn
42393
42394 @tex
42395 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42396 % meantime:
42397 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42398 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42399 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42400 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42401 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42402 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42403 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42404 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42405 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42406 \page\colophon
42407 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42408 @end tex
42409
42410 @bye